Skip to main content

Full text of "STP 21-24-SMCT Skill Level 2, 3, 4"

See other formats


STP 21-24-SMCT 



HEADQUARTERS 
DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY 



Soldier's Manual of 

Common Tasks 

Skill Level 2, 3, and 4 



AUGUST 2003 



DISTRIBUTIONRESTRICTION:Approvedforpublic release; 
distributionisunlimited. 



This publication is available at Army 

Knowledge OnLine ( www.us.army.mil ) and 

the General Dennis J. Reimer Training and 

Doctrine Digital Library at 

(www.adtdl.army.mil) 



*STP 21 -24-SMCT 

Soldier Training Publication Headquarters 

No. 21 -24-SMCT Department of the Army 

Washington, DC, 31 August 2003 

SOLDIER'S MANUAL OF 
COMMON TASKS 

Skill Levels 2, 3, and 4 

TABLE OF CONTENTS 

Page 

PREFACE vi 

Chapter 1 . Introduction 1 -1 

Chapter 2. Training Guide 2-1 

Chapter 3 Skill Levels 2, 3, and 4 Tasks 3-1 

Skill Level 2 

Subject Area 1 : Individual Conduct and Laws of War 

181-101-2023 Enforce the Uniform Code of Military Justice 

(UCMJ) 3-1 

1 81 -1 05-2001 Enforce the Law of War and the Geneva and 

Hague Conventions 3-7 

1 81 -1 05-2002 Conduct Combat Operations According to the 

Law of War 3-11 

224-176-2426 Enforce Compliance with Media Ground Rules 3-13 

331-202-1050 Enforce Compliance with the Code of Conduct 3-15 

805C-PAD-2503 Enforce Compliance with the Army's Equal 

Opportunity and Sexual Harassment Policies 3-17 

Subject Area 2: First Aid 

081-831-0101 Request Medical Evacuation 3-21 

081-831-1054 Evacuate Casualties 3-27 

081-831-9000 Implement Preventive Medicine Measures (PMM) ...3-31 



Distribution Restriction: Approved for public release; dis tribution is 

unlimited. 

This manual supersedes STP 21 -24-SMCT, 1 October 1 992. 



Subject Area 3: Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical 

031-503-1023 Protect Yourself from Nuclear, Biological, and 

Chemical Injury/Contamination When Changing 

Mission-Oriented Protective Posture Gear 3-38 

031-503-2001 Identify Chemical Agents Using M256-Series 

Chemical Agent Detector Kit 3-43 

031-503-2023 Measure Radiation Dose Rate and Total Dose 3-47 

031-503-3002 Conduct Unmasking Procedures 3-50 

031-503-3004 Supervise the Crossing of a Contaminated Area 3-52 

031-503-3005 Submit an NBC 1 Report 3-55 

031-503-3008 Implement Mission-Oriented Protective Posture 3-57 

031-503-3010 Supervise the Employment of Nuclear, Biological, 

and Chemical Markers 3-59 

031-503-4002 Supervise Unit Preparation for a Nuclear, 

Biological, and Chemical Attack 3-62 

031-506-1053 Report Nuclear, Biological and Chemical 

Information Using NBC 4 Report 3-65 

031-506-2061 Conduct a Mask Fit Test 3-67 

Subject Area 4: Survive (Combat Techniques) 

061-283-6003 Adjust Indirect Fire 3-70 

071-326-0608 Use Visual Signaling Techniques 3-79 

071-326-5704 Supervise Construction of a Fighting Position 3-101 

071-326-5705 Establish an Observation Post 3-103 

Subject Area 5: Navigate 

071-329-1019 Use a Map Overlay 3-106 

Subject Area 20: Casualty Reporting and Handling 

805C-PAD-2060 Report Casualties 3-1 14 

Subject Area 21 : Defense Measures 

071-430-0002 Conduct a Defense by a Squad 3-118 

Subject Area 22: Unit Operations 

071-326-5502 Issue a Fragmentary Order 3-123 

071-326-5503 Issue a Warning Order 3-125 

551-88N-0002 Prepare for Unit Move 3-127 

Subject Area 23: Security and Control 

301-371-1200 Process Captured Materiel 3-131 

Subject Area 25: Equipment Checks 

091-CLT-4029 Supervise Preventive Maintenance Checks and 

Services 3-135 

101-92Y-0003 Enforce Compliance with Supply Discipline 

Procedures 3-137 



101-92Y-0004 Enforce Property Accountability Policies 3-140 

101-92Y-0005 Enforce Compliance with Property Accountability 

Policies 3-152 

101-92Y-0006 Inspect Equipment for Accountability, Cleanliness, 

and Serviceability 3-170 

Subject Area 27: Risk Management 

850-001-2000 Employ Accident Prevention Measures and Risk 

Management Process 3-171 

Subject Area 28: Administration/Management 

805C-PAD-2044 Recommend Individual for Award 3-172 

805C-PAD-2145 Counsel a Soldier on the Contents of a 

Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation Report and 

NCOER Checklist 3-175 

805C-PAD-2146 Prepare the Rater's Portion of a 

Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation Report 3-177 

805C-PAD-2402 Provide Input on Personnel Actions Affecting 

Subordinates 3-181 

805C-PAD-2407 Recommend Disciplinary Action for a Soldier 3-184 

805C-PAD-2461 Maintain Accountability of Personnel (Status 

Report) 3-186 

805C-PAD-2472 Prepare a Duty Roster 3-188 

Skill Level 3 

Subject Area 1 : Individual Conduct and Laws of War 

805C-PAD-3238 Enforce the Equal Opportunity Program 3-190 

Subject Area 4: Survive (Combat Techniques) 

052-192-4053 Supervise Minefield Breaching Operations 3-195 

071-410-0012 Conduct Occupation of an Assembly Area 3-197 

071-420-0021 Conduct a Movement to Contact by a Platoon 3-200 

071-430-0028 Consolidate a Unit 3-202 

071-430-0029 Reorganize a Unit 3-204 

Subject Area 5: Navigate 

071-332-5000 Prepare an Operation Overlay 3-206 

Subject Area 19: Crowd Control 

191-378-4302 Form Squad-Size Riot Control Formations 3-224 

Subject Area 21 : Defense Measures 

052-195-3066 Direct Construction of Nonexplosive Obstacles 3-232 

071-410-0019 Control Organic Fires 3-247 

441-091-3000 Supervise the Implementation of Air Defense 

Measures 3-252 



Subject Area 22: Unit Operations 

071-326-3013 Conduct a Tactical Road March 3-256 

071-326-5805 Conduct a Route Reconnaissance Mission 3-260 

071-332-5021 Prepare a Situation Map 3-263 

071-720-0015 Conduct an Area Reconnaissance by a Platoon.... 3-264 

101-92Y-0002 Plan Tactical Re-Supply Operations 3-269 

301-371-1150 Identify Intelligence and Electronic Warfare (I EW) 

Assets 3-281 

551-88M-0001 Lead a Convoy Serial/March Unit 3-286 

551-88N-0003 Plan Unit Move 3-289 

Subject Area 23: Security and Control 

191-379-4407 Plan Convoy Security Operations 3-291 

301-371-1052 Protect Classified Information and Material 3-297 

805C-PAD-3594 Store Classified Information and Materials 3-305 

Subject Area 24: Enemy Personnel 

191-379-4450 Supervise Handling of Enemy Personnel and 

Equipment at Squad Level 3-307 

Subject Area 27: Risk Management 

850-001-3001 Control Mission Safety Hazard 3-31 1 

Subject Area 28: Administration/Management 

805C-PAD-3147 Prepare the Senior Rater's Portion of a 

Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation Report 

(NCOER) 3-312 

Skill Level 4 

Subject Area 2: First Aid 

081-831-1047 Supervise the Implementation of Preventive 

Medicine Policies 3-315 

081-831-1055 Ensure Unit Combat Lifesaver Requirements Are 

Met 3-326 

Subject Area 4: Survive (Combat Techniques) 

071-326-5775 Coordinate with an Adjacent Platoon 3-335 

101-CLT-0198 Supervise Tactical Feeding Operation 3-338 

Subject Area 19: Crowd Control 

191-379-5400 Form the Platoon into a Riot Control Formation 3-341 

Subject Area 21 : Defense Measures 

071-430-0006 Conduct a Defense by a Platoon 3-359 

Subject Area 22: Unit Operations 

091-CLT-3009 Supervise Maintenance Operations 3-363 

101-92Y-0001 Supervise Supply Activities 3-365 



151-357-0001 Supervise CSS Functions During Platoon 

Operations 3-370 

151-357-0002 Coordinate Combat Service Support (CSS) 

Operations 3-373 

1 59-200-2020 Integrate Threat Capabilities into Mission 

Planning 3-376 

181-101-4001 Conduct a Search/Seizure 3-378 

551-721-4326 Perform Duties as Convoy Commander 3-384 

Subject Area 23: Security and Control 

191-379-4408 Plan Security for a Command Post (CP) 3-384 

Subject Area 26: Crime Prevention 

191-379-4425 Implement the Unit's Crime Prevention Program ... 3-394 

Subject Area 27: Risk Management 

850-001-4001 Integrate Risk Management into Mission Plans 3-396 

Subject Area 28: Administration/Management 

805C-PAD-4359 Manage Soldier's Deployment Requirements 3-397 

805C-PAD-4550 Prepare a Standing Operating Procedure (SOP)... 3-401 
805C-PAD-4597 Integrate Newly Assigned Soldiers 3-403 

Appendix A Proponent or Agency Codes A-1 

Appendix B Guide to Forms B-1 

Glossary Glossary-1 

References References-1 



PREFACE 

This manual is one of a series of soldier training publications that support 
individual training. Commanders, trainers, and soldiers will use this manual 
and STP 21-1-SMCT, Soldier's Manual of Common Tasks, Skill Level 1, to 
plan, conduct, sustain, and evaluate individual training of common tasks in 
units. 

This manual contains a common task training plan for skill levels (SL) 1 
through 4 and task summaries for SL 2 through SL 4 critical common tasks 
that support unit wartime missions. This manual is the only authorized 
source for these common tasks. Task summaries in this manual supersede 
any common tasks appearing in MOS-specific soldier's manuals. 

Training support information, such as reference materials, is also included. 
Trainers and first-line supervisors should ensure SL 2 through SL 4 soldiers 
have access to this publication in their work areas, unit learning centers, and 
unit libraries. 

This manual applies to both active and Reserve Component soldiers. 

Unless this manual states otherwise, masculine pronouns do not refer 
exclusively to men. 

The proponent of this publication is the Commander, United States Army 
Training and Doctrine Command (TRADOC), with the Commander, United 
States Army Training Support Center (ATSC) designated as the principle 
publishing, printing and distribution agency. Proponents for the specific 
tasks are the Army schools and agencies as identified by the school code, 
listed at appendix A, consisting of the first three digits of the task 
identification number. All comments, suggestions and recommended 
changes to this publication should be submitted as follows: Record any 
comments or questions regarding the task summaries contained in this 
manual on a DA Form 2028 (Recommended Changes to Publications and 
Blank Forms) and send it to the respective task proponent with inform ation 
copies forwarded to: Commander, U.S. Army Training and Doctrine 
Command, ATTN: ATTG-I, Fort Monroe, VA 23651-5000, and Commander, 
U.S. Army Training Support Center, ATTN: ATIC-ITSC-CM, Fort Eustis, VA 
23604-5166. 

REPRODUCIBLE FORMS 

Following the very favorable acceptance of previous skill level 1 SMCTs 
"pocket-size" format, the August 2003 revisions (STP 21-1-SMCT and STP 
21-24-SMCT) are printed in 5-by-7-inch format. This size precludes 
incorporating full-size, reproducible forms in these manuals. Instead, these 
manuals include a Guide to Forms (appendix B). In the online versions of the 
new manuals, appendix B contains electronic links to the downloadable, 



reproducible forms. Where online access is not available, the soldier's unit 
must obtain hard copies of these forms 

SPECIAL NOTE FROM THE STAFF 
CONCERNING THE REVISED SMCT 

Experienced trainers will notice that, in addition to numerous new tasks in 
the revised SMCT, there are many tasks for which the skill level has been 
lowered from that in the past. This reflects results from the recent survey of 
approximately 19,000 enlisted soldiers, their commanders, and senior 
leaders, to determine who was actually performing certain tasks, and the 
amount of learning that was actually filtering down in the "one room 
schoolhouse" of the working Army. When it was established that a 
significant percentage of soldiers were performing those tasks at skill levels 
that were above their own, it was decided to lower the task designation, 
giving trainers — and the Army— the full advantage of accelerated learning at 
every level. This SMCT, if anything, reflects back to its users a faithfulness 
to this spirit of Army training from whom it derived, an allegiance and 
gratitude to the profession and legacy of every United States Army soldier. 

Thank you. 

United States Army Training and Doctrine Command 

United States Army Training Support Center 



Chapter 1 

Introduction 

1 -1 . GENERAL INTRODUCTION 

This manual contains the critical common tasks for skill levels 2, 3, and 4. 
Mastering the performance of these tasks will help the individual soldier fight 
better and survive on the battlefield, and perform across the full spectrum of 
operations. Each soldier must be able to perform all critical common tasks 
for his or her own skill level and below. The individual soldier shares 
responsibility with the trainer to sustain the skills and knowledge required to 
perform all critical common tasks. 

a. Individual Soldiers. To ensure you can perform each task, have 
another soldier or your supervisor periodically evaluate your performance 
using the task summaries. If you have questions about how to perform a 
task or which task to perform, ask your first-line supervisor. The first-line 
supervisor knows how to perform each task and can direct you to the 
appropriate training materials. You should also check the Reimer Digital 
Library for new training materials. It is your responsibility to use these 
materials to maintain your proficiency. 

b. Trainers. If you are a supervisor and trainer and have soldiers 
working for you, you must train them to do the tasks for their skill level and 
below. Commanders and trainers should use the Soldier's Manual of 
Common Tasks (SMCT), military occupational specialty (MOS) specific 
soldier's training publications (STPs), and mission training plans (MTPs) to 
establish effective training plans and programs which integrate individual 
and collective tasks. 

1-2. SMCT AND SUPPORT OF BATTLE- FOCUSED TRAINING 

a. Overview. The SMCTs document the common tasks by skill level 
on which all soldiers must be trained and evaluated. These documents 
assist leaders in identifying the strengths and weaknesses of the soldiers in 
their unit and provide a means for evaluating the effectiveness of the unite 
individual training program. Evaluation results also tell leaders where to 
concentrate training to improve unit readiness and help soldiers develop 
professionally. 

b. Leader's Assessment. The leader's assessment focuses on 
specific unit mission requirements. It gives commanders a way to evaluate 
soldier performance on individual tasks that directly support their unit 
mission. These tasks may be common tasks as well as MOS-specific tasks. 
Leader's assessments should be conducted year round. Unit commanders 
should make leader's comments an integral part of their unit training so 
hands -on evaluation is systematically performed at the unit level. 

1-1 



(1) Tasks selected for leader's assessments include, but are not 
limited to, individual tasks that — 

(a) Support the units mission essential task list (METL). 

(b) Support other non-METL unit tasks as shown in the MTP. 

(c) Are identified by higher headquarters for inclusion in 
planned individual training. 

(d) Were rated as substandard on previous training feedback, 
such as the common task test (CTT) or annual general inspections. 

(e) Are relevant to the soldier's MOS but not required in his 
current duty assignment. 

(2) Leaders may conduct their assessment— 

(a) Before, during, or after individual skills training. 

(b) As part of MTP training. 

(c) On the job. 

(d) At specially prepared test sites or in a battlefield scenario. 

(e) During training or job breaks. 

(f) After hours in the barracks. 

(g) During special squad or individual competitive events. 

(3) The leader's assessment evaluates the combat effectiveness of 
soldiers and the unit. Commanders can use this evaluation to correct training 
deficiencies and plan unit training. Commanders can also use the results for 
personnel actions (such as preparing enlisted evaluation reports, making 
recommendations for promotions, and other personnel management 
decisions). 

c. Common Task Test (CTT). The CTT is a hands-on test to evaluate 
proficiency on critical combat and survival tasks. A new CTT is fielded each 
year, based on STP 21-1-SMCT and STP 21-24-SMCT. Refer to AR 350-1 
for details on test administration and scoring. Units may administer the CTT 
any time during the test period. CTT evaluations should be integrated with 
training exercises to conserve resources and improve realism. For example, 
units could test soldiers on CTT tasks during — 

• MTP evaluations and other collective training activities. 

• Weapons qualification. 

• Gas chamber training. 

• Stations in a soldier battlefield course or military stakes 
competition. 

The CTT is a routine part of the training schedule; it is a m ajor event on the 
unit calendar. Like the leader's assessment, CTT results are objective 
measures for the commander to use to evaluate unit readiness and the 

1-2 



effectiveness of the training program. Leaders also consider CTT results 
when preparing enlisted evaluation reports and recommending soldiers for 
promotion. 

1 -3. SMCT FEATURES 

a. Common Task Training Plan. The common task training plan 
(chapter 2) lists, by skill level, the critical common tasks for which all soldiers 
are responsible. It indicates where each task is first taught to standard and 
how often training on the task is required to sustain proficiency. Leaders 
should use this information to develop a comprehensive unit training plan. 

b. Task Summary. Each task summary documents the performance 
requirements of a critical common task. The summaries provide the soldier 
and the trainer with the information necessary to evaluate the critical tasks. 
The task summaries use the following format: 

• Task Title. The task title identifies the action to be performed. 

• Task Number. A ten-digit number identifies each task. The first 
three digits of the number represent the proponent code for that task. (A list 
of the proponent codes is given in appendix A.) Include the entire ten-digit 
task number, along with the task title, in any correspondence relating to the 
task. 

• Conditions. The task conditions identify all the equipment, tools, 
materials, references, job aids, and supporting personnel the soldier needs 
to perform the task. This section identifies environmental conditions that can 
alter task performance (such as visibility, temperature, or wind). This section 
also identifies specific cues or events (such as a chemical attack or 
identification of an unexploded ordnance hazard) that trigger task 
performance. 

• Standard. A task standard specifies the requirements for task 
performance by indicating how well, completely, or accurately a product 
must be produced, a process must be performed, or both. Standards are 
described in terms of accuracy, tolerances, completeness, format, clarity, 
number of errors, quantity, sequence, or speed of performance. 

• Training and Evaluation Guide. This section has two parts. The 
first part, Performance Steps, lists the individual steps the soldier must 
complete to perform the task. The second part is the Performance 
Evaluation Guide. This provides guidance on how to evaluate a soldier's 
performance of the task. It is composed of three subsections. The Evaluation 
Preparation subsection identifies special setup procedures and, if required, 
instructions for evaluating the task performance. Sometimes the conditions 
and standard must be modified so the task can be evaluated in a situation 
that does not exactly duplicate actual field performance. This subsection 
may also include instructions the evaluator should give to the soldier before 
the performance test. The Performance Measures subsection identifies the 

1-3 



criteria for acceptable task performance. The soldier is rated (GO/NO GO) 
on each specific action or specific product produced. As indicated in the 
Evaluation Guidance subsection, the soldier must score a GO on all (or each 
specified) performance measure to receive a GO on the task. 

• References. This section identifies references that provide more 
detailed and thorough explanations of task performance requirements than 
that given in the task summary description. This section identifies resources 
the soldier can use to improve or maintain performance. 

Additionally, task summaries can include safety statements, environmental 
considerations, and notes. Safety statements (danger, warning, caution) 
alert users to the possibility of immediate death, personal injury, or damage 
to equipment. Notes provide additional information to support task 
performance. 

c. Training Support. This manual includes the following that provide 
additional training support information. 

• Appendix A (Proponent School and Agency Codes ) — lists the 
task proponents and agency codes (first three digits of the task number) with 
addresses for submitting comments concerning specific tasks in this manual. 

• Appendix B (Guide to Forms) — explains the use of various 
SMCT training and evaluation forms and, in the online version, provides links 
to the forms. 

• Glossary — lists abbreviations and acronyms and their 
definitions. 

• References — lists all reference materials cited in the task 
summaries by type, identification number, title, and date. 

1-4. CONDUCTING COMMON TASK TRAINING AND EVALUATION 

a. Role of the Commander. As a commander, you must ensure that 
your training plan prepares the unit for the full spectrum of operations. The 
plan should enable your soldiers to develop and sustain proficiency on the 
MOS-specific and common tasks for their skill level. Use critical common 
task summaries to evaluate your soldiers' proficiency on those tasks critical 
to your unit mission. An effective training program converts unproductive 
time into effective training time. This will upgrade the skills of individual 
soldiers and promote the development of junior leaders. To develop an 
effective unit training program we reiterate, from the STP 21-1 -SMCT, the 
following seven-step approach — 

Step 1. Set the objectives for training. 

Step 2. Plan the resources (personnel, time, funds, facilities, devices, 
training aids). 

Step 3. Train the trainers. 
Step 4. Provide the resources. 

1-4 



Step 5. Manage risks, environmental and safety considerations. 

Step 6. Conduct the training. 

Step 7. Evaluate the results. 

b. Role of the Trainer. Although training is everyone's business, you, 
the NCO, are the key to training the individual soldiers assigned to your unit. 
You should be the first to recognize which tasks each soldier can or cannot 
perform. You must ensure each soldier takes steps to master these tasks. 
This manual will assist you, the trainer, in doing what trainers do best — train. 
To train effectively, you must perform the following functions. 

(1) Plan the training. You can usually integrate or conduct training 
for specific common tasks concurrently with other training or during slack 
periods. Use the Common Task Training Plan in chapter 2 to identify the 
critical common tasks for which each soldier is responsible. 

(2) Prepare yourself. Get training guidance from your chain of 
command on when to train, what to train, and what resources are available. 
Know the training objectives for each task and ensure you can perform the 
task. Gather the necessary training references for each task, as listed in the 
task summary. 

(3) Obtain the resources. Gather the required resources and 
prepare the training site according to the conditions statement and the 
evaluation preparation section of the task summary. Ensure equipment 
needed to complete the task is operational. Coordinate the use of training 
aids and devices. 

(4) Train the soldiers. Show the soldiers how to do the task to 
standard and explain each step. Give each soldier at least one chance to 
perform the task. 

(5) Evaluate the soldiers. Evaluate how well the soldiers perform. 
You may conduct the evaluation during individual training or while evaluating 
individual performance during the conduct of unit collective tasks. Use the 
Common Task Training Plan to determine how often to check soldiers to 
ensure they maintain proficiency. 

(6) Record the results. Record the GO/NO GO results in the 
leader book. You may use DA Form 5165-R; see the Guide to Forms 
(appendix B) at the end of this publication. Do not make written entries 
directly on the evaluation guides in the SMCT. 

(7) Retrain and reevaluate. Work with soldiers until they can 
perform the task to specific soldier's manual standard. 

Good training increases the professionalism of each soldier and helps 
to develop an efficient unit. You are a vital link in the conduct of good 
training. 



1-5 



Chapter 2 

Training Guide 

2-1. COMMON TASK TRAINING PLAN 

The Common TaskTraining Plan provides information to help the trainer 
plan, prepare, train, evaluate, and monitor individual training in units. It lists, 
by general subject area and skill level, the critical common tasks soldiers 
must perform, the initial training location, and a suggested frequency of 
training. The training location column uses brevity codes to indicate where 
the task is first taught to standards. If the task is taught in the unit the word 
"UNIT" appears in this column. "SD" indicates tasks trained via self- 
development media. If it is taught in the training base, the brevity code 
(BCT, OSUT, AIT) of the resident course appears. Brevity codes and 
resident courses are listed below. 



ANCOC 


Advanced NCO Course 


BNCOC 


Basic NCO Course 


PLDC 


Primary Leadership Development Course 


BCT 


Basic Combat Training 


OSUT 


One Station Unit Training 


AIT 


Advanced Individual Training 


UNIT 


Trained in/by the Unit 


SD 


Self-Development Training 



The sustainment training column lists how often (frequency) soldiersshould 
train on the task to ensure they maintain their proficiency. This information 
is not a requirement, but rather a guide the commander can use to develop a 
comprehensive unit training plan. The commander, with the unit trainers, is 
in the best position to determine on which tasks and how often soldiers need 
training to maintain unit readiness. 



Frequency Codes 


AN 


Annually 


SA 


Semi-Annual ly 


QT 


Quarterly 



2-1 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 






Training 


Training 


Task Number 


Title 


Location 


Frequency 


Skill Level 1 


Subject Area 1 . Individual Conduct and Laws of War 


181-101-1013 


Comply with the Uniform 
Code of Military Justice 
(UCMJ) 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


181-105-1001 


Comply with the Law of 
War and the Geneva and 
Hague Conventions 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


224-176-1425 


Interact with News Media 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


331-202-1049 


Comply with the 
Requirements of the Code 
of Conduct 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


805C-PAD-1245 


Support Unit and Family 
Readiness Through the 
Army Family Team 
Building (AFTB) Program 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


805C-PAD-1391 


Co mply with the Army's 
Equal Opportunity and 
Sexual Harassment 
Policies 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


Subject Area 2. F 


irst Aid 






081-831-1000 


Evaluate a Casualty 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


081-831-1003 


Perform First Aid to Clear 
an Object Stuck in the 
Throat of a Conscious 
Casualty 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


081-831-1005 


Perform First Aid to 
Prevent or Control Shock 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


081-831-1007 


Perform First Aid for Burns 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 



2-2 



Common Task Training Plan 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 


081-831-1008 

081-831-1025 

081-831-1026 

081-831-1032 

081-831-1033 

081-831-1034 

081-831-1042 

081-831-1044 

081-831-1045 

081-831-1046 
081-831-1053 


Perform First Aid for Heat 
Injuries 

Perform First Aid for an 
Open Abdominal Wound 

Perform First Aid for an 
Open Chest Wound 

Perform First Aid for 
Bleeding of an Extremity 

Perform First Aid for an 
Open Head Wound 

Perform First Aid for a 
Suspected Fracture 

Perform Mouth-to-Mouth 
Resuscitation 

Perform First Aid for Nerve 
Agent Injury 

Perform First Aid for Cold 
Injuries 

Transport a Casualty 

Practice Individual 
Preventive Medicine 
Countermeasures 


UNIT 

UNIT 

UNIT 
BCT/OSUT 
BCT/OSUT 
BCT/OSUT 
BCT/OSUT 
BCT/OSUT 

UNIT 

BCT/OSUT 
BCT/OSUT 


AN 

AN 

AN 

AN 

AN 

AN 

SA 

QT 

AN 

AN 
SA 


Subject Area 3. Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical (NBC) 


031-503-1013 


Decontaminate Yourself 
and Individual Equipment 
Using Chemical 
Decontaminating Kits 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 



2-3 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


031-503-1015 


Protect Yourself from NBC 
Injury/Contamination with 
Mission-Oriented 
Protective Posture (MOPP) 
Gear 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


031-503-1017 


Respond to Depleted 
Uranium 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


031-503-1018 


React to Nuclear 
Hazard/Attack 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


031-503-1019 


React to Chemical or 
Biological Hazard/Attack 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


031-503-1035 


Protect Yourself from 
Chemical/Biological 
Contamination Using Your 
Assigned Protective Mask 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


031-503-1036 


Maintain Your Assigned 
Protective Mask 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


031-503-1037 


Detect Chemical Agents 
Using M8 or M9 Detector 
Paper 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


Subject Area 4. E 


Survive (Combat Techniqi 


ies) 




052-192-1042 


Perform Self -Extraction 
From a Mined Area 


AIT 


QT 


052-192-1242 


Locate Mine and Booby 
Trap Indicators by Visual 
Means 


AIT 


AN 


071-326-0502 


Move Under Direct Fire 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-326-0503 


Move Over, Through, or 
Around Obstacles (Except 
Minefields) 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 



2-4 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


071-326-0510 


React to Indirect Fire While 
Dismounted 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-326-0511 


React to Flares 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-326-0513 


Select Temporary Fighting 
Positions 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-326-3002 


React to Indirect Fire While 
Mounted 


UNIT 


AN 


071-326-5703 


Construct Individual 
Fighting Positions 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-331-0815 


Practice Noise, Light, and 
Litter Discipline 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-331-1004 


Perform Duty as a Guard 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


071-410-0002 


React to Direct Fire While 
Mounted 


UNIT 


AN 


071-710-0006 


Plan Use of Night Vision 
Devices 


UNIT 


SA 


093-401-5040 


React to Unexploded 
Ordnance Hazards 


UNIT 


SA 


551 -88M -0005 


Operate a Vehicle in a 
Convoy 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 5. t 


Javigate 






071-329-1006 


Navigate from One Point 
on the Ground to Another 
Point While Dismounted 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-329-1030 


Navigate from One Point 
on the Ground to Another 
Point While Mounted 


UNIT 


SA 



2-5 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


Subject Area 6. Communicate 


113-571-1022 


Perform Voice 
Communications 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


113-600-2001 


Communicate Via a 
Tactical Telephone 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


113-637-2001 


Communicate Via a 
Tactical Radio in a Secure 
Net 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


Subject Area 7. See 


071-331-0804 


Perform Surveillance 
Without the Aid of 
Electronic Devices 


UNIT 


SA 


071-730-0014 


Identify Combat Vehicles 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 8. Hand Grenades and Land 


Mines 




071-325-4401 


Perform Safety Checks on 
Hand Grenades 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-325-4407 


Employ Hand Grenades 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-325-4425 


Employ an M18A1 
Claymore Mne 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


Subject Area 9. M16-Series Rifle 


071-008-0007 


Engage Targets with an 
M16-Series Rifle Using an 
AN/PAS- 1 3 Series 
Thermal Weapon Sight 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


071-311-2025 


Maintain an M16-Series 
Rifle 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-311-2027 


Load an M16-Series Rifle 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 



2-6 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


071-311-2028 


Unload an M16-Series 
Rifle 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


071-315-2308 


Engage Targets with an 
M16-Series Rifle Using a 
Night Vision Sight 
AN/PVS-4 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


Subject Area 10. 


M240B Machine Gun 




071-000-0005 


Prepare a Range Card for 
a Machine Gun 


UNIT 


SA 


071-025-0001 


Maintain an M240B 
Machine Gun 


AIT 


QT 


071-025-0003 


Load an M240B Machine 
Gun 


AIT 


QT 


071-025-0004 


Unload an M240B Machine 
Gun 


AIT 


QT 


071-025-0007 


Engage Targets with an 
M240B Machine Gun 


AIT 


QT 


Subject Area 11. 


M249 Machine Gun 




071-010-0006 


Engage Targets with an 
M249 Machine Gun 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


071-312-4025 


Maintain an M249 Machine 
Gun 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


071-312-4027 


Load an M249 Machine 
Gun 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


071-312-4028 


Unload an M249 Machine 
Gun 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


Subject Area 12. 


M60 Machine Gun 




071-312-3025 


Maintain an M60 Machine 
Gun 


UNIT 


SA 



2-7 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


071-312-3027 


Load an M60 Machine Gun 


UNIT 


SA 


071-312-3028 


Unload an M60 Machine 
Gun 


UNIT 


SA 


071-312-3031 


Engage Targets with an 
M60 Machine Gun 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 13. 


MK19 Machine Gun 






071-030-0001 


Maintain an MK19 Machine 
Gun 


UNIT 


AN 


071-030-0004 


Engage Targets with an 
MK19 Machine Gun 


UNIT 


AN 


071-030-0005 


Load an MK19 Machine 
Gun 


UNIT 


AN 


071-030-0006 


Unload an MK19 Machine 
Gun 


UNIT 


AN 


071-030-0007 


Perform a Function Check 
on an MK19 Machine Gun 


UNIT 


AN 


Subject Area 14. 


Caliber .50 M2 Machine G 


un 




071-022-0001 


Maintain a Caliber .50 M2 
Machine Gun 


UNIT 


QT 


071-022-0003 


Load a Caliber .50 M2 
Machine Gun 


UNIT 


QT 


071-022-0004 


Unload a Caliber .50 M2 
Machine Gun 


UNIT 


QT 


071-313-3454 


Engage Targets with a 
Caliber .50 M2 Machine 
Gun 


UNIT 


QT 



2-8 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


Subject Area 15. 


M136 Launcher 






071-054-0001 


Prepare an M136 
Launcher for Firing 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


071-054-0002 


Restore an M136 Launcher 
to Carrying Configuration 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


Subject Area 16. 


M203 Grenade Launcher 






071-311-2125 


Maintain an M203 Grenade 
Launcher 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


071-311-2127 


Load an M203 Grenade 
Launcher 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


071-311-2128 


Unload an M203 Grenade 
Launcher 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


071-311-2129 


Correct Malfunctions of an 
M203 Grenade Launcher 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


071-311-2130 


Engage Targets with an 
M203 Grenade Launcher 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


Subject Area 17. 


M4 Carbine 






071-100-0003 


Engage Targets with an 
M4 or M4A1 Carbine 


UNIT 


AN 


071-100-0004 


Maintain an M4 or M4A1 
Carbine 


UNIT 


AN 


Subject Area 18. 


9-mm Pistol 






071-004-0001 


Maintain an M3 Pistol 


UNIT 


AN 


071-004-0003 


Load an M9 Pistol 


UNIT 


AN 


071-004-0004 


Unload an M9 Pistol 


UNIT 


AN 


071-004-0006 


Engage Targets with an 
M9 Pistol 


UNIT 


AN 



2-9 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


Subject Area 19. 


Crowd Control 






191-376-4121 


Use a Riot Baton 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


191-376-4122 


Position Yourself in Riot 
Control Formations 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


Subject Area 20. Casualty Reporting and Handling 


101-515-1997 


Inter Isolated Remains 
(After Receiving 
Authorization) 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


101-515-1998 


Evacuate Isolated 
Remains 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


101-515-1999 


Recover Isolated Remains 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


Subject Area 21. 


Defense Measures 






052-191-1361 


Camouflage Yourself and 
Your Individual Equipment 


BCT/OSUT 


QT 


052-191-1362 


Camouflage Equipment 


UNIT 


SA 


191-376-4114 


Control Entry to and Exit 
from a Restricted Area 


BCT/OSUT 


SA 


301-371-1000 


Report Intelligence 
Information 


BCT/OSUT 


AN 


301-371-1050 


Implement Operations 
Security (OPSEC) 
Measures 


UNIT 


AN 



2-10 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


Skill Level 2 


Subject Area 1 . Individual Conduct and Laws of War 


181-101-2023 


Enforce the Uniform 
Code of Military Justice 
(UCMJ) 


PLDC 


AN 


181-105-2001 


Enforce the Law of War 
and the Geneva and 
Hague Conventions 


UNIT 


AN 


181-105-2002 


Conduct Combat 
Operations According to 
the Law of War 


UNIT 


AN 


224-176-2426 


Enforce Compliance 
with Media Ground 
Rules 


UNIT 


SA 


331-202-1050 


Enforce Compliance 
with the Code of 
Conduct 


UNIT 


AN 


805C-PAD-2503 


Enforce Compliance 
with the Army's Equal 
Opportunity and Sexual 
Harassment Policies 


PLDC 


QT 


Subject Area 2. F 


irst Aid 






081-831-0101 


Request Medical 
Evacuation 


PLDC 


AN 


081-831-1054 


Evacuate Casualties 


PLDC 


SA 


081-831-9000 


Implement Preventive 
Medicine Measures 
(PMM) 


PLDC 


SA 



2-11 



Common Task Training Plan 



Task Number 



Title 



Training 
Location 



Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 



Subject Area 3. Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical (NBC) 



031-503-1023 



031-503-2001 



031-503-2023 



031-503-3002 



031-503-3004 



031-503-3005 



031-503-3008 



031-503-3010 



Protect Yourself From 
Nuclear, Biological, and 
Chemical (NBC) 
Injury/Contamination 
When Changing 
Mission-Oriented 
Protective Posture 
(MOPP)Gear 

Identify Chemical 
Agents Using M256- 
Series Chemical Agent 
Detector Kit 

Measure Radiation 
Dose Rate and Total 
Dose 

Conduct Unmasking 
Procedures 

Supervise the Crossing 
of a Contaminated Area 

Submit an NBC 1 
Report 

Implement Mission- 
Oriented Protective 
Posture (MOPP) 

Supervise the 
Employment of Nuclear, 
Biological, and 
Chemical (NBC) 
Markers 



UNIT 



UNIT 



UNIT 



UNIT 



UNIT 



UNIT 



UNIT 



UNIT 



SA 



SA 



SA 



SA 



SA 



SA 



SA 



AN 



2-12 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


031-503-4002 


Supervise Unit 
Preparation for a 
Nuclear, Biological, and 
Chemical (NBC) Attack 


UNIT 


AN 


031-506-1053 


Report NBC Information 
Using NBC 4 Report 


UNIT 


SA 


031-506-2061 


Conduct a Mask Fit 
Test 


UNIT 


QT 


Subject Area 4. Survive (Combat Techniques) 


061-283-6003 


Adjust Indirect Fire 


UNIT 


QT 


071-326-0608 


Use Visual Signaling 
Techniques 


PLDC 


SA 


071-326-5704 


Supervise Construction 
of a Fighting Position 


PLDC 


AN 


071-326-5705 


Establish an 
Observation Post 


PLDC 


AN 


Subject Area 5. Navigate 


071-329-1019 


Use a Map Overlay 


UNIT 


QT 


Subject Area 20. Casualty Reporting and Handling 


805C-PAD-2060 


Report Casualties 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 21. Defense Measures 


071-430-0002 


Conduct a Defense by a 
Squad 


PLDC 


SA 



2-13 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


Subject Area 22. 


Unit Operations 






071-326-5502 


Issue a Fragmentary 
Order 


PLDC 


QT 


071-326-5503 


Issue a Warning Order 


PLDC 


QT 


551-88N-0002 


Prepare for Unit Move 


UNIT 


QT 


Subject Area 23. Security and Control 


301-371-1200 


Process Captured 
Materiel 


UNIT 


AN 


Subject Area 25. Equipment Checks 


091-CLT-4029 


Supervise Preventive 
Maintenance Checks 
and Services (PMCS) 


PLDC 


QT 


101-92Y-0003 


Enforce Compliance 
with Supply Discipline 
Procedures 


PLDC 


SA 


101-92Y-0004 


Enforce Property 
Accountability Policies 


PLDC 


SA 


101-92Y-0005 


Enforce Compliance 
with Property 
Accountability Policies 


PLDC 


SA 


101-92Y-0006 


Inspect Equipment for 
Accountability, 
Cleanliness, and 
Serviceability 


UNIT 


QT 



2-14 



Common Task Training Plan 








Sustainment 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Training 
Frequency 


Subject Area 27. 


Risk Management 






850-001-2000 


Employ Accident 
Prevention Measures 
and Risk Management 
Process 


PLDC 


QT 


Subject Area 28. 


Administration/Management 




805C-PAD-2044 


Recommend Individual 
for Award 


PLDC 


QT 


805C-PAD-2145 


Counsel a Soldier on 
the Contents of a 
Noncommissioned 
Officer Evaluation 
Report and NCOER 
Checklist 


PLDC 


QT 


805C-PAD-2146 


Prepare the Rater's 
Portion of a 
Noncommissioned 
Officer Evaluation 
Report (NCOER) 


PLDC 


AN 


805C-PAD-2402 


Provide Input on 
Personnel Actions 
Affecting Subordinates 


PLDC 


QT 


805C-PAD-2407 


Recommend 
Disciplinary Action for a 
Soldier 


PLDC 


AN 


805C-PAD-2461 


Maintain Accountability 
of Personnel (Status 
Report) 


UNIT 


SA 


805C-PAD-2472 


Prepare a Duty Roster 


UNIT 


AN 



2-15 



Common Task Training Plan 



Task Number 



Title 



Training 
Location 



Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 



Skill Level 3 



Subject Area 1 . Individual Conduct and Laws of War 



805C-PAD-3238 



Enforce the Equal 
Opportunity Program 



BNCOC 



QT 



Subject Area 4. Survive (Combat Techniques) 



052-192-4053 

071-410-0012 

071-420-0021 

071-430-0028 
071-430-0029 



Supervise Minefield 
Breaching Operations 

Conduct Occupation of 
an Assembly Area 

Conduct a Movement to 
Contact by a Platoon 

Consolidate a Unit 

Reorganize a Unit 



UNIT 

BNCOC 

BNCOC 

BNCOC 
BNCOC 



SA 

SA 

SA 

SA 
SA 



Subject Area 5. Navigate 



071-332-5000 



Prepare an Operation 
Overlay 



BNCOC 



QT 



Subject Area 19. Crowd Control 



191-378-4302 



Form Squad-Size Riot 
Control Formations 



UNIT 



AN 



Subject Area 21. Defense Measures 



052-195-3066 



071-410-0019 



Direct Construction of 
Nonexplosive Obstacles 

Control Organic Fires 



UNIT 



UNIT 



AN 



SA 



2-16 



Common Task Training Plan 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 


441-091-3000 


Supervise the 
Implementation of Air 
Defense Measures 


UNIT 


AN 


Subject Area 22. Unit Operations 


071-326-3013 


Conduct a Tactical 
Road March 


BNCOC 


QT 


071-326-5805 


Conduct a Route 
Reconnaissance 
Mission 


UNIT 


QT 


071-332-5021 


Prepare a Situation 
Map 


UNIT 


QT 


071-720-0015 


Conduct an Area 
Reconnaissance by a 
Platoon 


UNIT 


QT 


101-92Y-0002 


Plan Tactical Resupply 
Operations 


BNCOC 


SA 


301-371-1150 


Identify Intelligence and 
Electronic Warfare 
(IEW) Assets 


BNCOC 


AN 


551-88M-0001 


Lead a Convoy 
Serial/March Unit 


UNIT 


SA 


551-88N-0003 


Plan Unit Move 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 23. Security and Control 


191-379-4407 


Plan Convoy Security 
Operations 


UNIT 


QT 



2-17 



Common Task Training Plan 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 


301-371-1052 
805C-PAD-3594 


Protect Classified 
Information and 
Material 

Store Classified 
Information and 
Materials 


UNIT 
UNIT 


AN 
AN 


Subject Area 24. Enemy Personnel 


191-379-4450 


Supervise Handling of 
Enemy Personnel and 
Equipment at Squad 
Level 


UNIT 


AN 


Subject Area 27. Risk Management 


850-001-3001 


Control Mission Safety 
Hazard 


UNIT 


QT 


Subject Area 28. Administration/Management 


805C-PAD-3147 


Prepare the Senior 
Rater's Portion of a 
Noncommissioned 
Officer Evaluation 
Report (NCOER) 


UNIT 


AN 



2-18 



Common Task Training Plan 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 


Skill Level 4 


Subject Area 2. First Aid 


081-831-1047 
081-831-1055 


Supervise the 
Implementation of 
Preventive Medicine 
Policies 

Ensure Unit Combat 
Lifesaver Requirements 
Are Met 


UNIT 
UNIT 


AN 
SA 


Subject Area 4. Survive (Combat Techniques) 


071-326-5775 
101-CLT-0198 


Coordinate with an 
Adjacent Platoon 

Supervise Tactical 
Feeding Operation 


ANCOC 
UNIT 


QT 
QT 


Subject Area 19. Crowd Control 


191-379-5400 


Form the Platoon into a 
Riot Control Formation 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 21. Defense Measures 


071-430-0006 


Conduct a Defense by a 
Platoon 


ANCOC 


QT 


Subject Area 22. Unit Operations 


091-CLT-3009 
101-92Y-0001 


Supervise Maintenance 
Operations 

Supervise Supply 
Activities 


ANCOC 
UNIT 


QT 
QT 



2-19 



Common Task Training Plan 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 


151-357-0001 

151-357-0002 

159-200-2020 

181-101-4001 
551-721-4326 


Supervise CSS 
Functions During 
Platoon Operations 

Coordinate Combat 
Service Support (CSS) 
Operations 

Integrate Threat 
Capabilities into Mission 
Planning 

Conduct a 
Search/Seizure 

Perform Duties as 
Convoy Commander 


ANCOC 

ANCOC 

ANCOC 

ANCOC 
UNIT 


AN 

AN 

QT 

SA 
SA 


Subject Area 23. Security and Control 


191-379-4408 


Plan Security for a 
Command Post (CP) 


UNIT 


SA 


Subject Area 26. Crime Prevention 


191-379-4425 


Implement the Unit's 
Crime Prevention 
Program 


UNIT 


AN 


Subject Area 27. Risk Management 


850-001-4001 


Integrate Risk 
Management into 
Mission Plans 


ANCOC 


QT 


Subject Area 28. Administration/Management 


805C-PAD-4359 


Manage Soldier's 

Deployment 

Requirements 


UNIT 


SA 



2-20 



Common Task Training Plan 


Task Number 


Title 


Training 
Location 


Sustainment 

Training 
Frequency 


805C-PAD-4550 
805C-PAD-4597 


Prepare a Standing 
Operating Procedure 
(SOP) 

Integrate Newly 
Assigned Soldiers 


ANCOC 
UNIT 


SA 
QT 



2-2. SUBJECT AREA CODES . 

Below is a list of subject areas contained in this STP. Table 2-1 
shows the relationship of subject areas between this STP and STP 
21-1-SMCT. 



Skill Level 2 


1 


Individual Conduct and Laws of War 


2 


First Aid 


3 


Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical (NBC) 


4 


Survive (Combat Techniques) 


5 


Navigate 


20 


Casualty Reporting and Handling 


21 


Defense Measures 


22 


Unit Operations 


23 


Security and Control 


25 


Equipment Checks 


27 


Risk Management 


28 


Administration/Management 


Skill Level 3 


1 


Individual Conduct and Laws of War 


4 


Survive (Combat Techniques) 


5 


Navigate 


19 


Crowd Control 


21 


Defense Measures 



2-21 



22 Unit Operations 

23 Security and Control 

24 Enemy Personnel 

27 Risk Management 

28 Administration/Management 



Skill Level 4 


2 


First Aid 


4 


Survive (Combat Techniques) 


19 


Crowd Control 


21 


Defense Measures 


22 


Unit Operations 


23 


Security and Control 


26 


Crime Prevention 


27 


Risk Management 


28 


Administration/Management 



2-22 



Table 2-1. Subject Areas in the Soldiers Manuals of Common Tasks 

Note. Columns at right indicate subject areas included in each manual, by skill level. 




STP21-1-SMCT 


STP21-24-SMCT 


Sub 


ectArea 


SL1 


SL2 


SL3 


SL4 


1 


Individual Conduct and Laws 
of War 


© 


© 


© 




2 


First Aid 


© 


© 




© 


3 


Nuclear, Biological, and 
Chemical (NBC) 


© 


© 






4 


Survive (Combat Techniques) 


© 


© 


© 


© 


5 


Navigate 


© 


© 


© 




6 


Communicate 


© 








7 


See 


© 








8 


Hand Grenades and Land 
Mines 


© 








9 


M16-Series Rifle 


© 








10 


M240B Machine Gun 


© 








11 


M249 Machine Gun 


© 








12 


M60 Machine Gun 


© 








13 


MK19 Machine Gun 


© 








14 


Caliber .50 M2 Machine Gun 


© 








15 


M136 Launcher 


© 








16 


M203 Grenade Launcher 


© 








17 


M4 Carbine 


© 








18 


9-mm Pistol 


© 








19 


Crowd Control 


© 




© 


© 


20 


Casualty Reporting and 
Handling 


© 


© 






21 


Defense Measures 


© 


© 


O 


© 


22 


Unit Operations 




© 


© 


© 


23 


Security and Control 




© 


© 


© 


24 


Enemy Personnel 






© 




25 


Equipment Checks 




© 






26 


Crime Prevention 








© 


27 


Risk Management 




© 


© 


© 


28 


Administration/Management 




© 


© 


© 



2-23 



Chapter 3 

Skill Levels 2, 3, and 4 Tasks 

Skill Level 2 



SUBJECT AREA 1 : INDIVIDUAL CONDUCT AND LAWS OF WAR 



181-101-2023 

Enforce the Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ) 

Conditions:You are a noncommissioned officer (NCO) in a leadership 
position in the U.S. Army. You are responsible for understanding that 
disciplinary action against a soldier for misconduct is a command 
responsibility. You are responsible for understanding the military justice 
system, including the Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ) and 
disciplinary options available to a commander. You are responsible for 
identifying potential violations of the UCMJ and expeditiously reporting them 
to the appropriate authorities for investigation and processing. 

Standards: Understood that disciplinary action against a soldier for 
misconduct was a command responsibility. Understood the military justice 
system, including the Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ) and the 
disciplinary options available to a commander. Identified potential violations 
of the UCMJ and expeditiously reported them to the appropriate authorities 
for investigation and processing. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Describe how disciplinary action against a soldier is a command 
responsibility. 

2. Identify who has authority to take disciplinary action against a soldier for 
misconduct. 

3. Describe a soldier's responsibility to identify potential or actual violations 
of the Uniform Code of Military Justice (UCMJ) and expeditiously report 
these violations to the appropriate authorities for investigation and 
processing. 

4. Describe a commander's responsibility to conduct a preliminary 
investigation into misconduct allegedly committed by a soldier under his 
command. 

a. Describe the basis and procedures of a commander's inquiry. 

b. Describe the basis and procedures of an AR 1 5-6 investigation. 



Skill Level 2 181-101-2023 3-1 





Performance Steps 



c. Describe the requirement for the military police or Criminal 
Investigation Division (CID) to conduct a criminal investigation. 

5. List the disciplinary options available to the commander. 

a. Describe how a commander can take no action at all or close a case. 

b. Describe how a commander can use administrative or nonpunitive 
measures. 

(1) List administrative or nonpunitive disciplinary measures available 
to a commander. 

(2) Describe why a commander would wish to use nonpunitive or 
administrative disciplinary measures rather than impose nonjudicial 
punishment or proceed to court-martial. 

(3) Describe how an NCO leader may be involved in the imposition 
of nonpunitive or administrative disciplinary measures (such as counseling 
or corrective training) to a subordinate soldier. 

c. Describe how a commander can use nonjudicial punishment. 

(1) Define nonjudicial punishment. 

(2) List the different types of nonjudicial punishment. 

(3) Describe nonjudicial punishment procedures. 

(4) Describe a soldier's legal rights during nonjudicial punishment 
procedures. 

(5) List the maximum punishment available under nonjudicial 
punishment. 

(6) Describe a soldier's appellate rights under nonjudicial 
punishment. 

d. Describe how a commander can use judicial punishment. 

(1) Define judicial punishment. 

(2) List the different types of court-martial in the military justice 
system. 

(3) Describe judicial or court-martial procedures. 

(4) Describe a soldier's legal rights during judicial or court-martial 
punishment. 

(5) List the maximum punishment available under judicial or court- 
martial punishment. 

(6) Describe a soldier's appellate rights under judicial or court- 
martial punishment. 



3-2 181-101-2023 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



6. List factors a commander should consider when determining what 
disciplinary option to pursue. 

a. Describe whether a commander should consider the character and ^ 

military service of the accused. a 

> 

b. Describe whether a commander should consider the nature and _2 

circumstances of the offense and the extent of the harm caused. = 

c. Describe whether a commander should consider the needs of the (/) 
Service and the probable effect of his or her decision on the command and 
the military community. 

d. Describe whether a commander should consider the disposition of 
similar offenses in the past and the general disciplinary trends within the 
command. 

e. Describe whether a commander should consider the appropriateness 
of the authorized punishment to the particular accused and offense. 

f. Describe whether a commander should determine whether he has 
jurisdiction over the accused and the offense. 

g. Describe whether a commander should consider the availability and 
admissibility of evidence against the accused. 

h. Describe whether a commander should consider the cooperation of 
the accused in the apprehension or conviction of others. 

i. Describe whether a commander should consider the possible 
improper motives of the accuser. 

j. Describe whether a commander should consider that the victim or 
others are reluctant to testify. 

7. Describe the permissibility of a commander discussing and gaining input 
from an NCO leader regarding which disciplinary option to pursue against a 
subordinate soldier within the unit. 

8. Describe the authority of an NCO to issue a lawful order to a subordinate 
soldier. 

a. Describe the duty of a subordinate soldier to follow this order. 

b. Describe the potential adverse ramifications for a soldier violating 
this order. 

c. Describe the elements and maximum punishment available under 
Article 91, UCMJ. 



Skill Level 2 181-101-2023 3-3 




b. Described how a commander can use 
administrative or nonpunitive measures. 



(1) Listed administrative or nonpunitive 
disciplinary measures available to a commander. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task at the end of military justice training. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be evaluated on his ability to 
understand that disciplinary action against a soldier for misconduct is a 
command responsibility. Tell the soldier that he will also be evaluated on his 
ability to understand the military justice system, including the UCMJ; the 
disciplinary options available to a commander; and the ability to identify 
potential violations of the UCMJ and expeditiously report them to the 
appropriate authorities for investigation and processing. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Described how disciplinary action against a soldier 

is a command responsibility. 

2. Identified who has authority to take disciplinary 

action against a soldier for misconduct. 

3. Described a soldier's responsibility to identify 

potential or actual violations of the UCMJ and 

expeditiously report these violations to the appropriate 

authorities for investigation and processing. 

4. Described a commander's responsibility to conduct 

a preliminary investigation into misconduct allegedly 

committed by a soldier under his or her command. 

a. Described the basis and procedures of a 
commander's inquiry. 

b. Described the basis and procedures of an AR 
15-6 investigation. 

c. Described the requirement for the military police 

or CID to conduct a criminal investigation. 

5. Listed disciplinary options available to the 
commander. 



a. Described how a commander can take no action 
at all or close a case. 



(2) Described why a commander would wish to 
use nonpunitive or administrative disciplinary measures 
rather than impose nonjudicial punishment or proceed 
to court-martial. 



3-4 181-101-2023 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

(3) Described how an NCO leader may be 
involved in the imposition of nonpunitive or 
administrative disciplinary measures, such as 
counseling or corrective training, to a subordinate 
soldier. > 

0) 

c. Described how a commander can use ^ 

nonjudicial punishment. !5 

(1) Defined nonjudicial punishment. 



(2) Listed the different types of nonjudicial 
punishment. 

(3) Described nonjudicial punishment 
procedures. 



(4) Described a soldier's legal rights during 
nonjudicial punishment procedures. 



(5) Listed the maximum punishment available 
under nonjudicial punishment. 



(4) Described a soldier's legal rights during 
judicial or court-martial punishment. 

(5) Listed the maximum punishment available 
under judicial or court-martial punishment. 



- 



(6) Described a soldier's appellate rights under 
nonjudicial punishment. 

d. Described how a commander can use judicial 
punishment. 

(1) Defined judicial punishment. 



(2) Listed the different types of court-martial in 
the military justice system. 

(3) Described judicial or court-martial 
procedures. 






(6) Described a soldier's appellate rights under 
judicial or court-martial punishment. 

6. Listed factors a commander should consider when 
determining what disciplinary option to pursue. 

a. Described whether a commander should 
consider the character and military service of the 
accused. 



Skill Level 2 181-101-2023 3-5 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

b. Described whether a commander should 
consider the nature and circumstances of the offense 
and the extent of the harm caused. 

c. Described whether a commander should 
consider the needs of the Service and the probable 
effect of his or her decision on the command and the 

^ military community. 

d. Described whether a commander should 
consider the disposition of similar offenses in the past 
and the general disciplinary trends within the command. 




e. Described whether a commander should 
consider the appropriateness of the authorized 
punishment to the particular accused and offense. 



g. Described whether a commander should 
consider the availability and admissibility of evidence 
against the accused. 

h. Described whether a commander should 
consider the cooperation of the accused in the 
apprehension or conviction of others. 

i. Described whether a commander should 
consider the possible improper motives of the accuser. 

j. Described whether a commander should 
consider that the victim or others are reluctant to testify. 

7. Described the permissibility of a commander 
discussing and gaining input from an NCO leader 
regarding which disciplinary option to pursue against a 
subordinate soldier within the unit. 

8. Described the authority of an NCO to issue a lawful 
order to a subordinate soldier. 

a. Described the duty of a subordinate soldier to 
follow this order. 

b. Described the potential adverse ramifications for 
a soldier violating this order. 

c. Described the elements and maximum 
punishments available under Article 91 , UCMJ. 



- 



f. Described whether a commander should 
determine whether he has jurisdiction over the accused 
and the offense. 



- 



3-6 181-101-2023 Skill Level 2 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

181-105-2001 

Enforce the Law of War and the Geneva and Hague Conventions 

Conditions:You are a soldier in the U.S. Army. As a soldier, you are 
responsible for identifying, understanding, and complying with the provisions 
of the Law of War, including the Geneva and Hague conventions. You are 
also responsible for identifying and notifying the appropriate authorities of 
any suspected or known violations of the Law of War. The appropriate 
authorities, including your chain of command, must enforce the provisions of 
the Law of War, including the Geneva and Hague conventions. 

Standards: Identified, understood, and complied with the Law of War. 
Identified problems or situations that violated the policies and took 
appropriate action, including notifying appropriate authorities, so expedient 
action could be taken to correct the problem or situation. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Identify the key violations of the Law of War. 

a. Define what is a Law of War violation. 

b. Identify the two general types of war crimes. 

c. Define what constitutes a grave breach and give examples . 

d. Describe what obligations exist if there is a grave breach. 

e. Define what constitutes an other than grave breach or a simple 
breach and give examples . 

f. Describe what obligations exist if there is a simple breach. 

2. Describe the responsibilities of U.S. soldiers to obey the Law of War. 

a. Describe how U.S. soldiers are bound to obey all the rules of the 
Customary Law of War and the Hague and Geneva Conventions . 

b. Describe how U.S. soldiers may be court-martialed for violating 
these rules. 

c. Describe how U.S. soldiers may also be prosecuted for committing 
a war crime. 

3. Describe the responsibilities of the commander in regard to violations 
of the Law of War. 



Skill Level 2 181-105-2001 3-7 





Performance Steps 



a. Describe how the legal responsibility for the commission of a war 
crime can be placed on the commander as well as the subordinate who 
actually commits the war crime. 

b. Describe the circumstances under which a commander may be 
prosecuted for the commission of a war crime. 

4. Describe a criminal order and a soldier's responsibility toward a 
criminal order. 

a. Describe the applicability of a soldier asserting the defense of 
"obeying a superior order" for the commission of a war crime. 

b. Describe whether a subordinate soldier, who actually commits a 
war crime, is excused from prosecution if the commander is charged with 
the commission of the war crime. 

c. Describe the responsibility of a soldier to disobey any order that 
requires the soldier to commit criminal acts in violation of the Law of War. 

d. Describe the responsibility of a soldier to obey the rules of 
engagement and the potential consequences for violating the rules of 
engagement. 

e. Describe the responsibility of the soldier to ask a superior for 
clarification of an order presumed to be criminal or illegal. 

5. Identify the key requirements in processing violations of the Law of 
War. 

a. Describe what actions are required when a Law of War violation is 
suspected. 

b. Describe what your combatant commander-in-chief's (CINC) 
guidance is. 

c. Describe the requirement to report suspected violations of the Law 
of War. 

d. Describe the obligations of the investigative team. 

(1) Describe who appoints the investigating officer(s). 

(2) Describe the qualifications of the investigating officer(s). 

(3) Describe the importance of timely collection of 
inform ation/evidence. 

(4) Describe the Initial Report format. 
Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task at the end of Law of War training. 



3-8 181-105-2001 Skill Level 2 



Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be evaluated on his ability to 
identify, understand, and comply with the Law of War, including the Geneva 
and Hague conventions. Tell the soldier that he will also be evaluated on his 
ability to identify problems or situations that violate the Law of War and take 
appropriate action, including notifying appropriate authorities of actual or 
suspected violations, so expedient action may be taken to correct the 
problem or situation. 



a. Defined a Law of War violation. 



b. Identified the two general types of war crimes. 



c. Defined what constitutes a grave breach and 
gave examples . 

d. Described what obligations exist if there is a 
grave breach. 

e. Defined what constitutes an other than grave 
breach or a simple breach, and gave examples . 

f. Described what obligations exist if there is a 
simple breach. 

2. Described the responsibilities of U.S. soldiers to 
obey the Law of War. 

a. Described how U.S. soldiers are bound to obey 
all the rules of the Customary Law of War and the 
Hague and Geneva Conventions. 

b. Described how U.S. soldiers may be court- 
martialed for violating these rules. 

c. Described how U.S. soldiers may also be 
prosecuted for committing a war crime. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 5 
C/5 

1 . Identified the key violations of the Law of War. 






3. Described the responsibilities of the commander in 
regard to violations of the Law of War. 



- 



a. Described how the legal responsibility for the 
commission of a war crime can be placed on the 
commander as well as the subordinate who actually 
commits the war crime. 

b. Described the circumstances under which a 
commander may be prosecuted for the commission of a 
war crime. 



Skill Level 2 181-105-2001 3-9 





Performance Measures GO NO GO 

4. Described a criminal order and a soldier's 
responsibility toward a criminal order. 

(/) a. Described the applicability of a soldier asserting 

|j the defense of "obeying a superior order" for the 
commission of a war crime. 



b. Described whether a subordinate soldier, who 
actually commits a war crime, is excused from 
prosecution if the commander is charged with the 
commission of the war crime. 

c. Described the responsibility of a soldier to 
disobey any order that requires the soldier to commit 
criminal acts in violation of the Law of War. 

d. Described the responsibility of a soldier to obey 
the rules of engagement and the potential 
consequences for violating the rules of engagement. 

e. Described the responsibility of the soldier to ask 
a superior for clarification of an order presumed to be 
criminal or illegal. 

5. Identified the key requirements in processing 
violations of the Law of War. 

a. Described what actions are required when a 
Law of War violation is suspected. 

b. Described what your combatant commander-in- 
chief's (CINC) guidance is. 

c. Described the requirement to report suspected 
violations of the Law of War. 

d. Described the obligations of the investigative 
team. 

(1) Described who appoints the investigating 
officer(s). 

(2) Described the qualifications for the 
investigating officer(s). 

(3) Described the importance of timely collection 
of information/evidence. 

(4) Described the initial report format. 



" 



- 



3-10 181-105-2001 Skill Level 2 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

181-105-2002 

Conduct Combat Operations According to the Law of War 

Conditions: You are a soldier in a deployed unit who has a mission that 
requires you and your subordinates to be actively involved in operations 
governed by the Law of War. 

Standards: Conducted operations in accordance with the Law of War and 
employed actions to prevent violations of the Law of War. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Identify the key elements of the Hague and Geneva conventions that 
pertain to combat operations. 

a. Unlawful and lawful targets. 

b. Noncombatants. 

c. Lawful use of force. 

d. Protected property— property dedicated to the humanities; 
structures and items of cultural or historical significance; and schools, 
orphanages, and other places dedicated to the use and benefit of 
children. 

e. Protected medical transports and facilities. 

f. Proper use of medical service symbols, a flag of truce, national 
emblems, and/or insignia or uniforms of an opposing force. 

g. Define perfidy and treachery. 
h. Proportionate use of force. 

i. Weapons and actions that cause unnecessary suffering and harm. 

j. Duties of the captor to prisoners of war, retained persons, and 
detainees. 

k. Duties of combatants toward civilians and civilian property. 
I. Rights, responsibilities, and discipline of prisoners of war. 
m.War crimes constituting grave breaches. 
n. State obligations when evidence of a war crime exists. 
o. Requirements to report Law of War violations. 

2. Employ actions to prevent violations of the Law of War. 

a. Protect — 

Skill Level 2 181-105-2002 3-11 





Performance Steps 



(1) Noncombatants/civilians. 

(2) Property. 

(3) Prisoners of war, retained persons, and detainees. 

(4) Medical transports and facilities. 

b. Prevent engagement of unlawful targets. 

(1) Protective emblems. 

(2) Noncombatants and protected property. 

(3) Indiscriminate fire. 

(4) Rules of engagement. 

c. List actions to prevent excessive use of force. 

d. List actions to prevent unauthorized use of medical service 
symbols, flags of truce, national emblems, and enemy uniform/insignia. 

e. List actions to prevent unnecessary destruction or seizure of 
property. 

f. List actions to prevent unnecessary suffering and harm. 

g. List actions to enforce the rights and responsibilities of prisoners of 
war. 

h. Describe the obligations of a military commander with respect to 
prevention, suppression, and prosecution of war crimes. 

i. Describe the concept of command responsibility in relation to war 
crimes. 

j. List methods for reporting violations of the Law of War. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup: Evaluate this task at the end of Law of War training. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be evaluated on his ability to 
conduct combat operations in accordance with the Law of War and employ 
actions to prevent violations of the Law of War. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Employed actions that prevented Law of War 
violations and war crimes to protect — 






a. Noncombatants and civilians. 


b. Property. 


c. Prisoners of war and detainees. 


d. Protected medical transports and facilities. 



3-12 181-105-2002 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 


CM 

"33 

> 

_i 
!S 

C/5 


2. Employed actions that prevented Law of War 
violations and war crimes: 


a. Engagement of unlawful targets. 




b. Excessive use of force. 




c. Unauthorized use of medical services symbol, 
flag of truce, national emblems, and enemy insignias 
and uniforms. 


d. Unnecessary suffering and harm . 


3. Employed actions that enforce the rights and 
responsibilities of prisoners of war. 


4. Listed the duties of the captor to prisoners of war, 
retained persons, and detainees. 




5. Listed the duties of combatants toward civilians and 
civilian property. 






6. Listed the rights and responsibilities of prisoners of 
war. 






7. Listed war crimes that constitute grave breaches. 






8. Listed the State obligations that occur when 
evidence of a war crime exists. 


- 




9. Listed the requirement to report Law of War 
violations. 






10. Listed the specific rules of engagement. 






1 1 . Listed the commander's primary responsibilities. 


- 





Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

224-176-2426 

Enforce Compliance with Media Ground Rules 

Conditions:Given a copy of your command/installation's media ground 
rules in a field, MOUT, or garrison environment, enforce compliance with the 
rules. 

Standards: Identified the steps for enforcing media ground rules. 



Skill Level 2 224-176-2426 3-13 



CAUTION 

Media ground rules may change between various command levels within garrison, 
field, and deployment environments. 



w 



Performance Steps 



< 



Note: Ground rules recognize the importance of media coverage of military 
operations and are not intended to prevent release of derogatory, embarrassing, or 
negative information. However, during operations, specific information on friendly 
5 troop movements, tactical deployments, and dispositions could jeopardize operational 
security and endanger lives. 

Note: Commanders and public affairs practitioners will establish basic ground rules 
ensuring the free flow of information while safeguarding classified materials or 
operational plans. 

1 . Obtain area-specific ground rules from the local public affairs office or 
representative. 

2. Define media ground rules . Media representatives are required to 
contact public affairs prior to conducting any media-related activities. 

3. Determine if the media representative is aware of area ground rules, if 
not explain violations. 

4. Be professional. 

5. Inform the chain of command and public affairs representative if ground 
rules are violated. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide soldier with a copy of the media ground rules. Obtain ground 
rules from the local PAO, chain of command or refer to FM 46-1 . Have one 
soldier play the part of a media representative. 

Brief soldier:! e\\ the soldier media representatives are in the area and want 
to interview soldiers for a print or broadcast story. Evaluate the soldier on his 
ability to enforce media ground rules. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Ensured soldier knew where to obtain a copy of 
media ground rules. 

2. Ensured soldier could define media ground rules. 



3. Briefed media representative of violations to 
established ground rules. 



4. Reported ground rule violations to chain of 
command or public affairs representative. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if 70 percent or more of the 
performance measures are passed and NO GO if less than 70 percent of the 
performance measures are passed. If the soldier scores NO GO on a 

3-14 224-176-2426 Skill Level 2 



performance measure, show or tell him what was wrong and how to perform 
the measure correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

AR 360-1 FM 46-1 

331-202-1050 

Enforce Compliance with the Code of Conduct 

Conditions: As the senior military person in a unit where you and members 
of your unit are placed in a survival/evasion/resistance/ escape situation. All 
members of your unit have completed Code of Conduct training during the 
pre-deployment training phase. 

Standards: Demonstrated knowledge of the six articles of the Code of 
Conduct by establishing and sustaining a chain of command, good 
discipline, and a means of communications. Provided positive moral, ethical 
leadership and direction on how to survive, evade, resist, and escape in 
accordance with the guidelines established in the Code of Conduct. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Demonstrated knowledge of Article I: I am an American fighting in the 
forces that guard my country and our way of life. I am prepared to give my 
life in their defense. 

a. Explanation. The Code applies to all service members at all times, 
whether in active combat, in captivity, or in peacetime as a result of 
hostage situations and terrorist activities. Members of the Armed Forces 
have a duty to support U.S. interest and oppose U.S. enemies regardless 
of the circumstances. 

(1) Medical personnel and chaplains are given special "retained 
status" by the 1 949 Geneva Convention including the GPW. The GPW 
requires that medical personnel and chaplains be allowed to perform their 
professional duties while captured. However, the captors control the 
degree to which these duties can be performed. But, even while 
performing limited professional duties, medical personnel and chaplains 
are held accountable for all their actions. 

(2) Recent experience has shown that captors have disregarded 
the GPW. All confined personnel have been subjected to the same 
coercive PW management practices. Therefore, all soldiers should be 
aware of the behavior standards of the Code and should receive training 
in its application. 

(3) Past experience of captured Americans reveals that honorable 
survival of captivity requires that a member possess a high degree of 

Skill Level 2 331-202-1050 3-15 





Performance Steps 

dedication and motivation. Maintaining this qualities requires - 

2. Demonstrated knowledge of Article II: I will never surrender of my own 
free will. If in command, I will never surrender the members of my 
command while they still have the means to resist. 

3. Demonstrated knowledge of Article III: If I am captured, I will continue 
to resist by all means available. I will make every effort to escape and aid 
others to escape. I will accept neither parole nor special favors from the 
enemy. 

4. Demonstrated knowledge of Article IV: If I become a prisoner of war, I 
will keep faith with my fellow prisoners. I will give no information or take 
part in any action that might be harmful to my comrades. If I am senior, I 
will take command. If not, I will obey the lawful orders of those appointed 
over me and will back them up in every way. 

5. Demonstrated knowledge of Article V: When questioned, should I 
become a prisoner of war, I am required to give name, rank, service 
number, and date of birth. I will evade answering further questions to the 
utmost of my ability. I will make no oral or written statements disloyal to 
my country and its allies or harmful to their cause. 

6. Demonstrated knowledge of Article VI: I will never forget that I am an 
American fighting for freedom, responsible for my actions, and dedicated 
to the principles that made my country free. I will trust in my God and in 
the United States of America. 

Evaluation Preparation: Service member will participate in class 
discussions and respond to instructor's questions about the six articles of the 
Code of Conduct as articulated in FM 3-05.71, chapters 2 and 13. Soldiers 
must be able to write or orally recite the six articles of the Code of Conduct. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


Demonstrated knowledge of the six articles of the Code 
of Conduct by reciting or writing them. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show what was done wrong and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 350-30 DODD 1300.7 

FM 3-05.71 



3-16 331-202-1050 Skill Level 2 



805C-PAD-2503 

Enforce Compliance with the Army's Equal Opportunity and Sexual 
Harassment Policies 

Conditions: You are a small -unit/section leader responsible for the 
supervision of personnel. Personnel include both male and female, and 
represent different races, colors, religions, and national origins. You have 
access to AR 600-20, FM 22-1 00, and the unit and Army Equal Opportunity | 
and Sexual Harassment Policies. 

Standards: Demonstrated personal behavior and leadership consistent with 
the Army's Equal Opportunity (EO) and Prevention of Sexual Harassment 
(POSH) policies. Enforced compliance with the Army's EO, POSH, and the 
Army's extremist activities policies. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Act in accordance with the Army's EO and sexual harassment 
policies. 

a. Demonstrate Army Values associated with EO. 

(1) Display unquestionable loyalty. 

(2) Follow your higher duty to the Army and the nation. 

(3) Treat people as they should be treated. 

(4) Live up to all the Army Values. 

b. Conform to the Army's EO and sexual harassment policies by 
avoiding — 

(1) Making racial or sexual comments and/or gestures. 

(2) Making national origin or religious comments/jokes/slurs. 

(3) Displaying racist or sexually offensive visual materials. 

(4) Making unsolicited and unwelcome sexual contact with fellow 
soldiers. 

(5) Stereotyping fellow soldiers or making assumptions about their 
cultural background, race, religion, or beliefs. 

(6) Using profanity or sexually oriented language. 

(7) Discounting the religious beliefs of fellow soldiers. 

(8) Belonging to extremist organizations or participating in 
extremist activities. 

c. Demonstrate leadership consistent with EO and sexual 
harassment policies. 

(1) Treat subordinates with dignity and respect. 

(2) Treat subordinates fairly and equally. 

Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2503 3-17 





Performance Steps 



(3) Recognize and respect subordinates' individual needs, 
aspirations and capabilities. 

(4) Avoid discriminating against subordinates based on race, 
color, national origin, gender, or religion. 

(5) Avoid using language that demeans, excludes, or offends 
subordinates. 

2. Maintain your unit free from unlawful discrimination and sexual 
harassment. 

a. Ensure subordinates understand Army and unit EO and sexual 
harassment policies and procedures. 

(1) Ensure subordinates understand required standards of 
behavior. 

(2) Counsel subordinates on the legal and administrative 
repercussions of EO/sexual harassment violations. 

(3) Ensure subordinates understand recommended techniques for 
dealing with sexual harassment. 

(4) Ensure subordinates understand the EO and sexual 
harassment complaint process. 

(5) Ensure subordinates understand the Army policy on extremist 
activities and organizations. 

b. Make on-the-spot corrections of subordinates whose behaviors are 
contrary to Army EO and sexual harassment policies. 

(1) Correct soldiers using racist or sexually harassing nonverbal 
gestures. 

(2) Correct soldiers using racist or sexually harassing verbal 
comments. 

(3) Correct soldiers displaying racist or sexually harassing visual 
materials. 

(4) Avoid allowing intimidation, harassment, or reprisal against 
soldiers for making complaints. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.This task can be tested in an administrative or field environment. 
Give the soldier a scenario that provides sufficient information to evaluate 
their knowledge of the Army's EO and sexual harassment polices, prohibited 
acts, and actions that should be taken if a violation occurred. 
Brief Soldier: Inform soldier that they will be tested on their knowledge of the 
Army's EO and sexual harassment polices, prohibited acts, and actions that 
should be taken if a violation occurs. 

3-18 805C-PAD-2503 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Acted in accordance with the Army's EO and sexual 
harassment policies. 

a. Demonstrated Army Values associated with EO. w 

(1) Displayed unquestionable loyalty. g 

(2) Followed your higher duty to the Army and -i 
the nation. ~ 



(3) Treated people as they should be treated. 



C/5 



(4) Lived up to all the Army Values. 



b. Conformed to the Army's EO and sexual 
harassment policies. 



(1) Avoided making racial or sexual comments 
and/or gestures. 

(2) Avoided making national origin or religious 
comments/jokes/slurs. 

(3) Avoided displaying racist or sexually 
offensive visual materials. 

(4) Avoided making unsolicited and unwelcome 
sexual contact with fellow soldiers. 

(5) Avoided stereotyping fellow soldiers or 
making assumptions about their cultural background, 
race, religion, or beliefs. 

(6) Avoided using profanity or sexually oriented 
language. 

(7) Avoided discounting the religious beliefs of 
fellow soldiers. 

(8) Avoided belonging to extremist 
organizations or participating in extremist activities. 

c. Demonstrated leadership consistent with EO 
and sexual harassment policies. 

(1) Treated subordinates with dignity and 
respect. 

(2) Treated subordinates fairly and equally. 



(3) Recognized and respected subordinates' 
individual needs, aspirations, and capabilities. 

(4) Avoided discriminating against subordinates 
based on race, color, national origin, gender, or religion 



" 



Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2503 3-19 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

(5) Avoided using language that demeaned, 
excluded, or offended subordinates. 

2. Maintained your unit free from unlawful 
discrimination and sexual harassment. 



a. Ensured subordinates understood Army and unit 
EO/sexual harassment policies and procedures. 

(1) Ensured subordinates understood required 
standards of behavior. 

(2) Counseled subordinates on the legal and 
administrative repercussions of EO/sexual harassment 
violations. 

(3) Ensured subordinates understood 
recommended techniques for dealing with sexual 
harassment. 



" 



(4) Ensured subordinates understood the EO 
and sexual harassment complaint process. 

(5) Ensured subordinates understood the Army 

policy on extremist activities and organizations. 

b. Made on-the-spot corrections of subordinates 
whose behaviors were contrary to Army EO and sexual 
harassment policies. 

(1) Corrected soldiers using racist or sexually 
harassing nonverbal gestures. 

(2) Corrected soldiers using racist or sexually 
harassing verbal comments. 

(3) Corrected soldiers displaying racist or 

sexually harassing visual materials. 

(4) Avoided allowing intimidation, harassment, 
or reprisal against soldiers for making complaints. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO for each performance 
measure accomplished. Score the soldier NO GO for each performance 
measure not accomplished. Soldier must receive a GO on all performance 
measures to receive a GO for the task. If the soldier receives a NO GO, 
show him the performance measures he missed. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 600-1 3 



3-20 805C-PAD-2503 Skill Level 2 



References 
Required Related 

AR 600-20 

DA Pam 350-20 

DODD 7050.6 § 

FM 22-1 00 

MCM2002 2 

TC 26-6 



SUBJECT AREA 2: FIRST AID 



081-831-0101 

Request Medical Evacuation 

Conditions:You have a casualty requiring medical evacuation (MEDEVAC) 
and a patient pickup site. Necessary equipment and materials: operational 
communications equipment, MEDEVAC request format, a standard scale 
military map, a grid coordinate scale, and unit signal operation instructions 
(SOI). 

Standards: Transmitted a MEDEVAC request, providing all necessary 
information within 25 seconds. Transmitted, as a minimum, line numbers 1 
through 5 during the initial contact with the evacuation unit. Transmitted 
lines 6 through 9 while the aircraft or vehicle was en route, if not included 
during initial contact. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Collect all applicable information needed for the MEDEVAC request. 

a. Determine the grid coordinates for the pickup site. 

b. Obtain radio frequency, call sign, and suffix. 

c. Obtain the number of patients and precedence. 

d. Determine the type of special equipment required. 

e. Determine the number and type (litter or ambulatory) of patients. 

f. Determine the security of the pickup site. 

g. Determine how the pickup site will be marked. 
h. Determine patient nationality and status. 

i. Obtain pickup site nuclear, biological, and chemical (NBC) 
contam ination information normally obtained from the senior person or 
medic. 
Note. NBC line 9 information is only included when contamination exists. 

Skill Level 2 081-831-0101 3-21 



Performance Steps 






< 



2. Record the gathered MEDEVAC information using the authorized 
brevity codes. (See table 081-831-0101-1.) 

Note. Unless the MEDEVAC information is transmitted over secure communication 
systems it must be encrypted except as noted in step 3b(1). 

a. Location of pickup site (line 1 ). (See STP 21 -1 -SMCT, Task 071 - 
329-1006.) 

b. Radio frequency, call sign, and suffix (line 2). (See STP 21 -1 - 
SMCT, Task 1 1 3-637-2001 .) 

c. Numbers of patients by precedence (line 3). 

d. Special equipment required (line 4). 

e. Number of patients by type (line 5). 

f. Security of pickup site (line 6). 

g. Method of marking pickup site (line 7). 
h. Patient nationality and status (line 8). 
i. NBC contamination (line 9). 

3. Transmit the MEDEVAC request. 

a. Contact the unit that controls the evacuation assets. 

(1) Make proper contact with the intended receiver. 

(2) Use effective call sign and frequency assignments from the SOI. 

(3) Give the following in the clear "I HAVE A MEDEVAC 
REQUEST"; wait one to three seconds for response. If no response, 
repeat the statement. 

b. Transmit the MEDEVAC information in the proper sequence. 

(1) State all line item numbers in clear text. The call sign and suffix 
(if needed) in line 2 may be transmitted in the clear. 

Note. Line numbers 1 through 5 must always be transmitted during the initial 
contact with the evacuation unit. Lines 6 through 9 may be transmitted while the 
aircraft or vehicle is en route. 

(2) Follow the procedure provided in the explanation column of the 
MEDEVAC request format to transmit other required information. 

(3) Pronounce letters and numbers in accordance with appropriate 
radiotelephone procedures. 

(4) Take no longer than 25 seconds to transmit. 

(5) End the transmission by stating "OVER." 

(6) Keep the radio on and listen for additional instructions or contact 
from the evacuation unit. 



3-22 081-831-0101 Skill Level 2 

















Table 081-831-0101-1 MEDEVAC Authorized Brevity Codes 








Where/ 


Who 










How 


Normally 






Line 


Hem 


Explanation 


Obtained 


Provides 


Reason 


CM 

CO 

> 


1 


Location of 


Encrypt the grid 


From Map 


Unit 


Required so 




Pickup Site 


coordinates of the 
pickup site. When 
using the DRYAD 




Leader(s) 


evacuation vehicle 
knows where to pick 
up patient. Also, so the 


CO 

_l 






Numeral Cipher, 






unit coordinating the 






the same "SET" 






evacuation mission 








line will be used to 






can plan the route for 








encrypt the grid 






the evacuation vehicle 








zone letters and 






(if the evacuation 








the coordinates. 






vehicle must pick up 










To preclude 






from more than one 








misunderstanding, 






location). 








a statement is 














made that grid 














zone letters are 














included in the 














message (unless 














unit SOP specifies 














its use at all 














times). 










2 


Radio 
F requency, 
Call Sign, 
and Suffix 


Encrypt the 
frequency of the 
radio at the pickup 
site, not a relay 
frequency. The call 
sign (and suffix if 
used) of person to 
be contacted at 
the pickup site 
maybe 

transmitted in the 
clear. 


From SOI 


RTO 


Required so 
evacuation vehicle can 
contact reques ting unit 
while en route (obtain 
additional information 
or change in situation 
or directions). 





Skill Level 2 



081-831-0101 



3-23 




Table 081-831-0101-1 MEDEVAC Authorized Brevity Codes 








Where/ 


Who 










How 


Normally 




Line 


Item 


Explanation 


Obtained 


Provides 


Reason 


3 


Numberof 


Report only 


From 


Medic or 


Required by unit 




Patients by 


applicable 


Evaluation 


Senior 


controlling the 




Precedence 


information and 


of 


Person 


evacuation vehicles to 






encrypt the brevity 


PaSent(s) 


Present 


assist in prioritizing 






codes. 






missions 






A - urgent 












B - Urgent- 












Surgical. 












C - Priority. 












D - Routine. 












E - Convenience. 












If two or more 












categories must be 












reported in the 












same request, 












insert the word 












"BREAK" between 












each category. 








4 


Special 


Encrypt the 


From 


Medic or 


Required so 




Equipment 


applicable brevity 


Evaluation 


Senior 


equipment can be 




Required 


codes. 


of Patient/ 


Person 


placed on board 






A - None. 


Situation 


Present 


evacuation vehicle 






B - Hoist 






prior to the start of 






C - Extraction 






mission. 






equipment 












D - Ventilator. 








5 


Numberof 


Report only 


From 


Medic or 


Required so 




Patients by 


applicable 


Evaluation 


Senior 


appropriate number of 




Type 


information and 


of 


Person 


evacuation vehicles 






encrypt the brevity 


Patient(s) 


Present 


may be dispatched to 






code. If requesting 






pickup site. They 






MEDEVAC for 






should be configured 






both types, insert 






to carry patients 






the word "BREAK" 






requiring evacuation. 






between the litter 












entry and 












ambulatory entry. 












L+# of Patient - 












Litter 












A-tf of Patient - 












Ambulatory 












(sitting) 









3-24 



081-831-0101 



Skill Level 2 



Table 081-831-0101-1 MEDEVAC Authorized Brevity Codes 










Where/ 


Who 










How 


Normally 






Line 


Hem 


Explanation 


Obtained 


Provides 


Reason 


CM 


6 


Security of 


N - No enemy 


From 


Unit 


Required to assist the 




Pickup Site 


troops in area. 


Evaluation 


Leader 


evacuation crew in 


"33 

> 




(Wartime) 


P - Possible 
enemy troops in 
area (approach 
withcauSon). 
E - Enemy troops 
in area (approach 
with caution). 
X - Enemy troops 
in area (armed 


of Situation 




assessing the situation 
and determining if 
assistance is required. 
More definitive 
guidance can be 
furnished the 
evacuation vehicle 
while it is en route 
(specific location or 










escort required). 






enemy to assist an 
aircraft in planning its 
approach). 




6 


Numberand 


Specific 


From 


Medic or 


Required to assist 






Type of 


information 


Evaluation 


Senior 


evacuation personnel 






Wound, 


regarding patient 


of Patient 


Person 


in determining 






Injury, or 


wounds by type 




Present 


treatment and special 






Illness 


(gunshot or 






equipment needed. 






(Peacetime) 


shrapnel). Report 
serious bleeding, 
along with patient 
blood type, if 
known. 










7 


Method of 


Encrypt the brevity 


Based on 


Medic or 


Required to assist the 






Marking 


codes. 


Situation 


Senior 


evacuation crew in 






Pickup Site 


A - Panels. 


and 


Person 


identifying the specific 








B - Pyrotechnic 


Availability 


Present 


location of the pickup. 








signal. 


of Materials 




Note that the color of 








C - Smoke signal. 






the panels or smoke 








D - None. 






should not be 








E - Other. 






transmitted untiithe 
evacuation vehicle 
contacts the unit (just 
prior to its arrival). For 
security, the crew 
should identify the 
coiorand the unit 
should verify it. 





Skill Level 2 



081-831-0101 



3-25 




Table 081-831-0101-1 MEDEVAC Authorized Brevity Codes 


Line 


Item 


Explanation 


Where/ 

How 

Obtained 


Who 
Normally 
Provides 


Reason 


8 


Patient 
Nationality 
and Status 


Thenumberof 

patients in each 

category need not 

be transmitted. 

Encryptoniythe 

applicable brevity 

codes. 

A =U.S. military. 

B - U.S.civiiian. 

C - Non-U. S. 

military. 

D- Non-U. S. 

civilian. 

E-EPW 


From 
Evaluation 
of Patient 


Medic or 
Senior 
Person 
Present 


Required to assist in 
planning for 
destination facilities 
and need forguards. 
Unit requesting 
supportshould ensure 
there is an English- 
speaking 

representative at the 
pickup site. 


9 


NBC Con- 
tamination 
(Wartime) 


Include this line 
only when 
applicable. Encrypt 
the applicable 
brevity codes. 
N -Nuclear. 
B = Biological. 
C -Chemical. 


From 
Situation 


Medic or 
Senior 
Person 
Present 


Required to assist in 
planning for the mis- 
sion. (Determine which 
evacuation vehicle will 
accomplish the 
mission and when it 
will be accomplished.) 


9 


Terrain 

Description 

(Peacetime) 


Include details of 
terrain features in 
and around pro- 
posed landing site. 
If possible, 
describe 

relationship of site 
to prominent 
terrain feature 
(lake, mountain, 
tower). 


From Area 
Survey 


Personnel 
at site 


Required to allow 
evacuation personnel 
to assess 

route/avenue of ap- 
proach into area. Of 
particular importance if 
hoist operation is 
required. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a training exercise involving a MEDEVAC 
aircraft or vehicle, or simulate it by creating a scenario and providing the 
information as the soldier requests it. You or an assistant will act as the 
radio contact at the evacuation unit during "transmission" of the request. 
Give a copy of the MEDEVAC request format to the soldier. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to prepare and transmit a MEDEVAC request. 
State that the communications net is secure. 



3-26 



081-831-0101 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Collected all information needed for the MEDEVAC 
request line items 1 through 9. 



2. Recorded the information using authorized brevity ^ 

codes. "5; 

> 

3. Transmitted the MEDEVAC request within 25 _3 

seconds. = 

!2 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures w 

are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 8-1 0-6 



081-831-1054 

Evacuate Casualties 

Conditions: You are a soldier deployed to a unit in a forward area. There 
are casualties that must be evacuated to receive medical aid. The 
casualties have had self-aid or buddy-aid applied. A military vehicle (ground 
vehicle or rotary-wing aircraft) is available. You may have a litter and straps 
(or materials to improvise them) to secure the casualty and other soldiers 
available to assist in the evacuation. 

Standards: Transported the casualties to medical aid or a pickup site using 
an appropriate carry or, if other soldiers are available, by litter. The litter was 
loaded onto a military vehicle (ground vehicle or rotary-wing aircraft) without 
dropping or causing further injury to the casualty. 

Performance Steps 

1. Request medical evacuation. (See Task 081 -831 -01 01.) 

a. Make contact. 

b. Determine whether casualties must be moved or will be picked up 
at current location. If they must be moved, continue with step 2. If they 
will not be moved, continue to monitor communications and go to step 5. 

2. Transport a casualty using the one and two man carries. (SeeSTP 
21-1 -SMCT, Task 081 -831 -1 046.) 

Note. Perform these procedures when medical and combat lifesaver personnel 
are not available. As soon as medical personnel are available, assist them, as 
necessary, in treating and evacuating the casualties. 

Skill Level 2 081-831-1054 3-27 




Performance Steps 



3. Move a casualty, if necessary, using a four-man litter squad. 

Note. If military vehicles and litter materials are not available, continue with step 4. 

Note. Four-man litter squad bearers should be designated with a number from 1 to 

4. The litter bearer designated as #1 is the leader of the squad. 

a. Prepare the litter. 

(1) Open a standard litter. 

(2) Lock the spreader bars at each end of the litter with your foot. 

b. Prepare the casualty. 

(1) Place the casualty onto the litter using the modified two-man 
arms carry or the modified two-man fore-and-aft carry. 

(2) Secure the casualty to the litter with litter straps. 

c. Lift the litter. 

(1 ) Position one squad member at each litter handle with the litter 
squad leader at the casualty's right shoulder. 

Note. The leader should be at the right shoulder to monitor the casualty's 
condition. 

(2) On the preparatory command, "PREPARE TO LIFT," the four 
bearers kneel beside and grasp the litter handles. 

(3) On the command, "LIFT," all bearers rise together. 

(4) On the command, "FOUR MAN CARRY, MOVE ," all bearers 
walk forward in unison. 

(a) If the casualty does not have a fractured leg, carry the 
casualty feet first on level ground and head first when going up hill. 

(b) If the casualty has a fractured leg, carry the casualty head 
first, except when going up hill. 

(5) To change direction of movement, such as from feet first to 
head first, begin in a litter-post carry position. The front and back bearers 
release the litter and the middle bearers rotate the litter and themselves. 

4. Load casualties onto a military vehicle. 

a. Ground ambulance. 

Note. Ground ambulances have medical specialists to take care of the casualties 
during evacuation. Follow any special instructions for loading, securing, or 
unloading casualties. 

(1) Make sure each litter casualty is secured to his or her litter. 
(Use litter straps when available.) 

(2) Load the most serious casualty last. 

3-28 081-831-1054 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(3) Load the casualty head first (head in the direction of travel) 
rather than feet first. 

(4) Make sure each litter is secured to the vehicle. 

b. Air ambulance. 

Note. Air ambulances have medical specialists to take care of the casualties 
during evacuation. Follow any special instructions for loading, securing, or 
unloading casualties. 

(1) Remain 50 yards from the helicopter until the litter squad is 
signaled to approach the aircraft. 

(2) Approach the aircraft in full view of the aircraft crew, 
maintaining visual confirmation that the crew is aware of the approach of 
the litter party. Ensure that the aircrew can continue to visually distinguish 
friendly from enemy personnel at all times. Maintain a low silhouette 
when approaching the aircraft. 

(3) Approach UH-60/UH-1 aircraft from the sides. Do not 
approach from the front or rear. If you must move to the opposite side of 
the aircraft, approach from the side to the skin of the aircraft. Then, hug 
the skin of the aircraft, and move around the front of the aircraft to the 
other side. 

(4) Load the most seriously injured casualty last. 

(5) Load the casualty who will occupy the upper birth first, then 
load the next litter casualty immediately under the first casualty. 

Note. This is done to keep the casualty from accidentally falling on another 
casualty if his litter is dropped before it is secured. 

(6) When casualties are placed lengthwise, position them with 
their heads toward the direction of travel. 

(7) Make sure each litter casualty is secured to his or her litter. 

(8) Make sure each litter is secured to the aircraft. 

c. Ground military vehicles. 

Note. Nonmedical military vehicles may be used to evacuate casualties when no 
medical evacuation vehicles are available. If medical personnel are present, 
follow their instructions for loading, securing, and unloading casualties. 

(1) When loading casualties into the vehicle, load the most 
seriously injured casualty last. 

(2) When a casualty is placed lengthwise, load the casualty with 
his or her head pointing forward, toward the direction of travel. 

(3) Ensure each litter casualty is secured to the litter. (Use litter 
straps, if available.) 

Skill Level 2 081-831-1054 3-29 





Performance Steps 



(4) Secure each litter to the vehicle as it is loaded into place. 
Make sure each litter is secured. 

(5) Watch the casualties closely for life-threatening conditions and 
provide first aid, as necessary. (See STP 21 -1 -SMCT, Task 081 -831 - 
1000.) 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a training exercise involving a MEDEVAC 
aircraft or vehicle, or simulate it by creating a scenario, and provide the 
equipment needed for the evaluation. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldiers the scenario to include the end result desired. 



Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 


1 . Requested medical evacuation (not measured). 
(See Task 081 -831 -01 01.) 


2. Transported a casualty using one- and two-man 
carries, if necessary (not measured). (See STP 21-1- 
SMCT, Task 081 -831 -1046.) 




3. Moved a casualty using a four-man litter squad, if 
necessary. 




a. Prepared the litter. 


b. Prepared the casualty. 


c. Lifted the litter. 


4. Loaded casualties onto a military vehicle. 


a. Ground ambulance. 


b. Air ambulance. 


c. Ground military vehicles. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all the performance 
measures are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any of the performance 
measures are failed. If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done 
wrong and how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

STP 21-1 -SMCT FM 4-25.11 

FM 8-1 0-6 



3-30 081-831-1054 Skill Level 2 



081-831-9000 

Implement Preventive Medicine Measures 

Conditions:You are a unit leader. Your unit is deployed to the field. You 

have the equipment authorized by your table of organization and equipment 2! 

(TOE), field sanitation equipment and supplies, and a field sanitation team > 

(FST) for every unit subject to deployment in a field environment. °- 

Note. Company aidmen (91 W), organic or attached to deployed units, normally fulfill 
the requirement for the FST. 

Standards: Briefed personnel on the three reasons soldiers are vulnerable 
to disease. Trained personnel on the seven major components of the 
medical threat to field forces. Trained soldiers on the seven individual 
preventive medicine measures necessary to prevent disease and nonbattle 
injuries. Taught the Army's tobacco use policies. Ensured selected unit 
personnel received field sanitation team training on the team's eight areas of 
responsibility. 

Performance Steps 

Note. Once FST personnel are selected and trained, they can be delegated the 
responsibility for training other members of the unit. 

1 . Brief personnel on the three reasons a soldier is vulnerable to 
disease. 

a. Harshness of the environment such as deserts, jungles, and the 
Arctic. 

b. Reduced natural defenses due to exposure and fatigue. Examples 
are — 

(1) Climatic changes. 

(2) Sleep deprivation. 

(3) Irregular meals. 

c. Breakdowns in basic sanitation, such as the lack of clean water 
and proper waste disposal. 

2. Train personnel on the seven major components of the medical threat 
to field forces. 

a. Heat. Types of heat injuries. 

(1) Heat cramps. 

(2) Heat exhaustion. 

(3) Heatstroke — a medical emergency. 

b. Cold. Types of cold injuries. 
(1) Chilblain. 



Skill Level 2 081-831-9000 3-31 





Performance Steps 



(2) Immersion foot. 

(3) Trench foot. 

(4) Frostbite. 

(5) General hypothermia. 

c. Arthropods (biting insects). 

(1) Diseases transmitted directly by arthropods. 

(a) Mosquitoes — malaria, yellow fever, dengue fever, and 
encephalitis. 

(b) Some ticks, as well as mosquitoes — encephalitis. 

(c) Sand flies — sand fly fever. 

(d) Body lice — epidemic typhus. 

(e) Hard ticks — Lyme disease. 

(2) Diseases transmitted by insects associated with rodents. 

(a) Fleas — plague and endemic typhus. 

(b) Mites — scrub typhus. 

d. Diarrhea. Diarrheal disease is contracted from contaminated food 
and water. 

(1) Waterbome diarrheal disease. 

(a) Typhoid fever. 

(b) Cholera. 

(c) Traveler's diarrhea. 

(d) Hepatitis A. 

(2) Food-borne diarrheal diseases. 

(a) Traveler's diarrhea. 

(b) Cholera. 

(c) Salmonellosis. 

(d) Hepatitis. 

e. Non-NBC chemical hazards. 

(1) Examples of non-NBC chemical hazards. 

(a) Carbon monoxide. 

(b) Hydrogen chloride. 

(c) Bore/gun gases. 

(d) Solvents, greases, insecticides, and oils. 



3-32 081-831-9000 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(2) Harmful effects of non-NBC chemical hazards. 

(a) Skin irritation. 

(b) Asphyxiation (choke, suffocate). 

(c) Central nervous system depression. 

(d) Death. 

f. Noise hazards. 

(1) Examples of noise hazards. 

(a) Weapons. 

(b) Aircraft. 

(c) Most Army vehicles and generators. 

(2) Harmful effects of hazardous noise exposures. 

(a) Temporary loss of hearing — lasts minutes to hours. 

(b) Permanent loss of hearing. 

(c) Blast over pressure effects. 

g. Other medical threats to field forces. 

(1) Skin disease — common in extremely dry or humid climates. 

(2) Altitude sickness — locations above 9,000 feet. 

(3) Harmful animals — poisonous reptiles, arthropods, and 
mollusks and coelenterates (such as jellyfishes and corals). 

(4) Tobacco use. 

(5) Poor medical threat intelligence. 

3. Train personnel on the seven individual preventive medicine 
measures (PMM) necessary to prevent disease and nonbattle injury 
(DNBI). 

Note. Once personnel have received the training on PMM, leaders should check 
periodically for application of PMM as appropriate for their situation. 

a. Prevent heat injuries. 

(1) Drink plenty of water. 

(2) Observe work and/or rest cycles. 

(3) Eat all meals to replace salt. 

(4) Recognize the risk of mission-oriented protective posture 
(MOPP) for body armor and armored vehicles. 

(5) Modify your uniform. 

b. Prevent cold injuries. 

Skill Level 2 081-831-9000 3-33 





Performance Steps 



(1 ) Drink plenty of water and warm nonalcoholic fluids. 

(2) Do NOT sleep in a vehicle with the engine running or in an 
enclosed area where an open fire is burning. 

(3) Wear your uniform properly. 

(a) Wear clothing as the commander directs. 

(b) Keep clothing clean and dry. (Avoid fuel spills.) 

(c) Avoid overheating by removing excess clothing when 
possible. 

(d) Wear clothing in loose layers. (Avoid tight-fitting clothing.) 

(4) Avoid loss of body heat. 

(a) Keep moving when possible. (Exercise big muscles, toes, 
feet, fingers, and hands.) 

(b) Avoid standing directly on cold, wet ground. 

(c) Avoid smoking. (Smoking decreases blood flow to the 
skin.) 

(d) Eat all meals to maintain energy. 

(5) Protect feet and hands by wearing gloves or mittens, changing 
socks frequently, and avoiding skin contact with snow, fuel, or bare metal. 

(6) Use the buddy system to spot frostbite on exposed skin. 

c. Protect against biting insects. 

(1) Use insect repellent according to label directions and 
precautions. 

(2) Wear your uniform as the commander directs. 

(3) Keep your uniform clean. 

(4) Follow medical advice; take antimalarial pills when directed 
and use insect powder, cream, and/or shampoo when prescribed by 
medical personnel. 

(5) Protect yourself at night. 

(a) Use a bed net when sleeping. 

(b) Use aerosol insecticide inside bed net. 

d. Protect against diarrhea. 

(1) Follow water sanitation guidelines. 

(a) Fill canteen with treated water, when possible. 

(b) Treat water (when treated water is not available) with 
iodine tablets, chlorine ampules, or boil water for 5 to 1 minutes (if iodine 
or chlorine is not available). (Boiling water for only 1 5 seconds will help.) 

3-34 081-831-9000 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(2) Follow food sanitation guidelines. 

(a) Use approved food sources. 

(b) Wash your mess kit carefully, in a mess kit laundry and cm 
with treated water. g 

(c) Wash hands after using the latrine and before touching .3 
food or food contact surfaces. j= 

(d) Bury waste or otherwise properly dispose of waste to w 
prevent spread of germs by flies. 

e. Prevent injuries from non-NBC chemical hazards. 

(1) Prevent carbon monoxide poisoning by — 

(a) Running engines outside. 

(b) Using natural ventilation or tailpipe extension systems to 
dispose of exhaust fumes. 

(c) Never using engine exhaust for heat. 

(2) Prevent hydrogen chloride (and other propellant exhaust) 
injuries by — 

(a) Positioning yourself upwind of rocket systems. 

(b) Holding your breath (after the blast) until the cloud 
passes. 

(3) Prevent injuries from bore/gun gases (from conventional 
weapons). 

(a) Use on-board ventilation systems. 

(b) Keep the bore evacuator well maintained on large weapon 
systems. 

(4) Prevent injuries from solvents, greases, and oils (liquid 
chemicals). 

(a) Minimize worker exposure by substituting less harmful 
chemicals for toxic chemicals. 

(b) Use personal protective equipment and practice good 
personal hygiene. 

(c) Comply with replacement and medical surveillance 
phys ical examinations to detect early signs of occupational disease. 

f. Prevent noise hazard injuries. 

(1) Use protective devices (earplugs, ear canal caps, or earmuffs). 

(2) Use vehicle headgear such as helicopter crew helmets and 
armored vehicle crew helmets. 



Skill Level 2 081-831-9000 3-35 




Performance Steps 



(3) Keep hearing protection devices clean to avoid ear infections. 

(4) Avoid noise and/or limit the time in noise hazardous areas. 
g. Prevent other DNBI (individual PMM). 

(1) Protect against skin disease. 

(a) Protect skin from elements. 

(b) Use sunscreen, if necessary. 

(c) Keep skin as clean as possible. 

(2) Protect against altitude sickness. 

(a) Acclimatize to new elevations. 

(b) Increase aerobic exercise prior to exposure. 

(c) Follow medical advice. 

(3) Avoid harmful animals. 

(a) Avoid habitats of harmful animals. 

(b) Do NOT attempt to capture or make pets of harmful 
animals. 

(4) Refrain from tobacco use. 

4. Explain the Army's tobacco use policies. 

a. Effects of tobacco use. 

b. Mission readiness. 

c. Army policies. 

(1) Army's Healthy #1 People 2000 Goal: reduce military smokers 
to 20 percent. 

(2) Army's Healthy #2 People 2000 Goal: reduce smokeless 
tobacco use to 4 percent for the 1 2-to-24 year age group. 

(3) Regulatory requirements under AR 600-63. 

5. Ensure training of personnel as members of a field sanitation team 
(FST) is provided if appropriate. 

Note. Training of FST members enables unit commanders to provide for limited 
control of insects, proper disinfection of water, and safe food supplies. Training of 
personnel as FST members will be provided by supporting medical resources. 

a. FST members, when no organic medical personnel are available. 

(1) Two soldiers are selected to receive FST training. 

(2) One soldier must be an NCO. 

(3) Neither will have less than six months of unit time remaining. 



3-36 081-831-9000 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(4) These soldiers should receive training from PM personnel in 
accordance with AR 40-5. 
Note. All unit leaders are expected to perform FST tasks. 

b. FST tasks and/or responsibilities. The unit FST performs the 
following tasks in the unit area: 

(1) Checks unit water supplies. 

(2) Inspects unit water containers and unit water trailers. 

(3) Inspects unit field food operations for application of PMM to 
prevent contamination. 

(4) Conducts limited control of insects. 

(5) Inspects unit waste disposal for compliance with accepted 
PMM. 

(6) Conducts limited control of rodents. 

(7) Provides training for individual PMM training in the unit. 

(8) Advises unit leaders on construction and maintenance of field 
waste disposal and personal hygiene devices. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate each soldier individually during a field training exercise 
(FTX) or normal training session. Use the location, weather conditions, and 
duration of the FTX as the scenario to base your evaluation questions 
around. If the evaluation is conducted during normal training sessions, 
create a scenario as the basis for your evaluation questions. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to answer 
preventive medicine measure questions pertaining to the training scenario 
provided. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Identified the three reasons soldiers are vulnerable 

to disease. 




2. Identified the seven major components of the 
medical threat to field forces. 



3. Identified preventive medicine m easures used in the 
prevention of various diseases and nonbattle injuries. 



4. Identified the Army's tobacco use policies. 



5. Identified requirements for FST manning and 
training. 



Skill Level 2 081-831-9000 3-37 




Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 40-5 
AR 600-63 
FM 4-25.12 
FM21-10 



SUBJECT AREA 3: NUCLEAR, BIOLOGICAL, AND CHEMICAL (NBC) 



031-503-1023 

Protect Yourself from Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical 
Injury/Contamination When Changing Mission-Oriented Protective 
Posture Gear 

Conditions:You are in MOPP 4 with load-bearing equipment (LBE). Your 
MOPP gear is contaminated. Your buddy is in MOPP 4 with LBE, and he is 
available to assist you with MOPP gear exchange. You have an 
uncontaminated set of chemical MOPP gear for yourself and your buddy and 
a personal decontaminating kit. For chemical and biological (CB) 
decontamination, you have one personal decontamination kit per person; 
one 50-pound drum of super tropical bleach (STB) dry mix; and a piece of 
plastic, a poncho, or sim ilar material. For radiological decontamination, you 
have 5 gallons of water (if water is not available for radiological 
decontamination, brush, wipe, or shake off contamination); three pails (3- 
gallon capacity); one can of government issue (Gl) soap or liquid detergent; 
two sponges; paper towels; and a piece of plastic, a poncho, or similar 
material. 

Standards: Decontaminated individual gear and equipment without 
spreading contamination ontoskin or undergarments. Set uncontaminated 
gear aside on an uncontaminated surface. Changed overgarments, 
overboots, and gloves without spreading contamination to the 
uncontaminated set of MOPP gear. Changed MOPP gear without yourself or 
your buddy becoming a casualty. 

Performance Steps 

Note. Both soldiers perform steps 1 and 2 at the same time. 



3-38 031-503-1023 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



Note. If the environment is only CB contaminated, omit steps 2 and 4. If the 
environment is only radiologically contaminated, omit steps 1 and 3. If the 
environment is radiologically and CB contaminated, perform all steps. 

1 . Decontaminate your individual gear for CB contamination without 
assistance. 

Note. If at any time during the technique you suspect you have spread 
contamination onto your skin or undergarments, decontaminate immediately with 
the personal decontaminating kit available; then proceed with the MOPP gear 
exchange. 

a. Remove your chemical protective helmet cover, and discard it. 

b. Cover your gear with STB dry mix. 

c. Brush or rub STB dry mix into the material, and shake off any 
excess STB. 

d. Set your gear aside on an uncontaminated surface (plastic, 
poncho, or similar material). 

2. Decontaminate your individual gear for radiological contamination, 
without assistance. 

a. Brush, wipe, or shake off dust or radiological contamination from 
your individual gear. 

b. Wash the equipment with warm, soapy water if available. 

c. Set the equipment aside to dry on an uncontaminated surface 
(plastic, poncho, or similar material). 

Note. Do not reverse roles until steps 3 through 8 are completed. 

3. Decontaminate your hood and mask for CB contamination. 

a. Buddy #1 — 

(1) Loosens Buddy # 2's drawcord. 

(2) Removes Buddy # 2's under-arm straps from under his arms. 

(3) Moves Buddy # 2's straps over his shoulders. 

(4) Reattaches Buddy # 2's straps to the Velcro R and hook-and- 
pile patches on the bottom of his hood. 

b. Buddy # 1 decontaminates Buddy # 2's hood and exposed parts of 
his mask using the M291 decontamination kit. 

(1) Buddy # 1 wipes Buddy # 2's mask eye lens outserts first. 

(2) Buddy # 1 wipes Buddy # 2's entire mask from the top of the 
hood down. 

c. Buddy # 1 repeats steps 3b(1 ) and (2) on his own hood and mask 
using the M291 decontamination kit. 

Skill Level 2 031-503-1023 3-39 





Performance Steps 



d. Buddy # 1 decontaminates his own gloves with the personal 
decontaminating kit after Buddy # 2's mask is decontaminated. 

4. Decontaminate your hood and mask for radiological contamination. 

a. Buddy # 1 dips a sponge in hot, soapy water and wipes Buddy # 
2's mask and hood (and the canister and hose of the M42-, M43-, or M40- 
series protective masks). 

b. Buddy # 1 rinses Buddy # 2's hood and mask with a sponge 
dipped in clean water. 

c. Buddy # 1 dries Buddy # 2's hood and mask with paper towels or a 
rag. 

d. Buddy # 1 wipes down his gloves. 

Note. Cool, soapy water is not as effective for removing contamination, but it can 
be used if you scrub longer. If no water is available, the personal decontaminating 
kit may be used for CB decontamination. 

5. Roll your hood. 

Note. Leave the zipper closed. 

a. Buddy # 1 lifts Buddy # 2's hood straight up off his shoulders by 
grasping the straps. 

b. Buddy # 1 pulls Buddy # 2's hood over his head until most of the 
back of his head is exposed (the hood should not be completely over 
Buddy* 2's face). 

c. Buddy # 2 places his hand over the voice transmitter, if necessary, 
to prevent the mask seal from being broken. 

d. Buddy # 1 rolls Buddy # 2's hood tightly, starting at the chin and 
working around the mask without pulling it completely off the back of his 
head. 

Note. Do not reverse roles. Go to the next step. Only Buddy # 2 will have his hood 
decontaminated and rolled at this time. 

6. Remove your jacket. 

a. Buddy #1 — 

(1 ) Unties Buddy # 2's cord. 

(2) Unfastens Buddy # 2's snaps on the front of his jacket. 

(3) Unzips Buddy* 2's jacket. 

(4) Unsnaps Buddy # 2's snaps in the back of his jacket from his 
overgarment trousers. 

b. Buddy # 2 makes a fist as each sleeve is pulled off to prevent his 
gloves from coming off. 

3-40 031-503-1023 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



> 
d) 



c. Buddy # 1 pulls Buddy # 2's jacket off, one arm at a time, turning 
the jacket inside out. 

d. Buddy # 1 places Buddy # 2's jacket on the ground nearby with the 
black side up. 

Note. Buddy # 2 will use the jacket later as an uncontaminated surface to stand on 

while redressing. _ 

7. Remove your trousers. « 

a. Buddy # 1 opens Buddy # 2's trouser cuffs, waist snap, zipper and, 
if necessary, waist tabs. 

b. Buddy # 1 grasps Buddy # 2's trouser leg by the cuff. 

c. Buddy # 2 pulls his legs from the trousers, one leg at a time. 

8. Remove your overboots. 

a. Buddy # 2 stands next to his jacket. 

b. Buddy # 1 unties or cuts Buddy # 2's overboot strings. 

c. Buddy # 1 pulls Buddy # 2's overboots off, one at a time. 

d. Buddy # 2 steps onto his jacket as his overboots are removed. 

9. Remove your rubber gloves. Buddy # 1 helps Buddy #2 remove his 
rubber gloves so he does not touch the outside of the rubber gloves with 
his bare hands. 

1 0. Put on an uncontaminated overgarment. 

a. Buddy # 1 opens the package containing a new overgarment, 
without touching it. 

b. Buddy # 2 removes the overgarment, one piece at a time, without 
touching the outside of the package. 

(1) Buddy # 2 puts on the new trousers, leaving the cuffs open. 

(2) Buddy # 2 puts on the jacket. 

1 1 . Put on the overboots. 

a. Buddy # 1 opens the package containing the new overboots 
without touching them. 

b. Buddy # 2 removes the overboots without touching the outside of 
the package. 

c. Buddy # 2 puts the overboots on. 

12. Put on the gloves. 

a. Buddy # 1 opens the package containing the new chemical 
protective gloves without touching them. 



Skill Level 2 031-503-1023 3-41 




Performance Steps 



b. Buddy # 2 removes the chemical protective gloves without 
touching the outside of the package. 

c. Buddy # 2 puts the gloves on. 

13. Secure the hood. 

a. Buddy # 1 decontaminates his chemical protective gloves with the 
personal decontaminating kit. 

b. Buddy # 1 repositions Buddy # 2's hood as follows: 

Note. Buddy # 1's gloves must be decontaminated before proceeding with this 
step. 

(1) Buddy #1 unrolls Buddy* 2's hood. 

(2) Buddy # 1 reattaches Buddy # 2's straps. 

c. Buddy # 2 checks all the zippers and ties on his hood and 
overgarment to ensure they are closed. 

1 4. Repeat steps 3 through 1 3. Buddy # 1 and Buddy # 2 reverse the 
roles. 

15. Secure the gear. 

a. Buddy # 1 and Buddy # 2 place the new chemical protective cover 
on their helmet. 

b. Buddy # 1 and Buddy # 2 put their individual gear back on. 

c. Buddy # 1 checks the fit of Buddy # 2's gear. 

d. Buddy # 2 checks the fit of Buddy # 1 's gear. 

16. Move to the assembly area. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field exercise or a normal training session. 
Soldiers must be in MOPP 4. Use the M291 decontamination kit. 
Brief Soldier: Identify pairs, designating Buddy # 1 and Buddy # 2. Provide 
each soldier with one of the following three scenarios: the soldier has been 
exposed to CB contamination (the soldier can omit steps 2 and 4); the 
soldier has been exposed to radiological contamination (the soldier can omit 
steps 1 and 3); or the soldier has been exposed to radiological and chemical 
and/or biological contamination (the soldier must perform all steps). 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Decontaminated individual gear for CB 
contamination, without assistance. 



2. Decontaminated individual gear for radiological 
contamination, without assistance. 



3-42 031-503-1023 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 


CM 

"33 

> 

_i 
!S 

C/5 


3. Decontaminated hood and mask for CB 
contamination. 


4. Decontaminated hood and mask for radiological 
contamination. 




5. Rolled hood. 




6. Removed jacket. 




7. Removed trousers. 


8. Removed overboots. 


9. Removed rubber gloves. 




10. Put on an uncontaminated overgarment. 






11. Put on overboots. 






12. Put on gloves. 






13. Secured hood. 






14. Repeated steps 3 through 1 3. Buddy # 1 and 
Buddy # 2 reversed roles. 


— — 




15. Secured gear. 






16. Moved to assembly area. 







Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM3-5 

031-503-2001 

Identify Chemical Agents Using M256-Series Chemical Agent Detector 
Kit 

Conditions:Given a tactical environment or a simulated chemically (nerve 
and blister) contaminated area and M256-series chemical agent detector kit, 



Skill Level 2 031-503-2001 3-43 




protective mask, mission -oriented protection posture (MOPP) gear or 
chem ical protective ensemble, watch, TM 3-6665-307-10, and FM 3-5. 

Standards: Identified chemical agents using an M256-series chemical agent 
detector kit without becoming a casualty. 



E Performance Steps 



1 . Perform before-operation preventive maintenance checks and 
services (PMCS) according to TM 3-6665-307-1 0. 

2. Prepare the kit for use. 

a. Read all the instruction cards in the kit. 

b. Remove one sampler detector from the kit, and read the 
instructions printed on the bag. 



WARNING 

Do not expose the sampler detector to heavy rain or other forms of 
water. Test results could be tainted. 

Do not touch the sampler detector test spots. Dirt and oil from your 
gloves will cause test results to be tainted. 



c. Remove the sampler detector from the bag (save the bag and use 
the instructions printed on the outside). Discard the sampler detector if 
there are broken or missing ampules, missing spots, or crushed reagent 
channels, or if the blood agent test spot is pink. 

3. Test for toxic-agent vapors. 

a. Swing out the heater and remove and save the two heater pads 
(used for breaking glass ampules). Swing the heater back in. Keep the 
protective strips over the spots. 

b. Remove the pull tab (marked 1 ) to expose the lewisite detecting 
tablet. Bend the tab (marked 2) over the lewisite detecting tablet, and rub 
the upper half of the tab until a mark is visible. 



WARNING 

Before breaking the glass ampules (except heater ampules), place 
one heater pad on each side of the sampler detector, covering the 
ampule to be broken. The pads will prevent pieces of glass from 
cutting your gloves and hands. 



c. Hold the sampler detector with the test spots and the arrow 
pointing up. Crush the four center ampules (marked 3). 

d. Turn the sampler detector so the arrow points down. Use the 
heater pads to squeeze the ampules, forcing liquid through the formed 
channels into the test spots. 



3-44 031-503-2001 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



e. Hold the sampler detector with the arrow pointed down and your 
thumb on the protective strip over the middle test spot. 

(1 ) Swing the heater away from the blister test spot. 

(2) Activate the first heater ampule (marked 4) by crushing one g 
green ampule, swing the heater back over the test spot, and leave it in _J 
place for 2 minutes. Hold the sampler detector to one side to avoid the = 
vapor. Do not use the heater pads to crush green ampules. % 



WARNING 

Do not use the heater pads to crush the green ampules. 



(3) Swing the heater and the protective strip away from the test 
spots. 



WARNING 

Do not hold the sampler detector in direct sunlight while exposing the 
test spots, because test results could be tainted. 



f. Expose the test spots to air (shield them from direct sunlight) for 
1 minutes. Lay the sampler detector down or hold it by the hinged 
protective strip. 

g. Crush the second green ampule (marked 4) after 10 minutes and 
immediately swing the heater over the blister test spot Swing the heater 
away from the test spot after 1 minute. 



WARNING 

Do not use the heater pads to crush the green ampules. 



h. Hold the sampler detector with the arrow pointing down and the 
test spots exposed. Use the heater pads to crush the remaining ampules 
(marked 5). Wet the test spots by squeezing the ampules and forcing 
liquid onto them. 

i. Bend the tab (marked 2) over the lewisite detecting tablet, and rub 
the bottom half of tab until a mark is visible. 

j. Turn the sampler detector upside down, and compare the colors of 
the test spots (including the lewisite tab) with those shown on the sampler 
detector. 

(1) Compare the blood agent (round) test spot after about 10 
minutes exposure time. 

(a) Yellow or orange sometimes occur when no agent is 
present. 

Skill Level 2 031-503-2001 3-45 



- 



C/> 



Performance Steps 



(b) Pink or blue must be present to indicate blood agents. 
Any combination of colors or a rainbow effect that includes pink or blue 
should be considered as a positive blood agent test. 

(2) Compare the lewisite test after about 10 minutes exposure 
time. Look very closely; at low concentrations, the color change may be 
very slight. 

Note. Blister agents (H and CX) develop color immediately after all ampules are 
broken. 

(3) Wait 3 minutes for the nerve-agent test. 

NOTE. Disregard any small blue or blue-green areas under the plastic rim of the 
nerve agent spot. 

(a) M256: If a peach color develops, a positive nerve test is 
indicated. 

(b) M256A1 : If no color develops, a positive nerve test is 
indicated. 

4. Report the results to your supervisor. 

5. Dispose of the materials by one of the following methods: 

a. Dispose of expended or unserviceable materials according to 
Federal, state, and local laws; military regulations and publications; host 
nation laws (if more restrictive than U.S. laws); and the local standing 
operating procedures (SOP). As a minimum, place used decontaminating 
materials in a sealed plastic bag and label it with the contents. 

b. Dispose of contaminated hazardous waste materials according to 
FM 3-5. 

6. Perform after-operation PMCS according to TM 3-6665-307-10. 

a. Ensure M8 detector paper is present. 

b. Ensure there are at least four sample-detectors in the kit. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field exercise or a tactical training session. 
The contaminated area should be set up with nerve and blister simulated 
agents. Use M256 training aid kits for training and evaluation purposes. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to perform 
operator checks of the chemical agent detector kit, to put the kit into 
operation using the correct sequence while in MOPP 4, and to identify 
agent(s) within the limitations of the kit. 



3-46 031-503-2001 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 


CM 

> 
0) 
_l 


1. Performed before-operation PMCS according to TM 
3-6665-307-10. 


2. Prepared the kit for use. 


3. Tested for toxic-agent vapors. 


4. Reported the results to the supervisor. 


5. Disposed of expended or unserviceable kits. 


6. Disposed of hazardous waste materials. 


7. Performed after-operation PMCS. 





Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

FM3-5 

TM 3-6665-307-10 

031-503-2023 

Measure Radiation Dose Rate and Total Dose 

Conditions: Given a tactical situation where nuclear contamination has 
occurred and radiation monitoring has been directed in your unit area. You 
are provided with an individual team or squad; radiation, detection, 
indication, and computation (RADIAC) detection equipment (dosimeters 
must be of the same type); a nuclear, biological, and chemical (NBC) 
marking set; a watch; (a vehicle or an aircraft, depending on mission 
requirements); communications equipment; DA Form 2404, Equipment 
Inspection and Maintenance Worksheet, 1971-R, Radiological Data Sheet- 
Monitoring or Point Technique, and DA Form 1971-6-R, Chemical/Biological 
Sample Documentation; and with applicable technical manuals (TMs), 
technical bulletins (TBs), and standing operating procedures (SOPs). Given 
the supervisor's guidance on continuous or periodic monitoring, the use of 
direct or indirect technique, intervals between readings (for monitoring dose 
rates only), and communication and reporting procedures. 

Standards: Performed operator preventive maintenance checks and 
services (PMCS) on equipment used. Reported and recorded accurate 

Skill Level 2 031-503-2023 3-47 




readings (+ 5 centigray [cGy]) to supervisor. Complied with the commander's 

operation exposure guidance and turn-back dose rate without overexposing 

personnel. 

Note. There is no degradation to standards if this task is performed in MOPP 4. 

W 

2j Performance Steps 

1. Perform PMCS on the RADIAC equipment. 

a. UseTM 11-6665-232-12 for PMCS on the IM1 74 series RADIAC 
meter. 

b. UseTM 1 1-6665-251-10 for PMCS on the AN/VDR-2 RADIAC set. 

c. UseTM 11-6665-365-12&PforPMCSontheAN/UDR-13 RADIAC 
set. 

d. UseTM 11-6665-214-10 for PMCS on the IM93 dosimeter. 

e. Use TB Signal (Sig) 226-8 for PMCS the PP1578 RADIAC 
charger. 

f. Use TM 1 1-6665-236-12 for PMCS on the AN/PDR-75 with DT- 
236 dosimeter. 

2. Measure the radiation dose rate. 

a. Use TM 1 1-6665-232-12 for operation of the IM174-series 
RADIAC meter. 

b. Use TM 1 1-6665-251-10 for operation of the AN/VDR-2 RADIAC 
meter. 

c. UseTM 11 -6665-365-1 2&P for operation of the AN/UDR-1 3 
RADIAC meter. 

d. Record the data on DA Form 1971-R. 

e. Report the data to the supervisor. 

Note. The data will be placed into an NBC 4 nuclear report by your supervisor or 
the unit NBC control party. 

f. Conduct continuous or periodic monitoring (guidance received 
from supervisor). 

g. Use the direct or indirect technique (guidance received from 
supervisor). 

h. Take readings at proper intervals (guidance received from 
supervisor). 

3. Measure the total dose of radiation. 

a. Use TM 1 1-6665-251-10 to measure the total dose with the 
AN/VDR-2 RADIAC set. 

b. Use TM 1 1-6665-214-10 to measure the total dose with the IM93 
dosimeter. 

3-48 031-503-2023 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



> 



Note. The DT-236 is worn on the wrist like a wristwatch, and measures cumulative 
doses of gamma and neutron radiation. It augments the IM93. The company 
AN/PDR-75 operator reads the DT-236. The company NBC control party records 
and processes this data. 

c. Use TM 1 1 -6665-365-1 2&P to measure the total dose using the 
AN/UDR-13RADIACset. 

4. Record the data on DA Form 1971 -R (except for DT-236). S 

5. Report the data to supervisor (except for DT-236). 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field exercise or a tactical training session. 
The AN/TDQ-T1 large-area RADIAC training set can be used to produce 
readings for RADIAC meters and RADIAC sets. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that the test will consist of performing PMCS, 
preparing the equipment for use, monitoring a designated area, recording 
the total dose/dose rate, and reporting the results to the supervisor. The 
actual completion of DA Form 2404 and DA Form 1 971 -R is not degraded if 
this task is performed in MOPP 4. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Performed PMCS on the RADIAC equipment. 



2. Measured the radiation dose rate. 



3. Measured the total dose of radiation. 



4. Recorded the data on the appropriate form. 



5. Reported the data to the supervisor. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

DA Form 1971-6-R 
DA Form 1971-R 
DA Form 2404 
TB Sig 226-8 
TM 11-6665-214-10 
TM 11-6665-232-12 

Skill Level 2 031-503-2023 3-49 




References 

Required Related 

TM 11-6665-236-12 
TM 11-6665-251-10 
TM 11 -6665-365-1 2&P 

031-503-3002 

Conduct Unmasking Procedures 

Conditions:Given a tactical situation and a group of soldiers in mission- 
oriented protective posture (MOPP) 4, an M256A1 chemical agent detector 
kit or an M256A1 trainer kit, a chemical agent monitor (CAM), M8/M9 
detector paper, an area where chemical agents have been used, and one of 
the following situations: 

1 . An M256A1 chemical agent detector kit is available. 

2. An M256A1 is not available. 

Standards: Conducted unmasking procedures without incurring casualties. 

Performance Steps 

Note. Before conducting unmasking procedures, make every effort to confirm the 
absence of chemical contamination. A CAM, an M256 chemical agent detector kit, 
and M8/M9 detector paper should be used along with a visual check of the area. 

Note. The senior person present selects one or two soldiers to unmask after 
permission is received from higher headquarters. 

1 . Conduct unmasking procedures using an M256A1 detector kit. 

a. Conduct unmasking procedures in the shade. 

b. Use an M256A1 detector kit to test for chemical agents. Use M8 
detector paper to check for possible liquid contamination. Continue 
unmasking procedures only if both tests are negative. 

c. Direct the selected soldiers to unmask for 5 minutes and don, seal, 
and clear their masks. 

d. Observe the soldiers for 1 minutes for chemical agent symptoms. 

e. Direct all soldiers to unmask if no symptoms appear. 

f. Check the soldiers for delayed symptoms. Have first aid treatment 
available. 

g. Complete steps 1 a through 1 f in sequence. 

2. Conduct unmasking procedures without using an M256A1 detector kit. 

a. Conduct unmasking procedures in the shade. 

3-50 031-503-3002 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



b. Use M8 detector paper to check for possible liquid contamination. 
Continue unmasking procedures only if the test is negative. 

c. Direct the selected soldiers to take a deep breath, break the seals 
of their masks (keeping their eyes open) for 1 5 seconds, and seal and 
clear their masks. 

d. Observe the soldiers for 1 minutes for chemical agent symptoms. 

e. Direct the soldiers to break the seals of their masks if no 
sym ptoms appear, take two or three breaths, and seal and clear their 
masks. 

f. Observe the soldiers for 1 minutes for symptoms. 

g. If no symptoms appear, direct the soldiers to unmask for 5 minutes 
and don, seal, and clear their masks. 

h. Observe the soldiers for 1 minutes for symptoms. 

i. If no symptoms appear, direct all soldiers to unmask. 

j. Check the soldiers for delayed symptoms. Have first aid treatment 
available. 

k. Complete steps 2a through 2j in sequence. 
3. Report the absence of contamination in your area and the successful 
completion of unmasking procedures to higher headquarters . 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field exercise or during a tactical training 
session. The M256A1 trainer kit will be used for training and evaluation 
purposes. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to conduct 
unmasking procedures with and without the use of a chemical agent detector 
kit. The soldiers taking part in the process will act only as directed by the 
soldier conducting the unmasking exercise and will not be evaluated on their 
performance. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 




1 . Conducted unmasking procedures in sequence 
using an M256A1 detector kit. 

2. Conducted unmasking procedures in sequence 
without ushg an M256A1 detector kit. 

3. Reported the absence of contamination in the area 
and the completion of unmasking procedures to higher 
headquarters . 



Skill Level 2 031-503-3002 3-51 




Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM3-4 

TM 3-6665-307-10 

031-503-3004 

Supervise the Crossing of a Contaminated Area 

Conditions:You receive orders to cross a nuclear, biological, or chemical 
contaminated area. Given a unit with mission-oriented protection posture 
(MOPP) gear; organic decontamination equipment (such as M1 3 
decontaminating apparatus portable (DAP) and individual decontaminating 
kits), chem ical (such as M256 chemical agent detector kit, M8 chemical 
agent detector paper, and M9 chemical detector tape) and radiological (such 
as IM174-series radiation, detection, indication, and computation [RADIAC] 
meter, AN/UDR-13 and AN/VDR-2 RADIAC sets, and IM93 dosimeter) 
detection and/or warning devices; shielding material (such as sandbags); 
and a defined NBC contaminated area. 

Standards: Supervised a unit crossing or passing through a nuclear, 
biological, or chemical contaminated area without producing additional 
casualties or spreading contamination. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Supervise a unit crossing a nuclear contaminated area. 
a. Before crossing — 

(1) Provide shielding for personnel. Use vehicles if possible. Place 
sandbags on the floor and sides of all vehicles (within reason for nonarmored 
vehicles). 

(2) Tell vehicle operators to close all doors, windows, hatches, and 
vents on their vehicles. 

(3) Have soldiers cover all exposed skin by rolling down their sleeves 
and buttoning their collars. Ensure that they wear handkerchiefs or similar 
cloths over their noses and mouths to keep from breathing radioactive dirt or 
dust. 

(4) Select the shortest possible route that would cause the least 
contamination and permit the fastest travel based on mission, enemy, terrain, 
troops, time available, and civilian considerations (METT-TC). 



3-52 031-503-3004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(5) Ensure that IM93 dosimeters are available and charged to zero. 

(6) Ensure that AN/UDR-1 3 and AN/VDR-2 RADIAC sets are 
available and operational. 

(7) Delay entry into the area as long as possible within the limits of 
the mission. 

b. During crossing — 

(1) Perform continuous monitoring. 

(2) Have the monitors watch the dose rate on the AN/UDR-1 3 or 
AN/VDR-2 RADIAC set. Instruct them to keep you informed. Ensure that the 
commander's turn-back dose rate is not exceeded without approval. 

(3) Have all personnel with dosimeters check them often to ensure 
that the commander's turn-back dose is not exceeded without approval. 

(4) Move through the area as quickly as possible. Do not forget safety 
or security. 

(5) Ensure that vehicles are far enough apart during movement to 
minimize dust. Consider the tactical situation, the command, and the control 
when spacing the vehicles. 

c. After crossing — 

(1) Have personnel check themselves and their equipment for 
contamination. Have everyone brush the dust from his or her clothing. 

(2) Determine if decontamination is required. 

2. Supervise a unit crossing a chemical contaminated area. 

a. Before crossing — 

(1) Select the shortest possible route that would cause the least 
contamination and allow the fastest travel based on METT-TC. 

(2) Tell vehicle operators to close all doors, windows, hatches, and 
vents on their vehicles. 

(3) Assume MOPP 4. 

(4) Have soldiers attach M9 detector paper to their clothing and 
equipment. 

b. During crossing — 

(1) Ensure that vehicles are far enough apart during movement to 
minimize dust. Consider the tactical situation, the command, and the control 
when spacing vehicles. 

(2) Move through the area as quickly as possible. Do not forget safety 
or security. Continuously monitor personnel for chemical agent symptoms, 
and give first aid as required. 

Skill Level 2 031-503-3004 3-53 





Performance Steps 



(3) Ensure that soldiers avoid touching anything in the area if 
possible. 

(4) Monitor personnel closely for symptoms of heat stress, and 
minimize excessive heat buildup. 

c. After crossing — 

(1) Continue to monitor soldiers for chemical agent symptoms, and 
give first aid as required. 

(2) Have soldiers use detector paper to check themselves and their 
equipment for contamination. 

(3) Have soldiers use their decontaminating kits to decontaminate 
any contaminated skin or personal equipment. Seek medical aid as required. 

(4) Have vehicle operators use available decontaminating equipment 
to decontaminate their vehicles, if required. 

3. Supervise a unit crossing a biological contaminated area. 

a. Before crossing — 

(1) Select the shortest possble route that would cause the least 
contamination and allow the fastest travel based on METT-TC. 

(2) Tell vehicle operators to close all doors, windows, hatches, and 
vents on their vehicles. 

(3) Assume the appropriate MOPP level, as required. 

b. During crossing — 

(1 ) Move through the area as quickly as possible. Do NOT forget 
safety or security. 

(2) Ensure that personnel do NOT touch anything in the area that can 
be avoided. 

(3) Ensure that vehicles are far enough apart during movement to 
minimize dust. Consider the tactical situation, the command, and the control 
when spacing vehicles. 

c. After crossing — 

(1) Decontaminate personnel and equipment by washing them 
thoroughly with hot, soapy water, if time and mission permit. 

(2) Do as many of the steps as possible for the types of 
contamination present in the area. 

(3) Seek medical aid if required. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field exercise or a normal training session. 
The contaminated area may have been marked with the appropriate 

3-54 031-503-3004 Skill Level 2 



markers, or a diagram may have been prepared showing the boundary of 
the contaminated area, the soldier's present location, and the desired 
direction of travel. Gather the necessary equipment and personnel to 
conduct the movement. Obtain, for training purposes, fictitious commander's 
operational exposure guidance (OEG) on the turn-back dose and the turn- 
back dose rate. 

Note. Before conducting this task, ensure that soldiers have been trained on the 
following tasks: 031-503-2020, 031-503-2001, 031-503-2013, 031-503-1037, 031-503- 
1013, and 031-503-2023. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to supervise the movement of a unit through a 
nuclear, biologically, or chemically contaminated area by performing the 
appropriate measures before, during, and after the movement through the 
area. Give the soldier an illustration, showing the boundary of the 
contaminated area, the soldier's present location, and desired direction of 










Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Supervised a unit crossing a nuclear contaminated 
area. 






2. Supervised a unit crossing a chemically 
contaminated area. 


3. Supervised a unit crossing a biologically 
contaminated area. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

FM3-3 
FM3-4 
FM3-5 

031-503-3005 

Submit an NBC 1 Report 

Conditions: A nuclear, biological, and chemical (NBC) attack has just 
occurred in your area. You are given a watch, a map, a compass, a 
protractor, a pencil, paper, and the NBC report format guide (Graphic 
Training Aid [GTA] 03-06-008) or DA Form 1971 -7-R, NBC-1 Observers 
Initial/Follow-Up Report. 



Skill Level 2 031-503-3005 3-55 



w 



< 

CD 



Standards: Submitted the NBC 1 report with the required information. 
Completed and submitted a spot report (SPOTREP) to give an immediate 
attack notification. 



Performance Steps 



1. React to an NBC attack or hazard. 

a. React to a nuclear attack or hazard. 

b. React to a chemical or biological attack or hazard. 

Note. The purpose of the SPOTREP is to give immediate notification of the NBC 
attack. 

2. Submit a SPOTREP immediately (use the size, activity, location, unit, 
time, and equipment [SALUTE] format if possible) for attack notification. 

3. Submit an NBC 1 (observer's) report after gathering the available 
data. 

a. Complete the required information as outlined in GTA 03-06-008, 
FM 3-3 (chemical or biological), or FM 3-3-1 (nuclear) to include — 

(1) Line B: Location of observer (use grid coordinates or place 
name). 

(2) Line D: Date -time group (DTG) of the attack (specify local or 
Zulu time). 

(3) Line H: Type and height of burst (nuclear) or type of agent and 
persistency (chemical or biological). 

(4) Line C: Direction of attack in mils or degrees from the 
observer; or 

Line F: Location of attack, grid coordinates, or place name. 

b. Select the proper communication precedence. 
Note. Flash reports should NOT be delayed for lack of information. 

(1) Use flash precedence if this is the first attack of its type (the 
first nuclear attack, the first biological attack, or the first chemical attack). 
(Flash precedence is used to report the first use of NBC weapons against 
U.S. troops.) 

Note. A flash precedence is used to report the first use of NBC weapons against 
U.S. troops. 

(2) Use immediate precedence for all other attacks. 

Note. Line L (nuclear) is measured 5 minutes after the attack, and Line M 
(nuclear) is measured 10 minutes after the attack. Submit the NBC 1 nuclear 
report after Line L or Line M is measured. The M256-series chemical agent 
detector kit takes 16 minutes to produce reliable results. Submit the NBC 1 Report 
after this test is done. 



3-56 031-503-3005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



c. Submit the NBC 1 report to the correct places. 

Note. Units selected by the division level NBC center (NBCC) as designated 
observers (applies only to nuclear bursts) also submit the NBC 1 report directly to 
the division level NBCC. All units submit the NBC 1 report to their higher — 

headquarters. > 

Evaluation Preparation: — 

Setup: Gather the items provided in the conditions statement. Develop a « 

situation containing observer data. (This information may be written.) A 
different situation should be developed for each type of report. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that the test will consist of submitting 
SPOTREPs and preparing and submitting NBC 1 reports. Give the 
necessary items to the soldier, including the data you developed. Tell the 
individual to give a warning and prepare reports of an NBC event. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1. Reacted to an NBC attack or hazard. 



2. Submitted a SPOTREP immediately for attack 
notification. 



=- 



3. Submitted an NBC 1 report after gathering available 
data and completing the required information for the 
report according to GTA 03-06-008. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM3-3 DA Form 1971 -2-R 

FM 3-3-1 DA Form 1971 -7-R 

GTA 03-06-008 

031-503-3008 

Implement Mission-Oriented Protective Posture 

Conditions:You are in a nuclear, biological, or chemical environment or are 
warned of a threat of a NBC hazard. Given two or more soldiers with MOPP 
gear, M8 and M9 detector paper, an M291 or M295 decontaminating kit, 
three nerve agent antidote autoinjectors, and a requirement to assume the 
appropriate MOPP level and check soldiers sleeping in MOPP 4. 

Skill Level 2 031-503-3008 3-57 




Standards: Implemented MOPP and directed soldiers to assume the 
appropriate MOPP level based on MOPP guidance from the commander. 
Identified all deficiencies and took appropriate corrective action for soldiers 
sleeping in MOPP 4. 



2; Performance Steps 



1 . Direct soldiers to put on MOPP gear and equipment for MOPP 1 
through MOPP 4. (See STP 21 -1 -SMCT, Task 031 -503-1 015.) 

a. Ensure the soldiers assume MOPP 1 . 

b. Ensure the soldiers assume MOPP 2. 

c. Ensure the soldiers assume MOPP 3. 

d. Ensure the soldiers assume MOPP 4. 

2. Check yourself and soldiers for proper wear of protective clothing. 

a. Ensure all soldiers are wearing the appropriate clothing and 
equipment for the directed MOPP level. 

b. Ensure protective masks are worn and sealed at MOPP 3 and 
MOPP 4. 

c. Ensure protective clothing is worn properly. 

3. Check each sleeping soldier. 

a. Observe soldier to ensure he is breathing. 

(1) Try to awaken him, if he does not appear to be breathing, 

(2) If the soldier cannot be awakened, perform task 081 -831 -1 000, 
STP 21-1 SMCT. 

b. Check soldier's mask for indicators of a broken seal. 

(1 ) Awaken the soldier and have him reseal his mask, if the seal 
appears to be broken. 

(2) Direct another soldier to observe h im for nerve agent 
poisoning. 

(3) Perform task 081 -831 -1 044, STP 21 -1 -SMCT, if symptoms are 
observed. 

c. Check soldier's protective clothing for problems. 

(1) Fasten or adjust the protective clothing of the sleeping soldier 
if his skin is not exposed and no symptoms are observed. 

(2) Awaken soldier and have him decontaminate using the M291 , 
if his skin is exposed and appears to be contaminated with liquid. Have 
soldier adjust his protective clothing or conduct MOPP gear exchange, as 
appropriate. 

(3) Perform task 081 -831 -1 044, STP 21 -1 SMCT, if skin is 
exposed and nerve agent symptoms are observed. 

3-58 031-503-3008 Skill Level 2 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a normal training session. Gather all 
necessary MOPP gear, and ensure that it is in good condition. Be prepared 
to direct a series of specific MOPP levels for the evaluated soldier to 
implement with the troops provided (such as MOPP through 4 
sequentially). Have the soldier explain the deficiencies he should look for 
and the corrective actions he should take for a soldier sleeping in MOPP 4. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that the test will consist of identifying all 
deficiencies and taking appropriate corrective actions for a soldier sleeping 
in MOPP 4 and directing soldiers to assume the appropriate MOPP level 
based on the MOPP guidance from the commander. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Directed soldiers to put on MOPP gear and 

equipment to assume MOPP 1 through 4. 




2. Checked self and soldiers for proper wear of 
protective clothing. 



3. Checked the sleeping soldier. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 4-25.11 

FM3-4 

TM 3-4240-279-10 

TM 10-8415-209-10 

031-503-3010 

Supervise the Employment of Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical 
Markers 

Conditions: You are in a tactical environment where NBC weapons have 
been used. The contamination has been located and identified in an area. 
You and your unit are at the appropriate mission -oriented protective posture 
(MOPP) level. You have NBC markers and a grease pencil or an NBC 
contamination marking set. 

Standards: Supervised the employment of NBC markers. Ensured that the 
appropriate marker was selected, the required information was recorded on 



Skill Level 2 031-503-3010 3-59 



7? 



< 

CD 



the marker, and the marker was properly emplaced. There is no change in 
standards if this task is performed in MOPP 4. 

Performance Steps 



1 . Supervise the employment of NBC markers for nuclear contamination. 

a. Ensure that markers are placed at the location where a dose rate 
of one centigray per hour (cGy/hr) or more was measured. 

b. Ensure that all information is printed on the front side of the marker 
so the word "ATOM" is facing toward you in an upright position. 
Information should include — 

(1) The dose rate in cGy/hr. 

(2) The date and time (local or Zulu, state which) of the 
detonation. (If the date and time are not known, print "UNKNOWN .") 

(3) The date and time (local or Zulu, state which) of the reading. 

c. Ensure that markers are positioned so they can be easily seen and 
the recorded information faces away from the area of contamination. 

(1) Ensure that markers are attached to objects, such as trees or 
poles, so they will be easily visible from all probable routes through the 
contaminated area. 

(2) Ensure that each marker is placed so the next one can be 
seen from the one previously emplaced. 

2. Supervise the employment of NBC markers for biological 
contamination. 

a. Ensure that all information is printed on the front side of the marker 
so the word "BIO" is facing toward you in an upright position. Information 
should include — 

(1) The type of agent detected. If unknown, print the word 
"UNKNOWN." 

(2) The date and time (local or Zulu, state which) of detonation 
(place beneath the date of detection). 

b. Ensure that markers are positioned so they can be easily seen and 
the recorded information faces away from the area of contamination. 

(1) Ensure that markers are attached to objects (such as trees or 
poles) so they will be easily visible from all probable routes through the 
contaminated area. 

(2) Ensure that each marker is placed so the next one can be 
seen from the one previously emplaced. 

3. Supervise the employment of NBC markers for chemical 
contamination. 



3-60 031-503-3010 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



a. Ensure that all information is printed on the front side of the marker 
so the word "GAS" is facing toward you in an upright position. Information 
should include — 

(1) The type of agent detected. If unknown, print the word 
"UNKNOWN." 

(2) The date and time (local or Zulu, state which) of detonation 
(place beneath the type of agent detected). 

b. Ensure that markers are positioned so they can be easily seen and 
the recorded information faces away from the area of contamination. 

(1) Ensure that markers are attached to objects, such as trees or 
poles, so they will be easily visible from all probable routes through the 
contaminated area. 

(2) Ensure that each marker is placed so the next one can be 
seen from the one previously emplaced. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Use simulated agents to produce a contaminated environment for 
chemical and biological (CB) agents. When requiring a marker for nuclear 
contamination, tell the soldier the amount of radiation present. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that the test will consist of ensuring that NBC 
markers are properly emplaced and all information is printed on the markers. 




Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Supervised the employment of NBC markers for 
nuclear contamination. 







2. Supervised the employment of NBC markers for 
biological contamination. 


3. Supervised the employment of NBC markers for 
chemical contamination. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails , show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM3-3 

TM 3-9905-001-10 



Skill Level 2 031-503-3010 3-61 




031-503-4002 

Supervise Unit Preparation for a Nuclear, Biological, and Chemical 
Attack 

Conditions: You are given commander's guidance, a radio, pioneer tools 
(ax, shovel, mattock), chemical alarms, chemical agent detector kits, 
covering materials (plastic sheets, ponchos, or tarpaulins), and soldiers who 
have their mission-oriented protective posture (MOPP) gear. 

Standards: Supervised unit preparation for a NBC attack. Prepared and 
protected materiel from becoming damaged, contam inated, or inoperable 
and unit personnel from becoming casualties. Standards are not degraded if 
performed in MOPP 4; however, because of the amount of physical work 
that must be done in this task, serious performance degradation may result if 
soldiers are in MOPP gear. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Supervise unit preparation for a nuclear attack. 

a. Individual protection. 

(1) Ensure that personnel are sheltered in well-constructed 
fighting positions with overhead cover, bunkers, and/or armored vehicles. 

(2) Ensure that personnel cover all exposed skin (roll sleeves 
down, button collars). A handkerchief or similar cloth may be worn over 
the nose and mouth to prevent inhalation of contaminated dust. 

b. Position. 

(1) Ensure that the terrain is used effectively to minimize the 
effects of an attack. 

(2) Ensure that the type of available shelter selected (covered 
foxholes, field-expedient overhead cover, buildings, tents, and armored 
vehicles) provides the best protection from weapon effects. 

c. Materiel. 

(1) Ensure that supplies, equipment, and vehicles are dispersed 
and/or dug in as much as possible. Ensure that explosives, ammunition, 
and flammables (fuel and oil) have been dispersed and/or dug in. Cover 
them if possible. 

(2) Ensure that existing cover provides protection and natural 
shielding for vehicles, supplies, and equipment from a nuclear explosion. 
Ensure that vans are parked so their air conditioner intakes are opposite 
the prevailing wind direction. Ensure that air conditioners are turned off 
and intakes are covered with nonporous materials (plastic sheets or 
ponchos). 



3-62 031-503-4002 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(3) Ensure that flammable debris is kept to a minimum. Ensure 
that small objects are secured to minimize the danger of casualties and 
damage from flying debris. 

(4) Ensure that all food and water are tightly sealed in containers 

and secured under available cover. S 

_i 

(5) Ensure that all electronic equipment and radios are turned off, = 

if not required for use. % 

(6) Ensure that power cables, antennas, and unused electronic 
equipment are disconnected and removed from power mounts. 

(7) Ensure that communications and electronics equipment are 
placed inside bunkers or armored vehicles to enhance protection against 
an electromagnetic pulse (EMP). 

d. Unit. Ensure that NBC equipment operators prepare the 
equipment for use. 

2. Supervise unit preparation for a biological attack. 

a. Individual protection. 

(1) Coordinate with medical personnel for needed immunizations. 

(2) Ensure soldiers practice good hygiene and field sanitation 
procedures. 

(3) Ensure soldiers are in good physical condition (well rested, 
well fed, and healthy). 

(4) Ensure soldiers button clothing and cover exposed skin or 
wear the appropriate MOPP level. 

(5) Ensure soldiers check protective masks and individual 
equipment for serviceability. 

(6) Coordinate with supply personnel for needed parts and 
equipment. 

b. Position. 

(1) Ensure the terrain is used effectively to minimize the effects of 
an attack. 

(2) Ensure the type of available shelter selected (covered 
foxholes, field-expedient overhead cover, buildings, tents, and armored 
vehicles) provides the best protection from weapon effects. 

c. Materiel. 

(1) Ensure all food and water are tightly sealed in containers and 
secured under available cover. 



Skill Level 2 031-503-4002 3-63 




Performance Steps 



(2) Ensure unused supplies and equipment are covered to avoid 
surface contamination from an aerial spray attack. 

(3) Ensure vans are parked so their air conditioner i ntakes are 
opposite the prevailing wind direction. Ensure air conditioners are turned 
off and intakes are covered with nonporous materials (plastic sheets or 
ponchos). 

3. Supervise unit preparation for a chemical attack. 

a. Individual protection. 

(1) Ensure soldiers are in good physical condition (well rested, 
well fed, and healthy). 

(2) Ensure soldiers check protective equipment for serviceability 
and coordinate with supply personnel for replacement parts and 
equipment. 

(3) Ensure the appropriate MOPP level is assumed. 

(4) Ensure individuals seek available overhead cover or use 
ponchos, plastic sheets, tarpaulins, and so forth to cover their positions. 

(5) Ensure antidotes and decontaminating kits are serviceable and 
readily available. 

b. Position. 

(1 ) Ensure the terrain is used effectively to minimize the effects of 
an attack. 

(2) Ensure the type of available shelter selected (covered 
foxholes, field-expedient overhead cover, buildings, tents, and armored 
vehicles) provides the best protection from weapon effects. 

c. Materiel. 

(1) Ensure all equipment, supplies, and vehicles are dispersed as 
much as possible. Ensure that these items are covered with nonporous 
materials (plastic sheets or ponchos). As a last resort, use dense foliage. 

(2) Ensure vans are parked so their air conditioner i ntakes are 
opposite the prevailing wind direction. Ensure that air conditioners are 
turned off and intakes are covered with nonporous materials (plastic 
sheets or ponchos). 

(3) Ensure unpackaged food is in sealed containers. Ensure 
soldiers open food only when they are ready to eat it, keep water in 
sealed containers, and cover items if possible. 

d. Unit. Ensure operators of NBC equipment prepare the equipment 
for use. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

3-64 031-503-4002 Skill Level 2 



Setup:Jo evaluate this task, choose a site that allows the dispersing and/or 
digging in of vehicles, supplies, and equipment. You may decide to quiz the 
soldier on performance measures that are difficult to evaluate otherwise, 
such as individual preparation for a biological attack. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to supervise 
unit preparations for an NBC attack. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Supervised unit preparation for a nuclear attack. 


2. Supervised unit preparation for a biological attack. 


3. Supervised unit preparation for a chemical attack. 



C/5 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM3-4 

031-506-1053 

Report Nuclear, Biological and Chemical Information Using NBC 4 
Report 

Conditions:You are in a nuclear, biological, or chemical contaminated 
tactical environment. Given a watch, a map, a compass, a protractor, a 
pencil, paper and the NBC report format guide (GTA 03-06-008 or DA Form 
1 971 -1 0-R, NBC 4-Radiation Dose Rate Measurements/Chemical/Biological 
Areas of Contamination). 

Standards: Reported NBC information using the NBC report. Completed 
NBC 4 reports with all heading information and mandatory line items (Q, R, 
and S for nuclear or H, Q, and S for chemical or biological). Included all 
other appropriate data, and ensured that each report was in the correct 
format. Disseminated completed NBC 4 reports to the proper authority. 

Performance Steps 

Note. Go to step 1 if it is a nuclear report. Go to step 2 if it is a chemical and 
biological (CB) report. Treat depleted uranium (DU) the same as a nuclear hazard. 

1. Prepare an NBC 4 nuclear report. 

Note. The mandatory information in an NBC 4 nuclear report is the location of the 
reading (line Q), the dose rate (line R), and the date-time group (DTG) of the 

Skill Level 2 031-506-1053 3-65 



- 



Performance Steps 



7? 



< 

CD 



reading (line S). 

a. Report the heading information for the NBC 4 nuclear report. 

(1) FROM: Enter your unit identification. 

(2) TO: Enter the unit identification you are calling. 

(3) PRECEDENCE: Use "IMMEDIATE." 

(4) CLASSIFICATION: Usually sent unclassified. 

(5) DATE-TIME: Use eight digits (DDHHMM— two digits for the 
day, four digits to represent military time) plus "Zulu" or "LOCAL." 

(6) TYPE OF REPORT: Enter "NUCLEAR." 

(7) CATEGORY OF REPORT: Enter "INITIAL" if this is the first 
report on this attack you will submit; otherwise, enter "FOLLOW-UP." 

b. Turn DA Form 1 971 -10-R to the reverse side. 

(1) Line A: Enter the strike serial number. 

(2) Line Q: Enter grid coordinates of the location of the reading 
(grid coordinates or place name, state actual or estimated). 

(3) Line R: Enter the dose rate in centigray per hour (cGy/hr). 

(4) LineS: Enter the DTG of the reading. 

Note. The NBC 4 report can contain more than one reading. Repeat lines Q, R, 
and S, if necessary. 

c. Goto step 4. 

2. Prepare an NBC 4 CB report. 

Note. The mandatory information in an NBC 4 CB report is the type of agent (line 
H), the location of the reading (line Q), and the DTG of the reading (line S). 

a. Report the heading information for the NBC 4 CB report. 

(1) FROM: Enter your unit identification. 

(2) TO: Enter the unit identification you are calling. 

(3) PRECEDENCE: Use "IMMEDIATE." 

(4) CLASSIFICATION: Usually sent unclassified. 

(5) DATE-TIME: Use eight digits (DDHHMM— two digits for the 
day, four digits to represent military time) plus "Zulu" or "LOCAL." 

(6) TYPE OF REPORT: Enter "CHEMICAL" or "BIOLOGICAL." 

(7) CATEGORY OF REPORT: Enter "INITIAL" if this is the first 
report on this attack you will submit; otherwise, enter "FOLLOW-UP." 

b. Use Section I on DA Form 1 971 -1 0-R. 

(1) Line A: Enter the strike serial number. 

3-66 031-506-1053 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(2) LineH: Enter the type of agent. 

(3) LineQ: Enter grid coordinates of the location of the reading 
(grid coordinates or place name, state actual or estimated). ^ 

(4) LineS: Enter the DTG of the reading. g 

Note. The NBC 4 report can contain more than one reading. Repeat lines Q, R, fj 

and S if necessary. 



c. Goto step 4. 
3. Submit the completed NBC 4 report using any means possible. 
Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Gather the items provided in the conditions statement. Develop a 
situation containing observer data. The information may be written and 
given to the soldier. Develop a different situation for each type of report. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that the test will consist of preparing and 
submitting NBC 4 reports. Give him the necessary items, including the data 
you developed. Tell the individual to prepare and submit NBC 4 reports. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Prepared an NBC 4 nuclear report. 



C/5 



2. Prepared an NBC 4 CB report. 



3. Submitted the completed NBC report. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

DA Form 1971 -10-R FM 3-3 

GTA 03-06-008 FM 3-3-1 

031-506-2061 

Conduct a Mask Fit Test 

Conditions:Given an M41 Protection Assessment Test System (PATS); 
M17-, M40-, M42- and M45- series protective masks; PATS operator 
manual; TC 3-41 ; and any of the following situations: 

1 . You are directed by the commander to conduct a mask fit test. 

Skill Level 2 031-506-2061 3-67 



0) 



2. You have a soldier(s) who requires an initial issue, an annual verification, 
or a replacement mask issue. 

3. This task will NOT be performed in MOPP 4. 

Standards: Conducted a mask fit test. Performed all the steps in sequence 
to verify the fit of a protective mask to an individual's face. 

Performance Steps 

5 1 . Prepare the mask for the fit test (M40-, M42-, and M45-series). 

a. Attach the drink tube sampling adapter to the drink tube quick- 
disconnect coupling. 

b. Have the soldier sit down for the fit test. 

c. Have the soldier don the mask. 

d. Instruct the soldier to blow as hard as possible several times into 
the internal drink tube mouthpiece to remove any trapped fluids or foreign 
matter. Ensure that the drink tube is clear so foreign matter will not be 
drawn into the protection assessment test instrument (PATI) and the PATI 
will be able to draw air from inside the mask. 

Note. THIS IS A CRITICAL STEP. 

e. Have the soldier adjust the face piece and tighten the head 
harness. Ensure that the face piece is properly fitted. 

2. Prepare the mask for the fit test (M 1 7-series). 

a. Attach the drink tube sampling adapter to the drink tube quick- 
disconnect coupling. 

b. Attach the drink valve retaining lever to hold the drink valve open. 

c. Have the soldier sit down for the fit test. 

d. Have the soldier don the mask. 

e. Instruct the soldier to blow as hard as possible several times into 
the internal drink tube mouthpiece to remove any trapped fluids or foreign 
matter. Ensure that the drink tube is clear so foreign matter will not be 
drawn into the PATI and the PATI will be able to draw air from inside the 
mask. 
Note. THIS B A CRITICAL STEP. 

f. Have the soldier remove the mask. Insert the sample tube 
extension into the internal drinking tube mouthpiece. 

g. Remove the drink valve retaining lever from the drink valve lever. 



3-68 031-506-2061 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



WARNING 

Have the soldier close his eyes while putting the mask on to prevent 
the sample extension tube from touching and possibly injuring his 
eyes. 



> 
<i> 



h. Instruct the soldier to don the mask. Ensure that the sample = 

extension tube is properly positioned. j* 

i. Adjust the face piece, and tighten the head harness. Ensure that 
the face piece is properly fitted. 

j. Attach the drink valve retaining lever so the drink valve is held in 
the open position for the duration of the fit test. 

3. Conduct a mask fit test (M1 7-, M40-, M42-, and M45-series). (See the 
PATS operator's manual .) 

Note. It is important that smoking not be permitted in the immediate area where 
the fit test is being conducted. The soldier should not smoke for at least 30 minutes 
before the test. To achieve proper results, the soldier should not talk during the 
test. 

a. Remove the high-efficiency particulate air (HEPA) filter from the 
twin tube assembly. 

b. Attach the twin sample tube (marked "SAMPLE") to the sample 
port on the end of the drink tube sampling adapter. 

c. Monitor the reading on the display with the PATI in the count mode 
and have the soldier remain still until an acceptable reading of 3.0 
particles/cubic centimeters or lower is obtained. 

d. Press the FIT TEST key on the keypad after obtaining an 
acceptable seal to bring the instrument into the standby fit test mode. 
Note. Before continuing to the next step, brief the soldier on how to perform the 
exercises outlined in the operator's manual. The soldier should be instructed to 
breathe normally during all exercises except the deep breathing exercise. 

e. Verify the number of exercises is set to S by pressing the 
NUMBER OF EXERCISES key. 

f. Press the START/STOP TEST key to begin the fit test. Instruct 
the soldier to perform the first exercise. 

g. Have the soldier remove his mask after the test is complete, and 
PASS is indicated. 

h. Remove all testing attachments from the soldier's mask. 

i. Repeat the test if FAIL is indicated. (Repeat steps 3f and 3g.) 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Skill Level 2 031-506-2061 3-69 




Setup: Ensure that the items required in the conditions section are available 
to the soldier. A soldier with a mask must be available. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to conduct the mask fit test based on the type 
of protective mask issued. 

Note. Performance measures will vary depending on type of mask being fitted (M17-, 
M40-, M42-, or M45-series. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Prepared the mask for the fit test (M40-, M42-, and 
M45-series). 







2. Prepared the mask for the fit test (M1 7-series). 


3. Conducted a mask fit test (M1 7-, M40-, M42-, and 
M45-series). 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

TC3-41 TM 3-4240-279-10 

TM 3-4240-279-20&P 



SUBJECT AREA 4: SURVIVE (COMBAT TECHNIQU ES) 



061-283-6003 

Adjust Indirect Fire 

Conditions:Given a pair of binoculars, a radio, a compass, pencils, a 
coordinate scale, a map of the target area, a target to engage within the 
area, and grid location of friendly troops. 

Standards: Determined the target location to within 250 meters of its actual 
location. The initial call for fire was made within 3 minutes after the target 
was identified. Adjustments were sent within 45 seconds after each round 
impacted. Observer entered the fire-for-effect phase using no more than six 
rounds (initial round plus five for adjustment). Fire for effect was within 50 
meters of the target using successive bracketing procedures (or creeping fire 
if danger close). 

Performance Steps 

1 . Locate the target within 250 meters of the actual target location. 



3-70 061-283-6003 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




a. Locate the target by grid coordinates . 


b. Determine the direction from your position to the target. 




c. Formulate a call for fire. Include the elements of the call for fire in 


CM 


sequence. 




(1) Observer identification (your call sign). 


3 


(2) Warning order (adjust fire). 




(3) Location of target. 


(4) Description of the target (for example "INFANTRY PLATOON IN 




THE OPEN"). 




(5) Method of engagement (may be omitted if area fire is desired). 





(a) If the target is within 600 meters of friendly troops, announce 
"DANGER CLOSE" to the fire direction center (FDC) in the initial call for fire, 
in the method of engagement phase. 

(b) Use creeping procedures to adjust danger close fire. Range 
corrections should NOT exceed 1 00 meters. 

(c) Initial target location is reported on the enemy side of the 
target. 

(6) Method of fire control. 
Note. The request for afire mission would be similar to figure 061-283-6003-1. 




"A4Z57, THIS IS G3H71 , ADJUST FIRE, OVER") 



("G3H71 , THIS IS A4Z57, ADJUST FIRE, OUT'') • 
("GRID, NG180513, OUT.') 



\ 



"INFANTRY PLATOON IN THE OPEN, ICM IN EFFECT, OVER.") 



("INFANTRY PLATOON IN THE OPEN, ICM IN EFFECT, OUT") ■ 



MESSAGE TO OBSERVER 



( "BRAVO, TWO ROUNDS, OVER."") /• \ 

V ! — — , ! / ( "BRAVO, TWO ROUNDS, OUT.'') 

('DIRECTION, 1650, OVER?) Q] 



"DIRECTION, 1650, OUT. 




Figure 061-283-6003-1. Initial Fire Request 



Skill Level 2 061-283-6003 3-71 




Performance Steps 



2. Transmit the call for fire to the FDC within three minutes of target 
identification. 

a. Conduct three transmissions. 

(1) Send observer identification and warning order. Example: 
"A4Z57, THIS IS G3H71 , ADJUST FIRE, OVER." 

(2) Send target location. Example: "GRID NG180513, OVER." 
(Give the six-digit grid of the target, with the grid zone identifier, to within 
250 meters of the actual target location.) 

(3) Send target description, method of engagement, method of fire 
and control. Example: "INFANTRY IN THE OPEN, ICMIN EFFECT, 
OVER." 

b. Give the direction to the target within 1 00 mils (M2 compass) or five 
degrees (lensatic compass) or give an accurate cardinal direction (no 
compass available) of the actual target location. This should be sent before 
the first correction, or with the first correction. 

3. Adjust rounds to within 50 meters of the target, within 45 seconds of the 
impact of each adjusting round. 

a. Spot each round when it impacts as right or left, over or short of your 
target. 

b. Determine corrections for deviation left or right of the target. 

Wore. Measure deviation. Measure the horizontal angle in mils, using the reticle 
pattern in the binoculars or hand measurement of angular deviation. Estimate the 
range to the target and divide by 1 ,000. This is the observer-target (OT) factor. If the 
OT distance is 1 ,000 meters or greater, the OT factor is expressed to the nearest 
whole number. If the OT distance is less than 1 ,000 meters, the OT factor is 
expressed to the nearest 1/1 0th. For example, 800 = 0.8. Multiplying the OT factor by 
the deviation measured in mils produces deviation corrections in meters. 

c. When the first range spotting is observed, make a range correction 
that would result in a range spotting in the opposite direction. For example, if 
the first round is short, add enough to get an over on the next round. This is 
called successive bracketing (figure 061-283-6003-2). Figure 061-283- 
6003-3 shows the impact of the initial round. The target is 21 00 meters 
away. Since the round is beyond the target, you must drop. You estimate 
that the round is 250 meters beyond the target. Therefore, you must drop 
400 meters to start successive bracketing procedures. The round impacted 
50 mils left of the target. With an OT factor of 2, the round impacted 1 00 
meters left. Your correction to the FDC is "RIGHT 1 00— DROP 400— 
OVER." 



3-72 061-283-6003 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



WARNING 

DO NOT BRACKET when DANGER CLOSE, it could result in friendly 
casualties, use the creeping fire procedure (all corrections are 100 
meters or less). 



> 



(I) 



'BRACKET" 




50 METERS 



Figure 061-283-6003-2. Successive Bracketing 



Skill Level 2 



061-283-6003 



3-73 





Performance Steps 


2; 




J7 




-5rfW\ 


< 
10 


/ 100 MILS 


~ 15 I 


/ I 




f*f 




WN5 4 3 2 1 


_ 4 5 / 
-20 / 




\ N^ 




\v TARGET y 




Figure 061-283-6003-3. Impact of Initial Round 



d. Continue splitting the range bracket until a 1 00-meter bracket is split 
or range correct spotting is observed, maintaining deviation on line. (Figure 
061-283-6003^ and 061 -283-6003-5 show the next adjustments). 



/ RIGHT 100 








r5 \ 
j-10 \ 




~ 15 I 


I 4*9 
\ 


■ ■ / 


\ 5 4 3 2 1 jrf» 


t 45 / 




L-20 / 


"LEFT 40, ADD 200 


OVER" 



Figure 061-283-6003-4. Second Round 



3-74 



061-283-6003 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 





Figure 061-283-6003-5. Third Round 



Skill Level 2 



061-283-6003 



3-75 



0) 



< 

CD 



Performance Steps 



e. Transmit corrections to the FDC in meters. The initial correction 
should bracket the target in range. The adjustment phase of a fire mission 
would resemble the example shown in figure 061 -283-6003-6. Deviation 
correction should be made to keep the rounds on the observer target line. 



observer ^Nn^ ADJUSTMENT PHASE 




"SHOT, OUT" 



3 



>*n 



RIGHT 100, DROP 400, OVER" 



3 



Lj \ "RIGHT100, DROP 400, OUT" ^f ^s\ 

5— JL i- % "SHOT, O VER" j^r\ 

2 "SHOT, OUT" f - — — * 



±C 



"LEFT 40, ADD 200, OVER" 



AT "SHOT, OUT 
rjl 



3 



"LEFT 40, ADD 200, OUT" 



"DROP 100, OVER' 



c 



t 



=3€_ 



DROP 100, OUT" 



3 




FIRE DIRECTION CENTER 



Figure 061-283-6003-6. Adjustment Phase 

f. Use the following guide to establish a bracket. When the estimated 
round impact distance to the target is — 

(1) More than 400 meters, add or drop 800 meters . 

(2) More than 200 but less than 400 meters, add or drop 400 
m eters . 

(3) More than 1 00 but less than 200 meters, add or drop 200 
m eters . 

(4) Less than 1 00 meters, add or drop 1 00 meters. 

(5) Add or drop 50 meters and announce fire for effect. 

4. Initiate fire for effect. When a 1 00-meter bracket is split or a range 
correct spotting is made, the fire-for-effect phase is entered (figure 061 -283- 
6003-7). Figure 061 -283-6003-8 shows a simulated pattern that might be 
observed in the fire-for-effect phase and the observed results of fire for 
effect are reported. 



3-76 



061-283-6003 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 





END OF 
MISSION 



Figure 061-283-6003-8. Fire for Effect Pattern 

5. Observe the results of fire for effect, transmit refinements (if necessary), 
and provide end of mission and surveillance (figure 061 -283-6003-9). 

a. Determine the effects on the target. 



Skill Level 2 



061-283-6003 



3-77 




Performance Steps 



b. Give a brief description of what happened to the target. Example: 
"EOM, TARGET DESTROYED, ESTIMATE TWO CAUSALITIES, OVER.' 



riRC for -rrrcc- phase 




i u:i.nC».ij»rii^hli mil I ■ 

f 



■ — ■ 

\..: i- .. 



RunrdlLraiipkUnwn iJ pl-jiJ-. 
to tH taptnhcd in busier ^IJ#t± 
twj* :r-iHi flr^d 




Figure 061-283-6003-9. End of Mission 




Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Ensure that a target is readily identifiable to the soldier and the 
required equipment is present and operational. The evaluator must know 
the grid location, direction, and distance to the target that will be used. 

Brief Soldier: Identify the target to the soldier. Tell the soldier he must enter 
the fire-for-effect phase using no more than six rounds (initial round plus five 
for adjustment). Fire for effect must be within 50 meters of the target, using 
successive bracketing procedures. The initial call for fire must be made 
within 3 minutes after the target has been identified. Adjustments must be 
sent within 45 seconds after each round impacts. 

Note. Ensure that the soldier understands exactly what is expected of him, but do not 
help him in anyway. 



Performance Measures 



GO 



NO GO 



1 . Located the target to within 250 meters of the actual 
target location. 



2. Transmitted the call for fire to the FDC within three 
m inutes of target identification. 



3. Adjusted rounds to within 50 meters of the target, 
within 45 seconds of the impact of each adjusting 
round. 



3-78 



061-283-6003 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

4. Entered the fire for effect phase when a 1 00-meter 
bracket was split, or when a range correct spotting was 
obtained. 

5. Observed the results of fire for effect, transmitted 



refinements (if necessary), and provided end of mission * 



> 

and surveillance. ^ 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures % 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-90.30 



071-326-0608 

Use Visual Signaling Techniques 

Conditions:Given a requirement to use visualsignals while mounted. 
Standards: Gave the proper procedures for each required action. 



Performance Steps 



1 . Ensure the soldiers you are signaling can see you. 

2. Perform the visual signals for combat formations, battle drills, and 
movement techniques as outlined below: 

a. Perform formation signals coil and herringbone (figures 071 -326- 
0608-1 and 071-326-0608-2). 



Skill Level 2 071-326-0608 3-79 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



Raise one arm above 
the head and rotate it in 
a small circle. 



Figure 071-326-0608-1. Coil 




Extend the arms 
parallel to ground. 
Bend the arms until 
the forearms are 
perpendicular. 




Figure 071-326-0608-2. Herringbone 

b. Perform following drill signals: Contact left, contact right, action 
right, action left, action front (right, left, or rear), air attack, and nuclear, 
biological, or chemical attack (figures 071 -326-0608-3 through 071 -326- 
0608-9). 



Extend the left arm 
parallel to ground. 
Bend the arm until the 
forearm is perpendicular. 
Repeat. 




Figure 071-326-0608-3. Contact Left 



3-80 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



Extend the right arm 
parallel to ground. 
Bend the arm until the 
forearm is perpendicular. 
Repeat. 




a) 

> 

0) 



(I) 



Figure 071-326-0608-4. Contact Right 




Extend both arms parallel to ground. Raise 
the right arm until it is overhead. Repeat. 



Figure 071-326-0608-5. Action Left 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-81 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 




Extend both arms parallel to ground. Raise 
the left arm until it is overhead. Repeat. 



Figure 071-326-0608-6. Action Right 




Raise the fist to shoulder 
level and thrust it several 
times in the desired 
direction of action. 



Figure 071-326-0608-7. Action Front(Right, Left, or Rear), Fight on Foot, 
or Assault Fire (Dismounted Troops) 



3-82 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



Bend the arms with forearms 
at a 45-degree angle. The 
forearms are crossed. Repeat 




a) 

> 

0) 



C/5 



Figure 071-326-0608-8. Air Attack 




Extend the arms and fists. Bend the arms 
to the shoulders. Repeat. 



Figure 071-326-0608-9. Nuclear, Biological, Chemical Attack. 

c. Perform movement technique signals: Traveling, traveling 
overwatch, and bounding overwatch (figures 071 -326-0608-10 through 
071-326-0608-12). 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-83 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



Extend the arm overhead 
and swing it in a circle 
from the shoulder. 




Figure 071-326-0608-10. Traveling 




Figure 071-326-0608-11. Traveling Overwatch 



3-84 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




Extend one arm to a 45- 
degree angle. Bend the 
arm and tap the helmet. 
Repeat. 




Figure 071-326-0608-12. Bounding Overwatch, Cover My Move 

d. Perform vehicle signals: Move to the left, move to the right, move 
forward, attention, I am ready, or ready to move, are you ready, mount, 
disregard previous command, I do not understand, start engine or prepare 
to move, halt or stop, increase speed, advance, open up, close up, right or 
left turn, slow down, move in reverse, close distance between vehicles and 
stop, stop engines, dismount, neutral steer, stop, button up or unbutton, 
and message acknowledged (figures 071 -326-0608-1 3 through 071-326- 
0608-36). 





JcsTa 




Extend the arm to the 
left and raise it up 
and down. 




5Ln 





Figure 071 -326-0608-1 3. Move to Left 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-85 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



Extend the arm to 
the right and raise it 
up and down. 




Figure 071-326-0608-14. Move to Right 




Move the hands and forearms 
backward and forward, palms 
toward the chest. 



Figure 071-326-0608-15. Move Forward 



3-86 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




Extend the arm sideways, 
slightly above the horizontal, 
palm to front. Wave the arm 
to and from the head 
several times. 



<i> 



C/5 



Figure 071 -326-0608-1 6. Attention 



Extend the arm toward the 
person being signaled; then 
raise the arm slightly above 
horizontal, palm outward. 




Figure 071-326-0608-17. 1 Am Ready, or Ready to Move, Are You Ready? 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-87 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



Make two or three movements 
upward with the open hand, 
palm up. 




Figure 071-326-0608-18. Mount 



Raise both arms and cross 
wrists above the head, palms 
to the front. 




Figure 071-326-0608-19. Disregard Previous Command or As You Were 



3-88 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




Raise both arms sideways to 
the horizontal; bend both 
arms at the elbows and place 
both hands across the face, 
palms to the front. 



> 



C/5 



Figure 071-326-0608-20. 1 Do Not Understand 




DAY 

Simulate cranking of engines 
by making a fist and moving 
the arm in a circular motion 
at waist level. 



NIGHT 

Move a light to describe a 
horizontal figure 8 in a vertical 
plane in front of the body. 



Figure 071-326-0608-21. Start Engine, or Prepare to Move 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-89 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 





DAY 

Raise the hand upward to the 
full extent of the arm, palm to 
the front. Hold that position 
until the signal is understood. 



NIGHT 

Move a light horizontally back 
and forth several times across 
the path of approaching traffic 
to stop vehicles. Use the same 
signal to stop engines. 



Figure 071-326-0608-22. Halt, or Stop 
Note. For alternate signal to stop vehicles, see figure 071 -326-0608-34. 



.£?•. 





DAY 

Raise the fist to shoulder level; 
thrust the fist upward to the full 
extent of the arm and back to 
shoulder level rapidly several 
times. 



NIGHT 

Move a light vertically several 
times in front of the body. 



Figure 071-326-0608-23. Increase Speed 



3-90 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




Face the direction of 
movement, hold the arm 
extended to the rear; 
swing the arm overhead 
and forward in the 
direction of movement 
(hold at the horizontal), 
palm down. 



Figure 071-326-0608-24. Advance orMove Out 



/5 







;r % :\*» 



Extend the arms overhead, palms inward, then slowly 
lower arms to a horizontal position. 



Figure 071-326-0608-25. Open Up 




Extend both arms 
parallel to the 
ground, palms up, 
then move the arms 
upward and inward 
toward the head. 



> 
Q) 



C/5 



Figure 071-326-0608-26. Close Up 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-91 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



HI 


■HMBM 


ien r -*. right ,<■"-, 




■>47;* ' -O'dHP'i 


DAY NIGHT 

Extend the arm horizontally to Rotate a light to describe a 
side, palm outward. circle 1 2 to 18 inches in 

diameter in the direction 

of the turn. 



Figure 071-326-0608-27. Right or Left Turn 




DAY 

Extend the arm horizontally to the 
side, palm to the front; wave the 
arm slightly downward several 
times, keeping the arm straight. 
Do not move arm above 
horizontal. 



NIGHT 

Hold a light at shoulder level; 
blink it several times toward 
the vehicle. 



Figure 071-326-0608-28. Slow Down 



3-92 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 





DAY 

Face the vehicle(s) (unit) being 
signaled, raise the hands to shoulder 
level, palms to the front. Move the 
hands forward and backward. 



NIGHT 

Hold a light at shoulder level; 
blink it several times toward 
vehicle(s). 



> 
<i> 



C/5 



Figure 071-326-0608-29. Move in Reverse (for Stationary Vehicles) 




Face the vehicle(s) being signaled, extend the forearms to the front, palms 
inward and separated (width of the shoulders). Bring the palms together as 
the vehicle(s) approaches. The vehicle(s) must stop when the palms come 
together. 



Figure 071-326-0608-30. Close Distance Between Vehicles and Stop 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-93 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



Extend the arm parallel 
to the ground, hand 
open, and move the arm 
across the body in a 
throat-cutting action. 




Figure 071-326-0608-31. Stop Engines 




Extend the arms, make two or three movements 
up and down, hands open toward ground. 



Figure 071-326-0608-32. Dismount 



3-94 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



Cross the wrists at the throat; 
point the index finger in 
direction of steer. Make 
a fist of the other hand. 





Figure 071-326-0608-33. Neutral Steer (Track Vehicles) 




Clasp the hands together, palms 
facing, at chin level. 



Figure 071-326-0608-34. Stop (Alternate Signal to Stop Track Vehicle) 
Note. For an alternate signal to stop vehicles, see figure 071-326-0608-22. 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-95 



Performance Steps 



BUTTON UP 




UNBUTTON 



For BUTTON UP, place both hands, one on top of the other, palms down, 
on top of the helmet. The arms are back and in the same plane as the body. 
For UNBUTTON, give BUTTON UP signal, then separate the hands, moving 
them to each side in a slicing motion; repeat. 



Figure 071-326-0608-35. Button Up or Unbutton 




Hold the fist out with 
the thumb up. 



Figure 071-326-0608-36. Message Acknowledged 

3. Perform flag signals: Single signal flag, mount, dismount, dismount 
and assault, assemble or close, move out and nuclear, biological or 
chemical hazard present (figures 071 -326-0608-37 through 071 -326-0608- 
43). 

Note. When used alone, flag colors have the following meanings. Red — danger, or 
enemy in sight. Green — all clear, ready, or understood. Yellow — disregard, or 
vehicle out of action. During periods of poor visibility colored chemical lights or 
flashlights with colored filters may be substituted for flags. 



3-96 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




Figure 071-326-0608-37. Use a Single Signal Flag 



YELLOW 



^SifCTOfcS 





Figure 071-326-0608-38. Mount 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-97 



Performance Steps 






< 



GREEN 



YELLOW 



f 



T:::ioi^jt 




Figure 071-326-0608-39. Dismount 



RED 



r 



*£3cnej$ 




) GREEN 

s 



-~T 



:»?z»'5|C_, 



Figure 071-326-0608-40. Dismount and Assault 



3-98 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



GREEN 




YELLOW 



Figure 071-326-0608-41. Assemble or Close 





Figure 071-326-0608-42. Move Out 



Skill Level 2 



071-326-0608 



3-99 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



RED 



YELLOW 




GREEN 



Figure 071-326-0608-43. Nuclear, Biological, Chemical Hazard Present 
Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide a set of vehicle signaling flags and flashlight. 
From the signals shown in the task, pick 1 to test. 

Brief Soldier: J e\\ the soldier you will give the 10 signals and he must 
correctly execute each signal. 



Performance Measures 



GO 



NO GO 



1 . Executed proper formation signals. 



2. Executed proper drill signals. 



3. Executed proper movement technique signals. 



4. Executed proper signals to control vehicle drivers 
and crews. 



5. Executed proper flag signals. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 



References 
Required 



Related 

FM7-7 



3-100 



071-326-0608 



Skill Level 2 



References 








Required 


Related 

FM 17-95 








FM 21-60 




CM 

"33 

> 

CO 

_l 


071-326-5704 

Supervise Construction of a 


Fighting Position 




Conditions:Given soldiers , TOE equipment, and a 


sector of responsibility. 




Standards: Ensured that the initial preparation was accomplished for each 
fighting position and that the completed position provided cover, 
concealment, and fields of fire. 





Performance Steps 



1 . Ensure that the construction of the individual fighting position 
generally follows the sequence below. 

2. Assign the location of the position and the sector of fire. The soldier 
constructing the position should emplace sector-of-fire stakes. 

3. Ensure the soldiers partially clear fields of fire within their sector and 
dig a hasty hole for minimum protection, being careful not to destroy 
natural camouflage around their positions. They should save sod, grass 
clumps, and so forth , for use as camouflage later. 

4. Ensure the soldiers dig a hole that is armpit deep. If they have a 
natural frontal parapet, the dirt from the hole should be carried away and 
camouflaged; if not, it should be used to make a frontal parapet. 

5. Ensure the soldiers get into the firing positions and check their fields 
of fire. They can now complete a clearing field of fire, clearing only what is 
absolutely necessary. 

6. Ensure the soldiers camouflage their positions using available 
materials (such as sod, grass clumps, foliage) blending the positions with 
the surrounding area. The camouflage should be checked from about 35 
meters to the front; if the position can be spotted easily, more camouflage 
work is needed. 

7. Ensure the soldiers construct overhead cover after all of the above 
have been accomplished satisfactorily. They should use logs and planks, 
4 to 6 inches thick, that will support at leas 1 6 or 8 inches of dirt (logs and 
dirt should total 12 inches), and dig a cave-like area big enough to get 



under. 



Skill Level 2 071-326-5704 3-101 



Performance Steps 



8. Ensure the soldiers begin to improve their positions upon completion 
of the overhead cover. Items to check for include grenade sump, drainage 
trench, elbow holes, night firing stakes, range cards, and camouflage. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

JJJ" Setup: At the site, assign each soldier an area of responsibility. Issue any 
required equipment or supplies needed to construct the fighting position. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to supervise the construction of a fighting 
pos ition with his soldiers , while being evaluated. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



w 



1 . Assigned sector of fire to each position. 



2. Checked that initial position was completed first. 



a. Sector-of-fire stakes were emplaced. 



b. Hasty hole for minimum protection was dug . 



c. Natural camouflage around position was 
preserved. 



- 



3. Supervised completion of fighting position. 



a. Position was at least armpit deep. 



b. Excess dirt from hole was carried away and 
hidden. 

c. Fields of fire were cleared only of minimum 

foliage. 

d. Position was camouflaged so it could not be 

seen 35 meters to the front. 

e. Overhead cover was at least 1 2 inches (with 4 tc 
6 inches of logs or planks and 6 to 8 inches of dirt). 

f. Grenade trenches were dug in position. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM5-103 
FM7-8 

3-102 071-326-5704 Skill Level 2 



References 
Required Related 

STP21-1-SMCT 



071-326-5705 

Establish an Observation Post 

Conditions:Given a squad- or platoon-size element in a defensive position, 
a TA-31 2/PT field telephone and communication wire, or a radio, and a 
probable enemy avenue of approach. 

Standards: Selected a location for an observation post (OP) that provided 
observation of the avenues of approach, was within small -arms range of the 
element, and offered adequate cover and concealment. Established 
communication between the OP and the platoon leader or squad leader. 




Performance Steps 



Note. OPs are generally established along probable avenues of approach to listen 
and observe and to provide early warning of enemy approach. 

1. Select an OP. 

a. The site selected for an OP should provide — 

(1) Maximum observation of the desired area (specified by the 
platoon leader). 

(2) Cover and concealment for the occupants of the OP. 

(3) Concealed routes to and from the OP. 

b. Observation is the best way to determine whether the above 
conditions exist at a site. 

c. Usually, the best location for an OP is on or near the military crest of 
a hill. Topographical crests should be avoided because of the possibility of 
being skylined. It may be appropriate to establish the OP well down the 
forward slope when observation is restricted by the terrain (figure 071 -326- 
5705-1). 



Skill Level 2 071-326-5705 3-103 



Performance Steps 






< 

CD 



WRONG 




r%^ji 



Figure 071-326-5705-1. OP Position 

d. OPs should be within effective small-arms range of the unit 
establishing the OP, and should be supported by other supporting fire when 
possible. 
2. Establish and operate an OP. 

a. Wire is the primary means of communication with an OP and may be 
supplemented by radio. Wire and radio antennas shou Id be carefully 
positioned and camouflaged to avoid detection by the enemy (figure 071- 
326-5705-2). 




WRONG 







RIGHT 



Figure 071-326-5705-2. Camouflage Communication Lines 

b. Personnel going to and from the OP must move carefully so 
movement does not reveal the location to the enemy. Separate routes to 
and from the OP are established. Camouflage is most important. The OP 
should be camouflaged even when natural concealment is adequate. 



3-104 



071-326-5705 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



<D 



c. OPs are operated in reliefs. A minimum of two soldiers is necessary 
for each relief. One observes while the other records and reports observed 
information. The observer and recorder should switch duties every 20 to 30 
minutes, because the visual efficiency of an observer decreases rapidly 
after that length of time. > 

3. Establish and operate an OP during limited visibility. d 

a. The enemy may use a different, more open avenue of approach £ 
during limited visibility conditions; therefore, an OP may have to be moved 
to another position to serve as an OP at night. 

b. Limited visibility OPs are usually closer to defensive positions. Night 
vision devices may be given for use on the OP. The enemy deploys 
infiltrators against the defense at night, so a series of OPs, backed up by 
alert troops equipped with night vision devices and by snipers, can counter 
this infiltration. 

c. OPs are operated in relief except when movement to and from 
pos itions would reveal their locations or endanger the personnel. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:\r\ a field environment with terrain on which an OP can be 
established, provide the element leader with a TA-31 2/PT field telephone 
and communication wire, or a radio, and two personnel to act as the 
observer and the recorder. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to establish an OP to observe an area 
(designated by the tester) forward or to the flanks of his element. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Selected an area within small-arms range of the 

squad- or platoon-size element. 

2. Selected a site that provided maximum observation 

of the desired area. 



3. Established and operated an area that offered cover 
and concealment. 



4. Ensured wire or radio communication was 
established. 



5. Ensured that radio antenna, if used, was 
camouflaged. 



6. Established several concealed routes to and from 
the observation post. 



- 



7. Ensured that the observation post was 
camouflaged. 



Skill Level 2 071-326-5705 3-105 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

8. Placed a minimum of two personnel on the 
observation post. 



9. Instructed observer and recorder to switch duties 

every 20 to 30 minutes. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM7-8 
FM 21-75 



SUBJECT AREA 5: NAVIGATE 



071-329-1019 

Use a Map Overlay 

Conditions:Given a military map and a company level map overlay. 

Standards: Positioned overlay correctly on the map and identified all 
graphic symbols and information on the overlay. 



Performance Steps 



1 . Obtain the map sheet(s) listed in the marginal information. 

2. Locate the grid intersections on the map that corresponds to the grid 
register marks in opposite corners of the overlay. 

3. Place the overlay on the map so the grid register marks fall exactly on 
top of the grid intersections (figure 071-329-1 01 9-1 ). 



3-106 071-329-1019 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



29 85 



29 84 



29 83 




MAP 



GRID 

REGISTER 

MARKS 



14 



15 



16 



Figure 071-329-1019-1. Registering the Overlay 

4. Locate the points and areas identified on the overlay. 
a. Basic symbols (figure 071 -329-1019-2). 



® 



UNIT 



HEADQUARTERS 



UNIT TRAINS 



AMMUNITION SUPPLY 
POINT 



A 
O 



OBSERVATION POST 



MEDICAL, 

ADMINISTRATIVE, OR 
LOGISTICAL INSTALLATION 



3 C MAINTENANCE ACTIVITY 



o 



PRISONER OF WAR 
COLLECTION POINT 



® 



f4 HOSPITAL/AID STATION 



Figure 071-329-1019-2 Basic Symbols 

b. Development of a unit symbol (figure 071 -329-1 01 9-3). 




Skill Level 2 



071-329-1019 



3-107 



Performance Steps 



UNIT SIZE 



HIGHER COMMAND ECHELONS 



UNIT DESIGNATION 



■h 



BRANCH OR DUTY PERFORMED 




Figure 071-329-1019-3. Development of Unit Symbol 

c. Unit-size symbols (figure 071-329-1019-4). 



• 


SQUAD 


1 COMPANY, BATTERY, 
I OR TROOP 


rpri TASK FORCE 

1 1 II (BATTALION SIZE) 


• • 


SECTION 


n - ! TEAM (COMPANY 
I I I SIZE) 


| | | REGIMENT OR GROUP 


• •• 


PLATOON 


I 1 BATTALION OR 

I I SQUADRON 


X BRIGADE 



Figure 071-329-1019-4. Unit-Size Symbols 

d. Branch symbols (figure 071-329-1019-5). 



X 

o 

m 



INFANTRY 



ARMOR 



ARTILLERY 



ENGINEER 






MECHANIZED 
INFANTRY 

ARMORED 
CAVALRY 



SIGNAL 



SUPPLY 



MEDICAL 



)— — C MAINTENANCE 



AIRBORNE 



Figure 071-329-1019-5. Branch Symbols 

e. Enemy units are depicted in red or by double lines (figure 071-329- 
1019-6). 



3-108 



071-329-1019 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




Figure 071-329-1019-6. Enemy Unit 

f. The broken lines depict proposed or future locations (figure 071 -329- 
1019-7). 




c ) 



Figure 071-329-1019-7. Proposed Unit Position 



Skill Level 2 



071-329-1019 



3-109 



Performance Steps 



g. Tactical control measures (figure 071-329-1019-8). 



A 



0) 



< 

CD 




INFANTRY COMPANY 
ASSEMBLY AREA 



ATTACK POSITION 



AXIS OF 
ADVANCE 



DIRECTION OF 
ATTACK 



OBJECTIVE 



COMPANY BATTLE 
POSITION 



I 1 LD LINE OF 

1 ' DEPARTURE 



/~\ f\ f~\ FRONTLINES 



LC|- 



-I LC LINE OF 
CONTACT 



COMPANY BOUNDARY 



o 

5 



CHECKPOINT 



PL — 

BRAVO 



— p L PHASE LINE 

BRAVO 






CONTACT 
POINTS 



COORDINATING POINT 



pD| poiNT OF 

DEPARTURE 



Figure 071-329-1019-a Tactical Control Symbols 



3-110 



071-329-1019 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 


CM 
"CO 






h. Weapon symbols (figure 


071-329-1019-9). 




AUTOMATIC A A 
INFANTRY 4- 
WEAPONS 1 1 


± MORTARS I T T 




LIGHT MEDIUM 


HEAVY 60-MM 81-MM 4.2-INCH 
LIGHT MEDIUM HEAVY 


CO 






ANTITANK ^ A 

ROCKET 1 

LAUNCHERS /\ /\ 


| ^L^ijl hfi $ 


C/5 






LIGHT MEDIUM 

ANTITANK 

MISSILE 

OR ROCKET 


HEAVY LIGHT MEDIUM HEAVY 








n ea t 


V 










LIGHT MEDIUM HEAVY 










"EXAMPLE" 










J Q 


1 








(LAW) (DRAGON) (TOW) 







Figure 071-329-1019-9. Weapon Symbols 

Armored vehicles (figure 071 -329-1 019-1 0). 



M M 



LIGHT 



MEDIUM 



HEAVY 



^ CI rOI 



APC 



BFV 



CFV 



Figure 071-329-1019-10. Armored Vehicle Symbols 



Skill Level 2 



071-329-1019 



3-111 



Performance Steps 



j. Fortification and obstacles (figure 071 -329-1 01 9-1 1 ) 



I 



< 

CD 





WEAPON POSITION 
FIGHTING 


□ 


PILLBOX OR 
CASEMENT 


n 


J1TLTL 


FORTIFIED LINE 


^ 


)~ STRONG POINT 


/~\/~\/~\S-\ 


OBSTACLE LINE 
FRONT LINE 


^ 


COMPLETED 
ROADBLOCK 



Figure 071-329-1019-11. Fortification and Obstacle Symbols 

k. Wire (figure 071 -329-1 01 9-12). 



WIRE OBSTACLES 
UNSPECIFIED 


xxxxxxxx 


SINGLE FENCE 




XXX 


DOUBLE FENCE 


vv vv vv 


AA XX XX 


DOUBLE APRON FENCE 


YVYYVVVV 


AAAAAAAA 


LOW WIRE FENCE 


xxxxxxxx 


HIGH WIRE FENCE 




xxxxxxxx 


SIGLE CONCERTINA 


oonnnoon 


DOUBLE STRAND CONCERTINA 


c\ c\ c\ c\ r\ c\ f\ c\ 


U in) u u u u u 


TRIPLE STRAND CONCERTINA 




onoonoon 


TRIPWIRE 


■+■ 



Figure 071-329-101 9- 

I. Mines (figure 071 -329-1 019- 



12. Tactical Wire Symbols 

13). 



3-112 



071-329-1019 



Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



o 


MINE TYPE 
UNSPECIFIED 


X 


ANTITANK, BOOBY TRAPPED 


• 


ANTIPERSONNEL 


6 


BOOBY TRAP 


• 


ANTITANK 







Figure 071-329-1019-13. Mine Symbols 

m. Indirect fire symbols (figure 071-329-1019-14). 



+ 



AC1021 



I 

— o— 

I 



TARGET (W/NUMBER) 

RECTANGULAR TARGET 

FINAL PROTECTIVE FIRE 
(FPF) 

NUCLEAR TARGET 




Figure 071-329-1019-14. Indirect Fire Symbols 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide a military map and a company level map overlay. Ask the 
soldier to identify information on the overlay from the performance 
measures. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he must be able to correctly place the overlay 
on the map and identify any graphic symbols or information on the overlay 
as requested. 



Performance Measures 



GO 



NO GO 



1 . Placed overlay grid register marks over grid 
intersections. 



2. Identified marginal information. 



3. Identified security classification. 



Skill Level 2 



071-329-1019 



3-113 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

4. Identified graphic symbols. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-25.26 
FM 101-5-1 



SUBJECT AREA 20: CASUALTY REPORTING AND HANDLING 



805C-PAD-2060 

Report Casualties 

Conditions:Given a casualty, DA Form 1155, DA Form 1156, a map, and a 
pen or pencil. 

Standards: Recorded all known data elements accurately and legibly on DA 
Form 1 1 56 and DA Form 1 1 55, without error. 

Performance Steps 

1. Prepare DA Form 1156. 

a. Leave the Control Number item blank. 

b. Complete the Check Applicable Box item as it pertains to the 
casualty. 

c. Complete item 1 with the casualty's last name, first name, and 
middle initial (to include Jr, Sr, III). 

d. Complete item 2 with the casualty's complete Social Security 
number. 

e. Complete item 3 with the casualty's rank. 

f. Complete item 4 with the hour and date of incident to include the 
time zone. 

g. Complete item 5 with the casualty's unit. 

h. Complete item 6 with the geographical location (nearby town) and 
grid coordinates to include the 1 00,000-meter square grid coordinates, 
2-letter designator, and nearest village or field trainers. 



3-114 805C-PAD-2060 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



tn 



i. Complete item 7 with a check in the appropriate box to enter the 
type of casualty (only medical personnel may enter a check in the lightly 
wounded or injured in action and seriously injured or injured in action 
boxes); check yes or no to indicate if the body was recovered; check yes or 21 
no to indicate if the body has been identified; enter the collection point to > 

which the casualty is evacuated, if unknown indicate "unknown." 

j. Complete item 8 with the witnesses who saw the incident or 5 

identified remains to include the name, grade, social security number, and 
unit(s) of witnesses. 

k. Complete item 9 with the applicable remarks to include additional 
circumstances such as , religious ministration performed, type of mission 
the unit was conducting, short synopsis of the incident. 

I. Do not complete the first three boxes in item 1 but enter his or her 
unit, grade, Social Security number, date, and signature in item 1 as the 
person who prepared the report. 

2. Prepare DA Form 1155. 

a. Check the applicable box at the top of the form as it relates to the 
casualty witnessed. 

b. Complete item 1 with the casualty's last name, first name, and 
middle name. 

c. Leave item 2 blank. 

d. Complete item 2a with the casualty's complete Social Security 
number 

e. Complete item 3 with the casualty's rank. 

f. Complete item 4, if appropriate, with the date of the casualty's 
death or the date when the casualty was last seen along with the time 
zone. 

g. Complete item 5 with the casualty's unit. 
h. Complete item 6 with the geographical location including the six- 
digit coordinate as well as the nearest town to the incident. 

i. Complete item 7 only if name or Social Security number of the 
casualty is unknown or not positive. If they are unknown or not positive 
enter the estimated age, weight, height, hair color, eye color, race, home 
town, civilian occupation, nickname, spouse's name, children's nam e(s), (if 
applicable), other identifying marks (such as birthmarks or tattoos), and 
other persons who may have witnessed the incident or have further 
information. 



Skill Level2 805C-PAD-2060 3-115 



Performance Steps 






P 



j. Complete item 8 with a short, concise narrative of the 
circumstances regarding the incident and, if known, the cause of death or 
condition when last seen and how identified. 

k. Complete items 9 through 13 with the name, Social Security 
number, unit, date, and signature of the person making the statement. 

< I. Submit form in accordance with local guidance. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide soldier with DA Form 1 1 55 and DA Form 1 1 56, a map, 
pencil and paper. Give the soldier a scenario that provides all the 
information needed to accomplish the performance measures. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be evaluated on his ability to report 
casualties, by preparing DA Form 1 1 55 and DA Form 1 1 56. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Prepared DA Form 1156. 



a. Left the Control Number item blank. 



b. Completed the Check Applicable Box item as it 
pertained to the casualty. 



c. Completed item 1 with the casualty's last name, 
first name, and middle initial (to include Jr. Sr. III). 

d. Completed item 2 with the casualty's complete 
Social Security number. 

e. Completed item 3 with the casualty's rank. 

f. Completed item 4 with the hour and date of 
incident to include the time zone. 

g. Completed item 5 with the casualty's unit. 



h. Completed item 6 with the geographic location 
(nearby town) and grid coordinates to include the 
100,000-meter square grid coordinates, 2-letter 
designator, and nearest village or field trainers. 



3-116 805C-PAD-2060 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

i. Completed item 7 with a check in the appropriate 
box; entered the type of casualty (only medical 
personnel may enter a check in the lightly wounded or 
injured in action and seriously injured or injured in action 
boxes); checked yes or no to indicate if the body was > 

recovered; checked yes or no to indicate if the body has 
been identified; entered the collection point to which the ^ 

casualty was evacuated, if unknown indicated a> 

"unknown." 

j. Completed item 8 with the witnesses who saw the 
incident or identified remains to include the name, grade, 
Social Security number, and unit(s) of witnesses. 









k. Completed item 9 with the applicable remarks to 
include additional circumstances, such as religious 
ministration performed, type of mission the unit was 
conducting, short synopsis of the incident. 

I. Did not complete the first three boxes in item 1 
but entered his or her unit, grade, Social Security 
number, date, and signature in item 1 as the person 
who prepared the report. 

2. Prepared DA Form 1 1 55. 

a. Checked the applicable box at the top of the form 
as it related to the casualty witnessed. 



b. Completed item 1 with the casualty's last name, 
first name, and middle name. 

c. Left item 2 blank. 

d. Completed item 2a with the casualty's complete 
Social Security number. 

e. Completed item 3 with the casualty's rank. 

f. Completed item 4, if appropriate, with the date of 
the casualty's death or the date when the casualty was 
last seen along with the time zone. 

g. Completed item 5 with the casualty's unit. 

h. Completed item 6 with the geographic location 
including the six-digit coordinate as well as the nearest 
town to the incident. 



Skill Level2 805C-PAD-2060 3-117 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

i. Completed item 7 only if name or Social Security 

number of the casualty is unknown or not positive. If 

they are unknown or not positive entered the estimated 
£ age, weight, height, hair color, eye color, race, home 
= town, civilian occupation, nickname, spouse's name, 
o children's name(s), (if applicable), other identifying marks 
o (such as birthmarks or tattoos), and other persons who 
to may have witnessed the incident or have further 

information. 

j. Completed item 8 with a short, concise narrative 
of the circumstances regarding the incident and, if 
known, the cause of death or condition when last seen 
and how identified. 

k. Completed items 9 through 1 3 with the name, 
Social Security number, unit, date, and signature of the 
person making the statement. 

I. Submitted form in accordance with local 
guidance. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on all of the performance measures to receive a 
GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was 
done wrong. 

References 

Required Related 

DA Form 11 55 AR 600-8-1 

DA Form 1156 



SUBJECT AREA 21 : DEFENSE MEASURES 



071-430-0002 

Conduct a Defense by a Squad 

Conditions:Given a squad, a priority of work, and locations for the crew- 
served weapons designated by the platoon leader. 

Standards: Accomplished preparation of a defensive position within the time 
specified in the platoon leader's order while maintaining security, 
camouflage, and concealment. 

1 . Designated fighting positions for squad members. 

3-118 071-430-0002 Skill Level 2 



2. Designated alternate and supplementary positions for squad members. 

3. Ensured all squad members followed assigned priority of work. 

4. Maintained security. 

5. Continued work as rapidly as possible. 

6. Maintained camouflage and concealment (to include noise, light, and litter "55 
discipline). a> 

7. Constructed positions properly. = 
Performance Steps M 

1 . Designate primary positions. 

a. Ensure each position has cover, concealment, and good fields of 
fire. Position weapons so their fires overlap, mutually support one another, 
and can be integrated, so you can place heavy surprise fire on the enemy. 
Watch closely any routes that could provide the attacker cover and 
positions from which he can mass his fire on your position. Be sure your 
entire squad sector is covered so you can repel any assault. 

b. Consider the number of men available, then position each one so 
he can support the men on his right and left. When the platoon's key 
weapons have been positioned, the men in the squad are positioned to 
protect those weapons from a dismounted assault. Each sector of fire must 
cross in front of another position at a point beyond hand grenade range. 
Site each fighting position using natural cover and concealment; then — 

(1 ) Clear fields of fire to allow each man to do the job for which he 
is positioned. DO NOT OVER CLEAR. 

(2) Build artificial cover, such as a parapet, if required. 

(3) Hide everything. 

c. Ensure that all enemy approaches into your squad sector are 
adequately covered by automatic weapons fire. 

d. Before digging in, move to the front of the position to ensure that 
each fighting position has frontal cover from enemy fire and all positions 
are mutually supporting. 

Note. A good fighting position should allow you to see and fire to the front when not 
receiving effective direct fire; however, if effective direct fire is received, the soldier 
can move behind frontal cover and fire to the oblique. 

e. To position each weapon of a rifle squad, follow the procedures 
below. 



Skill Level2 071-430-0002 3-119 



Performance Steps 



CD 



(1) Automatic riflemen. Identify dismounted avenues of approach, 
such as ravines, draws, and heavily wooded or brushy areas that are not 
covered with the machine gun. In areas covered by the machine gun, find 

£ out what dead space the machine gun has and cover it with automatic rifle 
= fire, if possible. If there is no dead space, assign a sector that will interlock 
|d with and overlap the machine gun's sector and final protective fire. 

(2) Grenadiers. Position grenade launchers to cover the dead 
space of the automatic weapon final protective fire. They must also be 
positioned to cover the entire squad sector. 

(3) Riflemen. Position riflemen between the remaining positions to 
give continuous observation and fire throughout the squad sector. They 
provide mutual support between positions and identify targets for the 
squad and platoon key weapons (grenade launcher, squad automatic 
weapons, machine gun, and Dragons). 

(4) Claym ore mines. Use these to cover any dead space that 
cannot be covered with 40-mm grenade launchers, and to supplement the 
fire of your riflemen. 

f. Select a position from which you can control the fire of your squad. 
Use your weapon only when necessary to protect yourself, to direct fire, or 
to influence the action at a critical point. Position yourself slightly behind 
the squad so you can observe and contact your squad, or at least your 
team leaders. If your squad strength is reduced, or the terrain does not 
permit you to establish a position to the rear, man a forward position. In 
this case, you may have to construct a single position to be able to observe 
your squad sector. You must be able to maintain contact with your platoon 
and fire team leaders from whatever position you select. Look for covered 
routes that you can use to move to the positions of your team leaders and 
platoon leader. 

2. Designate alternate positions. 

a. Prepare alternate positions so they are ready for occupation by the 
squad when the primary positions are no longer defendable. The locations 
of alternate positions are highly dependent upon the terrain, cover and 
concealment, and existing enemy situation. They must be near enough to 
the primary positions so the squad can cover the same sectors of fire as 
from the primary positions, without sustaining excessive casualties. A 
soldier's alternate position may be to the flank or slightly to the rear of his 
primary position. 

b. When selecting alternate positions, consider the following points: 

(1) Do they allow the weapon(s) or element(s) to accomplish the 
same mission as from the primary positions? 



3-120 071-430-0002 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(2) Do they provide — 

(a) Observation of the primary sector of fire? 

(b) Cover and concealment? 

(c) Maximum use of natural and artificial obstacles? 

(d) Control of the key terrain in the squad sector? 

(e) Cover of the avenues of approach into the sector? 

(f) Cover and concealment of withdrawal? 

c. Pick squad alternate positions based on the alternate pos itions of 
key weapons (M60 machine gun, M249 machine gun, and Dragon). 

d. Depending on their priority, prepare alternate positions immediately 
after the completion of the primary positions. Construct communication 
trenches between prim ary and alternate pos itions as time and terrain 
permit. When supervising the preparation of alternate positions, ensure 
that they are sited and constructed to take maximum advantage of the 
natural defensive characteristics of the terrain and the capabilities of 
organic weapons. 

3. Designate supplementary positions. 

a. Orient supplementary positions, unlike alternate positions, in a 
different direction than the primary position normally, within 200 meters of 
the primary positions. As time and terrain perm it, prepare communication 
trenches to provide covered routes between primary and supplementary 
positions. 

b. When selecting supplementary positions, consider the following: 

(1) Do they allow the squad to defend as part of the platoon against 
enemy attack from the flank(s) and rear? 

(2) Do they cover the most dangerous avenues of approach, other 
than those into the primary positions? 

(3) Do they meet the same guidelines that apply to placement and 
construction of primary and alternate positions? 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.Select an area in the field with varying terrain, cover, and 
concealment. Show the squad leader the squad's area of responsibility. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he is to select primary, alternate, and 
supplementary positions, in an area specified by the platoon leader, 
ensuring that the supplementary position is oriented in a different direction 
than the primary position. 



Skill Level 2 071-430-0002 3-121 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Ensured the primary position met the following 
requirements: 



(/j a. Used natural cover and concealment 



b. Ensured all fighting positions and weapon 
emplacements were mutually supporting. 



o c. Marked primary positions and informed squad 

ro members where fighting positions were constructed. 

d. Supervised construction of the fighting positions. 

2. Ensured the alternate position met the following 

requirements: 

a. Provided observation of the primary sector of fire. 

b. Provided cover and concealment. 

c. Provided use of natural and artificial obstacles. 

d. Provided cover of avenues of approach into the 

sector. 

e. Provided covered and concealed routes of 

withdrawal. 

3. Ensured the supplementary position provided for and 

met the following requirements: 

a. Allowed the squad to defend as part of the 
platoon against enemy attack from the flank(s) and rear. 

b. Provided observation of the primary sector of fire. 

c. Provided cover and concealment. 

d. Provided natural and artificial obstacles. 

e. Provided cover of avenues of approach into the 

sector. 

f. Provided covered and concealed routes for 

withdrawal. 

g. Covered dangerous avenues of approach other 

than those into the primary position. 

h. Provided the same guidelines in construction and 
placement of the supplementary position as in the 
alternate position. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was done wrong and 
how to do it correctly. 

3-122 071-430-0002 Skill Level 2 



References 

Required Related 

FM7-7 
FM7-8 



SUBJECT AREA 22: UNIT OPERATIONS 



071-326-5502 

Issue a Fragmentary Order 

Conditions:Given changes to original operation order (OPORD), and a 
requirement to develop and issue a fragmentary order (FRAGO). (See figure 
071-326-5502-1.) 

Standards: Developed and issued a clear and brief FRAGO based on 
changes in the mission or additional information. Issued the FRAGO in the 
standard OPORD format. 

Performance Steps 

Note. The FRAGO provides timely changes of existing orders to subordinate and 
supporting commanders while providing notification to higher and adjacent 
commands. A FRAGO is either oral or written and addresses only those parts of the 
original OPORD that have changed. The FRAGO differs from an OPORD only in the 
degree of detail provided. 

1 . Use standard military terminology. 

2. Issue the FRAGO in the same sequence as the OPORD. Use all five 
paragraph headings as shown in the following example. 




Skill Level 2 071-326-5502 3-123 



- 



7? 



Performance Steps 



FRAGMENTARY ORDER 



References: (Mandatory) Reference the ofder being modified. 

Time Zone Used Throughout the Order: (Optional) 

1 . SITUATION. (Mandatory) Include any changes to the existing 
order. 

2 MISSION (Mandatory) List the new mission. 

3. EXECUTION. 
Intent: (Optional) 

a . Con cept of o pe rati ons. (Mand atony} 

b. Tasks to subordinate units, (Mandatory) 

c. Coordinating instructions. (Mandatory) Include the 
statement. "Current overlay remains in effect" or "See 
change 1 to Annex C, Operations Overlay." Mark changes 
to control measures on cveriay or issue a new overlay. 

4. SERVICE SUPPORT. Include any changes to existing order 
or the statement, "No changes to OPORD ,* 

5 . CQMMAIM D AN D S I GN AL. includ e a ny eh anges to existing 

order or the state ment, "No changes to OPORD " 

ACKNOWLEDGE: (Mandatory) 



NAME (Commander's last name) 
RANK (Commander's rank) 



Figure 071-326-5502-1. FRAGO Example 



3-124 071-326-5502 Skill Level 2 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide equipment as stated in conditions. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to develop and issue a FRAGO that includes all 
changes to the original OPORD. 

CM 

Performance Measures GO NO GO a> 

> 

1. Issued a FRAGO. ii 



2. Used standard military terminology. ^ 



3. Included all changes to original OPORD. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measures , show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

FM 101-5 

071-326-5503 

Issue a Warning Order 

Conditions:Given preliminary notice of an order or action that is to follow 

and a requirement to develop and issue a warning order (WARNO) to 

subordinates. 

Standards: Developed a warning order and issued it to subordinate leaders 

within the time allotted. The order was issued so all subordinate leaders 

understood their missions and any coordinating instructions. Issued the 

warning order in the standard OPORD format. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Precede the order with the words "WARNING ORDER." 

2. Use standard terminology. 

3. Issue the WARNO in the five-paragraph field order format. 

a. Situation Paragraph. 

(1) Enemy forces: Provide available information on disposition, 
composition, strength, capabilities, and most probable course of action. 

(2) Friendly forces: Give available information concerning the 

m issions of next higher and adjacent units. 



Skill Level 2 071-326-5503 3-125 





Performance Steps 


(3) Attachments and detachments: Give information concerning 
any units that have been attached or detached. 




b. Mission Paragraph. The mission paragraph contains a clear, 
concise statement of the task to be accomplished and the purpose for 
doing it. 


< 

<D 

to 


c. Execution Paragraph. Provide information about the operation, if 
available. 




d. Service Support Paragraph. Provide all known instructions and 
arrangements supporting the operation. 




e. Command and Signal Paragraph. Designate the succession of 
command if it differs from unit SOP. 



Note. Warning orders involving movement should state the time of movement. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide a platoon -level warning order. The warning 
order will be given orally to the soldier. The soldier will then be given 1 
minutes to prepare his squad warning order. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to extract from the platoon warning order all 
information that pertains to his squad. Tell him he will have 1 minutes to 
prepare the squad warning order. Tell him that he will present an oral squad 
warning order. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Stated the words WARNING ORDER. 



2. Used standard military terminology. 



3. Issued the warning order in the five-paragraph field 
order format. 



4. Gave all available information. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measures , show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 



References 
Required Related 

FM 101-5 



3-126 071-326-5503 Skill Level 2 



551-88N-0002 

Prepare for Unit Move 

Conditions:You have received a movement order directing your unit to 

conduct a move to the port of embarkation and deploy in support of an Army 21 

or Joint mission. You have access to the unit SOP and all unit movement > 

directives. .3 

Standards: Prepared the unit for movement using the necessary references 2 
(vehicle -1 Os) and equipment to deliver vehicles and equipment to arrive at m 
the port of debarkation with no loss of vehicles or equipment (operational 
and ready for combat). 

Performance Steps 



1 . Prepare vehicles and equipment for shipment. 

2. Load vehicles with unit equipment. 

3. Load containers (when applicable). 

4. Prepare vehicle load cards. 

5. Prepare equipment and supplies for shipment. 

6. Build 463L pallets. 

7. Load equipment and supplies into containers. 

8. Prepare hazardous materials for shipment. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Evaluate this task during a field training exercise or a unit training exercise. 
Inform the soldier that the evaluation is measured on the ability to perform all 



the functions listed. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Prepared vehicles and equipment for shipment. 



a. Cleaned equipment thoroughly, removing all dirt 
and oil. 

b. Inspected vehicle to ensure it is mechanically 
sound, free of leaks, drips, and other operational defects 

c. Stenciled vehicles. 

d. Checked fuel levels. 

e. Inspected fuel cans for faulty lid gaskets, leaks, 
and other defects. 

f. Removed and secured sensitive and classified 
material. 



Skill Level 2 551-88N-0002 3-127 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

g. Removed and consolidated hazardous materials 
when practical. 

oj h. Reduced vehicle length, height, and width. 



Secured ignition keys to steering wheel with wire. 



» j. Secured rotating parts. 



CD 



k. Ensured all vehicles and trailers were equipped 
with serviceable tiedown devices or shackles. 

I. Protected radios and other electronic components 
on vehicles. 

m.Boxed and/or stored on vehicle equipment (OVE). 



n. Lowered cab assembly (only if required). 



2. Loaded vehicles with unit equipment. 



a. Maximized use of all cargo space. 



b. Did not exceed vehicle payload capacity. 



c. Protected against metal-to-metal contact. 



d. Protected load from weather damage. 



e. Securely restrained all loaded equipment. 



f. Weighed and documented the load on the load 
card. 



3. Loaded containers (when applicable). 



a. Prepared vehicles as described in step 1 . 



b. Reduced vehicle fuel levels to 1/4 tank. 



c. Placed vehicles in gear with the handbrake set. 



d. Disconnected batteries and secured terminal 
cables to prevent arcing. 



e. Chocked or cradled vehicle wheels on all four 
sides to prevent lateral and lengthwise movement. 

f. Placarded container appropriately when 
enclosing vehicle with fuel in the tank. 

g. Documented container load and seal number (if 
applicable) on the packing list. 

4. Prepared vehicle load cards. 



a. Completed, in duplicate, FORSCOM Form 285-R. 



3-128 551-88N-0002 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



b. Placed one copy of the vehicle load card in the 
driver side door pocket (or taped to the inside of the 
door) and provided one copy to the platoon sergeant or 
platoon leader. 

5. Prepared equipment and supplies for shipment. J 



6. Built 463L pallets. 



b. Placed lighter and/or smaller items on top or 
beside the heavier objects. 

c. Placed containers right-side up with "special 
handling" labels facing out. 

d. Constructed load in a square or pyramid shape, 
whenever possible, to make load stable, easy to handle, 
and easier to secure on the pallet. 

e. Placed hazardous materials, approved for 
palletizing by the UMO, on the pallet with the label 
clearly visible and never buried or hidden. 

f. Placed plastic covers over the load. 

g. Placed nets over the plastic covers and adjusted 
to fit snugly to load. 

7. Loaded equipment and supplies into containers. 



a. Distributed large, heavy objects from the center ol 
the pallet outwards to maintain center of balance (CB). 



(I) 




a. Inspected containers for defects. Rejected 
containers with holes, severe dents, faulty doors, 
damaged lifting points, or structural defects. 

b. Equalized weight distribution throughout the 
container. 

c. Placed heavy and wet material on the bottom and 
light and dry material on top. 



" 



d. Kept the CB of the load, as near as possible, at 
the center of the container for air shipments. If this was 
not possible, marked the CB on the outside of the 
container. 

e. Stored items that could be damaged by water on 
dunnage off the floor 



Skill Level 2 551-88N-0002 3-129 



0) 



< 

CD 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

f. Placed packages containing liquid, or that posed 
a leak hazard, on a double layer of dunnage to reduce 
damage due to leakage. 

g. Stowed hazardous material by the doors of the 
containers. 



f. Drained and placarded bulk fuel carriers. 



- 




h. Blocked and braced spaces between the contents 
of the load and the container walls and container ceiling 
to prevent the load from shifting when moved or tilted. 

i. Blocked and braced doors at least six inches 
back to prevent the load from falling out when the doors 
were opened. 

j. Placed one copy of the packing list inside the 
container on the door and one copy on the outside of the 
container door. Three additional copies of the packing 
list should be provided to the Unit Movement Officer 
(UMO), who in turn will forward a copy each to the 
Installation Transportation Office (ITO) and the 
Transportation Terminal Battalion (TTB). 

8. Prepared hazardous materials for shipment. 

a. Packed for shipment with equipment only those 
hazardous materials identified by the UMO. 

b. Applied the required markings, proper shipping 
name, ID number, and UIC/SUN provided by the UMO. 

c. Marked all oxygen and acetylene containers with 
the UIC/SUN. 

d. Drained and cleaned all five-gallon fuel cans, field 
cans, water heaters, gasoline lanterns, portable 
generators, blow torches, and similar equipment in which 
combustibles or fuel, other than diesel, were used or 
stored. 

e. Disconnected the batteries of non-self-propelled 
equipment, such as generators, and protect the terminal 
ends from arcing and from corrosion. 







g. Removed all loose ammunition and explosives 
from all containers and vehicles. 






Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO for the task if all performance 
measures are passed. Score the soldier a NO GO for the task if any 

3-130 551-88N-0002 Skill Level 2 



performance measures are failed. For all NO GO performance measures , 
demonstrate how they should be performed and allow the soldier to improve 
and correct their mistakes. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 4-01 .011 
TM 38-250 



SUBJECT AREA 23: SECURITY AND CONTROL 



301-371-1200 

Process Captured Materiel 

Conditions:This task can be performed in field and garrison locations 
under all conditions. Given captured enemy materiel consisting of a map, 
signal operation instructions, unidentified equipment, complete with 
reference manuals, captured enemy equipment tags, captured document 
tags, a sheet marked TECHDOC, blank spot reports, and unit SOP 
describing the processing and evacuation of captured enemy materiel. 

Standards: Secured captured enemy materiel. Prepared a spot report on 
captured enemy materiel known or believed to be of intelligence value. 
Filled out and attached tag to the item of captured enemy materiel. Selected 
correct disposition procedure for each item of captured enemy materiel. 

Performance Steps 

1. Safeguard the CEM. 

a. Categorize the CEM into — 

(1) Captured enemy documents include any piece of recorded 
information, regardless of form, obtained from the enemy, which 
subsequently comes into the hands of a friendly force. CEDscan be U.S. 
or allied documents that were once in the hands of the enemy. 

(2) Captured enemy equipment (CEE) includes all types of foreign 
materiel which may have military application found on an enemy prisoner 
of war (EPW) or on the battlefield. 

b. Protect the CEM from looting, loss, misuse, recaptures or 
destruction by placing under guard at all stages during the intelligence 
exploitation process. Use the best method available to preserve the item 
in its original condition. 

2. Prepare a spot report on all time-sensitive information. 

a. Identify time-sensitive information. The TECHINT appendix to an 

Skill Level 2 301-371-1200 3-131 





Performance Steps 



intelligence annex will delineate time-sensitive technical items and 
reporting channels. 

Note. Time-sensitive information includes any significant intelligence information 
with either military or technical application, to include enemy order of battle, enemy 
maps, overlays, operation orders, signals, codes, cryptographic materiel, new 
weapons or equipment on the battlefield, information critical to successfully 
accomplishing friendly courses of action, or information that indicates a significant 
change in the enemy's capabilities or intentions. 

b. Submit a spot report to notify higher commands of the capture or 
identification of enemy materiel believed to answer intelligence 
requirements. 

(1) Use S-A-L-U-T-E format to identify — 

(a) S-Size. 

(b) A- Activity. 

(c) L - Location . 

(d) U-Unit. 

(e) T-Time. 

(f) E - Equipment. 

(2) Report time-sensitive items by the least IMMEDIATE 
precedence. 

3. Tag each item of CEM. 

a. Tag all CEM found on the battlefield with no known association to 
an EPW. 

(1) Use CEE Tag on each piece of equipment. 

(2) Use Captured Document Tag for each document. 

b. Attach a sheet marked TECHDOC to flag the CED, if the CED is 
associated with a particular piece of CEM. 

(1) List the precise location, time, circumstances of capture and a 
detailed description of the materiel, on the sheet marked TECHDOC. 

(2) Treat all documents marked TECHDOC with the highest 
priority and forward them through the intelligence officer to the higher 
command until their value is determined. 

c. Use special procedures for handling captured communication- 
encryption (C-E) equipment and documents marked TECHDOC. 

(1) Handle in close coordination with the communications staff. 

(2) Treat CEDs containing communications or cryptographic 
information as secret material. 

(3) Tag and evacuate through secure channels without delay. 

3-132 301-371-1200 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



d. Use field expedient method when no preprinted tags are available. 
Ensure, as a minimum, to include the following information: 

(1) Provide date and time of capture. 

(2) Identify capturing unit and its designation. 

(3) Explain circumstances of capture. 

(4) Provide the identity of the CED or CEE captured. 

(5) Identify the location where the document was captured, 
including the six or eight digit grid coordinate. 

e. Tag without defacing the item. 

(1) Ensure that all markings that appear on the materiel at the 
time of capture are preserved. 

(2) Ensure that items are tagged so as not to damage or destroy 
the documents or equipment. 

(3) Never write on the document itself. 

(4) Put tag, without damaging the CED, in a waterproof bag. 

(5) Attach tag to CEM so it will not come off. 

4. Select the correct disposition procedure for each item of CEM. 

a. Identify all time-sensitive captured enemy materiel to be evacuated 
to the S2, who will screen for intelligence or technical value, and evacuate 
to the rear for examination and exploitation. All enemy documents 
captured on the battlefield are sent immediately to the first intelligence 
staff officer in the chain. The S2/G2 routes all enemy documents to the 
nearest interrogation element for tactical exploitation. Interrogators 
screen the documents for immediate information and forward them to 
higher command, as required. 

(1) Evacuate CEM with any technical documents found that relate 
to its design or operation. When the materiel cannot be evacuated, the 
documents should be identified with the materiel by attaching a sheet 
marked TECHDOC, and the following information: 

(a) List the precise location, time, and circumstance of 
capture. 

(b) List a detailed description of the materiel. 

(c) Take photographs of the equipment and evacuate with the 
document. 

(d) Take photographs of the materiel, placing an object of 
known size such as a ruler near the materiel to provide a size reference. 

(e) Protect equipment that is too large to evacuate. 

Skill Level 2 301-371-1200 3-133 





Performance Steps 



(f) Detail guards to s afeguard the item until you receive 
further directions. 

(g) Keep photos with TECHDOC and evacuate. 

(2) Evacuate CEM through your chain of command to the S2, who 
will screen for intelligence or technical value, then evacuate to the rear for 
examination and exploitation. 

b. Evacuate other CEM through similar logistic assets (for example 
route captured petroleum, oil, and lubricants [POL] through our POL 
points). 

c. Protect the CEM that cannot be evacuated, until disposition 
instructions are received. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Prepare samples of captured enemy documents. Prepare captured 
document tags for CEDs. Prepare captured enemy equipment tags for all 
unidentified equipment, complete with reference manuals. Provide a sheet 
marked TECHDOC, blank spot reports, and unit SOP. 

Brief Soldier: Instruct the soldier to process and evacuate all CEDs and 
CEE using captured document tags, captured enemy equipment tags and a 
sheet marked TECHDOC, when necessary. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Safeguarded each item. 



a. Used best method available to preserve the item 
in its original condition. 

b. Protected the item from looting, loss, misuse, 
recapture or destruction by placing under guard at all 
stages during the intelligence exploitation process. 

2. Submitted a written or verbal spot report on time- 
sens itive information that included six of six S-A-L-U-T-E 
items identified correctly. 



3. Completed the appropriate tag for each item. 



a. Used captured enemy equipment or captured 
document tag for CEM found on the battlefield. 

b. Attached a sheet marked "TECHDOC" to any 
CED associated with a particular piece of CEM. The 
cover sheet should list the precise location, time, 
circumstances of capture, and a detailed description of 
the materiel. Took photos of the CEM with a size 

3-134 301-371-1200 Skill Level 2 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 



reference, if possible, and kept with TECHDOC. 



CM 
"a) 



c. Used field expedient method when no preprinted 
tags were available. 

d. Tagged without defacing the item. 
? 

4. Selected the correct disposition procedure for each ^J 

item. = 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures w 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-19.40 
FM 34-52 
FM 34-54 



SUBJECT AREA 25: EQUIPMENT CHECKS 



091-CLT-4029 

Supervise Preventive Maintenance Checks and Services 

Conditions: In the field or in a motor pool environment, given proper 
equipment, appropriate technical manuals, supporting forms and 
documentation, tools, and personnel. 

Standards: Ensured maintenance status of assigned equipment was 
reported and personnel were trained in the proper procedures for conducting 
preventive maintenance checks and services (PMCS) and in accordance 
with the appropriate references. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Direct preventive maintenance checks and services. 

a. Verify that all current and updated technical manuals and 
references are available or requisitioned for unit assigned equipment. 

b. Verify that all tools, POL, personnel and other resources are 
available for PMCS. 

c. Observe operators performing PMCS at prescribed intervals. 

d. Review maintenance forms and reporting procedures for accuracy 

Skill Level 2 091-CLT-4029 3-135 




Performance Steps 



and completeness. 

2. Report maintenance status of assigned equipment. 

a. Verify that the operator has correctly identified and corrected, or 
recorded, faults on DA Form 5988-E, Equipment Inspection Maintenance 
Worksheetor DA Form 2404, Equipment Inspection and Maintenance 
Worksheet 

b. Confirm that not mission capable (NMC) faults are corrected 
before dispatch. 

3. Train personnel in the proper procedures for conducting PMCS. 

a. Enforce the commander's training program for operators of 
assigned equipment. 

b. Lead collective training. 

c. Verify that all operators are licensed for their equipment. 

d. Verify that squad leaders/section chiefs/team leaders train team 
members. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Verified that all current and updated technical 

manuals and references were available or requisitioned 
for unit's assigned equipment. 



2. Verified that all tools, POL, personnel, and other 
resources were available for PMCS. 

3. Enforced standing operating procedures in 
accordance with AR 750-1 and local policy. 

4. Reduced training distractions. 



5. Checked operator's DA Form 346 to confirm that 
operators were licensed. 



6. Observed operators performing PMCS at prescribed 
intervals. 



7. Compared PMCS process to the PMCS table in the 
appropriate technical reference. 



8. Reviewed maintenance forms and reporting 
procedures for accuracy and completeness. 



- 



9. Corrected technical and administrative deficiencies 
on the spot and provided feedback for the operator/crew 
on correct procedures. 



3-136 091-CLT-4029 Skill Level 2 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 600-55 
AR 750-1 
DA Pam 738-750 
DA Pam 750-1 
DA Pam 750-35 
TM 9-243 

101-92Y-0003 

Enforce Compliance with Supply Discipline Procedures 

Conditions:Given the requirement to ensure compliance with Command 
Supply Discipline Program (CSDP) by using existing assets to avoid 
duplication or fragmentation of effort and stewardship of resources. Given 
AR 71 0-2, AR 735-5, and local unit standing operating procedures (SOP). 

Standards: Enforced the CSDP in accordance with AR 71 0-2 and 
AR 735-5. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Initiate CSDP in accordance with AR 71 0-2, appendix B, and 
AR 735-5, paragraph 11-1. 

a. Define CSDP. 

(1) A compilation of existing regulatory requirements. 

(2) A mandatory program. 

(3) A program designed to simplify command, supervisory, and 
managerial responsibilities. 

b. Develop CSDP to implement in unit. 

(1) Provide the personal interest necessary to establish an 
effective CSDP. 

(2) Identify the appropriate CSDP requirements listing from 
AR710-2, appendix B. 

(3) Review the requirements listing within the CSDP to become 
familiar with applicable regulatory requirements. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0003 3-137 





Performance Steps 



(4) Make adjustments to the requirements listing as dictated by 
the unit unique requirements/missions. 

(5) Incorporate local SOP requirements into the CSDP. 

c. Obtain parent-level inspection checklists. 

d. Obtain parent-level evaluation schedule for your unit. 

e. Report to the immediate higher headquarters any applicable 
requirements within the requirements listing or checklists that cannot be 
completed. 

2. Execute the CSDP in accordance with AR 71 0-2 and AR 735-5. 

a. Perform routine duties using the CSDP. 

b. Review past evaluations conducted by higher headquarters to 
determine if any discrepancies have not been corrected. 

c. Perform general regulatory requirements. 

d. Check property authorization documents. 

e. Check requesting and receiving supplies. 

f. Check disposition of property. 

g. Check property responsibility. 

h. Check organizational clothing and individual equipment (OCIE) 
and personal clothing. 

i. Check management of loads. 

j. Check prescribed load list (PLL). 

k. Check inventories. 

I. Check adjustments for lost, damaged, or destroyed property. 

m.Check storage. 

n. Check petroleum management. 

o. Perform automated system checks. 

3. Maintain the CSDP in accordance with AR 71 0-2 and AR 735-5. 

a. Develop measures to enforce supply discipline. 

(1) Continue command emphasis on supply discipline by unit 
leadership. 

(2) Provide training to unit personnel on supply requirements, 
procedures, and methods. 

(3) Take administrative measures to account for lost, damaged, or 
destroyed property. 

(4) Take disciplinary measures to deter and/or correct fraud, 

3-1 38 1 01 -92Y-0003 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



waste, negligent damage, and/or loss of government property. 

b. Update SOP and CSDP to align with changing unit requirements. 

c. Submit to the commander any systemic problems that cannot be ^ 

■35 



resolved. 



Evaluation Preparation: This task can be evaluated during routine unit ^J 

operations. = 

Brief Soldier: Inform soldier that the evaluation is measured on the ability to % 
perform the listed performance measures. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1. Initiated the CSDP. 



a. Defined the CSDP. 



b. Developed the CSDP to implement in the unit. 



c. Obtained parent level inspection checklist. 



d. Obtained parent level evaluation schedule for the 



unit. 



e. Reported to the immediate higher headquarters 
any applicable requirements within the requirements 
listing or checklists that cannot be completed. 

2. Executed the CSDP. 



a. Performed routine duties using the CSDP. 



c. Performed general regulatory requirements. 



d. Checked property authorization documents. 



e. Checked requesting and receiving supplies. 



f. Checked disposition of property. 



g. Checked property responsibility. 



h. Checked OCIE and personal clothing. 



Checked management of loads. 



j. Checked PLL. 



k. Checked inventories. 



" 



b. Reviewed past evaluations conducted by higher 
headquarters to determine if discrepancies had not been 
corrected. 



" 



I. Checked adjustments for lost, damaged, or 
destroyed property. 

Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0003 3-139 





Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 




m.Checked storage. 






n. Checked petroleum management. 




0) 


o. Performed automated system checks. 




E" 


3. Maintained the CSDP. 




< 

<D 


a. Developed measures to enforce supply discipline. 




N> 


b. Updated SOP and CSDP to align with changing 
unit requirements. 






c. Submitted s ystemic problems that could not be 
resolved to the commander for resolution. 





Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 710-2 
AR 735-5 

101-92Y-0004 

Enforce Property Accountability Policies 

Conditions:Given the requirement to enforce property accountability 
policies. Given the appropriate supply documentation; and appropriate 
publications and forms. 

Standards: Ensured all property was accounted for in accordance with AR 
25-400-2, AR 710-2, AR 735-5, DA Pam 25-30, and DA Pam 710-2-1 . 

Performance Steps 

1 . Review hand receipt/sub-hand receipts, temporary hand receipts, 
inventory list, and equipment receipts for accuracy in accordance with DA 
Pam 71 0-2-1. 

a. Review manual hand receipt procedures. 

(1) Review DA Form 2062, Hand Receipt/Annex Number, used as 
a hand receipt/sub-hand receipt. 

(a) Verify change of primary hand receipt holder inventory 
was conducted and recorded. 



3-140 101-92Y-0004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(b) Verify hand receipt holders are still assigned to unit. 

(c) Verify all authorized equipment is listed on hand receipt. 

(d) Determine if all authorized equipment is on hand or on 
request. 

(e) Verify that all publication data is recorded in the item 
description block. 

(f) Verify shortage annexes are on hand for shortages as a 
result of an inventory. 

(g) Determine if the document number(s) are recorded on 
shortage annexes for due-ins. 

(h) Verify component hand receipts are being used when 
required. 

(i) Verify installation and organization property is not issued 
on the same hand receipt. 

(j) Verify if change documents are on hand for transactions 
and adjustment documents. 

(k) Determine if the hand receipt is being updated at least 
every six months based on the date of oldest change document. 

(I) Verify that change documents for hand receipts are being 
destroyed after being posted. 

(m) Verify items issued on component hand receipts are 
issued to the intended user. 

(n) Determine if the unit is using temporary hand receipt 
procedures when issuing equipment for less than thirty days. 

(o) Verify hand receipt is placed in the appropriate unit supply 
title. 

(2) Review DA Form 2062 used as component hand receipt. 

(a) Verify component hand receipt holder is still assigned to 
unit. 

(b) Verify items issued on component hand receipt are being 
issued to intended user. 

(c) Verify shortages are annotated on component hand 
receipt. 

(d) Verify all authorized equipment is listed on component 
hand receipt. 

(e) Verify all authorized equipment is on hand or on request. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0004 3-141 





Performance Steps 



(f) Verify the document number(s) are recorded on 
component hand receipt to show due-ins. 

(g) Verify end item stock number is entered. 
(h) Verify end item description is entered. 

(i) Verify recorded publication data is correct. 

(j) Verify the quantity of end item is correct. 

(k) Verify change documents are on hand for transactions 
affecting the component hand receipt on hand balance. 

(I) Verify the component hand receipt is being updated at 
least every six months based on the date of oldest change document. 

(m) Verify that change documents for component hand 
receipts are destroyed after being posted. 

(n) Verify component hand receipts are placed in appropriate 
unit supply file. 

(o) Confirm signature, rank, and date. 

(3) Review DA Form 2062 used as a hand receipt annex. 

(a) Verify the hand receipt/sub-hand receipt has a shortage 
annex annotated with any shortages that exist. 

(b) Verify hand receipt holders are still assigned to unit. 

(c) Verify that all shortages are listed on the shortage annex. 

(d) Verify publication data is recorded in the item description 



block. 



annex. 



(e) Verify there is a valid due-in for all shortages on shortage 



(f) Verify the document number(s) are recorded on shortage 
annex for due-ins. 

(g) Verify end item stock number is entered. 
(h) Verify end item description is entered. 

(i) Verify recorded publication data is correct. 

(j) Verify the quantity of end item is correct. 

(k) Verify item description of existing shortages. 

(I) Verify change documents are on hand for transactions 
affecting the shortage annex. 

(m) Verify the shortage annexes are updated at least every six 
months when hand receipts are updated. 



3-142 101-92Y-0004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(n) Verify person filling the position identified in the "From" 
block of DA Form 2062 is initialing shortages . 

(o) Verify change documents are on hand for all transactions. 

(p) Verify that change documents for shortage annexes are 
destroyed after being posted. 

(q) Verify shortage annex is placed in the appropriate unit 
supply file. 

(4) Review DA Form 2062 used as an inventory list. 

(a) Verify unit is using the inventory list to account for 
property when assigning responsibility is impractical. 

(b) Verify copy of inventory list is kept in area where the 
property is located and placed where it can beseen easily. 

(c) Verify inventory of property is being conducted and 
recorded at least semi-annually. 

(d) Verify unit SOP has instructions for using inventory list 
procedures. 

(e) Ensure DA Form 2062 is filled out in accordance with DA 
Pam 71 0-2-1. 

(5) Review DA Form 3749, equipment receipt used as a hand 
receipt. 

(a) Verify equipment receipt is used to issue individual 
equipment to the same person for brief recurring periods. 

(b) Ensure DA Form 3749 is filled out properly in accordance 
with DA Pam 710-2-1. 

(c) Verify an equipment receipt is prepared for each soldier 
authorized to receipt property. 

(d) Verify that equipment receipts are prepared and 
maintained correctly. 

(6) Review DA Form 31 61 , Request for Issue or Turn-In, used as 
a temporary hand receipt. 

(a) Determine if unit hand receipt holders are loaning 
equipment to another unit without approval of PBO. 

(b) Verify temporary hand receipts are only used to loan 
equipment for thirty calendar days or less. 

(c) Verify the original copy of temporary hand receipt is on 
hand. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0004 3-143 





Performance Steps 



(d) Verify temporary hand receipts are being filed in date 
sequence. 

(e) Ensure DA Form 3161 is filled out properly. 

(f) Verify the temporary hand receipt file is being reviewed 
daily. 

(g) Verify temporary hand receipls are destroyed upon return 
of property. 

b. Review automated hand receipts. 

(1) Review Standard Property Book System -Redesigned (SPBS- 
R) hand receipt/property list. 

(a) Verify the change of primary hand receipt holder inventory 
was conducted and recorded. 

(b) Verify the signed copy of hand receipt is current. 

(c) Verify all authorized equipment is listed on hand receipt. 

(d) Verify all authorized equipment is on hand or on request. 

(e) Verify shortage annexes are on hand for shortages as a 
result of an inventory. 

(f) Verify the document number(s) are recorded on shortage 
annex for due-ins. 

(g) Verifyperson filling the position identified in the "From" 
block of DA Form 2062 is initialing shortages. 

(h) Verify component hand receipts are being used when 
required. 

(i) Verify change documents are on hand for transactions 
and adjustment documents. 

(j) Verify changes are being posted to work copy of hand 
receipts. 

(k) Verify work copy against monthly hand receipt/property list 
for accuracy. 

(I) Verify change documents are destroyed after posting to 
hand receipt. 

(m) Determine if the SPBS-R monthly update is being 
downloaded to ULLS-S4. 

(n) Verify cyclic and sensitive items inventories are being 
conducted and recorded. 

(o) Determine if distribution instructions are on hand or have 
been requested for excess equipment. 

3-144 101-92Y-0004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(p) Verify hand receipt is placed in the appropriate unit supply 
file. 

(2) Review ULLS-S4 automated hand receipt. 

(a) Review property origin record. |j 

(b) Verify SPBS-R download is being performed to update 2 
primary hand receipt. j= 

(c) Determine if there is an imbalance report for equipment w 
not assigned on the sub-hand receipt. 

(d) Verify all entries of the automated hand receipt are 
accurate. 

2. Review posting of change documents and adjustment documents to 
hand receipt/sub-hand receipts in accordance with AR 710-2, DA Pam 
710-2-1, and ULLS-S4EM. 

a. Review manual, SPBS-R, and ULLS-S4 hand receipt procedures. 

(1) Determine if change documents are being maintained with 
hand receipt/sub-hand receipts. 

(2) Verify change documents are posted to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipts prior to change of hand receipt/sub-hand receipt holder inventory. 

(3) Verify installation and organization equipment is not issued on 
same change document. 

(4) Verify change documents are posted to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipt at least every six months. 

(5) Verify information being posted to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipts is accurate. 

(a) Verify the quantity of item being posted to sub-hand 
receipt. 

(b) Verify national stock number of item being posted to hand 
receipt/sub-hand receipt. 

(c) Verify line item number of item being posted to hand 
receipt/sub-hand receipt. 

(d) Verify serial number of item being posted to hand 
receipt/sub-hand if required. 

(e) Verify the nomenclature of item being posted to hand 
receipt/sub-hand receipt. 

(f) Verify unit of issue of item being posted to hand 
receipt/sub-hand receipt. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0004 3-145 




Performance Steps 



(g) Verify size of item being posted to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipt if required. 

(6) Verify change documents are destroyed when hand 
receipt/sub-hand receipts are updated. 

(7) Verify hand receipts/sub-hand receipts are placed in the 
appropriate unit supply files. 

b. Review hand receipt filing procedures . 

3. Prepare for inventory in accordance with DA Pam 710-2-1 , chapter 9. 

a. Check with the commander for any special instructions. 

b. Verify that the current DA Pam 25-30 is used to conduct the 
inventory. 

c. Verify availability of facilities for laying out equipment. 

d. Verify the date, time, and location of inventory with all hand receipt 
holders. 

e. Identify personnel that will be assisting with the inventory. 

f. Notify the sub-hand receipt holders of when, where, and how the 
inventory will be conducted. 

g. Ensure hand receipt holders are in the unit that is assigned the 
property. 

h. Ensure all hand or subhand receipts and annexes with change 
documents are posted prior to inventory. 

4. Conduct a physical inventory in accordance with DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , 
chapter 9. 

a. Follow the commander's special instructions. 

b. Compare authorization documents, modified table of allowances 
(MTOE), table of distribution and allowances (TDA), or joint table of 
allowance (JTA) with the hand receipts. 

c. Review DA Pam 25-30, to ensure that the most current 
publications are used to conduct the inventory. 

d. Ensure the quantity agrees with quantity recorded on the hand 
receipt document. 

e. Ensure the items being inventoried belong to the unit. 

f. Visually count and verify serial numbers of each item being 
inventoried. 

g. Check the serial number when an item has a serial number. 

h. Check end item for completeness using the proper technical 
manual or supply catalog. 

3-146 101-92Y-0004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



i. Make visual check of the condition of the item. 
j. Validate maintenance and laundry requests. 
k. Report discrepancies to the commander. 

5. Perform post inventory procedures in accordance with 
DA Pam 710-2-1 , chapter 9. 

a. Compare inventory results with authorization documents, hand 
receipts, property listings, or component listings to verify shortages. 

b. Inform commander of inventory results. 

c. Cross level and report excess property to accountable officer. 

d. Prepare adjustment document(s) if required. 

e. Process any adjustment document(s) as a result of inventory. 

f. Ensure all hand receipts, property listings, or component listings, 
as required, are available. 

Note: Upon completing a change of command inventory, the incoming and 
outgoing commanders will meet with the PBO for the change of property 
responsibility. 

g. Prepare a memorandum with results of inventory between 
outgoing and incoming commander, if required. 

h. Provide a copy of memorandum of inventory results to higher 
headquarters, if required. 

i. Place the inventory documents in the property record inspection 
and inventory report file, 710-2d. 

j. Place copies of all adjustment documents in property book and 
supporting documents file, 71 0-2a. 

k. File the inventory results in accordance with AR 25-400-2, 
appendix B. 

I. Turn in overages as "found on installation property." 

6. Verify the accuracy of adjustment documents in accordance with 
AR 735-5 and DA Pam 710-2-1 . 

a. Review the DA Form 4697, Report of Survey, that is being 
processed. 

(1) Verify that all entries on front (blocks 1 through 20) are 
completed. 

(2) Verify accountable officer signature and document number is 
obtained. 

(3) Verify the higher headquarters has assigned a survey number. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0004 3-147 





Performance Steps 



(4) Verify adjustment(s) that are made to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipt as applicable. 

(5) Verify a copy of DA Form 4697 is in the appropriate unit supply 
file in accordance with AR 25-400-2. 

(6) Verify that a memorandum of summary was prepared for the 
appointing/approving authority. 

(7) Determine if surveys are being forwarded to the approving 
authority in a timely manner. 

(8) Ensure that a survey officer has been appointed on orders. 

(9) Verify the survey officer has been provided a copy of 
DA Pam 735-5. 

(10) Verify the fair market value or depreciation value is being 
allowed. 

(11) Verify that surveys are being sent to Judge Advocate 
Generals (JAG) office for legal review. 

(12) Check to see if the survey officer's findings and 
recommendations are being reviewed prior to being presented to 
appointing/approving authority. 

(13) Verify that replacement item(s) were requested through 
supply channels. 

(14) Verify accountability of property was reestablished, if required. 

b. Review the DD Form 362, Statement of Charges/Cash Collection 
Voucher. 

(1) Check the date prepared. 

(2) Verify all entries for correctness. 

(3) Obtain accountable officer's signature and document number. 

(4) Verify adjustment(s) that are made to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipts as applicable. 

(5) Place copy of DD Form 362 in the appropriate unit supply file 
and dispose of in accordance with AR 25-400-2. 

(6) Verify replacement items were requested through supply 
channels. 

c. Review DA Form 4949, Administrative Adjustment Report. 

(1) Check the date prepared. 

(2) Verify that all entries are correct. 

(3) Verify change of account requirements. 



3-148 101-92Y-0004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(4) Verify accountable officer has signed and annotated a 
document number. 

(5) Verify hand receipts/sub-hand receipts have been adjusted for ^ 

all changes. a 

> 

(6) Verify a copy of DA Form 4949 is in the appropriate unit supply _3 

file in accordance with AR 25-400-2. = 

7. Complete final disposition of an adjustment document to obtain relief co 

from responsibility for property in accordance with AR 735-5 and DA Pam 
710-2-1. 

a. Verify that final action was completed, as required, by the 
approving authority. 

b. Verify that the individual(s) is notified of his or her rights regarding 
financial liability charges. 

c. Verify that Finance has processed financial liability against the 
individual being charged. 

d. Ensure the property book officer is provided a completed copy of 
final action on adjustment documents. 

e. Remove suspense copy from unit suspense file, and file the 
approved copy in document support file in accordance with AR 25-400-2 
and DA Pam 710-2-1. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Reviewed hand receipt/sub-hand receipts, 

temporary hand receipts, inventory list, and equipment 
receipts for accuracy in accordance with DA Pam 71 0- 
2-1. 



a. Reviewed manual hand receipt procedures. 



b. Reviewed automated hand receipts. 



2. Reviewed posting of change documents and 
adjustment documents to hand receipt/sub-hand 
receipts in accordance with AR 71 0-2, DA Pam 71 0-2- 
1,andULLS-S4EM. 



a. Reviewed manual, SPBS-R, and ULLS-S4 hand 
receipt procedures. 



b. Reviewed hand receipt filing procedures. 



3. Prepared for inventory in accordance with 
DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , chapter 9. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0004 3-149 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

a. Checked with the commander for any special 
instructions. 

b. Verified that the current DA Pam 25-30 was 
used to conduct the inventory. 

c. Verified availability of facilities for laying out 
§ equipment. 

d. Verified the date, time, and location of inventory 
with all hand receipt holders. 

e. Identified personnel who would assist with the 
inventory. 

f. Notified the sub-hand receipt holders of when, 
where, and how the inventory would be conducted. 

g. Ensured hand receipt holders were in the unit 
that was assigned the property. 






h. Made sure all hand or sub-hand receipts and 
annexes with change documents were posted to 
inventory. 






4. Conducted a physical inventory in accordance with 
DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , chapter 9. 



a. Followed the commander's special instructions. 

b. Compared authorization documents , MTOE, 
TDA, or JTAwith the hand receipts. 

c. Reviewed DA Pam 25-30, to ensure that the 
most current publications were used to conduct the 
inventory. 

d. Made sure the quantity agreed with quantity 
recorded on the hand receipt document. 

e. Made sure the items being inventoried belong to 
the unit. 






f. Visually counted and verified serial numbers of 

each item being inventoried. 

g. Checked the serial number when an item had a 
serial number. 

h. Checked end item for completeness using the 
proper technical manual or supply catalog. 

i. Made visual check of the condition of the items. 

j. Validated maintenance and laundry requests. 

3-150 101-92Y-0004 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

k. Reported discrepancies to the commander. 

5. Performed post inventory procedures in accordance 

with DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , chapter 9. w 

a. Compared inventory results with authorization g 
documents, hand receipts, property listings or _J 
component listings to verify shortages. = 

b. Informed commander of inventory results. c/j 

c. Cross leveled and reported excess property to 
accountable officer. 

d. Prepared adjustment document(s) if required. 

e. Processed any adjustment document(s) as a 
result of inventory. 

f. Ensured all hand receipts, property listings, or 
component listings, as required, were available. 

g. Ensured, upon completing a change of 
command inventory, the incoming and outgoing 
commander met with the PBO for the change of 
property responsibility. 

h. Prepared a memorandum with results of 
inventory between outgoing and incoming commander, 
if required. 

i. Provided a copy of memorandum of inventory 
results to higher headquarters, if required. 

j. Placed the inventory documents in the property 
record inspection and inventory report file, 710-2d. 

k. Placed copies of all adjustment documents in 
property book and supporting documents file, 71 0-2a. 



I. Filed the inventory results in accordance with 
AR 25-400-2, appendix B. 



" 






m.Tumed in overages as "found on installations 
property." 

6. Verified the accuracy of adjustment documents in 

accordance with AR 735-5 and DA PAM 71 0-2-1 . 

a. Reviewed the DA Form 4697, Report of Survey, 
that was being processed. 

b. Reviewed the DD Form 362, Statement of 

Charges/Cash Collection Voucher. 

Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0004 3-151 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

c. Reviewed DA Form 4949, Administrative 
Adjustment Report. 



w 7. Completed final disposition of an adjustment 
|j document to obtain relief from responsibility for property 
in accordance with AR 735-5 and DA Pam 71 0-2-1 . 



- 




a. Verified that final action was completed, as 
required, by the approving authority. 

b. Verified that the individual(s) was notified of his 
or her rights regarding financial liability charges. 

c. Verified that finance had processed financial 
liability against the individual charged. 

d. Ensured the property book officer was provided 
a completed copy of final action on adjustment 
documents. 

e. Removed suspense copy from unit suspense 
file, and filed the approved copy in document support 
file in accordance with AR 25-400-2 and DA Pam 71 0- 
2-1. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 25-400-2 
AR 710-2 
AR 735-5 
DA Pam 25-30 
DA Pam 71 0-2-1 



101-92Y-0005 

Enforce Compliance with Property Accountability Policies 

Conditions:Given the property records, blank forms, appropriate supply 
publications, and the requirement to provide proper guidance and direction 
to subordinate unit personnel; ensure the security of all property of the 
command, whether in use or in storage; observe subordinates to ensure 
their activities contribute to the proper custody, care, use and safekeeping of 
all property within the command; enforce all security, safety, and accounting 
requirements; take administrative or disciplinary measures when necessary. 
Standards: Enforced property administration in units and maintained 
property accountability in accordance with Army and DOD Regulations. 

3-152 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



1 . Determine the requirements to manage property administration. 

a. Review the guidance to manage property administration in units in 
accordance with AR 710-2. ^ 

(1) Forward requests through command channels when regulatory g 
guidance is not clear. 

(2) Process deviation for supply policy requiring HQDA approval to 
Commander, U.S. Army Logistics Evaluation Agency, ATTN: LOEAOS, w 
New Cumberland, PA 1 7070-5007. 

(3) Identity and report supply constraints to higher headquarters. 

(4) Implement the Hazardous Materials Management Program. 

b. Review administrative procedures as outlined in DA Pam 710-2 and 
local SOP to manage property administration. 

2. Establish property administration in a unit. 

a. Ensure personnel use the correct property authorization documents. 

(1) Verify all pertinent property authorization documents (such as 
MTOE, TDA) are on hand. 

(2) Verify all items that require property book accounting are on the 
property book. 

(3) Ensure hand receipts are reconciled with the authorization 
allowances. 

(4) Verify that the property book officer (PBO) accounts for 
organization and installation property separately. 

(5) Verify commander or head of separate activity for which the 
property book is maintained appoints the PBO. 

b. Ensure personnel maintain the automated property listings. 

(1) Verify the automated hand receipt, ALV-1 51 is on hand to show 
acceptance of, and responsibility for, assigned property. 

(2) Verify the hand receipt accuracy. 

(3) Determine if assistance is needed by the commander to conduct 
required inventories by verifying accuracy of listings. 

(4) Verify the preparation and maintenance of hand receipt 
procedures. 

c. Ensure personnel prepare and maintain hand receipts using correct 
procedures. 

(1) Verify that sub-hand receipt holders accept direct responsibility for 
property by signing a hand receipt. 

(2) Verify that equipment is issued on hand receipt/sub-hand receipt. 

Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-153 



Performance Steps 



(3) Verify change documents are posted to hand/sub-hand receipt at 
least six months from the oldest change document, 
y) (4) Verify temporary hand receipt properties are issued for less than 

S 30 calendar days. 

J7 (5) Verify property issued for more than 30 calendar days are issued 

§ on a permanent hand receipt. 

io (6) Verify inventory listings are used when assigning individual 

responsibility is not practical. 

(7) Verify that components of sets, kits, and outfits (SKOs) are 
controlled. 

(8) Verify hand receipt shortage annexes are prepared when 
component shortages exist. 

(9) Verify hand receipts are filed in appropriate unit supply files. 

d. Ensure procedures for request and receipt of supplies and logistical 
services are followed. 

(1) Verify that all authorized property, components and basic loads 
are on hand or on request. 

(2) Verify commander or designated representative review all 
requests having an Urgency of Need designator "A" and "B" for priority 
abuse. 

(3) Verify the use of end item codes (EIC) for requesting repair parts. 

(4) Verify that requests for recoverables are preceded by a turn-in of 
an unserviceable like item. 

(5) Verify the establishment and maintenance of document registers 
within the unit. 

(6) Verify controls are in place to account for all VISA IMPAC 
purchases. 

(7) Verify command requirement procedures are followed when a unit 
member is appointed as an ordering/contracting officer. 

(8) Verify requests for DRMO property are processed through Supply 
Support Activity (SSA). 

(9) Verify that delegation of authority documents are prepared to 
receipt for supplies and equipment. 

(10) Report all discrepancies when supplies and equipment are 
received. 

(1 1 ) Verify that document modifiers are submitted when a change is 
required. 



3-154 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(12) Verify cancellation requests are submitted when requested items 
are no longer needed. 

(13) Monitor the hazardous material program and provide guidance on 

the availability of materials. 

■> 
e. Ensure supply personnel comply with policies in issuing, storing, _J 

turning in supplies and equipment. = 

(1) Issuing. co 

(a) Verify all property is issued and hand receipt accountability is 
maintained 

(b) Verify hand receipts are used when property book or durable 
items are issued. 

(2) Storage. 

(a) Verify that adequate facilities and space is available for hand 
receipt holders to store the different classes of supplies. 

(b) Verify that storage facilities meet physical security 
requirements to prevent loss. 

(c) Verify that storage facilities meet the Occupational Safety and 
Health Administration (OSHA) Guidelines and local SOP. 

(d) Verify that adequate material handling equipment (MHE) is on 
hand. 

(e) Verify that storage facilities are properly marked with 
appropriate identifying symbols. 

(f) Verify that materials are inspected and kept ready for use. 

(3) Turn-ins. 

(a) Verify that transferred property meets accountability and 
maintenance requirements. 

(b) Verify turn-in action of excess property and associated 
components are initiated within 1 calendar days after effective data of 
authorization document change. 

(c) Verify turn-in of unserviceable and not repairable property 
book items through the PBO. 

(d) Verify the custodian handles the turn-in of unserviceable 
communication security (COMSEC) equipment. 

(e) Verify turn-in of unserviceable repairable to supporting SSA. 

(f) Validate component shortages of property for turn-in. 

(g) Items "found on installation" that are not on accountable 
records must be turned in through PBO. 

Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-155 




Performance Steps 



(h) Verify turn-in of residue and unexpended ammunition after 
completion of training. 

(i) Verify ammunition that is found is turned -in to the amnesty 
program. 

(j) Verify excess hazardous materials are tumed-in to SSA. 

f. Establish and maintain document registers. 

(1) Manual. 

(a) Verify PBO has designated, by informal memorandum, those 
elements authorized to request expendable and durable supplies. 

(b) Verify an informal memorandum, that specifies class of 
supply, Department of Defense Activity Address Code (DODAAC) and block 
of document serial numbers to be used by element is on hand. 

(c) Verify document registers are prepared and maintained 
correctly. 

(d) Verify supply status, status cards and/or listings are 
maintained for supplies due-in. 

(e) Verify all transactions, such as cancellation, follow-up, 
modification, and receipt data is posted to document register. 

(f) Verify document register is closed out and filed correctly. 

(2) Automated. 

(a) Verify PBO has designated, by informal memorandum those 
elements authorized to request expendable and durable supplies. 

(b) Verify an informal memorandum that specifies class of 
supply, DODAAC and block of document serial numbers to be used by 
element is on hand. 

(c) Verify document number parameter is set for classes of 
supply. 

(d) Verify active and inactive document/transaction history 
listings are maintained correctly. 

g. Conduct reconciliation procedures with supply support activity. 

(1) Verify reconciliation is accomplished on a monthly basis or in 
accordance with local standing operating procedures. 

(2) Verify copy of reconciliation is on file. 

h. Establish supply and equipment inventory control functions. 
(1) Verify elements that impact on acquisition, allocation, and 
disposal of materiel. 

(2) Verify joint change of primary hand receipt holder is conducted. 

3-156 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



03 



(3) Verify all unit property is inventoried annually. 

(4) Verify inventory is conducted prior to receipt or turn-in of property. 

(5) Verify a change of custody of arms storage facility is conducted w 
with results recorded on a hand receipt. g 

(6) Verify sensitive item inventories are conducted and recorded. .3 

(7) Verify weapons and ammunition inventories are conducted and 
recorded. 

(8) Verify unit loads, basic loads, and operational loads are 
inventoried to verify authorized stockage levels. 

(9) Verify authorized stockage of the prescribed load list (PLL) is on 
hand or on request. 

(10) Verify inventories of OCIE is conducted: 

(a) Soldiers departing or newly assigned. 

(b) Soldiers placed on AWOL status, hospitalized, or emergency 
leave. 

(c) Soldiers returning from a field exercise. 
i. Establish and maintain supply files. 

(1) Verify unit files are on hand and maintained. 

(2) Verify files are disposed of in accordance with AR 25-400-2. 
j. Supervise unit budget operations. 

(1) Verify that qualified individuals are available to operate the Unit 
Level Logistics System S4 (ULLS-S4). 

(2) Verify that the ULLS-S4 EM is on hand. 

(3) Verify that security accesses for ULLS-S4 have been established. 

(4) Verify that ULLS-S4 Parameter Files are established. 

(5) Verify that property origin records have been established. 

(6) Verify that Continuity Operation Procedures (COOP) for ULLS-S4 
is being performed. 

3. Maintain property administration in a unit by applying the Command 
Supply Discipline Program procedures. 

a. Administrative action. 

(1) Review the last evaluation to determine if past discrepancies were 
resolved. 

(2) Establish suspense dates for corrective actions. 
(3) Correct all findings using regulatory guidance. 

Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-157 




Performance Steps 



(4) Brief commander on the findings at the completion of the 
evaluation. 

(5) Evaluate the supply operations by using command inspection 
checklist. 

(6) Determine if any discrepancies are repeat findings. 

(7) File evaluation results in the appropriate unit supply files. 

b. Train personnel. 

(1) Verify that school trained supply personnel are assigned and 
working in their assigned positions. 

(2) Conduct military occupational skill (MOS) training classes to 
validate skills. 

(3) Recommend professional development through enrollment in 
Army correspondence courses. 

c. Re-inspect areas. 

(1 ) Review the last evaluation and correct discrepancies found. 

(2) Inform commander that corrective action has been taken. 

(3) Forward results of corrective action to higher headquarters. 

(4) Determine if any discrepancies are repeat findings. 

(5) File evaluation results in the appropriate unit supply files. 

4. Store Class I meal ready to eat (MRE) in accordance with DOD 
Regulation 41 45.1 9. R-1 change 5, section V. 

a. Prepare to store supplies. 

(1 ) Review storage area layout to determine best location for storage. 

(2) Verify storage area is clean and dry. 

(3) Verify storage area is properly ventilated. 

(4) Verify storage area temperature remains constant (between 70 
and 80 degrees Fahrenheit). 

(5) Verify the storage area can be secured. 

(6) Obtain necessary supplies or equipment to store Class 1 MREs. 

b. Store MREs using indoor/covered storage. 

(1) Place wooden pallets on floor/ground. 

(2) Stack MREs on the wooden pallets, leaving a space between 
each case (cross-stacking). 

(3) Place each lot on a separate pallet using the cross -stacking 
method. 



3-158 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(4) Stack oldest date packs in front. 

(5) Mark the lots and place the cases of MREs on the pallet where 
the date of the pack can be seen (location placard). 

(6) Do not stack MREs near the ceiling or heater pipes where 
temperature is high. 

c. Apply precautionary measures to avoid loss or damage to supplies. 

(1) Place a fire extinguisher in the storage area. 

(2) Place a mousetrap on each corner of the storage area. Report 
any signs of insect or rodent infestation to proper authority. 

(3) Check MREs periodically for pilferage, spoilage, and lot expiration 
date. 

5. Store Class II expendable supplies in accordance with DOD Regulation 
4145.19-R-1 chapter 3, section 3. 

a. Prepare to store supplies. 

(1) Review storage area layout to determine where items are to be 
stored. 

(2) Verify the area is clean and dry. 

(3) Verify that the area is well ventilated. 

(4) Obtain necessary supplies and equipment needed to store Class 
II expendable supplies. 

b. Store Class II expendable supplies. 

(1 ) Store supplies most often requested in an easy to reach place. 

(2) Store housekeeping supplies such as soap and toilet paper 
beneath issue counter. 

(3) Store housekeeping supplies such as brooms in tool room or 
closet. 

(4) Store nonflammable weapon maintenance materials such as rifle 
patches and repair parts in the arms room. 

(5) Store other unit expendable supplies in designated areas using 
shelving, drawers, cabinets, or bins. 

c. Apply precautionary measures to avoid loss or damage to supplies. 

(1) Place a fire extinguisher in the storage area. 

(2) Report any sign of insect or rodent infestation to proper authority. 

(3) Check expendable supplies periodically to prevent waste and 
pilferage. 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-159 





Performance Steps 



6. Store Class NIP petroleum products in accordance with DOD Regulation 
4145.19-R-1 chapter 5, section 7. 

a. Prepare to store supplies. 

(1) Store packaged fuels, lubricants, and greases in an area 
designated for storage of these items. 

(2) Store in a building only if adequate dispersion and ventilation are 
obtained and the building meets the requirements of the current flammable 
liquid code. 

(3) Place all packaged fuels, lubricants, and greases in a covered 
storage area, when possible. 

b. Store Class NIP petroleum products. 

(1) Store the maximum quantity of products in limited space while 
maintaining fire control and providing ease and safety in handling. 

(2) Store cans using the pyramidal stacking or vertical stacking 
methods. 

(3) Stack cans on wooden pallets, at unit and organizational level 
using one or both methods, pyramidal or vertical. 

(4) Verify that no containers are leaking. 

(5) Store container with date of pack clearly in view. 

c. Apply precautionary measures to avoid loss or damage to supplies or 
environment. 

(1) Verify that package fuel does not drain into rivers or sewage 
systems. 

(2) Verify uncased container exteriors are free of grease and oil 
before being placed in storage. 

(3) Inspect stacks periodically for evidence of leakage, abnormal 
swelling or corrosion of containers, for stability of stacks, and to verify that 
product markings are legible. 

(4) Place a fire extinguisher in the storage area. 

7. Store Class IV expendable supplies in accordance with DOD Regulation 
4145.19-R-1 chapter 5, section 5. 

a. Prepare to store supplies. 

(1) Store Class IV expendables in a covered storage area, when 
possible. 

(2) Verify that the area is clean and dry. 

(3) Verify that the area is well ventilated. 

(4) Obtain dunnage and place in storage area, if needed. 

3-160 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(5) Store in an easily accessible location. 
b. Apply precautionary measures to avoid loss or damage to supplies. 

(1) Inspect periodically to prevent waste, pilferage, or loss due to dry 
rot or mildew. 

(2) Rotate stocks when appropriate. 

(3) Place a fire extinguisher in the storage area. 

8. Store Class V ammunition in the unit arms room, in accordance with 
AR 190-11 and DOD Regulation 41 45.1 9-R-1 . 

a. Prepare to store supplies. 

(1) Verify the storage room can be secured. 

(2) Verify an unaccompanied "access control register" is posted on 
the outside of the door, in accordance with AR 1 90-1 1 , chapter 4, paragraph 
4-19. 

(3) Affix signs announcing the presence of Intrusion Detection 
System (IDS) at eye level when applicable. 

(4) Place a "RESTRICTED AREA" sign easily visible to people 
approaching the area. 

(5) Place a "NO SMOKING" sign outside the door. 

(6) Place a "FIRE SYMBOL #4" outside the storage room or building. 

b. Place the ammunition on pallet. 

(1) Separate by lot numbers. 

(2) Arrange so free circulation of air beneath and throughout the stack 
is possible. 

(3) Verify the stacks of ammunition are not closer than 1 8 inches from 
the roof and 3 inches off the floor. 

(4) Level the dunnage (if required). 

c. Apply precautionary measures to avoid loss or damage to supplies. 

(1) Verify the boxes, cases, and other containers of ammunition are 
clean and dry before being stored. 

(2) Verify that all cases are sealed. 

(3) Position fire extinguishers within the distance prescribed for the 
type Class V ammunition/explosives stored. 

9. Store paints, cylinders, and flammable supplies in accordance with DOD 
Regulation 4145.19-R-1, paragraph 5-404. 

a. Prepare to store paint and flammable supplies in a covered storage 
area designated for "FLAMMABLE STORAGE." 

Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-161 





Performance Steps 



(1 ) Place the total quantities of each within the storage area. 

(2) Pallets or dunnage will be used to segregate containers in piles. 

(3) Storage arrangements will comply with DOD Regulation 
4145.19-R-1, table 5-5. 

b. Prepare to store compressed gases (used for welding). 

(1) Identify cylinders by color code of noun in accordance with 
MILSTD-101. 

(2) Tag or label all filled cylinders with stock numbers. One for the 
type gas and one for the cylinder. 

(3) Tag empty cylinder with "MT" to designate "empty". 

c. Comply with handling procedures for movement of cylinders. 

(1) Move cylinders by using a suitable hand truck. 

(2) Move cylinders by tilting and rolling when suitable hand trucks are 
not available. 

(3) Do not lift cylinder by the valve protection cap. 

(4) Do not lift cylinder by the cranes or mechanical lifts unless 
fastened in proper containers, racks, and cradles. 

(5) Do not lift cylinder with rope, chain slings, or electromagnets. 

(6) Do not use cylinder as a roller, support or for any purpose other 
than for containing compressed gases. 

d. Apply precautionary measures to avoid damage or loss to supplies. 

(1) Do not use open flame devices in the flammable storage area. No 
smoking rule will be rigidly enforced. 

(2) Place fire extinguishers by required type in flammable storage 
area. 

(3) Roll paint drums stored horizontally every 90 days. 

10. Determine method of obtaining relief from responsibility for "damaged 
property" in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 12-1c (5) and table 12-1. 

a. Process a relief document for damaged organizational clothing and 
individual equipment (OCIE) when there is no negligence and item costs less 
than $1 00 in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 1 4-25, b (2). Prepare a 
"damage memorandum" stating the cause of the damage for the unit 
commander's approval in accordance with AR 735-5, Paragraph 14-25. 

b. Process a relief document for damaged property when there is no 
negligence and items cost less than $200. Prepare a "damage 
memorandum" stating the cause of the damage for the unit commander's 
approval and attach it to the maintenance request or turn-in document. 

3-162 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



<D 



c. Process a relief document for damaged property when there is no 
negligence and the item costs more than $200. Prepare a "damage 
memorandum" for the approving authority's designated representative; he wi 
enter "concur" on the statement and include the signature of the approving 
authority or designated representative. In no case will the unit commander > 
be a designated representative for reviewing damage statement when the 
cost for repair of the damage item is equal to or exceeds $200. 

d. Process a relief document for any item when a person admits liability 
and the amount is less than one month's pay, in accordance with AR 735-5 
paragraph 14-25b (1). Prepare a statement of charges/cash collection 
voucher. 

e. Process a relief document for any item when a person admits liability 
and the amount is less than one month's pay, in accordance with AR 735-5, 
paragraph 14-25, b (1) (b). Prepare and process a report of survey for the 
damaged property. 

f. Process a relief document for any item when a person does not admit 
liability or negligence in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 13-2, a (1). 
Prepare and process a report of survey for the damaged property. 

1 1 . Determine method of relief from responsibility for "lost or destroyed 
property" in accordance with AR 735-5, chapter 1 2, paragraph 1 2-1 , c (5), 
table 1 2-2; and AR 1 5-6, chapter 3 through 5; and AR 1 90-1 1 , paragraph 2-9 
page 5. 

a. Process a relief document for any item (except sensitive items) when 
a person admits liability and the amount is less then one month's pay, in 
accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 1 2-2c. Prepare a statement of 
charges/cash collection voucher. 

b. Process a relief document for any lost or destroyed item that requires 
a Report of Survey (RS) or AR 1 5-6 investigation in accordance with 
AR 1 5-6, chapters 3 through 5. 

(1) Prepare DA Form 4697 for sensitive items when an investigation 
is required under AR 1 5-6 for those items so designated in accordance with 
AR 190-11, appendix E. 

(2) Prepare a DA Form 4697 when directed by higher authority or by 
DA directive in accordance with AR 735-5, chapter 13, paragraph 13-2 (8). 

(3) Prepare a DA Form 4697 when the loss was discovered through 
inventory on a change of accountable officer and when individual does not 
make voluntary reimbursement to the government, in accordance with AR 
735-5 paragraph 13-2, a (2). 



Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-163 



Performance Steps 



S" 



(4) Prepare a DA Form 4697 for household furnishings and damage 
of government family housing units when amount is more than one month's 
pay, in accordance with AR 735-5 paragraph 13-2, a (4). 

(5) Prepare a DA Form 4697 for item when a person admits liability 
but the amount is more than one month's pay. 

§ (6) Prepare a DA Form 4697 for item when negligence is suspected 

but person does not admit liability and when the person refuses to sign DD 
Form 362, in accordance with AR 735-5, table 12-2. 

(7) Prepare a DA Form 4697 when bulk petroleum loss exceeds 
allowable loss and is over $500 in accordance with AR 735-5 paragraph 13- 
2, a (5). 

12. Determine method of obtaining relief from responsibility for "damaged, 

lost, or destroyed items under special situations" in accordance with 

AR 735-5, table 12-2; AR 710-2, paragraph 2-35, and AR 700-84, paragraph 

5-4. 

a. Process a relief document for bulk petroleum item when loss exceeds 
allowable loss and is less than $500, in accordance with AR 735-5, 
paragraph 2-35. 

(1) Perform causative research. 

(2) File a copy of the report with the monthly bulk petroleum 
accounting summary report as a supporting document. 

b. Process a relief document for hand tools authorized to a unit when 
liability is admitted in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 12-26. Prepare 
a DD Form 362. 

c. Process a relief docum ent for items lost in laundry in accordance with 
AR 735-5, table 12-2. 

(1) Prepare DA Form 3078, Personal Clothing Request. 

(2) Prepare a property issue slip listing the items lost. 

(3) Prepare a monthly report of survey for all articles reissued or for 
credit given. 

d. Process a DA Form 4697 for items lost resulting from fire, theft, or 
disaster in accordance with AR 735-5, table 12-19. 

e. Process a memorandum for items destroyed because of infection. List 
items on the memorandum and identify the officer who directed destruction. 

f. Process a memorandum for unsafe items due to age, (such as drugs, 
ammunition, parachutes, or chemicals) in accordance with AR 735-5, table 
12-2. 

(1) Prepare turn-in document in accordance with AR 710-2. 
3-164 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 



(2) Use reference information on age published in Army supply 
bulletins or DA Form 4697. 

g. Process a memorandum for abandoned items (such as combat 
contingency, or large scale field maneuvers) in accordance with AR 735-5, 
table 1 2-2. Prepare written orders to abandon, signed by the installation or 
division commander, to serve as a property adjustment voucher. If the 
commander declines to approve the order, prepare DA Form 4697. 2 

h. Process a relief document for items abandoned for reasons of health, 
safety, expense, difficulty to maintain, or handling in accordance with AR 
735-5, table 1 2-2. Submit an abandonment order to installation or division 
commander; then use it as a property adjustment voucher. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Determined the requirements to manage property 

administration. 



b. Reviewed administrative procedures as outlined 
in DA Pam 71 0-2 and local SOP to manage property 
administration. 

2. Established property administration in a unit. 



b. Ensured personnel maintained the automated 
property listings. 

c. Ensured personnel prepared and maintained 
hand receipts using correct procedures. 

d. Ensured procedures for request and receipt of 
supplies and logistical services were followed. 

e. Ensured supply personnel complied with policies 
in issuing, storing, and turning in supplies and 
equipment. 

f. Established and maintained document registers. 

g. Conducted reconciliation procedures with supply 
support activity. 

h. Established supply and equipment inventory 
control functions. 



a. Reviewed guidance to manage property 
administration in units in accordance with AR 71 0-2. 



a. Ensured personnel used the correct property 
authorization documents. 






Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-165 





Performance Measures GO NO GO 




i. Established and maintained supply files. 




j. Supervised unit budget operations. 


0) 


3. Maintained property administration in a unit by 
applying the Command Supply Discipline Program 
procedures. 


< 


a. Applied administrative action. 


to 


b. Trained personnel. 


c. Re-inspected areas . 


4. Stored Class 1 MRE in accordance with DOD R 
4145.19.R-1 chapter 5, section V. 




a. Prepared to store supplies. 




b. Stored MREs using indoor/covered storage. 




c. Took precautionary measures to avoid loss or 
damage to supplies. 




5. Stored Class II expendable supplies in accordance 
with DOD Regulation 4145.19-R-1 , chapter 3, section 3. 




a. Prepared to store supplies. 




b. Stored Class II expendable supplies. 




c. Took precautionary measures to avoid loss or 
damage to supplies. 




6. Stored Class HIP petroleum products in accordance 
with DODR 4145.19-R-1 , chapter 5, section 7. 




a. Prepared to store supplies. 




b. Stored Class IMP petroleum products. 




c. Took precautionary measures to avoid loss or 
damage to supplies or environment. 




7. Stored Class IV expendable supplies in accordance 
with DODR 41 45.1 9-R-1 , chapter 5, section 5. 




a. Prepared to store supplies. 




b. Took precautionary measures to avoid loss or 
damage to supplies. 




8. Stored Class V ammunition in the unit arms room, in 
accordance with AR 190-11 and DODR 4145. 19-R-1 . 




a. Prepared to store supplies. 




b. Placed the ammunition on pallets. 



3-166 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



c. Took precautionary measures to avoid loss or 
damage to supplies. 



9. Stored paints, cylinders, and flammable supplies in ^ 

accordance with DOD R4145.19-R-1, paragraph 5-404. -5; 

> 

a. Prepared to store paint and flammable supplies in _J 

a covered storage area designated for "FLAMMABLE 

STORAGE." 



b. Prepared to store compressed gases (used for 
welding). 

c. Followed handling procedures for movement of 
cylinders. 

d. Took precautionary measures to avoid damage or 
loss to supplies. 

10. Determined method of obtaining relief from 
responsibility for "damaged property" in accordance with 
AR 735-5, paragraph 1 2-1 c (5) and table 1 2-1 . 






a. Processed a relief document for damaged 
organizational clothing and individual equipment (OCIE) 
when there was no negligence and item cost less than 
$100 in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 
14-25b(2). Prepared a "damage memorandum" stating 
the cause of the damage for the unit commander's 
approval in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 14-25, 
b(2). 

b. Processed a relief document for damaged 
property when there is no negligence and item (s) costs 
less than $200. Prepared a "damage memorandum" 
stating the cause of the damage for the unit 
commander's approval and attached it to the 
maintenance request or turn-in document. 

c. Processed a relief document for damaged 
property when there was no negligence and the item 
cost more than $200. Prepared a "damage 
memorandum" for the approving authority's designated 
representative; he entered "concur" on the statement 
and included the signature of the approving authority or 
designated representative. In no case was the unit 
commander a designated representative for reviewing 
damage statement when the cost for repair of the 
damage item was equal to or exceeded $200. 

Skill Level 2 1 01 -92Y-0005 3-1 67 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

d. Processed a relief document for any item when a 

person admitted liability and the amount was less than 

one month's pay, in accordance with AR 735-5 
£ paragraph 14-25b(1). Prepared a statement of 
= charges/cash collection voucher. 



CD 

< 

CD 










e. Processed a relief document for any item when a 
person admitted liability and the amount was more than 
one month's pay, in accordance with AR 735-5, 
paragraph 14-25b(1)(b). Prepared and processed a 
report of survey for the damaged property. 

f. Processed a relief document for any item when a 
person did not admit liability or negligence in accordance 
with AR 735-5, paragraph 13-2a (1). Prepared and 
processed a report of survey for the damaged property. 

1 1 . Determined method of relief from responsibility for 
"lost or destroyed property" in accordance with AR 
735-5, chapter 12, paragraph 1 2-1 c(5), table 12-2; and 
AR 1 5-6, chapters 3 through 5; and AR 1 90-1 1 , 
paragraph 2-9. 

a. Processed a relief document for any item (except 
sensitive items) when a person admitted liability and the 
amount was less than one month's pay, in accordance 
with AR 735-5, paragraph 12-2c. Prepared a statement 

of charges/cash collection voucher. 

b. Processed a relief document for any lost or 
destroyed item that required a report of survey or AR 
15-6 investigation in accordance with AR 15-6, chapters 
3 through 5. 

12. Determined method of obtaining relief from 
responsibility for "damaged, lost or destroyed items 
under special situations" in accordance with AR 735-5, 
table 12-2, paragraph 2-35; and AR 700-84, paragraph 
5-4. 

a. Processed a relief document for bulk petroleum 
item when loss exceeded allowable loss and was less 
than $500, in accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 
2-35. 

b. Processed a relief document for hand tools 
authorized to a unit when liability was admitted in 
accordance with AR 735-5, paragraph 12-26. Prepared 



3-168 101-92Y-0005 Skill Level 2 







Performance Measures GO NO GO 

a DP Form 362. ~ 

c. Processed a relief document for items lost in 
laundry in accordance with AR 735-5 table 12-2. 

d. Processed a DA Form 4697 for items lost 
resulting from fire, theft or disaster in accordance with 
AR 735-5, table 12-2. ^ 

e. Processed a memorandum for items destroyed % 
because of infection. Listed items on the memorandum 
and identified the officer who directed destruction. 

f. Processed a memorandum for unsafe items due 
to age, (such as drugs, ammunition, parachutes, or 
chemicals) in accordance with AR 735-5, table 12-2. 

g. Processed a memorandum for abandoned items 
(such as combat contingency or large scale field 
maneuvers ) in accordance with AR 735-5, table 1 2-2. 
Prepared written orders to abandon, signed by the 
installation or division commander, to serve as a 
property adjustment voucher. If the commander 
declined to approve the order, prepared DA Form 4697. 

h. Processed a relief document for items abandonee 
for reasons of health, safety, expense, difficulty to 
maintain or handling in accordance with AR 735-5, table 
1 2-2. Submitted an abandonment order to installation or 
division commander; then used it as a property 
adjustment voucher. 

References 

Required 

AR 190-11 
AR 25-400-2 
AR 710-2 
AR 735-5 
DA Pam 25-30 
DA Pam 71 0-2-1 




Skill Level 2 101-92Y-0005 3-169 



< 

CD 



101-92Y-0006 

Inspect Equipment for Accountability, Cleanliness, and Serviceability 

Conditions:Given the requirement to inspect equipment, a piece of 
;£ equipment, DA Pam 25-30, and the appropriate supply publications and 
— forms. 

Standards: Ensured all equipment was inspected, and accounted for in 
accordance with AR 71 0-2, AR 735-5, DA PAM 71 0-2-1 , and applicable 
equipment publications. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine applicable publications. 

a. Review DA Pam 25-30. 

b. Ensure that the most current supply catalogs, component list, 
technical manuals, and other related publications are used during 
inventory/inspection. 

2. Conduct inspection of equipment. 

a. Accountability. 

(1) Check end items for completeness. 

(2) Use the proper technical manual or supply catalog to identify 
components. 

(3) Make sure that component shortages are listed on hand 
receipt shortage annexes. 

(4) Check the document register to make sure component 
shortages are on request. 

(5) Make a list of component shortages that are not listed on hand 
receipt shortage annexes. 

(6) Make a list of component overages. 

(7) Check serial numbers. 

(8) List serial number differences. 

b. Serviceability. 

(1) Conduct a visual check of the condition of the item. 

(2) List any damaged property. 

(3) Report damaged items. 

3. Take corrective action. 

a. Report differences pertaining to property book items to the PBO. 

b. Report damaged equipment to unit maintenance personnel. 



3-170 101-92Y-0006 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 


CM 
"a) 

5 

_i 

C/5 


1 . Determined applicable publications. 


a. Reviewed DA Pam 25-30. 


b. Ensured that the most current supply catalogs, 
component list, technical manuals, and other related 
publications were used during inventory/inspection. 


2. Conducted inspection of equipment. 


a. Performed accountability inspection. 


b. Performed serviceability inspection. 


Performance Measures GO NO GO 


3. Took corrective action. 




a. Reported differences pertaining to property book 
items to the PBO. 




b. Reported damaged equipment to unit 
maintenance personnel. 





References 
Required Related 

AR 710-2 
AR 735-5 
DA Pam 25-30 
DA Pam 71 0-2-1 



SUBJECT AREA 27: RISK MANAGEMENT 



850-001-2000 

Employ Accident Prevention Measures and Risk Management Process 

Conditions: You are a small unit leader, given a mission or task, in a 
garrison or tactical environment. 

Standards: Made an oral or written report that correctly identified the 
hazards associated with the mission or task, the level of risk for each 
identified hazard, and the initial overall level of risk. 



Performance Steps 



1. Identify the hazards. 

a. List the hazards associated with the mission or task. 

Skill Level 2 850-001-2000 3-171 




Performance Steps 



b. Determine what hazards need to be risk-managed. 
2. Assess the hazards to determine their impact on the mission or task. 

a. Determine the level of risk for each hazard. 

b. Determine the initial overall level of risk for the mission or task. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task you need an assigned mission or task, which 
may be an operation order (OPORD), fragmentary order (FRAGO), warning 
order, patrol order, training task, and so forth. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to do a risk assessment for the assigned 
mission or task. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Identified all the hazards associated with the mission 

or task (a minimum of one, depending on the mission or 

task). 



2. Determined the level of risk (E, H, M, L) for each 
hazard. 



3. Determined the initial overall level of risk for the 
mission or task. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 100-14 
FM 101-5 



SUBJECT AREA 28: ADMINISTRATION/MANAGEMENT 



805C-PAD-2044 

Recommend Individual for Award 

Conditions:Given opportunity to observe or evaluate performance of 
subordinates or to observe an act of an individual that warrants recognition, 
and access to AR 600-8-22, DA Form 638, Recommendation for Award, pen 
and/or computer with authorized software . 

3-172 805C-PAD-2044 Skill Level 2 



Standards: Prepared a DA Form 638 and included personal data, 
recommended award, and justification (achievement) entered in bullet 
format. Forwarded the DA Form 638 to the commander of the individual. 

Performance Steps 

1. Determine if soldier's performance or action merits an award. "35 

2. Determine the type of award merited. a> - 

a. Review authorized awards. ^ 

b. Compare performance or act against award criterion. m 

3. Determine criteria for submitting award recommendations. 

a. Identify time limitations for submitting awards. 

b. Identify period of award. 

c. Identify service vs achievement. 

d. Identify duplication of awards. 

e. Identify interim awards. 

f. Identify rules for recognition upon retirement. 

g. Identify approving authorities. 

4. Prepare the award recommendation, DA Form 638. 

a. Complete personal data on soldier. 

b. Specify type and level of award. 

c. Enter period of award. 

d. Enter supporting comments in block 20. 

5. Sign DA Form 638 in the appropriate block. 

6. Forward DA Form 638 to the commander of the individual. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, gather the items listed in the conditions 
statement. Provide the soldier with sufficient information to prepare the 
personal data, type of award, and justification/achievement. 

Note. If your command directs use of FormFlow or another forms software, have the 
computer and printer available. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to 
recommend an individual for an award. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Determined if soldier's performance or action merits 

an award. 



2. Determined the type award merited. 



Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2044 3-173 



Skill Level 2 


Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 


3. Determined criteria for submitting award 
recommendation. 


— 




a. Identified time limitations for submitting awards. 






b. Identified period of award. 






c. Identified service vs . achievement. 






d. Identified duplication of awards. 






e. Identified interim awards. 






f. Identified rules for recognition upon retirement. 




g. Identified recommendation official. 


h. Identified approving authorities. 






4. 


Prepared the award recommendation. 








a. Completed personal data on soldier. 








b. Specified type and level of award. 








c. Entered period of award. 








d. Entered supporting comments in block 20. 






5. 


Signed DA Form 638 in the appropriate block. 






6. 

inc 


Forwarded DA Form 638 to the commander of the 
iividual. 





Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measure failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on all performance measures to receive a GO on 
the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was done 
wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 600-8-22 
DA Form 638 
Software-Form Flow 
Software-Office 
Software-Windows 



3-174 805C-PAD-2044 Skill Level 2 



805C-PAD-2145 

Counsel a Soldier on the Contents of a Noncommissioned Officer 
Evaluation Report and NCOER Checklist 

Conditions: You are a section leader given soldiers, a mission statement or 
function manual, job descriptions, DA Form 2166-8, Noncommissioned 
Officer Evaluation Report, DA Form 2166-8-1, Noncommissioned Officer 
Counseling Checklist, and AR 623-205. 

Standards: Conducted initial performance counseling within 30 days of the 
NCO's assignment, conducted quarterly performance counseling thereafter, 
or as performance warranted. Maintained counseling record on 
DA Form 2166-8-1. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine type of counseling (such as initial, quarterly, or as 
required). 

2. Gather support material. 

a. Gather forms required. 

b. Determine duty descriptions. 

c. Determine mission statement. 

d. Obtain function manual. 

e. Determine areas of special emphasis. 

3. Schedule counseling. 

a. Allot time for soldier to prepare. 

b. Select site. 

c. Notify individual. 

4. Prepare for counseling. 

a. Review DA Form 2166-8-1 and related documents. 

b. Prepare counseling outline. 

5. Conduct counseling. 

a. Provide individual assessment of his or her performance, if 
applicable. 

b. Solicit input from individual. 

c. Provide the meaning of each value/responsibility on DA Form 
2166-8. 

d. Provide specific examples of excellence. 

e. Determine future counseling sessions. 

f. Obtain rated NCO's initials. 

Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2145 3-175 




Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, provide the soldier a DA Form 2166-8, DA 
Form 21 66-8-1 , personal data sheet, job description (duties clearly stated), 
rating scheme, a scenario that specifies special areas of emphasis, and AR 

(/) 623-205. Have the soldier prepare the forms for an initial counseling to 
include personnel administrative data, listing of duty description, and special 

£■ area of concern. 

<d Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to conduct 
performance counseling on a noncommissioned officer evaluation report 
(NCOER). Have the soldier prepare the forms for an initial counseling to 
include personnel administrative data, listing of duty description, and special 
area of concern. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Determined type of counseling. 



2. Gathered support material. 



a. Gathered forms required. 



b. Determined duty description. 



c. Determined mission statement. 



d. Obtained function manual. 



e. Determined areas of special emphasis . 



3. Scheduled counseling. 



a. Allotted time for soldier to prepare. 



b. Selected site. 



c. Notified individual. 



4. Prepared for counseling. 



a. Reviewed DA Form 2166-8-1 and related 
documents. 



b. Prepared counseling outline. 



5. Conducted counseling. 



a. Provided individual assessment of his or her 
performance. 



b. Solicited input from individual. 



c. Provided the meaning of each value/responsibility 
on DA Form 2166-8. 



d. Provided specific examples of excellence. 



3-176 805C-PAD-2145 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 


CM 

"33 

> 

CO 

_l 


e. Determined future counseling sessions. 


f. Obtained rated NCO's initials. 


Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measure failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on performance measures 2 and 4 to receive a GO 
on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was wrong. 


References 


Required Related 




AR 623-205 FM 22-1 00 




DA Form 21 66-8-1 





805C-PAD-2146 

Prepare the Rater's Portion of a Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation 
Report 

Conditions:You are a section leader and must rate one of your subordinate 
NCOs. You are given DA Form 21 66-8, DA Form 21 66-8-1 , AR 623-205, 
current rating scheme, paper, pen/pencil, and computer with authorized 
software. 

Standards: Completed all elements of the rater's portion of the NCOER 
without error. 



Performance Steps 



1. Determine type of report. 

2. Determine if eligible to render report. 

3. Review Soldier's Counseling work sheet, DA Form 21 66-8-1 . 

4. Verify Part I (Administrative Data) of DA Form 2166-8 (NCOER) with rated 
NCO. 

a. Verify name. 

b. Verify SSN. 

c. Verify rank. 

d. Verify date of rank. 

e. Verify Primary Military Occupational Specialty Code (PMOSC). 

f. Verify unit, organization, station, zip code or APO, major command. 

g. Verify reason for submission. 
h. Verify period covered. 

Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2146 3-177 




Performance Steps 



i. Verify rated months. 
j. Verify non-rated codes. 
k. Verify number of enclosures. 
= 5. Verify Part II (authentication) of NCOER with rated NCO. 

a. Verify name of rater (include rater's AKO email address), SSN, rank, 
PMOSC/branch, organization, duty assignment. 

b. Verify name of senior rater (include senior rater's AKO email address), 
SSN, rank, PMOSC/branch, organization, duly assignment. 

c. Verify name of reviewer (include reviewer's AKO email address), SSN, 
rank, PMOSC/branch, organization, duty assignment. 

6. Complete Part III (duty description) of NCOER. 

a. Enter principal duty title. 

b. Enter duty MOSC. 

c. Enter daily duties and scope. 

d. Enter areas of special emphasis. 

e. Enter appointed duties. 

f. Enter counseling dates from checklist/record. 

7. Complete Part IV (values/NCO responsibilities) of NCOER. 

a. Enter values. 

b. Enter competence. 

c. Enter physical fitness and military bearing. 

d. Enter leadership. 

e. Enter training. 

f. Enter responsibility and accountability. 

8. Complete Part V (overall performance and potential) of NCOER. 

a. Enter an X in the appropriate block. 

b. List up to three future duty positions . 

9. Sign Part II of the NCOER. 

10. Forward NCOER tosenior rater. 



3-178 805C-PAD-2146 Skill Level 2 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, gather DA Form 21 66-8, DA Form 21 66-8-1 , 
AR 623-205, current rating scheme, paper and pen/pencil, computer with 
authorized software and a printer. Give the soldier a scenario that provides 
all the information needed to complete the task performance steps. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldiers he will be evaluated on his ability to prepare > 
the rater's portion of an NCOER. ffi ' 

Performance Measures GO NO GO j* 

1. Determined type of report. 



2. Determined if eligible to render report. 



3. Reviewed soldier's counseling worksheet DA Form 
2166-8-1. 



4. Verified Part I, Administrative Data, DA Form 2166-8 
(NCOER) with rated NCO. 



a. Verified name. 



b. Verified SSN. 



c. Verified rank. 



d. Verified date of rank. 



e. Verified PMOSC. 



f. Verified unit, organization, station, zip code or 
APO, major command. 



g. Verified reason for submission. 



h. Verified period covered. 



Verified rated months. 



j. Verified non-rated codes. 



k. Verified number of enclosures. 



5. Verified Part II, Authentication entries on NCOER 
with rated NCO. 



a. Verified name of rater (included rater's AKO email 
address), SSN, rank, PMOSC/branch, organization, duty 
assignment. 



b. Verified name of senior rater (included senior 
rater's AKO email address), SSN, rank, PMOSC/branch, 
organization, duty assignment. 






Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2146 3-179 





Performance Measures GO NO GO 


0) 

2; 


c. Verified name of reviewer (included reviewer's 
AKO email address), SSN, rank, PMOSC/branch, 
organization, duty assignment. 


6. Completed Part III, duty description, of NCOER. 


J7 

< 

<D 

to 


a. Entered principal duty title. 


b. Entered duty MOSC. 


c. Entered daily duties and scope. 


d. Entered areas of special emphasis. 


e. Entered appointed duties. 




f. Entered counseling dates from checklist/record. 




7. Completed Part IV, values/NCO responsibilities, of 
the NCOER. 


a. Entered values. 


b. Entered competence. 


c. Entered physical fitness and military bearing. 


d. Entered leadership. 


e. Entered training. 


f. Entered responsibility and accountability. 


8. Completed Part V, overall performance and potential 
of the NCOER. 


a. Entered an X in the appropriate block. 


b. Listed up to three future duty positions. 


9. Signed Part II of the NCOER. 


10. Forwarded NCOER to senior rater. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measure failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on all performance meas ures to receive a GO on 
the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 623-205 
DA Form 2166-8 
DA Form 21 66-8-1 

3-180 805C-PAD-2146 Skill Level 2 



References 
Required Related 

Software-Form Flow 

Software-Office 

Software-Windows 

805C-PAD-2402 

Provide Input on Personnel Actions Affecting Subordinates 

Conditions:You are a squad/section leader and must assess your 
subordinates and make recommendations as to actions, qualifications, 
potential, and experience for pertinent personnel actions. 

Standards: Determined soldier's eligibility and potential for promotion, 
assignments, education/training, and career. Counseled soldier on actions 
required to maintain or obtain eligibility for appropriate personnel action. 
Provided recommendation/input to commander on personnel action. 
Provided commander with any change in previous recommendation/input as 
required. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine eligibility requirements for PV2 to SPC. 

a. Assess eligibility and potential of assigned soldiers for promotion. 

b. Counsel soldier on actions required to maintain or obtain 
promotion eligibility. 

c. Submit recommendation/input through channels to the 
commander. 

2. Determine availability of professional/educational programs or 
courses . 

a. Determine eligibility requirements, training benefits, frequency, and 
how to schedule soldier for attendance. 

b. Assess eligibility and potential of assigned soldiers for attendance 
at professional/educational training course/programs. 

c. Counsel soldier on potential effects of attending 
professional/educational training courses/programs. 

d. Counsel soldier on actions required to be recommended for 
attendance. 

e. Submit recommendation/input through channels to the 
commander. 

3. Determine assignment eligibility. 

Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2402 3-181 




7? 



< 

CD 



Performance Steps 



a. Determine eligibility requirements for reassignment or request for 
special assignment. 

b. Assess eligibility and potential of assigned soldiers for 
reassignment/special assignment. 

c. Counsel soldier on eligibility for the assignment and the effect the 
assignment could have on his career. 

d. Submit recommendation/input through channels to the 
commander. 

4. Determine soldier's career potential . 

a. Assess soldier's current duty performance and potential for 
continued service. 

b. Counsel soldier on actions required to maintain or obtain eligibility 
for continued service. 

c. Counsel soldier on the possible long-term effects that poor 
performance could have on his or her personal benefits and future. 

d. Submit recommendation/input through channels to the 
commander. 

5. Keep abreast of changes in assigned soldiers' eligibilities and 
potential. 

a. Determine changes in requirements and effect of new policies and 
programs on assigned soldiers . 

b. Inform soldiers when their performance has improved or fallen 
down. 

c. Submit change to previous recommendation/input when warranted 
through channels to the commander. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, prepare a scenario that provides information on 
the soldier(s) affected and the specifics of the personnel action(s) involved. 
Have the soldier determine if the subordinate soldier meets eligibility 
requirements and has the potential for the personnel action, and prepare the 
recommendation for the commander. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to provide 
input on personnel actions (promotion, assignments, education/training, and 
career potential) affecting subordinate personnel. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Determined eligibility requirements for PV2 to SPC. 







3-182 805C-PAD-2402 Skill Level 2 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



a. Assessed eligibility and potential of assigned 
soldiers for promotion. 



c. Counseled soldier on potential effects of 
attending professional/educational training 
courses/programs. 



e. Submitted recommendation/input through 
channels to the commander. 



3. Determined assignment eligibility. 



a. Determined eligibility requirements for 
reassignment or request for special assignment. 



c. Counseled soldiers on their eligibility for and the 
effect the assignment could have on their career. 

d. Submitted recommendation/input through 
channels to the commander. 



4. Determined soldier's career potential. 



b. Counseled soldiers on actions required to 
maintain or obtain eligibility for continued service. 



b. Counseled soldiers on actions required to ^ 

maintain or obtain promotion eligibility. a 
> 

c. Submitted recommendation/input through « 

channels to the commander. = 

2. Determined availability of professional/educational a> 

programs or courses. 

a. Determined eligibility requirements, training 
benefits, frequency, and how to schedule soldier for 
attendance. 

b. Assessed eligibility and potential of assigned 
soldiers for attendance at professional/educational 
training courses/programs. 




- 



d. Counseled soldier on actions required to be 
recommended for attendance. 



b. Assessed eligibility and potential of assigned 
soldiers for reassignment/special assignment. 



= 



a. Assessed soldier's current duty performance and 
potential for continued service. 



Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2402 3-183 



0) 



CD 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

c. Counseled soldier on the possible long-term 
effects that poor performance could have on his personal 
benefits and future. 

d. Submitted recommendation/input through 
channels to the commander. 



- 



g 5. Kept abreast of changes in assigned soldiers ' 
eligibilities and potential. 



a. Determined changes in requirements and effect 

of new policies and programs on assigned soldiers 

b. Informed soldiers when their performance has 
improved or fallen down . 

c. Submitted change to previous recommendation/ 
input when warranted through channels to the 
commander. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on all of the performance measures listed above to 
receive a GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was 
wrong. 

805C-PAD-2407 

Recommend Disciplinary Action for a Soldier 

Conditions:You are a squad/section leader. One of your soldiers has 
committed an act that may require disciplinary action based on violation of 
standards, bad conduct, breach of discipline, or insubordination. Given a 
computer with appropriate software, printer, AR 25-50, AR 27-10, 
AR 600-8-2, AR 600-20, AR 601 -280, AR 630-1 and AR 635-200. 

Standards: Verified act occurred, determined if conduct was a violation, 
prepared and submitted recommendation. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Verify that reported or observed act occurred. 

a. Obtain written/sworn statements. 

b. Obtain blotter reports/counseling statements. 

2. Determine if conduct is in violation of standards, breach of discipline, or 
insubordination. 

a. Gather all information. 



3-184 805C-PAD-2407 Skill Level 2 



Performance Steps 




b. Seek advice from legal representative (unit legal clerk or JAG 


officer). 




3. Prepare recommendation in memorandum or as required by local 


CM 


directive. 


"CO 


4. Submit recommendation to higher authority. 


CO 

_l 


Evaluation Preparation: 


Setup:To evaluate this task, give the soldier a scenario that would provide 


« 


enough information to accomplish the performance steps. Provide the 




soldier with access to a computer, a printer, and references . 




Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to 




recommend disciplinary action for a soldier. 





Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 


1 . Verified that reported or observed act occurred. 


a. Obtained written/sworn statements. 


b. Obtained blotter reports/counseling statements. 


2. Determined if conduct was in violation of standards, 
breach of discipline, or insubordination. 




a. Gathered all information. 


b. Sought advice from legal representative (unit 
legal clerk or JAG officer). 




3. Prepared and sent recommendation to higher 
authority for disciplinary action. 





Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on performance measures 1 through 3 to receive a 
GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 27-10 FM 22-1 00 

AR 600-20 

AR 600-8-2 

AR 601-280 

AR 630-10 

AR 635-200 



Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2407 3-185 




805C-PAD-2461 

Maintain Accountability of Personnel (Status Report) 

Conditions:You are a squad/section leader. Given a squad/section roster 

and DA Form 5367-R, Personnel Status Report. 

Standards: Status report accounted for all assigned/attached personnel. 



o Performance Steps 



1 . Verify the squad/section roster. 

2. Prepare the personnel status report (DA Form 5367-R). 

a. Enter the report number. 

b. Enter the time the report was prepared. 

c. Enter the unit. 

d. Prepare the personnel daily summary. 

(1 ) Enter the number of authorized personnel who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(2) Enter the number of assigned personnel who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(3) Enter the number of present for duty (PDY) who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(4) Enter the number of killed in action (KIA) who are 
commissioned, warranted and enlisted. 

(5) Enter the number wounded in action (WIA) who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(6) Enter the number missing in action (MIA) who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(7) Enter the number of NONBAT LOSSES who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(8) Enter the number of total LOSSES who are commissioned, 
warranted, and enlisted. 

(9) Enter the GAINS that are commissioned, warranted, and 
enlisted. 

(10) Enter written comments in the remarks section. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, give the soldier a scenario that would require 
him to accomplish the performance measures. Provide the soldier a 
squad/section roster and DA Form 5346-R. The scenario should indicate 
changes in the status of assigned/attached soldiers. Have the soldier 
prepare a status report that accounts for all assigned/attached sddiers. 

3-186 805C-PAD-2461 Skill Level 2 



Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to maintain 
accountability of assigned/attached personnel. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Verified the squad/section roster. 



d) 

2. Prepared the personnel status report. > 



a. Entered the report number. 



b. Entered the time the report was prepared. OT 

c. Entered the unit. 



d. Entered the personnel daily summary. 



(1) Entered the number of authorized personnel 
who are commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(2) Entered the number of assigned personnel 
who are commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(3) Entered the number of PDY who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 



(4) Entered the number of KIA who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 



(5) Entered the number WIA who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 



(6) Entered the number MIA who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 



(7) Entered the number of NONBAT LOSSES 
who are commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(8) Entered the number of total LOSSES who are 
commissioned, warranted, and enlisted. 

(9) Entered the GAINS who are commissioned, 
warranted, and enlisted. 

(10) Entered written comments in the remarks 

section. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on all of the performance measures listed above to 
receive a GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was 
wrong. 



Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2461 3-187 




References 
Required Related 

AR 600-8-101 
DA Form 5367-R 



805C-PAD-2472 

Prepare a Duty Roster 

Conditions: You are a squad/section leader. Given requirements to provide 
soldiers to perform additional duties on a recurring basis, DA Form 6, Duty 
Roster, and AR 220-45. 

Standards: Prepared a DA Form 6 for each duty requirement, listed all 
eligible soldiers, posted only days on which a detail was required. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine the requirements of the duty. 

a. Determine the period of the duty. 

b. Determine the nature of the duty performed. 

2. Determine personnel eligible. 

a. Determine grade of individuals eligible for duty. 

b. Determine special skills needed. 

3. Prepare DA Form 6. 

a. Prepare a separate form for each recurring duty. 

b. Complete administrative data. 

(1) Enter duty title. 

(2) Enter start date. 

(3) Enter month/day performed. 

c. Enter soldiers eligible to perform duty. 

d. Post numbers for day detail, as required. 

4. Select soldier(s) for duty. 

a. Notify individual. 

b. Post duty roster. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, give the soldier a scenario that would require 
the individual to prepare a duty roster, post numbers, and select individual to 
perform duty. Provide soldier with a section roster, DA Form 6, pencil, and 
AR 220-45. 

3-188 805C-PAD-2472 Skill Level 2 



Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to prepare a 
duty roster. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Determined the requirements of the duty. 



0) 

a. Determined the period of the duty. > 



b. Determined the nature of the duty performed. 



2. Determined personnel eligible. <J) 



a. Determined grade of individuals eligible for duty. 



b. Determined special skills needed. 



3. Prepared DA Form 6. 



a. Prepared a separate form for each recurring duty. 



b. Completed administrative data. 



(1) Entered duty title. 



(2) Entered start date. 



(3) Entered month/day performed . 



c. Entered soldiers eligible to perform duty. 



d. Posted numbers . 



4. Selected soldier(s) for duty. 



a. Notified individual concerned. 



b. Posted duty roster. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on performance measures 1 to 3 to receive a GO 
on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 220-45 
DA Form 6 



Skill Level 2 805C-PAD-2472 3-189 



Skill Level 3 



SUBJECT AREA 1 : INDIVIDUAL CONDUCT AND LAWS OF WAR 




805C-PAD-3238 

Enforce the Equal Opportunity Program 

Conditions:You are a unit/section leader responsible for the supervision of 
personnel. Personnel include both males and females and represent 
different races, colors, religions, and national origins. You have access to 
AR 27-10, AR 600-13, AR 600-20, DA Pam 350-20, DA Pam 600-26, DA 
Pam 600-75, DODD 7050.6, Manual for Courts Martial, and the Army and 
unit equal opportunity (EO) and sexual harassment policies. 

Standards: Demonstrated personal behavior and leadership consistent with 
the EO and sexual harassment policies. Enforced compliance with the Army 
EO, sexual harassment, and the Army extremist activities policies. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Act in accordance with the Army's EO and sexual harassment policies. 

a. Demonstrate Army Values associated with EO. 

(1) Display unquestionable loyalty. 

(2) Follow your higher duty to the Army and the nation. 

(3) Treat people as they should be treated. 

(4) Live up to all the Army Values. 

b. Conform to the Army's EO and sexual harassment policies by 
avoiding — 

(1) Making racial or sexual comments and/or gestures. 

(2) Making national origin or religious comments/jokes/slurs. 

(3) Displaying racist or sexually offensive visual materials. 

(4) Making unsolicited and unwelcome sexual contact with fellow 
soldiers. 

(5) Stereotyping fellow soldiers or making assumptions about their 
cultural background, race, religion, or beliefs. 

(6) Using profanity or sexually oriented language. 

(7) Discounting the religious beliefs of fellow soldiers. 

(8) Belonging to extremist organizations or participating in extremist 
activities. 

c. Demonstrate leadership consistent with EO and sexual harassment 
3-190 805C-PAD-3238 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



policies. 

(1) Treat subordinates with dignity and respect. 

(2) Treat subordinates fairly and equally. 

(3) Recognize and respect subordinates' individual needs, 
aspirations, and capabilities. 

(4) Avoid discriminating against subordinates based on race, color, 
national origin, gender, or religion. 

(5) Avoid using language that demeans, excludes, or offends 
subordinates. 

2. Promote EO and interpersonal harmony within the unit. 

a. Conduct assessments of the EO climate within the unit. 

b. Promote interaction among soldiers of different races and genders. 

c. Ensure subordinates respect the cultural background of fellow 
soldiers. 

d. Ensure subordinates communicate openly and honestly with each 
other. 

e. Consider support for EO when making recommendations for 
assignment, promotions, awards, and reenlistment of soldiers. 

f. Ensure subordinates understand Army and unit EO andsexual 
harassment policies and procedures. 

(1 ) Ensure subordinates understand required standards of behavior. 

(2) Counsel subordinates on legal and administrative repercussions 
of EO/sexual harassment violations. 

(3) Ensure subordinates understand recommended techniques for 
dealing with sexual harassment. 

(4) Ensure s ubordinates understand the EO and sexual harassment 
complaint process. 

(5) Ensure subordinates know the identities and roles of the unit EO 
representative and EO advisor. 

(6) Ensure subordinates understand the Army policy on extremist 
activities and organizations. 

(7) Ensure subordinate leaders understand their responsibilities for 
enforcing EO and sexual harassment policies. 

3. Promptly resolve EO and sexual harassment violations. 

a. Make on-the-spot corrections of subordinates whose behaviors are 
contrary to Army EO and sexual harassment policies. 

(1) Correct soldiers using racist or sexually harassing nonverbal 

Skill Level 3 805C-PAD-3238 3-191 




Performance Steps 




gestures. 

(2) Correct soldiers making racist or sexually harassing verbal 
comments. 

(3) Correct soldiers displaying racist or sexually harassing visual 
materials. 

b. Act promptly to resolve EO and sexual harassment 
violations/incidents. 

(1) Conduct an evaluation of the violation/incident. 

(2) Take prompt and effective action to preclude recurrence. 

(3) Counsel soldiers who com mit EO violations or who sexually 
harass. 

(4) Inform the chain of command. 

(5) Conduct follow-up assessment. 

c. Assist in resolving formal EO and sexual harassment complaints 
within required timelines. 

(1) Provide all required information to investigating personnel within 
established timelines. 

(2) Implement required corrective actions and monitor results. 

(3) Avoid allowing intimidation, harassment, or reprisal against 
~ soldiers for making complaints. 

(4) Assist follow-up assessments of corrective actions. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.This task can be tested in an administrative or field environment. 
Give the soldier a scenario that provides sufficient information to evaluate 
his or her knowledge of the Army's EO and sexual harassment polices, 
prohibited acts, and actions that should be taken if a violation occurs. 

Brief Soldier: Inform soldier that he will be tested on his knowledge of the 
Army's EO and sexual harassment polices, prohibited acts , and actions that 
should be taken if a violation occurred. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Acted in accordance with the Army's EO and sexual 

harassment policies. 



a. Demonstrated Army Values associated with EO. 



(1) Displayed unquestionable loyalty. 



(2) Followed higher duty to the Army and the 
nation. 



3-192 805C-PAD-3238 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

(3) Treated people as they should be treated. 

(4) Lived up to all the Army Values. 



b. Conformed to the Army's EO and sexual 
harassment policies. 



(1) Avoided making racial or sexual comments 
and/or gestures. 



(2) Avoided making national origin or religious 
comments/jokes/slurs. 

(3) Avoided displaying racist or sexually offensive 
visual materials. 

(4) Avoided making unsolicited and unwelcomed 
sexual contact with fellow soldiers. 



: 

: 



(2) Treated subordinates fairly and equally. 



0) 



(5) Avoided stereotyping fellow soldiers or 
m aking assumptions about their cultural background, 
race, religion, or beliefs. 

(6) Avoided using profanity or sexually oriented 
language. 

(7) Avoided discounting the religious beliefs of S 
fellow soldiers. 

(8) Avoided belonging to extremist organizations j| 
or participating in extremist activities. 

c. Demonstrated leadership consistent with EO and 
sexual harassment policies. 

(1) Treated subordinates with dignity and 
respect. 



(3) Recognized and respected subordinates' 
individual needs, aspirations, and capabilities. 

(4) Avoided discriminating against subordinates 
based on race, color, national origin, gender, or religion. 

(5) Avoided using language that demeaned, 
excluded, or offended subordinates. 

2. Promoted EO and interpersonal harmony within the 
unit. 

a. Conducted assessments of the EO climate within 
the unit. 






b. Promoted interaction among soldiers of different 
Skill Level 3 805C-PAD-3238 3-193 





Performance Measures GO NO GO 


races and genders. 


c. Considered support for EO when making 
recommendations for assignment, promotion, award, 
and reenlistment of soldiers. 


d. Ensured subordinates understood Army and unit 
EO and sexual harassment policies and procedures. 


e. Ensured subordinate leaders understood their 
responsibilities for enforcing EO and sexual harassment 
policies. 


3. Promptly resolved EO and sexual harassment 
violations. 


a. Made on-the-spot corrections of subordinates 
whose behaviors were contrary to Army EO and sexual 
harassment policies. 






b. Acted promptly to resolve EO and sexual 
harassment violations/incidents. 


< 

(D 


(1) Conducted an evaluation of the 
violation/incident. 


(2) Took prompt and effective action to preclude 
recurrence. 


U 


(3) Counseled soldiers who committed EO 
violations or who sexually harassed. 




(4) Informed the chain of command. 




(5) Conducted follow-up assessment. 








c. Assisted in resolving formal EO and sexual 
harassment complaints within required timelines. 


d. Avoided allowing intimidation, harassment, or 
reprisal against those making complaints. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO for each performance 
measure accomplished. Score the soldier NO GO for each performance 
measure not accomplished. Soldier must receive a GO on all performance 
measures to receive a GO for the task. If the soldier receives a NO GO, 
show him the performance measures he missed. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 600-1 3 
AR 600-20 

3-194 805C-PAD-3238 Skill Level 3 



References 
Required Related 

DA Pam 350-20 
DA Pam 600-26 
DODD 7050.6 
MCM2002 



SUBJECT AREA 4: SURVIVE (COMBAT TECHNIQU ES) 



052-192-4053 

Supervise Minefield Breaching Operations 

Conditions: You are a soldier, given FM 3-34.2, a combat engineer 
platoon, organic equipment, explosives, and an operation order (OPORD) 
with detailed obstacle intelligence (OBSTINTEL) requiring your platoon to 
conduct breaching operations. 

Standards: Supervised minefield breaching operations. Created a safe lane „ 
through the minefield s o the maneuver force could maintain its momentum — 
without causing mine casualties to personnel and equipment. > 

Performance Steps = 
2 

CO 



1 . Conduct troop-leading procedures. 

a. Receive the mission. 

(1) Obtain the number of breach lanes required. 

(2) Obtain security, suppression, obscuration, and assault plans 
for the minefield breach. 

(3) Conduct a back brief to the commander and request the 
required resources. 

b. Issue the platoon warning order (WO). 

c. Make a tentative plan. 

(1) Use OBSTINTEL and the mission analysis to develop a 
scheme of reduction. 

(2) Task-organize the platoon. 

(3) Develop subunit instructions for the breaching, marking, and 
security elements. 

(4) Integrate maneuver unit suppression, security, and 
obscuration support into the plan. 

d. Initiate movement. 

Skill Level 3 052-192-4053 3-195 



Performance Steps 




e. Conduct a reconnaissance. 

(1) Identify the minefield size and composition. 

(2) Identify breach locations. 

f. Complete the plan. Adjust the plan based on the information 
obtained during reconnaissance. 

g. Issue the platoon OPORD. 

(1) Brief the five-paragraph OPORD. 

(2) Assign breaching, marking, and security tasks to subunits 
based on the scheme of reduction. 

h. Supervise the plan. 

(1) Supervise precombat inspections. 

(2) Supervise rehearsals. 

2. Supervise actions at the breach site. 

Note. Breaching elements are normally located with the lead elements of the 
maneuver units. Usually, an engineer squad instead of an entire platoon performs 
in-stride breaches. In such cases, the platoon sergeant should supervise the most 
critical breach site, if possible. 

a. Coordinate with the maneuver element for suppression, security, 
and obscuration. 

b. Ensure that the platoon breaches the number of lanes specified in 
the OPORD. 

Note. Breach lanes for personnel are one meter wide and breach lanes for 
vehicles are four meters wide. 

c. Ensure that the breach lanes are free of mines. 

d. Ensure that the breach lanes are marked according to FM 3-34.2. 

e. Notify the maneuver commander when the breach lanes are safe 



for traffic. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide the soldier with the items listed in the conditions. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the noncommissioned officer (NCO) to perform a minefield 
breaching operation. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Conducted troop-leading procedures. 



2. Supervised actions at the breach site. 



3-196 052-192-4053 Skill Level 3 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-34.2 FM5-10 

FM5-100 
FM 20-32 

071-410-0012 

Conduct Occupation of an Assembly Area 

Conditions: You are a platoon-size unit leader, given a company 
commander's order to occupy a specific sector of a company assembly area 
and a map of the operational area. 

Standards: Moved unit to the location specified in the company order. 
Ensured preparation of the assigned sector was completed in the time 
specified in the order. Positioned elements, weapons, and observation posts 
in a manner that supported the company plan for occupation of the assembly 
area. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Conduct preparation for occupation of the assembly area (AA). 

a. Perform the required troop-leading procedures (a series of eight 
interrelated, overlapping processes that are often accomplished 
concurrently and do not follow a rigid sequence). Use the procedures as 
outlined, if only in abbreviated form, to ensure that nothing is left out of 
planning and preparation and that soldiers understand the mission and 
prepare adequately. 

(1) Receive the mission and the company OPORD. 

(2) Issue the warning order to subordinate leaders. Include 
location, special equipment required, and the earliest time for movement. 

(3) Make a tentative plan for moving to the position and preparing 
the position based on the estimate of the situation and an analysis of 
METT-TC. Your plan must support the company plan for occupation of the 
AA. 

(4) Start necessary movement. Movement may need to begin 
while you are still planning. This step could occur at any time during the 
troop-leading procedures. 

(5) Reconnoiter the position and the route(s) to it. This may not be 

Skill Level 3 071-410-0012 3-197 



> 

3 



CO 



Performance Steps 




possible due to the situation. As a minimum, conduct a map 
reconnaissance to confirm or deny assumptions made during the estimate 
of the situation. 

(6) Complete the plan. 

(7) Issue the order to subordinate leaders. Use the standard 
OPORD format. As a minimum, the order should include — 

(a) Situation. 

(b) Mission and purpose for occupation of the AA. 

(c) Each squad position (left, right, center) in the platoon 
sector. 

(d) Security plan (passwords, observation posts, percent of 
personnel on alert). 

(e) Times for movement or occupation of the AA. 

(f) Other pertinent information such as location of the 
command post, waste disposal, and environmental hazards. 

(8) Supervise continuously. 

b. Make necessary coordination with elements that will be attached 
or adjacent to your position in the AA. 

c. Provide platoon representatives for company quartering party as 
required. Instruct them to perform the following tasks or other tasks, as 
required. 

(1 ) Reconnoiter the AA to ensure it is clear of enemy. 

(2) Establish initial security. 

(3) Select initial positions for all platoon elements. 

(4) Identify, clear, or mark obstacles in the platoon sector of the 
AA. 

2. Direct platoon movement to designated platoon release point. Use 
appropriate movement techniques based on the terrain and the situation. 

3. Prepare your sector of the AA in accordance with the company plan. 

a. Link up with guides and move the platoon to its initial position. 

b. Establish and maintain local security. 

c. Assign squad sectors. Ensure sectors are mutually supporting and 
that all gaps are covered by fire and observation. 

d. Designate observation post(s) locations and the elements 
responsible for establishing and maintaining them. 

e. Ensure communication is established within the platoon and 
company. 

3-198 071-410-0012 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



f. Submit timely progress reports to company headquarters. 

g. Establish and enforce priority of work. The following is an example 
of work priority and may vary based on unit SOP, mission, or METT-TC. 

(1) Position vehicles, crew-served weapons, and chemical-agent 
alarms, and designate PDF, FPL, and FPF. 

(2) Construct fighting position. 

(3) Set up wire communications. 

(4) Prepare range cards. 

(5) Distribute ammunition, rations, water, supplies, and special 
equipment. 

(6) Conduct preventive maintenance checks and services on 
equipment. 

(7) Inspect personnel and equipment. 

(8) Rehearse critical aspects of the upcoming mission. 

(9) Test small arms (if situation permits). 

(10) Conduct personal hygiene and field sanitation. 

(11) Institute a rest plan. 

h. Coordinate with adjacent units and others, as required. 

(1) Coordinate for security patrols (if applicable). 

(2) Establish responsibility for overlapping enemy avenues of 
approach between adjacent units. 

(3) Ensure there are no gaps between elements. 

(4) Exchange information on OP locations and unit signals. 

(5) Coordinate for local counterattacks. 

(6) Complete and forward a copy of the platoon sector sketch to 
company headquarters. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.This task should be evaluated during a field training exercise. 
Otherwise, assign an assembly area to be occupied and a quartering party 
that has accomplished its tasks according to the company and platoon SOP. 
Brief Soldier: Issue an OPORD for an operation requiring the occupation of 
an assembly area. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 




1 . Conducted preparations for occupation of the AA. 



Skill Level 3 071-410-0012 3-199 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

2. Directed platoon movement to designated release 

point. Used appropriate movement technique based on ~~ 

terrain and situation. 

3. Prepared assigned sector of AA in accordance with 

company plan. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM7-7 
FM 3-21 .71 
FM7-8 

071-420-0021 

Conduct a Movement to Contact by a Platoon 

Conditions:Given a platoon, and a mission requiring movement to contact, 
in a combat environment. 

Standards: 

1 . Developed a plan that included objectives, routes, key terrain, fire 
support, formations, and other required control measures. 

2. Included in the preparations the cleaning and test firing of weapons, 
maintenance of vehicles and equipment, and the resupply of ammunition or 
needed equipment. 

3. Made contact with the threat with the smallest possible element. 
Developed the situation by controlling movement and fires. Submitted 
situation reports as required. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Receive and analyze the mission. 

Note. A warning order should be issued to provide subordinates as much 
preparation time as possible. 

2. Make a tentative plan. 

3. Start preparations. 

4. Conduct reconnaissance. 



3-200 071-420-0021 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



5. Finalize the plan. 

Note. Preparation continues as the plan develops. New information is 
incorporated into preparations. The OPORD is issued at the time and place 
specified in the warning order. 



6. Continue preparations. 

7. Request supplies. 

8. Receive supplies. 

9. Conduct rehearsals. 

10. Conduct final inspection. 

1 1 . Control movement. 

12. Control fires. 

13. Report the contact to the company. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide an area in which a movement to contact can 
be conducted. Test this task during a platoon or larger tactical exercise. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he is the leader of a platoon conducting a 
movement to contact and that he must react properly to enemy fire. as 



> 

.3 
Performance Measures GO NO GO _ 

1. Received and analyzed the mission. <J) 

2. Made a tentative plan. 



3. Started the preparations. 



4. Conducted the reconnaissance. 



5. Finalized the plan. 



6. Continued preparations. 



= 



7. Requested supplies. 



8. Received supplies. 



9. Conducted rehearsals. 



10. Conducted final inspection. 



1 1 . Controlled movement. 



Skill Level 3 071-420-0021 3-201 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

12. Controlled fires. 




13. Reported contact to the company. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM7-7 
FM 3-21 .71 
FM7-8 

071-430-0028 

Consolidate a Unit 

Conditions:Given a squad leader with a squad or platoon sergeant with a 
platoon or acting platoon leader defending as part of a larger unit. The unit 
has just repelled an enemy assault. 

Standards: Consolidated the unit (squad or platoon) in the defense 
following enemy contact. 

Performance Steps 

Once enemy resistance on the objective has ceased, the squad or 
platoon must quickly take the following steps to consolidate and prepare 
to defend against a counterattack: 

1 . Reestablish security if the observation post (OP) withdrew back to 
the defensive position, send them back out. If the OP did not return, they 
must be accounted for and returned. 

2. Use snipers (if available) for targets of opportunity. They may be 
employed with the OP or at a vantage point on or behind the defensive 
positions. 

3. Restore camouflage and improve fighting positions. Do not over- 
camouflage positions. If it was not found during the first assault, chances 
are it will not be found during the next counterattack. 

4. Reestablish communications to higher headquarters and throughout 
the platoon and squad. Check wires to ensure it does not break during the 
attack. Change pyrotechnic signals for the enemy may have learned what 
they represent. 

3-202 071-430-0028 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



5. Replace obstacles, mines, and early warning devices (conduct only 
if the enemy withdraws far enough and time permits). This is a risky 
action, especially if the enemy has snipers. Soldiers must use caution 
when moving about. Request smoke to conceal their movement or have 
them wait until limited visibility. 

6. Reposition fighting and weapons positions. If the squad or platoon 
has just repelled an attack, the enemy may have found some of the 
positions. Reposition those that have been compromised. 

7. Reassign sectors of fire to ensure that all gaps caused by the 
evacuation of casualties are covered and that the firing positions remain 
mutually supporting. 

8. Implement alert and sleep plans once all of the above have been 
accomplished and is feasible to the situation. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide a squad or platoon in an established defensive position, 
simulated casualties, simulated EPWs, simulated destroyed crew-served 
weapons, blank ammunition, and a communication network. 
Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier this task should be conducted and evaluated in 
a realistic field environment using a realistic combat scenario. 



> 



Performance Measures GO NO GO _ 

1. Reestablished security throughout the squad and </) 

platoon's sector. 



2. Used snipers (if available). 



3. Restored camouflage and improved positions. 



4. Reestablished communications. 



5. Replaced obstacles, mines, and early warning 
devices. 



6. Repositioned fighting and weapon positions. 



7. Reassig ned sectors of fire for the squad and platoon. 



8. Implemented sleep and alert plans (if feasible). 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 



Skill Level 3 071-430-0028 3-203 




References 
Required Related 

FM7-8 FM 3-21.71 

FM7-7 
FM7-10 
FM 23-90 



071-430-0029 

Reorganize a Unit 

Conditions:Given a squad leader with squad, or platoon sergeant with 
platoon, or mortar section sergeant, or acting platoon leader defending as 
part of a larger unit; your element has just repelled an enemy assault. 

Standards: Reorganized the unit (squad, platoon, or mortar section) in the 
defense following enemy contact. 

Performance Steps 

1 . The platoon leader must plan the required reorganization of the 
platoon while defending (either deliberate or hasty). He must include his 
plan in the order to the squad leaders. The plan must be tentative and 
flexible and may be changed as the situation evolves. The leader's plan 
must be complete and as detailed as possible. 

2. Reorganize a unit: 

a. Reestablish the chain of command; fill all key positions from the 
remaining element members and ensure the new chain of command is 
disseminated down to the last member of your element. 

b. Evacuate the dead and seriously wounded according to your 
casualty evacuation plan. Ensure all positions and sectors remain 
mutually supporting. Check all sectors of fire after all casualties are 
evacuated to ensure all sectors are covered. If necessary, shift positions 
or reassign sectors to cover any gaps in your sector. 

c. Redistribute or resupply ammunition, weapons, and fuel. Ensure 
the squad leaders pass out additional ammunition (if available), or divide 
the remainder equally throughout the squad or platoon. Conduct a quick 
inventory and submit a supply request to higher headquarters if 
necessary. 

d. Ensure all enemy prisoners of war (EPWs), enemy material, and 
enemy information are collected, reported, and evacuated (if possible). 

e. Ensure all crew-served weapons are manned and positioned on 
likely avenues of approach. 

3-204 071-430-0029 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



f. Issue to higher headquarters, a LACE report to include: 

(1) L - Liquid, how much water each soldier has left (canteens 
per). 

(2) A- Ammunition, how much ammunition does the squad or 
platoon have per man (after redistribution). 

(3) C - Casualties, how many casualties did the squad or platoon 
encounter. 

(4) E - Equipment, how much special equipment does the squad 
and platoon have remaining. 

3. For mortar section — 

a. Reestablish section communications. 

b. Reestablish the FDC. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide a squad or platoon in an established defensive position, 
simulated casualties, simulated EPWs, simulated destroyed crew-served 
weapons, blank ammunition, and a communication network. 



CO 



Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier this task should be conducted and evaluated in _ 

a realistic field environment using a realistic combat scenario. > 

fi 

Performance Measures GO NO GO _ 

1. Reestablished and disseminated the chain of j| 

command. 



2. Evacuated the dead and seriously wounded. 



3. Ensured all positions remained mutually supporting. 



4. Checked sectors of fire. 



5. Redistributed or resupplied ammunition, weapons, 
and fuel if needed. 



6. Ensured squad leaders and platoon sergeants 
passed out additional ammunition if available. 



7. Ensured all EPWs were reported and evacuated 
ASAP. 



8. Ensured all crew-served weapons were manned. 



9. Issued a LACE report to higher headquarters. 



10. Reestablished section communications (mortar 
section). 



Skill Level 3 071-430-0029 3-205 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 1 . Reestablished the FDC (mortar section). 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM7-8 FM 3-21.71 

FM 7-7 
FM7-10 
FM 23-90 




SUBJECT AREA 5: NAVIGATE 



071-332-5000 

Prepare an Operation Overlay 

Conditions:Given a complete copy of the operation order (OPORD) that 
your unit is to execute, a commander's or a battalion operations officer's (S3) 
guidance (to include time available for preparation), overlay paper, tape, a 
map of the operational area, colored pencils (red, black, blue, green, and 
yellow), a No. 2 pencil, a coordinate scale, and FM 1 01 -5-1 . 

Standards: Within the specified time, identified the overlay by map 
reference data, effective date, and purpose. The overlay contained 
classification markings and downgrading instructions, if applicable and 
distribution instructions and authentication, if distributed separately. 
Prepared overlay in accordance with overlay techniques outlined in 
FM 1 01 -5-1 , with boundaries and unit locations plotted to within 50 meters, 
and tactics and fire support measures to within 25 meters. 

Performance Steps 

Note. Overlay techniques involve the use of military symbols to portray, in a 
condensed form, the plans, orders, and information concerning a military operation. 

1 . Register the overlay. 

a. Orient the overlay material over the map area to the annotated 
portion and temporarily attach it to the map with the tape. 



3-206 071-332-5000 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



b. Trace the grid intersections nearest the opposite corners of the 
overlay and label each with the proper grid coordinates. 

2. Plot new detail. Use colored pencils or markers in standard colors, when 
available, to plot any detail (FM 101-5-1); otherwise, plot the activity you 
wish to show with a pen or pencil that makes a lasting mark without cutting 
the overlay. Use standard military symbols where possible. When the author 
invents nonstandard symbols , they must be identified on the edge of the 
overlay. Show only that detail with which the document is directly 
concerned. Standard colors are — 

a. Blue or black. Friendly units, installations, equipment, and activities. 

b. Red. Enemy installations, equipment, and activities. 

c. Yellow. Any areas of chemical, biological or radiological 
contamination. 

d. Green. Any man-made obstacle. 

Note. If only one color is available, enemy symbols are depicted with double lines. 

3. Mark the overlay classification. The classification of the overlay is 
dependent upon classification of the order used to prepare the overlay. Mark 
the top and bottom of the overlay with the classification. 

4. Recognize overlay techniques. 

a. Use solid and broken lines. When the location of a unit or installation 
or coordinating detail (for example, line of departure or boundary) is in effect 
and will continue, or is made effective by the order prepared, the appropriate 
symbol is shown by solid lines. The symbol indicating any proposed or 
future location, or coordinating detail to become effective later, is shown by 
broken lines. 

b. Boundaries. 

(1) Boundaries show areas of tactical responsibility. In the offense, 
these are referred to as zones of action. In the defense and retrograde, 
they are referred to as sectors of responsibility. When described orally, 
lateral boundaries are described from rear to front in the offense and from 
front to rear in the defense and retrograde. 

(2) Rear boundaries are used when the area of responsibility for 
forward units must be precisely defined. When a rear boundary is not 
delineated, the rear limit of a unit area of responsibility is determined by 
visualizing a rear boundary drawn generally parallel to the front, preferably 
along a natural terrain feature, and connecting at the rearward limit of the 
unit lateral boundaries. 



Skill Level 3 071-332-5000 3-207 




Performance Steps 



(3) If a rear boundary is shown, the size indication along the 
boundary corresponds to the low unit. Arm or branch is shown when 
required to prevent confusion (figure 071 -332-5000-1 ). 




Boundaries (Rear) [ 
(Forward) | 

(Corps are designated by Roman numerals.) 
(All text should be oriented as shown so that 
it is readable with the bottom nearest the 
reader or by turning the overlay one quarter 
turn clockwise.) 




Figure 071-332-5000-1. Rear Boundary 

(4) Desirably, boundaries are drawn along terrain features easily 
recognizable on the ground, and are situated, if possible, so the key terrain 
features, avenues of approach, and river are wholly inclusive of the one unit. 
They are shown by a solid line if currently in effect or made effective by the 
order prepared. Their use is based on the techniques and tactics peculiar to 
the type of tactical operation in which they are used. 

(5) Future or proposed boundaries are shown by a broken line and 
labeled to indicate the effective time, if appropriate (figure 071 -332-5000-2). 



Friendly Planned or On Order 


..--- xx 


Enemy Suspected or Templated 





Figure 3-071-332-5000-2. Proposed Boundary 

(6) A symbol is placed on the boundary to show size and 
designation of the highest units that share the boundary. 

(7) If the units are of unequal size, the symbols of the higher unit are 
shown and the designation of the lower is given completely to show its size. 
The boundary between the 52d Infantry Division and the 230th Infantry 
Brigade (separate) is shown in figure 071-332-5000-3. 



3-208 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



Boundaries (Lateral) I 1-90 



2(SA) 
■ XXX - 

X(US) 



52 ID (M) 

^ mmm XX ~^— 

312 SIB (M) 



Figure 071-332-5000-3. Lateral Boundary 

(8) On overlays or sketches accompanying written or oral orders that 
specify task organization, unit designation on battalion boundaries indicate 
the numerical designation. If the battalion is organized into a task force, the 
letters "TF" precedes the numerical designation. A unit symbol is identified 
as task force by placing the symbol (||) over the unit size designation (||). 
Company boundaries are labeled with the appropriate letter unless the 
company is organized into a team. In the latter case, the boundary is labeled 
with the abbreviation "TM" and the letter designation or a code name. On 
other boundaries, only the unit designation needed for clarity is required. 
Branch designations may be added when necessary for clarity. When 
unequal-size units have a boundary in common, the designation of the 
smaller unit is spelled out. 

c. Axis of advance. 

(1) An axis of advance arrow should extend only as far as this form 
of control is essential to the overall plan. Normally, it is shown from the line 
of departure (LD) to the objective following an avenue of approach. It 
indicates that the commander may maneuver his forces and place them 
freely to either side of the axis to avoid obstacles, engage the enemy, or 
bypass enemy forces that could not threaten his security or jeopardize the 
accomplishment of his mission. The commander ensures that such 
deviation does not interfere with adjacent units, that his unit remains 
oriented on the objective, and that the location and size of the bypassed 
enemy forces are reported to higher headquarters. Boundaries may be 
assigned as an additional control measure when using the axis of advance, 
if the situation so dictates. 

(2) An axis of advance is shown below, identified by a code. It could 
be identified by a unit designation (figure 071 -332-5000-4). 



> 

2 



tn 



Skill Level 3 



071-332-5000 



3-209 



Performance Steps 




Friendly G round A xis of Supporting 



Friendly Ground Axis of Main Attack 



Friendly Ground Axis on Order with 
Date and Time (if known) Effective 



Enemy Confirmed 



Enemy Templated 



> 




-K 



RED EFF 040500Z NOV > 



-ENY- 
■ENY- 



■ENY- 
■ENY- 



Figure 071-332-5000-4 Axis of Advance 

(3) To differentiate between a ground axis of advance and an air 
assault of advance, a twist is placed in the shaft of the open arrow, symbolic 
of a propeller (figure 071 -332-5000-5). 



3-210 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 





x> 


Axis of Advance \^^^\ 

(The tip of the arrow should touch the 
objective or limit of the movement.) 

Friendly Aviation 


Friendly Airborne 


s>^> 


Friendly Attack Helicopter 


>*<> 



Figure 071-332-5000-5. Air Assault Axis of Advance 

d. Direction of attack arrows. This control measure is used when the 
commander desires to specify the direction in which the center of mass of a 
subordinate unit must move in an attack to ensure the accomplishment of a 
closely coordinated plan of maneuver (for example, in a night attack or 
counterattack). A direction of attack arrow should extend from the line of 
departure to the objective and is not labeled (figure 071 -332-5000-6). 



> 

J5 



03 



Skill Level 3 



071-332-5000 



3-211 



Performance Steps 




Direction of Attack I 1-53 I 

(The tip of the arrow should touch the 
objective or limit of the movement.) 
Friendly Aviation 



Friendly Aviation Planned or On Order 



Enemy Known/Confirmed Aviation 



Templated Enemy Aviation 



Enemy Confirmed/Known Ground 



Templated Enemy Ground 



Friendly Direction of Supporting 
Attack \1-147I 



Friendly Planned or On Order 



-• ^- J, 



— ENY X" 



,-ENY \A"' 



___»«'' 



— ENY — > 



^ 



+ 



Figure 071-332-5000-6. Direction of Attack Arrow 

(1) The arrow should be used only where necessary because it 
restricts the maneuver of the subordinate unit. 

(2) When a unit is directed to seize successive objectives with its 
main attack along a certain line, either one arrow extending through the 
objectives to the final objective or a series of arrows connecting the 
objectives may be used. 

(3) The double arrowhead is used to distinguish the main attack for 
the command as a whole (figure 071 -332-5000-7). 



3-212 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 




Figure 071-332-5000-7. Arrowhead Indicating the Main Attack 

e. Graphic portrayal of units assigned a security mission. 

(1) To show the general location of a unit with a security mission, 
arrows generally indicate the terrain over which the unit operates and the 
farthest extension of its mission (figure 071 -332-5000-8). 



Note: 

The letter "S" is used for screening mission. 
"G" is used for guard mission. 
"C" is used for covering force. 




i 




/ 


& 


\ 


< <!— S 


S— ^ ' 









Figure 071-332-5000-8. Unit With Security Mission 

(2) The primary security mission normally is shown on an operation 
overlay; however, a secondary or proposed mission is not shown. 

f. Graphic portrayal of supply routes. 

(1) The main supply route (MSR) is the route(s) designated within an 
area of operations upon which the bulk of traffic flows in support of military 
operations. The route is labeled MSR and assigned a code name. 

Note. The term MSR is not used below division level. 

(a) In the defense, the division extends the MSR forward to the 
brigade trains. The brigade's supply route (SR) extends from the battalion 
trains to a point at the rear of the forward company defense sectors. 

(b) In the offense, the proposed SR may be shown forward to 
the objective or as far as the battalion supply officer (S4) can visualize the 
combat service support for the operation. Forward of the LD, it is shown as 
a broken line. 

(2) The symbols to show the division (offensive action) are shown in 
figure 071 -332-5000-9. 



> 

2 



V) 



Skill Level 3 



071-332-5000 



3-213 



Performance Steps 






MSR NAME 


Supply Routes 1 1-95 I 
Main Supply Route 






ASR NAME 


Alternate Supply Route I 1-8 I 




One-way Traffic 


MSR NAME 




Alternating Traffic 


MSR NAME 




Two-way Traffic 


MSR NAME 


. 



Figure 071-332-5000-9. Division Main Supply Route 

(3) Combat service support facilities are shown on the operation 
overlay or their location disseminated by the S4, as appropriate. 

g. Portrayal of a unit location. 

(1) To show the location of a unit on an overlay, the symbol should 
be drawn so its center corresponds with the coordinates at which the unit is 
located (figure 071 -332-5000-10). 



A solid line symbol represents a present or 
actual location. 




n 




A broken line symbol indicates a future or 
projected location. 


r~ i 

! J 



Figure 071-332-5000-10. Location of a Unit 

(2) To show the location of a training area, observation posts, or 
logistical activity, the center of the symbol also should correspond with the 
coordinates at which the element is located. The illustration shown is the 
location of an observation post (figure 071 -332-5000-1 1 ). 



3-214 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 







I 




A 


Observation Post/Outpost |^^2| 









Figure 071-332-5000-11. Location of an Observation Post 

(3) The offset technique is used for clarity when space precludes 
normal placement of symbols. Offset staffs may be "bent" as required. The 
offset staff is dashed for future or proposed locations. Offset staffs extend 
vertically from the bottom center of the symbol (except for command posts 
[CP]). The end of the offset staff indicates exact locations of CPs and aid 
stations and the center of mass for other units or installations. The staff for 
a CP symbol is always on the left edge (figure 071-332-5000-1 2). 



Basic symbols other than the headquarters 
symbols (for example, points) may be placed 
on a staff which is extended or bent. The end 
of the staff indicates the precise location. 
















I 




Since the headquarters symbol already 
includes a staff, this staff may be extended or 
bent. The end of the staff, or extension (if 
used), indicates the exact location of the 
headquarters. 








v 






CP 



Figure 071-332-5000-12. Offset Technique 

(4) Location of units. 

(a) The locations of attacking units normally are indicated by 
boundaries (and CP symbols, when the locations of the CPs are known) or 
by unit symbols. 

(b) The location of the reserve is indicated by an assembly area 
symbol and by a CP or unit symbol. 

(c) Reserve units of a force assigned defense position or battle 
position normally are shown by a line enclosing the area occupied or to be 
occupied — in other words, a "goose egg." These positions may be 
numbered or lettered for convenient reference. An occupied and 
unoccupied company assembly area (reserve location) is shown in figure 
071 -332-5000-1 3. An occupied and unoccupied reserve company battle 
position is shown in figure 071 -332-5000-1 4. 




Skill Level 3 



071-332-5000 



3-215 



Performance Steps 




Figure 071-332-5000-13. Occupied and Unoccupied Company Assembly Area 

(Reserve Location) 




m 



1-66 




OCCUPIED 



(A^1-66) 



UNOCCUPIED 



Figure 071-332-5000-14. Occupied and Unoccupied Reserve Company Battle 

Position 

h. Objective(s). 

(1) Each objective is identified by the abbreviation "OBJ" and a 
number, letter, or name designation (figure 071 -332-5000-15). 




Figure 071-332-5000-15. Objective 

(2) An objective assigned by higher headquarters may be given 
entirely to one subordinate unit or may be divided. If divided, the objective 
may be shown graphically as separate objectives and numbered 
accordingly, or may be divided into two objectives by a boundary line. 

i. Pinch out a unit. 



3-216 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(1) This type operation is indicated by drawing the boundary across 
the front of the unit, usually along a well-defined terrain feature such as a 
stream, ridge, or highway. 

(2) The following example indicates that Company A will be pinched 
out after seizing OBJ 1 ; Company B will seize OBJ 2 and continue the 
attack to seize OBJ 3 (figure 071 -332-5000-16). 




Figure 071-332-5000-16. Pinching Out a Unit 

j. Defensive battlefield. The defensive battlefield is organized into the 
covering force area and the main battle area (MBA) (figure 071 -332-5000- 
17). 



2 



tn 



=® 




XX 



MAIN BATTLE 
AREA (MBA) 



JQL 



COVERING FORCE 
AREA 




Figure 071-332-5000-17. Organizing the Defensive Battlefield 



Skill Level 3 



071-332-5000 



3-217 



Performance Steps 



k. Defended areas. If an area is occupied and the defense of the area 
is prepared, a line (including the size symbol of the defending unit) encloses 
the area, and the closed side of the symbol is oriented toward the most 
likely enemy threat. If desired, the military symbols of the unit may be 
entered in the center of the enclosed area. A defensive area for 2d Platoon, 
C Company, 1st Battalion, 6th Infantry, and a proposed defensive area for B 
Company, 3d Battalion, 52d Infantry, are shown in figure 071-332-5000-18. 




DEFENSIVE AREA 2d PLT, C CO, 
1st BN, 6th INF 




PROPOSED DEFENSIVE AREA B CO, 
3d BN, 52d INF 



B 



_L 




3-52 






Figure 071-332-5000-18. Defensive Area 

I. Control measures. 

(1) Line of departure (LD). The LD is a control measure to 
coordinate the advance of an attacking unit (figure 071 -332-5000-1 9). The 
LD should be — 

(a) Clearly defined on the ground and on the map. 

(b) Approximately perpendicular to the direction of the attack. 

(c) Under control of friendly units. 

(d) Marked on both ends. 



3-218 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



Line of Departure (LD) I 1-91 I 



LD | 
(PL NAME) I 



9 g 9 



\ 



I (PL NAME] 



SI 



Figure 071-332-5000-19. Line of Departure 



(2) Line of contact (LC) (figure 071 -332-5000-20). 



Line of Departure is Line of Contact 
(LD/LC) I 1-92 I 



LD/LC ; 
(PL NAME) I 



LD/LC 
I (PL NAME) 



9 g g 
5 i S 



Figure 071-332-5000-20. Line of Contact 

(a) When units are in contact with the enemy, the frontline is 
shown as a series of arcs, and the ends of the arced line are labeled "LC." 

(b) If the LC is used as an LD, it is marked LD/LC. 

(c) If the LC is not used, the LD is shown by a solid line marked 
LD. 

(3) Phase line (PLs). PLs are used to control the progress of units 
for reference in issuing orders or receiving reports. They should be easily 
recognized terrain features, normally perpendicular to the direction of 
advance. A PL is also used to control fires and unit movement and even to 
limit the advance of attacking elements. Units report their arrival at, or 
clearance of, a PL, but they do not halt unless ordered to do so. A PL is 
drawn as a solid line with the letters PL at each end of the line or, where 
appropriate, to allow easy identification. A PL is identified further by a 
number, a letter, or code name (which can be phonetic letters, colors, 
flowers, cars, or any other code system) under or beside the PL 
abbreviation (figure 071-332-5000-21). 



CO 



CO 



Skill Level 3 



071-332-5000 



3-219 



Performance Steps 




Phase Line (PL) 



PL NAME 



PL NAME 



Figure 071-332-5000-21. Phase Line 

(4) Initial delay position (IDP). An IDP is where a delaying action 
begins, trading space for time. The delay sector is defined by boundaries. 
The initial and all subsequent delay positions can be related to a time- 
phased forward edge of the battle area (FEBA). The initial and subsequent 
delay positions are specified, and PLs may be used to report the progress of 
the battle. The enemy is held forward of delay lines until the specified time 
or until permission is granted to withdraw. The initial and successive delay 
positions are shown on boundaries by coordination points with a solid line 
between them. Although most IDPs are given a code name, they may have 
a number, letter, or a variety of code names. The letter abbreviation (IDP) 
can be to the flank of the coordination symbol (when at the flank, it is in 
parentheses) or on the line itself. Its time phase is indicated as a date-time 
group having a two-digit day and a four-digit hour, both connected. The 
month indicator can be a three-letter type or spelled out, depending upon 
the desires of the commander. The letters IDP should be placed in 
parentheses between the line code name, letter, or number and the date- 
time group (figure 071 -332-5000-22). 



PL RED 
(IDP) i 
090702 JUL Z 



PL RED 
(IDP) 
090702 JUL Z 



PL WACO . 



PL PLUM 
(IDP) 




PL WACO 



PL PLUM 
(IDP) 



Figure 071-332-5000-22. Initial Delay Position 



(5) Delay lines (DLs). These indicate where a succeeding delay 
position is located. Delay positions (other than initial) are drawn the same, 
except that the letter abbreviation is along the line, and none are placed to 
the flanks at the coordinating points. 

(6) Coordinating points. 



3-220 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(a) Coordinating points are designated on boundaries as 
specific points for coordination of fires and maneuver between adjacent 
units. They are indicated when a boundary crosses the FEBA and should 
be indicated when the boundary crosses the covering force. Coordinating 
points are also used where DLs and internal boundaries intersect. 

(b) Coordinating points should be located at some terrain 
feature easily recognizable both on the ground and on a map. Their location 
on a boundary indicates the general trace of the FEBA, covering force, or 
DL as visualized by the commander who designates them. 

(c) The symbol for a coordinating point is shown by a circle with 
an "X" centered in it (figure 071-332-5000-23). The symbol is labeled as 
appropriate. 



Coordinating Point |^^^ 
(Center of symbol is exact location.) 




0) 

> 



Figure 071-332-5000-23. Coordinating Point 2 

(7) Checkpoints. Checkpoints are shown graphically by a number, ^ 
letter, or code word inside an upright rectangle with a pointed bottom (figure | 
071 -332-5000-24). They are easily recognizable terrain features or objects, 
such as crossroads, churches, lone buildings, stream junctions, hills, 
bridges, and railroad crossings. They may be selected throughout the area 
of operation. By reference to these points, the subordinate commander may 
rapidly and accurately report his location; or the higher commander may 
designate objectives, boundaries, assembly areas, phase lines, and so 
forth, to his subordinate commanders. 



Skill Level 3 071-332-5000 3-221 



Performance Steps 










Checkpoint (CKP) 1 1-25 1 

(Bottom point or an extension is exact 

location.) 




8 

V 



Figure 071-332-5000-24. Checkpoint 

(8) Contact points. Contact points, shown graphically by squares 
with a staff extending from the bottom center, are designated at the units to 
make physical contact. Contact points may also be used to delineate areas 
of responsibility in specific localities when boundaries are obviously 
unsuitable, such as between elements of a flank guard (figure 071 -332- 
5000-25). 



Contact Point 








I 1-37 1 




3 

I 



Figure 071-332-5000-25. Contact Point 

(9) Passage points (PP). A passage point, shown similar to a 
checkpoint with the letters PP and the number or letter designation of the 
passage point within the symbol, is designated along the LD or the FEBA of 
the unit being passed through. The PPs will be located where the 
commander desires subordinate units to actually pass. 



3-222 



071-332-5000 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(10) Linkup points. A linkup point should be an easily identifiable 
point on the ground and map that is used to facilitate the joining, connecting, 
or reconnecting of elements of a unit or units. They are used when two or 
more Army elements are to join each other, when Army and sister service 
elements are to join each other, and when Army or sister service and allied 
elements are to join each other. The linkup is an operation in itself and is 
conducted as part of an airborne or airmobile operation, an attack to assist 
in the breakout of an airborne or airmobile operation, an attack to assist in 
the breakout of an encircled force, or an attack to join an infiltrating force. 
The battalion may participate in a linkup as part of a larger force, or it may 
conduct a linkup. The symbol for linkup points is similar to a checkpoint with 
a dot in the center. A number, the name, or code name is placed near the 
symbol in such a manner as to ensure it is referring to the symbol (figure 
071-332-5000-26). 




Figure 071-332-5000-26. Linkup Point 

(11) Points of departure (PDs). These normally are shown along the 
LD for night attacks. They are shown similar to a checkpoint containing the 
abbreviation "PD" and a letter or number within the symbol. The point of the 
arrow is at the bottom of its location. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide the soldier with all the material and equipment listed in the 
conditions statement. 

Brief SoldienTeW the soldier he is to prepare an overlay for the operation 
indicated in the OPORD. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Placed registering marks in opposite corners of the 

overlay. 

2. Marked information using standard military symbols. 



03 



3. Indicated enemy installations, equipment, or 
activities with either the color RED or with double-lined 
symbols. 



Skill Level 3 071-332-5000 3-223 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

4. Indicated future locations or coordinating detail with 

broken-line symbols. 

5. Placed symbols indicating size on a boundary to 

indicate the highest unit sharing the boundary. 



6. Extended the axis of advance arrow from the line of 
departure to the objective. 

7. Labeled the route of march arrows with a code 
name or unit designation. 

8. Labeled the MSR and assigned a code name. 



9. Ensured the center of a unit symbol corresponded 
to the coordinates of the unit. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-90.2 
FM 101-5-1 



SUBJECT AREA 19: CROWD CONTROL 



191-378-4302 

Form Squad-Size Riot Control Formations 

Conditions:Given a riot control situation and a squad of soldiers fully 
equipped with riot control gear, FM 1 9-1 5, and STP 1 9-95B1 -SM. 

Standards: Selected the best formation to control or disperse the crowd. 
Correctly formed the squad into the formation selected. Reassembled the 
squad from the formation after the crowd had been controlled or dispersed. 

Performance Steps 

Note. Any size squad, platoon, or large unit can be employed and a crowd control 
formation can be adapted to fit the unit organization. A leader should be able to 
employ a unit sized to fit the circumstances. 

1. Prepare the squad for formation. 



3-224 191-378-4302 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



a. Form the squad in a single column behind you, with the base 
member directly behind you and the assistant squad leader at the end. 

b. Direct squad members to count off from front to rear with yourself as 
number one and the base member as number two. 

Note. The purpose for counting off is so each squad member has a number and will 
know where his position will be in each type of formation. 

2. Direct the squad in forming a squad line (figure 191 -378-4302-1 ). 

(2) (3) (5) (6) (7) (Vj 




SL 




Figure 191-378-4302-1. Squad Line Formation with Squad Leader and 
Assistant Squad Leader 

Note. As an offensive formation, this formation is used to push or drive crowds 
straight back across an open area or up a city street. As a defensive formation, it is 
used to hold a rioting group in place or to deny them access to restricted streets or 
areas. 

a. Face the squad and give the command, "Squad as skirmishers " 

Simultaneously, give hand signals with the command by raising your arms 
straight out, horizontal to the shoulders, hands extended, palms down. 

b. Point to where you want the squad to assemble and complete the 
command, "Move." (Make sure the base member moves to where you 
pointed and the rest of the squad forms up according to their number.) 

c. Take your position behind the formation. 

3. Direct the squad in forming a squad echelon, right or left (figure 1 91 - 
378-4302-2). 




Skill Level 3 



191-378-4302 



3-225 



Performance Steps 



7? 



< 

CD 



O 



O 



Squad echelon 
right 



© © 

© © 

© © L^- 1 



W 
© 
© ^ 



^ 



Squad echelor 
left 



_©. 



Figure 191-378-4302-2 Squad Echelon, Right and Left 
Note. This formation is used offensively to turn groups in either open or built-up areas 
and to move crowds away from buildings, fences, or walls. 

a. Face the squad and give the command, "Squad echelon right (or 
left)." Simultaneously, give hand and arm signals by extending one arm 45 
degrees above the horizon and the other arm 45 degrees below the horizon, 
arms and hands extended. (When facing the squad, the upper arm shows 
the direction of the echelon.) 

b. Point to where the squad should assemble and complete the 
command, "Move." (The base member will move to where you pointed. The 
rest of the squad will align themselves on the base member, one pace 
behind the member in front and one pace to the right or left, depending on 
the echelon.) 

c. Position yourself behind the formation. 

4. Direct the squad in forming a squad wedge (figure 1 91 -378-4302-3). 



3-226 



191-378-4302 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 

© 


© 


© 

© 


^^ Ol 


® 


© ^ 





Figure 191-378-4302-a Squad Wedge 
Afofe. This formation is used as an offensive formation to penetrate or to split crowds. 

a. Face the squad and give the command, "Squad wedge." 
Simultaneously, give hand and arm signals in conjunction with the 
command. (Extend both arms down and to the sides at an angle of 45 
degrees below the horizon, arms and hands extended, palms down.) 

b. Point to where the squad will assemble and complete the command, 
"Move." (The base member will move to where you pointed. The odd 
numbered members align themselves behind the base member, one pace to 
the left and one pace to the rear of the preceding member. Even numbered 
personnel will do the same except to the right.) 

5. Tell the squad members which weapon positions to use. Each position 
has a specific use and is discussed below. 




Skill Level 3 



191-378-4302 



3-227 



Performance Steps 



a. Safe port. Use when making a show of force (figure 191 -378-4302- 




b. Safe guard. Use for semi-readiness (figure 1 91 -378-4302-5). 



3-228 



191-378-4302 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 




c. On guard. Use for complete readiness and when troops are in 
contact with a group showing any kind of resistance or hesitance to 
withdraw (figure 191-378-4302-6). 



Skill Level 3 



191-378-4302 



3-229 



Performance Steps 




6. Reassemble the squad. 



3-230 



191-378-4302 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



a. Take a position a sufficient distance to the rear of the squad and 
command, "Squad assemble." Simultaneously, raise your right hand in the 
air and make a circular motion. (The squad members who hear the 
command automatically come to the safe-port position. The base member 
faces the squad leader. The other squad members face toward the base 
member.) 

b. Point to the place you want the squad to assemble and give the 
command of execution "Move." (The base member double-times to the 
designated spot, and the other members of the squad follow the base 
member. The squad forms in a column behind the base member and waits 
for further instruction.) 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Prepared the squad for formation. 

2. Directed the squad informing a squad line. 

3. Directed the squad informing a squad echelon, 

right and left. 

4. Directed the squad in forming a squad wedge. 

5. Told the squad members which weapon positions to 

use. 

6. Reassembled the squad. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed . 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

FM 19-15 

STP 19-95B1-SM 




Skill Level 3 191-378-4302 3-231 



SUBJECT AREA 21 : DEFENSE MEASURES 




052-195-3066 

Direct Construction of Nonexplosive Obstacles 

Conditions:Given a mission directive, logistical support for the type of 
nonexplosive obstacle, squad personnel, organic equipment, and FM 5-34. 
Standards: Directed the construction of obstacles that were tied to existing 
or reinforced obstacles to block, channel, or delay the enemy according to 
the mission brief or intent. 



Performance Steps 



1 . Analyze mission requirements using the mission, enemy, terrain, 
troops, time available, and civilian considerations (METT-TC) factors. 
Consider the following — 

a. Manpower available. 

b. Material available. 

c. Time available. 

d. Type of transportation. 

e. Site selection (take advantage of existing obstacles). 

f. Type of obstacle to be constructed. 

2. Direct the construction of wire obstacles. 

Note. When using U-shaped pickets to construct obstacles, ensure the U faces the 
enemy. 

a. Direct the construction of a double-apron 4- and 2-pace fence. 
Ensure — 

(1) The fence centerline is laid. 

(2) The long pickets are spaced at 3 -meter (4-pace) intervals. 

(3) The anchor pickets are spaced at 1 .5-meter (2-pace) intervals 
each way from the centerline and midway between the long pickets. 

(4) All 12 wires are installed. Ensure work is done from the enemy 
side to the friendly side (figure 052-1 95-3066-1 ). 



3-232 052-195-3066 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 




Plan 
To make a B- and 3-oass fenos, 

use! ft and 3 pK» 

*i placimf 2 and Jl pacns, 



MqTF: Flails iha muss uhcHj ffw apuora. 



Ugand 
Numb** 1 through 1 2 
inufcaJCce- tht aider far 
instalLng pickets and 



Anc*orjipit*fll «t 
ea<* end or ths fetws, 



Figure 052-195-3066-1. Double-Apron Fence 
Note. Ensure the soldier is not cut off between the enemy and the fence. 

(5) The wire is tied at the beginning and end of each roll of barbed 
wire, as a minimum. 

(6) The wires are properly secured and tight. 

b. Direct the construction of a triple-standard concertina fence. 

(1) Ensure work is done from the enemy side to the friendly side. 

(2) Direct the installation of an anchor picket (short picket) at each 
end of the front and back row (2 paces). 

(3) Ensure long pickets are spaced at 3.8-meter (5-pace) intervals 
(stagger the back row) (figure 052-195-3066-2). 



> 

3 



CO 



Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-233 




Performance Steps 



Tighten the horizontal support 
wire racked 10 Uia upper 
concertina halfway between 
the p:ckcts. 




5 paces 



; i* 90 cm 



5 paces 



Tighten Itie horizontal 

Support wine. 



>K 



5 paces 



2 paces 

•I- -I 



~~7 



i * ■ * Anchor 
— J Pickets 



p-JC6?!i 



5 paces 



2 paces 



Direction of 
construction 



Figure 052-195-3066-2. Triple-Standard Concertina Fence 

Note. Install the pickets in such a manner that the lower notch of the long picket is 4 
inches above the ground. 

(4) Direct the installation of concertina wire. Ensure — 

(a) A roll of concertina is placed at the third picket in the front 
row and at every fourth picket thereafter (figure 052-195-3066-3). 




1 . Install the front row 
and the horizontal 
wire. 




2. Install the back row 
and the horizontal 
wire. 




3. Install the top row 
and rack it to the 
back horizontal wire. 



Figure 052-195-3066-3. Install Concertina and Horizontal Wire 

(b) The bottom row (concertina wire) is secured with the 
horizontal wire (barbed wire) (figure 052-195-3066-4). 



3-234 



052-195-3066 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 





1 . Place the bottom 
portion of the first 
coil over the picket. 



2. Place the bottom 
and top portions of 
the second coil over 
the picket. 




3. Place the top portior 
of the first coil over 
the picket. 



Figure 052-195-3066-4. Join Concertina Wire 

(c) The back row (friendly side) is begun once the first team 
has cleared the head of the fence. 

(5) Direct the installation of the remaining row of concertina wire on 
top of the first two rows and fasten it securely. 

(6) Ensure the concertina wire is properly tied and all horizontal 
wire is properly installed. 

c. Direct the construction of a four-strand cattle fence. 

(1) Ensure an anchor picket (short picket) is installed at each end 
of the fence. 

(2) Ensure the long pickets are installed 3 meters apart (figure 052- 
195-3066-5). 




Figure 052-195-3066-5. Four-Strand Cattle Fence 

(3) Direct the installation of the barbed wire. Ensure — 



> 

2 



tn 



Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-235 



Performance Steps 



(a) The reel of barbed wire is rolled out. Ensure that a row of 
barbed wire is used per strand. 

(b) The wire is tied from the bottom strand and that it is worked 
upward to the top strand. 

(4) Ensure the wire is taut and tied correctly. 

d. Direct the construction of a knife rest. 

(1) Ensure that a knife rest is prepared 3 to 5 meters long (figure 
052-195-3066-6). Ensure— 




\^_ fc 


. - * _ . - ♦ * ---*■•' ■ \V..«'* yy 




1.2 m i ArJfiFS*^ 

1 - ? 'J7^^ > ^ 





Figure 052-1 95-3066-& Knife Rest 

(a) The end poles (1 .2 meters in height and width) are lashed 
to form two Xs. 

(b) The center pole is lashed to the two Xs. 

(c) Barbed wire is used to complete the knife rest. 
(2) Ensure the knife rest is secured to the ground. 

e. Direct the construction of an 1 1 -row obstacle out of concertina wire. 
(1) Ensure long pickets are installed at 3.8-meter (5-pace) intervals 
for 1 1 rows (figure 052-195-3066-7). 



3-236 



052-195-3066 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



NOTE: Place three long pickets 5 paces apart per coil 
and place the horizontal wire on top of the coil. 







Figure 052-195-3066-7. Eleven-Row Obstacle 

(2) Direct the placement of concertina wire over the long pickets. 

(3) Ensure the horizontal wire (barbed wire) is anchored to the 
anchor stakes 1 .5 meters (2 paces) from each end of the concertina rows. 

(4) Ensure the horizontal wire is secured over the concertina wire. 

(5) Ensure that a log 20 centimeters in diameter is placed between 
the fifth and sixth row. 

(6) Ensure the obstacle is no less than 1 meters deep. 
3. Direct the construction of log obstacles. 

Note. When constructing a log crib, use only logs with a 20-centimeter diameter 



> 

2 



CO 



Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-237 



Performance Steps 



a. Direct the construction of a triangular log crib (figure 052-1 95-3066- 
8). Ensure — 




tZW 




The interior of the crib should 
be filled with earth. 



20-cm diameter 



Figure 052-1 95-3066-a Triangular Log Crib 

(1) The vertical postholes are marked and dug 1 .5 meters deep. 
Ensure one corner of the log crib is facing toward the enemy and four 3- 
meter posts are used per wall. 

(2) The 1 2 horizontal logs (four per wall) are cut to roadway width. 

(3) The vertical logs are emplaced and tamped into place. 

(4) The horizontal logs are emplaced and posts are lashed together 
with wire. 

(5) The interior of the crib is filled with earth material taken from the 
enemy side of the obstacle. 

b. Direct the construction of a rectangular log crib (figure 052-1 95- 
3066-9 and table 052-1 95-3066-1 ). Ensure— 



3-238 052-195-3066 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



POST-OPPOSING 
DESIGN 



1.5 m 




The interior of the crib should 
be filled with earth. 



The interior of the crib should 
be filled with earth. 



20 cm 
diameter 



Figure 052-195-3066-9. Rectangular Log Crib 



Note. A rectangular log crib can be emplaced with the post opposing design or the 
offset-post design. 




Table 052-195-3066-1, Post Requirements 
(Post Opposing/Offset Post Designs) 


Posts 


Road Width (m) 




1.8 


2.1 
to 
3.6 


3.9 
to 
5.4 


5.8 
to 
7.3 


7.6 
to 
9.1 


9.4 

to 

10.9 


11.3 

to 

12.8 


13.1 

to 

14.6 


Long 3 


8 


12 


16 


20 


24 


28 


32 


36 


Short 2.1 


2 


3 


4 


5 


6 


7 


8 


9 


Braces 2.1 


4 


6 


8 


10 


12 


14 


16 


18 



Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-239 



Performance Steps 



(1) The vertical postholes are dug and marked 1 .5 meters deep. 
Use table 052-195-3066-1 for post requirements. 

(2) The horizontal logs (four per wall) are cut to the roadway width. 

(3) The vertical logs are emplaced 1 .8 meters apart and tamped 
into place. 

(4) The horizontal logs are emplaced and posts, logs, and braces 
are lashed with wire. 

(5) The interior of the crib is filled with earth material taken from the 
enemy side of the obstacle. 

c. Direct the construction of a log hurdle obstacle (figure 052-1 95- 
3066-10). Ensure— 




3-240 052-195-3066 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



l-« H 

1 .8 to 2.4 m 

3=* 



I— »-a 



3 to 4 m 



^4^4= 



T 

3 to 4 m 



Roadway ■ 



Position of obstacle 



Employment of staggered 

1 .8 to 2.4 m hurdles 

(three 25-cm logs or 

one 45-cm log) 




7.5 m 



t* 



* 



4.5 m 



Roadway ■ 



Position of obstacle 

Employment of 45-cm 

logs as hurdles 



Logs wired together 



Wire lashing 




Ground level 




Ten 1 5-crr 
stakes 



SECURING A 3-LOG HURDLE 
SECTION A-A 



*I3 



SECURING A 45-CM LOG HURDLE 
SECTION B-B 



<a 

> 

2 



tn 



Figure 052-195-3066-10. Log Hurdles 

Note. Select a site where the log hurdles cannot be readily bypassed. Hurdles are 
constructed on the steepest part of a slope. 

(1) Logs are cut 1 .8 to 2.4 meters long. 



Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-241 



Performance Steps 



(2) Three logs 25 centimeters in diameter or one log 45 centimeters 
in diameter are used. 

(3) Logs are staked firmly in place. Ensure stakes are no more 
than 1.5 meters apart. 

(4) The log poles are lashed to the stakes with wire. 

(5) The securing stakes are buried a minimum of 60 centimeters in 
the ground with 60 centimeters remaining above ground. 

d. Direct the construction of a log post obstacle (figure 052-1 95-3066- 
11). Ensure — 





Figure 052-195-3066-11. Log Post Obstacle 

(1) A minimum of four rows of posts are emplaced. 

(2) Posts are cut in varying lengths from 2 to 3 meters. 
Note. The diameter of the timber is 40 centimeters minimum. 

(3) Postholes are dug 1 .5 meters underground. 

(4) Posts are emplaced at irregular distances of 1 to 2 meters and 
at irregular heights of 75- to 120-centimeters above ground. Ensure posts 
are buried vertically or at a slight angle toward the enemy. 

(5) The barbed wire is attached to posts in an irregular pattern. 

4. Direct the construction of tank ditch obstacles (figure 052-195-3066- 
12). 



3-242 



052-195-3066 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



SpoiT 
U- 4 m -*\ \ Enemy 



• Revetted 



TRIANGULAR CUT 



1.5 m 




SIDEHILLCUT 



Enemy 



Hurdle oblique to 
line of ditch 
Sp011 . 3.3 m , Hurdle 

Y — H^& 

| K?S>757777JS75jfc 

|fr-4.5m- 




7.5 m min 



Enemy 




Revetted 



RECTANGULAR CUT 



Figure 052-195-3066-12. Tank Ditches 

a. Direct the construction of a rectangular tank ditch obstacle. 
Ensure — 

(1) The T-push method is used with a dozer/dozer, dozer/loader, 
dozer/armored combat earthmover (ACE), ACE/ACE, or ACE/loader team 
configuration. 

(2) The tandem method is used with a scraper/scraper, 
scraper/ACE, or a scraper/dozer team configuration. 



> 

3 



tn 



Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-243 



Performance Steps 



(3) The ditch is dug a minimum of 1 .5 meters deep and 3.3 meters 



wide. 



= 5 




(4) The berm is placed on the friendly side of the ditch. 

b. Direct the construction a triangular tank ditch obstacle. Ensure — 

(1) The T-push method is used with a dozer/dozer, dozer/loader, 
dozer/ACE, ACE/ACE, or ACE/loader team configuration. 

(2) The ditch is dug a minimum of 1 .5 meters deep and 4 meters 
wide. 

(3) The spoil is spread on the enemy side of the ditch. 

c. Direct the construction a sidehill-cut tank ditch obstacle. Ensure — 

(1) The T-push method is used with a dozer/dozer, dozer/loader, 
dozer/ACE, ACE/ACE, or ACE/loader team configuration. 

(2) The one-dozer or ACE method is used. 

(3) The tank ditch is cut a minimum of 1 .5 meters deep and 4.5 to 6 
meters wide. 

(4) The spoil is spread on the enemy side of the ditch. 
Direct the construction of barrier obstacles. 

a. Ensure barrier materials are obtained. Barrier materials include — 
(1) Steel hedgehogs and tetrahedrons (figure 052-195-3066-13). 




Figure 052-195-3066-13. Steel Hedgehog and Tetrahedron 

(2) Concrete cubes and tetrahedrons (figure 052-195-3066-14). 



3-244 



052-195-3066 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 




Figure 052-195-3066-14. Concrete Cubes and Tetrahedron 

(3) Jersey barriers (figure 052-195-3066-15). 




Anchor to concrete slab 



No. 6 bars 2' long, 
3' on center 



NOTE: Tested, stopped a 4,000 pound vehicle at 50 mph. 



Figure 052-195-3066-15. Jersey Barrier 

b. Ensure barrier materials (figure 052-1 95-3066-1 6) are emplaced. 




Skill Level 3 



052-195-3066 



3-245 



Performance Steps 




Active vehicle barriers 




24' 



t 
10 ! 

+ U 




Figure 052-195-3066-16. Concrete Obstacle Placement 

Note. The distance between barriers will vary depending on the type of traffic 
expected (cars, trucks, or semitrailers). 

Evaluation Preparation : 

Setup: Provide the soldier with the items listed in the conditions. Provide 
him with a mission brief describing the type of obstacle to be emplaced. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to direct the construction of the obstacle 
according to the mission brief. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Analyzed mission requirements using the METT-TC 
factors. 






2. Directed the construction of wire obstacles. 


3. Directed the construction of log obstacles. 


4. Directed the construction of tank ditch obstacles. 


5. Directed the construction of barrier obstacles. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM5-34 FM5-102 



3-246 



052-195-3066 



Skill Level 3 



071-410-0019 

Control Organic Fires 

Conditions:Given a unit equipped with TOE weapons, attached fire support 
elements (machine gun teams, antitank teams, TOW squad, BFV), an area 
of responsibility, and the requirement to regulate the first of all weapon 
systems assigned or attached to your unit. 

Standards: Assigned sectors of fire for each individual and crew-served 
weapon; issued a priority of target engagement appropriate for each weapon 
system; inform ed all personnel of current rules of engagement (ROE); and 
implemented procedures to engage threat targets in your area of 
responsibility in a timely manner, with the appropriate weapon system, and 
without causing injury or death to friendly personnel. 

Performance Steps 



WARNING 

Soldiers may be killed or injured when firing weapons. Minimum firing 
distances, backblast areas, and weapon-specific regulations must be 
strictly followed. 



0) 

1 . Implement procedures to apply the following principles of fire control: > 

a. Avoid target overkill; keep in mind ammunition conservation. z 1 

b. Use each weapon in its intended role. ^ 

c. Concentrate on engaging targets that offer a high probability of a 
kill. 

d. Concentrate on engaging long-range targets first. 

e. Destroy targets that pose the greatest threat first. 

2. Use fire control methods to — 

a. Maximize the effects of the weapons on the target. 

b. Achieve mutual support. 

c. Provide coverage of assigned area of responsibility. 

d. Ensure soldiers' safety from friendly fire. 

3. Use the following methods to coordinate and regulate fire. 

a. Assign sectors of fire. Assign an area for each crew-served 
weapon, team, or unit to cover by fire. Targets in each assigned sector are 
the responsibility of the individual(s) assigned to cover the area with fire. 



Skill Level 3 071-410-0019 3-247 



Performance Steps 




b. Assign priority of fires. Tell each soldier, according to weapon 
assignment, what to fire at, when, and why. This ensures each weapon is 
used in the role for which it is best suited . (For example, Dragon gunners 
engage light armored vehicles; BFV gunners engage tanks with the TOW 
and BMPs with the 25-mm; riflemen engage dismounted personnel out to 
400 meters.) 

c. Use target reference points (TRPs). Designate recognizable points 
on the ground (natural or manmade) to use as reference points when 
identifying sectors of fire or targets, or to control supporting fires. 

d. Assign final protective fire areas. Assign final protective lines (FPL) 
or principal direction of fire (PDF) for machine guns and other automatic 
crew-served weapons, ground- or carrier-mounted (MK 1 9, BFV coaxial, 
25-mm, and soon). 

4. Use any of the following techniques to communicate when to start, 
shift, or ceasefire. 

a. Prearranged signals. Use visual or sound signals (pyrotechnics, 
whistles, horns, detonation of a device, or firing of a weapon), or set a 
specific time. 

b. Arm-and-hand signals. Use standard signals when feasible. 
Remember, personnel must see arm -and-hand signals in order to respond. 

c. Fire by example. Initiate firing at, or in the direction of, the intended 
target and have the unit or specific weapon system follow your example. 

d. Fire commands. Some elements of fire commands may be omitted. 
If any element is omitted, ensure the unit or crew thoroughly understands 
the command. Every fire command should contain the target description 
and execution element as a minimum. (See tables 071-41 0-001 9-1 and 
071 -41 0-001 9-2 for examples of fire command elements.) 



3-248 071-410-0019 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 












rable 071-410-0019-1, Examples of Fire 


Command Elements 










Antitank 


Crew-Served 






Elements 


TOW Squad 


Team 


Weapon 


Units 




1. Alert 


Fire Mission 


Fire Mission 


Fire Mission 


Fire Mission, 






or Squad 


Gun#1 


Gun #3 


A team, 1 st 
squad, etc. 




2. Description 


Tank 


PC 


Truck with 


Troops 




(direction 






Troops 






optional) 












2A. Direction 


Front, 1 1 


Right Front, 2 


Left of Lone 


Center of 




(if used) 


o'clock (clock 


o'clock (clock 


Pine Tree 


Sector 






method) 


method) 


(TRP method) 






3. Range (in 


1,000 


600 


400 


200 




meters) 












4. Method of 


Frontal, 


Single, Pair, 


Sustained, 


Sustained, or 




Fire 


Depth, or 


Volley, or 


Search, or 


Until Target is 






Crossfire 


Sequence 


Traverse, or 


Defeated 






(situation 


(situation 


Combination 








dependent) 


dependent) 


(situation 
dependent) 




CO 

"33 

> 

!2 


4A. Type 


TOW 2 


Dragon 






Missile 


TOW2A 


AT-4 






5. Execution 


Fire, or At My 


Fire, or At My 


Fire, or At My 


Fire, or At My 




Command 


Command 


Command 


Command 


(/) 


6. Closing 


Cease 


Cease 


Cease Fire 


Cease Fire 




Tracking or 


Tracking or 










Cease 


Cease 










Tracking, Out 


Tracking, Out 










of Action 


of Action 









Skill Level 3 



071-410-0019 



3-249 





Performance Steps 








Table 071-410-0019-2, Examples of fire command elements for a BFV 




Elements 


Gunnery Techniques 




Battlesight 


Precision 




1 . Alert 


Gunner 


Gunner 




2. Weapon/Ammunition 


Battlesight 


SABOT 
HE 
Coax 
Missile 




3. Description 


Tank, Chopper, Truck, 
Troops, PC 


PC, Truck, Troops, Tank 




4. Direction (optional) 


Shift Right (Left), TRP-1 

(TRP method) or 

2 o'clock (clock method) 


Shift Right (Left) TRP-1 

(TRP method) or 

2 o'clock (clock method) 


CO 

< 

2. 
u 


5. Range (in meters) 
Gunner ID* 


Identified 


600 Identified 


6. Execution 
Gunner's response 


Fire, or 

At My Command 

On the way 


Fire, or 

At My Command 

On the way 


7. Closing 


Cease Fire 


Cease Fire 


*lf the BFV gunner cannot identify the target, the Bradley commander (BC) engages 
the target f rom his position. The BC announces "From my position, on the way." 
"Fire" is not announced. 



(1) Use fire commands to direct the fires of units or key weapons 
and to place a specific type fire on certain targets. Fire commands for 
some weapon systems may vary in form because of weapon 
characteristics. They should identify who is to fire, the direction of fire, type 
of ammunition, type of target, range, and when to fire. 

(2) Correct errors in fire commands by stating "CORRECTION," 
correcting the element in error, then repeating all elements following the 
corrected element. 

(3) Use subsequent fire commands to adjust for range or new 
targets. For example, shift left (or right) up (or down) and designate new 
target. For subsequent fire commands for a Bradley, use shift left (or right) 
PC and up (or down) half or full target frame. 



3-250 



071-410-0019 



Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(4) Develop standing operating procedures (SOPs) and drills for 
certain actions and commands to make fire control more effective. 



CAUTION 

Dispose of all belt links and spent brass in accordance with unit SOP. 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.This task should be evaluated during a field training exercise on a 
live-fire range. Otherwise, assign a defensive position to a fire team, and 
designate team and individual sectors of fire. Provide appropriate 
ammunition for the weapons assigned. Target areas should represent 
various types of targets, such as an enemy column formation, a line 
formation, or a linear target with depth. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to have his team engage the various targets 
and to use the appropriate weapons on the targets. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Assigned individual sectors of fire. 



2. Issued a fire command to engage a target. 



3. Issued subsequent fire commands, as necessary. 



4. Gave the arm-and-hand signals to control fires. 



> 



CO 



5. Used unit SOP to engage a target. (Graded only if 
unit has an SOP for team/squad fire.) 



6. Used appropriate weapon(s) on target. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 385-63 
FM 21-75 
FM 23-1 
FM 23-14 



Skill Level 3 071-410-0019 3-251 




441-091-3000 

Supervise the Implementation of Air Defense Measures 

Conditions: You are a leader in a tactical combat situation. Given the 
concept of operations from your higher headquarters, employ your direct fire 
weapons as an effective method of defense against attacking enemy aircraft. 
You will use this method in conjunction with passive air defense techniques 
and will provide effective air defense protection with or without specific 
supporting air defense (AD) assets. 

Standards: Established and directed unit air defense posture. Ensured 1 00 
percent use of available passive defense measures. Planned for 
employment of all available individual and crew -served weapons capable of 
being directed against enemy air threats. Ensured hostile targets engaged 
were destroyed, neutralized, or suppressed. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Prepare and brief unit personnel on each of the following battle data 
and information: 

a. Air dimension of the intelligence preparation of the battlefield (IPB) 
process. (Includes the portion of the IPB process that provides intelligence 
data.) 

(1) Threat overview. 

(2) Estimate hostile air strength. 

b. Terrain analysis. (Briefs analysis data for friendly elements.) 

(1) Observation and fields of fire. 

(2) Air avenues of approach. Air routes of an attacking force. 

2. Brief the rules of engagement (ROE). Rules of engagement are the 
positive and procedural management directives. Specify the 
circumstances and limitations under which your unit initiates or continues a 
combat engagement. 

a. Right of self-defense. When under attack, the right of self-defense 
takes precedence over any other established rules and procedures that 
normally govern engagements. 

b. Hostile criteria. Specify which detected targets and under what 
circumstances they are considered hostile. 

c. Air defense warning (ADW). (Provide status of air defense 
conditions.) 

(1) ADW Red. Attack by hostile aircraft or missiles is imminent or 
in progress. 

(2) ADW Yellow. Attack by hostile aircraft or missiles are probable. 
3-252 441-091-3000 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(3) ADW White. Attack by hostile aircraft or missiles are 
improbable. 

d. Weapon control status (WCS). Describe the relative degree in 
effect under which the fires of air defense systems are managed: 

(1) Weapons Free. Fire at any aircraft not positively identified as 
friendly. 

(2) Weapons Tight. Fire only at aircraft positively identified as 
hostile. 

(3) Weapons Hold. Do not fire except in self-defense or in 
response to a formal order. 

e. Local air defense warning (LADW). Provide the LADW status: 

(1) Dynamite. Air platforms are inbound or are attacking; response 
is immediate. 

(2) Lookout. Air platforms are in the area of interest, but are not 
threatening, or they are inbound with time to react. 

(3) Snowman. No air platforms pose a threat at this time. 

CO 

f. Method of receiving directed early warning with or without an Air _ 
and Missile Defense Officer (AMDO): > 

(1) AMDO disseminates local air defense warning on supported ^ 
unit net. ("Dynamite! Dynamite! Four Hinds heading East at Phase Line 2 
Blue.") w 

(2) Without an AMDO, the unit may monitor the early warning net. 

3. Establish air attack warning systems and include search and scan 
techniques. 

a. Establish visual warnings (hand signal, flag). 

b. Establish audible warnings (vehicle, horn, whistle, siren, and voice). 

c. Position air watch sentries in the unit's area of operation. 

d. Position air guards in a convoy. 

e. Apply search and scan techniques. 

4. Enforce passive air defense measures. 

Note. Passive air defense measures are all measures, other than active defense, 
taken to minimize the effects of the hostile air action. Passive defense measures 
are of two types: attack avoidance and damage, limiting measures that include the 
use of protective cover, concealment, camouflage, and deception. 

a. Attack avoidance measures. Include concealment, camouflage, 
and deception. 

(1) Use available concealment (hiding, blending, and disguising). 
Skill Level 3 441-091-3000 3-253 



Performance Steps 




(2) Use natural and manmade materials for camouflage effectively. 

b. Damage limiting measures (dispersion, protective construction, and 
use of cover). 

(1) Use dispersion, protective construction, and cover effectively. 

(2) Select position(s) that cannot be seen from the air. 

5. Direct engagement of hostile air targets using combined arms for air 
defense procedures. 

a. Volume and mass fire. 

b. For correct leads, use football field lengths. 

c. Aiming points for helicopters, fixed-wing aircraft, cruise missiles and 
unmanned aerial vehicles (UAV). 

d. Firing positions for small arms. Select and use natural and 
manmade positions. 

e. Aircraft engagement techniques for missile systems. 

Evaluation Preparation: Evaluate this task during a field exercise, during 
improved moving target simulator (IMTS) training, or as part of lane training. 
Provide the soldier with the mission and concept of operations, maps, and 
overlays for air intelligence preparation of the battlefield (IPB) development 
and employment of assets. Ensure sufficient equipment is available for 
passive air defense measure implementation. Provide live air or drone 
aircraft for target detection, identification, and engagement. 

Note. If live air, IMTS, or drone aircraft are not available, aircraft recognition can be 
performed using aircraft recognition cards or other multimedia techniques. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he is to plan for and employ all available 
assets capable of being directed against enemy air threats, fully implement 
passive air defense measures (in the offense or defense), comm unicate air 
defense warnings and weapons control status, and destroy, neutralize, or 
suppress all enemy air threats. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Prepared and briefed unit personnel on the 
following battle data and information. 



a. Air dimension of the IPB process. Included the 
portion of the IPB process that provides intelligence 
data. 



(1) Threat overview. 



(2) Estimated hostile air strength. 



b. Terrain analysis. 



3-254 441-091-3000 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


(1) Observation and fields of fire. 


(2) Air avenues of approach; air routes of an 
attacking force. 


2. Briefed ROE to unit personnel specifying the 
circumstances and limitations under which the unit 
would initiate or continue a combat engagement. 







a. Right of self-defense. When under attack, the 
right of self-defense took precedence over any other 
established rules and procedures that normally govern 
engagements. 

b. Hostile target criteria specifying which targets, 
when detected, were friendly or hostile. 

c. ADW in effect. 



d. WCS in effect. 



e. LADW in effect. 



f. Methods of disseminating early warning 
inform ation and data. 



system. 



a. Established visual warnings. 



b. Established audible warnings. 



c. Positioned air watch sentries. 



d. Performed search and scan procedures. 



4. Enforced passive air defense measures using: 



a. Attack-avoidance measures. 



(1) Used concealment principles. 



(2) Used available concealm ent . 



b. Damage limiting measures. 



(1) Selected positions with natural covering. 




3. Directed establishment of an air attack warning > 



3 

CO 



(3) Used natural and manmade materials for 
camouflage effectively. 



(2) Used dispersion, protective construction, 
and cover effectively. 



5. Directed engagements of hostile aircraft using 
combined air defense procedures. 



- 



Skill Level 3 441-091-3000 3-255 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

a. Applied proper engagement procedures. 

(1) Volume and massing fire. 



(2) Football field technique. 



(3) Ensured proper aiming points were used for 
flight directions of hostile aircraft. 



b. Applied firing positions for small arms. 



c. Applied aircraft engagement techniques for 
missile systems. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if he passes all performance 
measures. Score the soldier NO GO if he fails any performance measures . 
If the soldier fails any performance measures , explain and or show him what 
was done wrong and how to perform the measures correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

FM5-103 

0) FM 20-3 

" FM 34-1 30 

o FM 44-8 

<L FM 44-80 

FM 44-1 00 



SUBJECT AREA 22: UNIT OPERATIONS 



071-326-3013 

Conduct a Tactical Road March 

Conditions: You are an acting platoon sergeant/platoon leader given a 
platoon with TOE weapons, personnel, equipment, operational vehicles with 
Bll, a 1 :50,000 military map of the road march area, a warning order, and an 
overlay of your route. You are under radio listening silence until detected or 
engaged or when a SPOTREP/STATREP must be sent. 

Standards: Within the time allowed in your warning order, planned, 
organized, and conducted a tactical road march from one point to an 
assembly area, and secured the assembly area. 



3-256 071-326-3013 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



1. Control actions in assembly area. 

a. Ensure quartering party NCO guides section/platoon into area. 

b. Clear section/platoon release point quickly. 

c. Ensure one man for each vehicle mans weapon, monitors radio, 
and observes vehicle sector. 

d. SetupOPs. 

e. Check primary positions and sectors; adjust if necessary. 

f. Camouflage positions. 

g. Start rest plan. 

h. Ensure range cards are prepared. 
i. Locate troop command post. 
j. Coordinate with flank elements. 
k. Select and prepare alternate positions. 

I. Prepare the platoon fire plan, brief the vehicles commanders , and 
send a copy of the plan to troop commander. 

m. Ensure maintenance is performed. 

n. Check personnel and equipment status; report to platoon 
leader/team/troop commander. 

o. Resupply. 

p. Check security. 

2. Plan sequence for a tactical road march. 

a. Prepare and issue your warning order. 

b. Prepare an estimate of the situation. 

c. Organize and dispatch reconnaissance and quartering parties in 
accordance with unit SOP. 

d. Prepare detailed movement plans. 

(1) Organize the march. 

(2) Review reconnaissance information. 

e. Prepare and issue the complete march order. 

3. Issue the march order. The order includes — 

a. Destination (map). 

b. Route of march (map). 

c. Location of start point (SP), critical points, and release point (map). 

d. Start point time. 

Skill Level 3 071-326-3013 3-257 




Performance Steps 




e. March interval (in meters). 

f. March speed. 

g. Catch-up speed. 

h. Time to leave present position. 
i. Order of march. 

4. Organize the march. 

a. Ensure that march columns, regardless of size, are composed of 
three elements: head, main body, and trail. 

(1 ) The head is the first vehicle of the column and normally sets 
the pace. 

(2) The main body is made up of the major elements of column 
serials and march units. 

(3) The trail party follows the march column and includes 
personnel and equipment needed for emergency vehicle repair and 
recovery, medical aid and evaluation, and unscheduled refueling. 

b. Ensure that vehicle commanders assign sectors of observation so 
there is 360-degree observation around their vehicles. Each vehicle 
commander must designate an airguard to provide air security. 

5. Control the march. 

a. Follow the route specified in the warning order. 

b. Enter the route of march at the SP. 

c. Adjust the march at critical points if movement isslow or difficult or 
where vehicles may lose their way. 

d. Release sections to their mission responsibilities. 

e. Ensure m arch speed and catch-up speeds are specified in the 
warning order. 

f. Maintain the order of march. This includes order of squads in the 
column and vehicles in the section. 

g. Maintain the march interval. 

h. Close the column intervals during periods of limited visibility. 
i. Open the column during periods of good visibility. 

6. Control actions at halts. 

a. Establish security off-road (when possible). 

b. Man weapons and radio on each vehicle; ensure each vehicle 
sector is observed. 

c. Maintain airguard. 

3-258 071-326-3013 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



d. Dismount OP if visibility is poor. 

e. Post guides to help other traffic pass. 

f. Determine cause of halt (if unscheduled). 

g. Eliminate cause of halt. 

h. Report status to platoon leader/troop commander. 

i. Perform maintenance at scheduled halts. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide all equipment and materials given in the task 
conditions statement, and the opportunity to issue a warning order. The task 
is performed along the specified route within the time allowed in your 
warning order. This task is performed as part of field training exercises. 

Brief Soldier: You are required to conduct a tactical road march using the 
equipment stated in the task conditions statement and route specified in your 
warning order. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



CO 



1. Conducted each step in the planning sequence for a _ 

tactical road march. g 

2. Ensured all actions in the assembly area were .3 

performed. j= 

3. Issued the march order in its entirety. !J> 



4. Identified two of the three elements of the march 
columns. 



5. Organized the march. 



6. Ensured all actions at halts were performed. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM7-7 
FM 17-95 
FM 3-21 .71 
FM7-8 

Skill Level 3 071-326-3013 3-259 




071-326-5805 

Conduct a Route Reconnaissance Mission 

Conditions:Given a platoon, a 1 :50,000 map of the area of operation, and 

a mission to conduct a route reconnaissance. 

Standards: Planned and conducted a route reconnaissance well enough 

to— 

1 . Organize the platoon to conduct the reconnaissance mission. 

2. Use movement techniques appropriate for the likelihood of enemy 
contact. 

3. Obtain necessary information concerning the conditions, obstacles, 
critical terrain features, and enemy along the assigned route. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Plan the reconnaissance. Receive the order. 

a. Issue a warning order. 

b. Gather information and prepare an operations order based on the 
factors of METT-TC. 

c. Ensure the plan is as detailed as possible and include the exact 
information to be obtained, the time by which the information is to be 
reported, where the information is to be reported, where the information is 
to be sought, action to be taken upon enemy contact, and when the 
mission is to be executed. Essential details include: 

(1) Pertinent information on the enemy, friendly troops, and the 
area of operations. 

(2) Proposed plans of higher commands, to include anticipated 
traffic flow along the route and types of vehicles to be employed. 

(3) When, where and how information is to be reported. 

(4) Time of departure. 

(5) Appropriate control measures. 

(6) Action to be taken when the mission is completed. 

(7) Special equipment requirements. 

(8) Terrain considerations. Existing routes and their physical 
characteristics: 

(a) Gradients of slope and radii of curvature. 

(b) Bridges. 

(c) Vehicular fording, ferrying, and swimming sites. 

(d) Tunnels, under passes, and similar obstructions to traffic 
flow. 

3-260 071-326-5805 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(e) Artificial obstacles, such as areas of chemical, biological, 
and radiological contamination, roadblocks, craters, and minefields. 

(f) Rock falls and slide areas. 

(g) Drainage. 

(h) Other natural or manmade features, such as wooded and 
built-up areas, that may affect movement. 

2. Supervise the preparation of the route reconnaissance. Ensure 
soldiers — 

a. Maintain equipment to vehicles and weapons. 

b. Conduct inspections. 

c. Conduct rehearsals. 

d. Issue the order. 

e. Ensure rest plan is followed. 

3. Control the route reconnaissance. 

a. Ensure reconnaissance commence from the flanks or rear when 
no reconnoitering areas along the route that is likely to be defended by 
enemy detachments, such as bridge approaches, defiles, or buildup 
areas. Detailed observation preceded actual reconnaissance, and 
approach routes were checked for mines, booby traps, and signs of 
ambush. 

b. Ensure when time is available, dismounted personnel are sent 
forward first, covered by the remaining elements of the unit. The number 
of dismounted personnel sent forward depends on the size of objective 
and on available approaches, cover, and concealment. If the dismounted 
patrols find that the near edge of the area is clear, the remainder of the 
unit moves quickly forward. The dismounted patrols then continue the 
reconnaissance, over watch and follow closely by the remainder of the 
unit. 




Skill Level 3 071-326-5805 3-261 



Performance Steps 




c. When conducting a mounted reconnaissance, part of the unit 
remained mounted and moves forward cautiously but rapidly, over 
watched by the remaining mounted elements. If the near edge of the area 
is clear, the over watching elements move forward quickly and the 
advance continues. 

4. Reconnaissance by fire. 

a. Reconnaissance by fire is accomplished by firing on likely or 
suspected enemy positions in an attempt to remove camouflage and to 
cause the enemy to disclose his presence by movement or return fire. 
During reconnaissance by fire, positions being reconnoitered must be 
observed continuously so enemy activity can be quickly and definitely 
located. 

b. Reconnaissance by fire may be employed by route 
reconnaissance teams as a security measure when time is critical and the 
loss of surprise is not essential. 

c. If the enemy returns the fire, the situation is further developed. If 
the fire is not returned, reconnaissance continues. However, caution 
should be exercised, for reconnaissance by fire often fails to disclose the 
presence of a well-disciplined enemy. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide all personnel, equipment, and material given 
in the task condition statement. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he is to plan and conduct a route 
reconnaissance using proper movement techniques for the likelihood of 
enemy contact, gather information about enemy forces along the assigned 
route, and critical terrain features. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Planned reconnaissance based on the intelligence 
requirement. 

2. Issued the plan for the mission. 



3. Conducted hasty or deliberate reconnaissance 
based on time available and detail requirements. 



4. Used reconnaissance by fire when permitted by the 
tactical situation. 



5. Avoided decisive engagement with enemy forces. 



6. Used proper movement techniques during the route 
reconnaissance. 



3-262 071-326-5805 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

7. Reported all items of military significance. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was done wrong and 
how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-21 .71 
FM5-170 
FM7-7 
FM7-8 
FM 7-20 
FM 17-95 
FM 3-90.1 

071-332-5021 

Prepare a Situation Map 

Conditions:Given the tactical situation, in a combat environment. 
Standards: Included the following elements on the situation map: 

1 . Military symbols (must be in accordance with FM 101-5-1). 

2. Enemy situation (must be depicted in red or with double lines ). 

3. Control measures. 

4. Location of the command post and/or command group. 

5. Location of all maneuver elements. 

6. Location of reserves. 




Performance Steps 



1 . Depict the control measures. 

2. Depict the command post and/or the command group location. 

3. Depict the location of the maneuver elements. 

4. Depict the location of the reserve. 

5. Determine the classification. 



Skill Level 3 071-332-5021 3-263 




Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide a copy of the operation order, map board, 
map, marking pens, overlay paper, coordinate scale, unit SOP, and 
FM 101-5-1. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he must prepare a situation map. The 
situation map must be prepared in accordance with FM 1 01 -5-1 and the unit 
SOP. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Depicted the control measures. 



2. Depicted command post and/or command group 
location. 



3. Depicted the location of the maneuver elements. 



4. Depicted the location of the reserve. 



5. Determined classification. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 101-5 
FM 101-5-1 

071-720-0015 

Conduct an Area Reconnaissance by a Platoon 

Conditions:Given a 1 :50,000 map, a lensatic compass, and a mission to 
conduct an area reconnaissance within a specified time. 

Standards: Satisfactorily performed the following within the time specified 
by the commander: 

1 . Organized the platoon into the command, reconnaissance, and security 
elements needed to accomplish the mission. 

2. Conducted a reconnaissance using the surveillance or vantage-point 
method. 

3. Obtained and reported information about the terrain and enemy within the 
specified area. 

3-264 071-720-0015 Skill Level 3 



4. Entered and left the target area without being detected by the enemy. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Estimate the situation. When the reconnaissance mission is received, 
develop an estimate of the situation. Base the estimate on current 
intelligence about the enemy in the vicinity of the target area, and on the 
capabilities of the unit. While planning for the mission, have the unit 
prepare for the mission also. Tailor the organization to best support the 
mission. The reconnaissance element of a platoon will normally be no 
larger than a squad. 

2. Plan details. Develop the overall plan with a consideration of the 
following factors: 

a. Use Intelligence. All reconnaissance operations must be based on 
the best information available as to actual conditions in the objective area. 

b. Use deceptive measures. The success of reconnaissance 
operations is determined, to a large extent, on deception measures and on 
undetected infiltration and exfiltration. 

c. Use the smallest unit possible to accomplish the mission. This 
decreases the possibility of enemy detection. Though only a small element 
reconnoiters, the parent unit must be large enough to provide security or 
support if the reconnaissance is detected or an enemy force engages the 
element. 

d. Remain undetected. The unit uses stealth, camouflage, 
concealment, and sound and light discipline. These techniques allow the OT 
unit to take advantage of periods of limited visibility to avoid contact and to 
get near, or on, the objective. 

e. Use surveillance, target acquisition, and night observation (STANO) 
devices. The unit makes use of STANO devices to help it move and gain 
information about the enemy. Based on intelligence reports, consideration 
must be given to the enemy's detection devices. When the enemy may 
have detection devices, passive devices should be used to decrease the 
probability of enemy detection. 

f. Rehearse. After intelligence has been analyzed, the plan 
developed, special items of equipment procured and issued, and the troops 
briefed, the unit rehearses the plan. This rehearsal is a key factor that 
enhances the probability of the success of the operation. Rehearsals are 
as detailed as time allows and include dry runs and briefings with repetition 
and questioning as needed to ensure understanding of the plan. 
Contingency plans are also rehearsed. To ensure that the contingency 
plans are understood, the reconnaissance members must repeat them. 



Skill Level 3 071-720-0015 3-265 



Performance Steps 




g. Minimize audio and electronic communications. Constraints on 
communication depend on enemy detection abilities and on how time 
sensitive the information obtained from the enemy is. There may be 
instances where the importance of the information requires an immediate 
report. The unit's existence could be threatened. Often, a one-time radio 
contact during the mission is necessary. 

h. Inspect. The planning phase of the operation includes at least one 
inspection of all members of the reconnaissance force, to include their 
equipment. Only essential equipment, identified by the platoon leader as 
equipment required for mission accomplishment, is carried. Special 
equipment must be closely inspected and safeguarded to ensure it 
functions during the mission. Extra personnel and equipment assigned to 
the unit must also be carefully inspected and monitored prior to and during 
the operation. Any shortcomings found in personnel or equipment are 
corrected before the operation begins. Thorough inspections and 
supervision of personnel and equipment before the operation reduce the 
probabilities of compromise or failure. 
3. Assign subordinate missions. Regardless of the types of 
reconnaissance, units are normally assigned one of the three subordinate 
missions: Command and control, reconnaissance of the objective, or 
security of the force. 

a. Command and control. The commander of the unit conducting a 
reconnaissance normally requires a small command group to assist in 
communicating with higher headquarters, subordinate elements, and 
supporting forces, and to coordinate and control supporting elements, fire 
support, and air or water transport for the operation. For small operations, 
this group may consist of only the commander and a radio operator. For 
larger operations, the commander may require intelligence, logistics, and 
fire support elements, with adequate communication personnel for 
sustained 24-hour operations. The command group is always kept as 
small as possible. 



3-266 071-720-0015 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



b. Reconnaissance of the objective. The element with the 
reconnaissance mission approaches the target using stealth and 
concealment. All plans and applicable contingencies are conducted with 
the major effort made toward obtaining the information required while 
remaining undetected. The reconnaissance element must skillfully avoid 
all known and discovered enemy sensing devices; therefore, patience is 
important. Passive STANO devices will be used to observe activities at the 
objective. Information received about the target may be transmitted back 
to the appropriate headquarters by electronic means as it is observed. Or, 
the reconnaissance personnel may withdraw from the target and 
disseminate information by other means. The reconnaissance site should 
be sterilized before withdrawal. Withdrawal from the area must be as 
skillful, patient, and precise as was the movement into it. 

c. Security of the force. The reconnaissance element(s) with this 
m ission must provide the commander sufficient warning of the location and 
movement of enem y forces to permit the parent force to take evasive 
action or, when this is not possible, to provide covering fires that permit 
withdrawal of the reconnaissance element. Only if warnings are timely and 
information is accurate does the commander have the time and space to " 
react. It is also the only way that, if the reconnaissance element is g 
detected, the commander can arrange to give it sufficient over watching ^j 
suppressive fires or time to evade and withdraw safely. = 
4. Conduct an area reconnaissance and obtain information about a <n 
specific location and the area immediately around it (for example, road 
junctions, hills, bridges, enemy positions). Designate the location of the 
objective by either grid coordinates or a map overlay with a boundary line 
drawn around the area. 

a. Once given an area reconnaissance mission, the platoon moves to 
the appointed area in the shortest possible time. This normally involves 
traveling along existing roads and, of course, using the appropriate 
movement techniques. During this movement to an area, the platoon 
reports and bypasses enemy opposition unless ordered to do otherwise. 

b. When the platoon reaches its area, it halts and sets up an objective 
rallying point (ORP). Once the ORP has been set up, the objective can be 
reconnoitered in one of two ways : 



Skill Level 3 071-720-0015 3-267 



Performance Steps 




(1) When the terrain permits the security element to move to a 
pos ition to over watch the reconnaissance element, the leader may decide 
to have small reconnaissance teams move to each surveillance point or 
vantage point around the objective instead of having the entire element 
move as a unit from point to point. After the objective has been 
reconnoitered, the elements return to the ORP and information is issued. 
The patrol then returns to friendly lines. 

(2) When the terrain does not allow the platoon to secure the 
objective area, the platoon leaves a security element at the ORP and uses 
reconnaissance and security (R&S) teams to reconnoiter the objective. 
These teams move to different surveillance points or vantage points, from 
which they reconnoiter the objective. Once the objective has been 
reconnoitered, the R&S team returns to the ORP, shares the information, 
and returns to friendly lines. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: At the test site, provide all equipment and material given in the task 
conditions statement. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he is to organize and conduct an area 
reconnaissance using the surveillance or vantage point method. Obtain and 
report any information about the terrain and enemy within the specified area. 
Tell the soldier he is to complete the mission within the time specified by the 
commander. Tell the soldier you will act as the battalion intelligence officer 
(S2) to provide answers to any questions he may ask. 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


1 . Established a plan of action based on the mission 
and the enemy situation. 






2. Conducted a reconnaissance. 


3. Conducted deceptive meas ures during infiltration 
and exfiltration. 


4. Used smallest unit required to conduct the 
reconnaissance. 


5. Applied stealth, camouflage, and concealment 
techniques along with noise and light discipline to avoid 
detection. 




— 


6. Conducted pre-mission inspection and rehearsal. 


7. Used the correct size command and control group 
for the mission. 







3-268 071-720-0015 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

8. Used correct movement techniques during the 

mission. 

9. Used correct security techniques during the mission. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was done wrong and 
how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-21 .71 

FM7-7 

FM7-8 

101-92Y-0002 

Plan Tactical Re-Supply Operations 

Conditions:Given a higher headquarters operation plan/order 
(OPLAN/OPORD), service support plan/order and the requirement to 
analyze the order/plan determine the anticipated ammunition, supply and 
service requirements; receive, consolidate and forward all logistical reports; 
select appropriate supply technique to support the plan/order; distribute and 
cross level supplies based on commander's priorities. Given troop list, 
equipment density list, FM 101-5, FM 101-10-1/2, common tables of 
allowance (CTA) 50-900, 50-909, 50-970 or Operations Logistics Planner 
software, and local unit standing operating procedures (SOP). 

Standards: Developed a service support plan/order for tactical resupply 
operations in accordance with FM 1 01 -5. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Review the higher headquarters OPLAN/OPORD. 

a. Review task organization for troop units. 

b. Review the situation requirements for the operation. 

c. Review the mission paragraph for combat service support 
implications and requirements. 

d. Review the execution paragraph and concept of operation. 

e. Review the coordinating instructions subparagraph. 

f. Review the service support paragraph. 

Skill Level 3 101-92Y-0002 3-269 




Performance Steps 




(1) Identify availability of specific classes of supply that might 
impact on the mission. 

(2) Determine supply point locations. 

(3) Identify medical evacuation and hospitalization requirements to 
include procedures to be used for chemical casualties. 

(4) Identify transportation capabilities, requirements, and 
shortages. 

(5) Identify maintenance capabilities, requirements, and location 
of facilities, collection points, and priority of maintenance for combat 
systems. 

(6) Identify the personnel services available and location of sites. 

(7) Identify the field services available and location of sites. 

(8) Identify civilian labor and host nation support available. 

g. Identify command and signal requirements for logistics planning 
applications. 

h. Review the acknowledgment of the OPLAN/OPORD. 

2. Determine requirements for all classes of supply and transportation. 

a. Prepare a logistics support forecast for all classes of supplies. 

(1 ) Determine unit personnel strength and replacement data for 
actual or estimated combat losses. 

(2) Determine the equipment on hand quantity. 

(a) Estimate combat losses. 

(b) Estimate equipment replenishment. 

b. Compute the Class I requirements based on assigned personnel 
strength and mission. 

(1) Compute the Class I requirements based on type of rations, 
climatic conditions, terrain, combat intensity, and weather. 

(2) Determine rations by type to support the mission. 

(3) Compute the resupply for Class I based on consumption rate. 

(4) Determine storage space requirements for Class I. 

(5) Determine transportation requirements necessary to move the 
Class I. 

(6) Identify transportation shortfall for moving Class I. 

c. Compute Class II requirements based on the basis of issue 
allowances in the common table of allowances. 



3-270 101-92Y-0002 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



d. Compute Class III bulk fuel and packaged products requirements 
based on equipment on hand. 

(1) Compute the Class III bulk fuel requirements based on the 
type equipment on hand in the unit. 

(a) Compute the mobile gasoline (MOGAS) requirements 
based on the equipment on hand. 

(b) Compute the diesel requirements based on the equipment 
on hand. 

(c) Compute the JP 8 fuel requirements based on the multi- 
fuel equipment on hand. 

(d) Compute the kerosene requirements based on the type of 
heaters on hand. 

(e) Compute the aviation gasoline (JP 8) requirements based 
on the type aircraft on hand. 

(f) Determine transportation requirements to move Class III 
bulk fuel. 

(g) Identify transportation shortfall for moving Class III bulk 
fuel. 

(h) Determine storage requirements for Class III bulk fuel. 

(2) Compute the Class III packaged products requirements based 
on the type of equipment on hand. 

(a) Verify quantity on hand. 

(b) Determine transportation requirements to move Class III 
package products. 

(c) Identify transportation shortfall for moving Class III 
package products. 

(d) Determine storage requirements for Class III package 
products. 

e. Compute Class IV requirements based on the mission needs, local 
unit SOP and allowances in the common table of allowances. 

(1) Verify quantity on hand. 

(2) Determine storage requirements for Class IV. 

(3) Determine transportation requirements necessary to move 
Class IV. 

(4) Identify transportation shortfall for moving Class IV. 



Skill Level 3 101-92Y-0002 3-271 




Performance Steps 




f. Compute the Class V requirements based on the required supply 
rate (RSR) for the type of mission, and the type and number of weapons 
on hand for one day. 

(1) Determine the Class V required to support the mission. 

(2) Identify the procedures to request for emergency ordnance 
detachment (EOD) support. 

(3) Determine the storage space required for Class V 
requirements. 

(4) Determine transportation requirements necessary to move 
Class V. 

(5) Determine if a transportation shortfall exists. 

g. Compute the Class VI requirements based on personnel assigned 
or attached. 

(1) Compute the number of health and comfort packs (type II) 
required based on the number of females assigned. 

(2) Compute the number of health and comfort packs (type I) 
required based on the total number of personnel assigned. 

(3) Determine the storage space required for the health and 
comfort packs. 

(4) Determine transportation requirements necessary to move 
Class VI. 

(5) Determine if transportation shortfall exists. 

h. Determine the Class VII major end item requirements and 
command controlled items. 

(1) Compute the Class VII major end items resupply based on 
battle loss reports. 

(2) Verify the weapon systems status (WESS) report for battle 
loss. 

(3) Plan for allocation of replacement ready-to-fight weapon 
systems to units to support the mission. 

(4) Plan for issue of ready-to-fight weapon systems plus crews. 

(5) Determine number of ready weapon systems available for 
issue. 

i. Determine the Class VIII requirements. 

(1) Compute the Class VIII requirements based on the number of 
pounds per man per day. 

(2) Verify quantity of Class VIM items on hand. 

3-272 101-92Y-0002 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(3) Coordinate storage requirements for Class VIM items with 
medical personnel. 

(4) Determine transportation requirements to move Class VIII. 

(5) Identify transportation shortfall for moving Class VIII. 

j. Compute the Class IX requirements based on demand history. 

(1) Determine storage requirements for Class IX. 

(2) Determine transportation requirements necessary to move 
Class IX. 

(3) Identify transportation shortfall for moving Class IX. 

k. Determine the requirement for miscellaneous items that are not 
one of the 1 supply classes (captured material and salvage material). 

I. Determine the methods of resupply for specific classes of supplies. 

(1) Identify the method of supply. 

(a) Establish amount and mix requirement for logistics 
packages (LOGPACs) based on situations. 

(b) Determine the transportation requirements to move 
LOGPACs. 

(c) Coordinate supply of LOGPACs. 

• Coordinate the service station resupply point. 

• Coordinate the tailgating resupply point. 

• Coordinate LOGPAC return instructions. 

(2) Coordinate the on hand, due in and cached resupply of Class 
I, III, IV and V. 

(3) Determine the need for cross leveling of supplies internally. 

(4) Coordinate emergency resupply from the combat trains. 

(5) Coordinate the distribution method for supplies. 

(a) Identify supply point distribution location. 

(b) Identify unit distribution location. 

(c) Identify refuel on the move locations for Class III bulk fuel. 

(6) Identify the types of loads required to support combat 
operations. 

(7) Determine storage requirements for resupply of Class I, III, IV 
andV. 

(8) Determ ine transportation requirements necessary for resupply 
for Class I, IV and V. 



Skill Level 3 101-92Y-0002 3-273 




Performance Steps 




m.ldentify organic transportation capabilities. 

n. Identify the type of transportation required. 

o. Identify transportation shortfalls. 

p. Request additional transportation support. 

q. Identify the traffic controls that may be necessary to the operation. 

r. Post the main supply route (MSR) and alternate supply route 
(ASR) to the supply point locations on the service support plan overlay. 

s. Post the drop zone (DZ) and landing zone (LZ) to the supply points 
locations on the service support plan overlay. 

t. Prepare the service support paragraph to the service support plan. 

3. Determine requirements for water and field services. 

a. Compute water requirements based on assigned personnel, unit 
equipment, and services to be provided. 

(1) Determine the water requirements for drinking water. 

(2) Determine the water requirements for personal hygiene. 

(3) Determine the water requirements for meal preparation and 
kitchen sanitation. 

(4) Determine the water requirements to operate shower and 
laundry site. 

(5) Determine water requirements for medical services and 
medical facilities. 

b. Determine water requirements for maintenance and care of 
equipment. 

c. Determine water requirements for other support requirements. 

(1) Determine water requirements for engineer construction 
support. 

(2) Determine water requirements for nuclear, biological, chemical 
(NBC) conditions and mission-oriented protective posture (MOPP) 3 

and 4. 

(3) Determine water requirements for NBC decontamination 
procedures. 

d. Determine the locations for mortuary affairs, showers, laundry 
services, and fabric repair. 

e. Post water and services graphics information to service support 
matrix and overlay. 

f. Prepare the service paragraph to the service support plan. 

3-274 101-92Y-0002 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



4. Determine labor requirements. 

a. Determine civilian and enemy prisoner of war (EPW) labor 
capabilities. 

b. Allocate and set priorities for available labor. 

c. Determine transportation requirements to move the labor force. 

d. Identify transportation shortfalls. 

5. Determine maintenance requirements. 

a. Verify the priority of maintenance support for air, ground, and 
watercraft. 

b. Verify the support maintenance facilities and salvage collection 
points for equipment. 

c. Identify the controlled exchange, and cannibalization points. 

d. Verify the maintenance evacuation procedures. 

e. Identify maintenance capability shortfalls. 

f. Post maintenance, controlled exchange, and cannibalization points 
to service support matrix and overlay. 

g. Prepare the maintenance paragraph to the service support plan. 

6. Determine requirements for medical evacuation and hospitalization. 

a. Identify the medical evacuation policy/procedure. 

b. Identify treatment and hospitalization facilities. 

c. Identify other services information for all other combat health 
support matters. 

(1) Identify the dental facilities and locations. 

(2) Identify preventative medicine support and facilities location. 

(3) Identify the health service logistics support and facilities 
location. 

(4) Identify the combat stress control support and facilities 
location. 

(5) Identify the veterinary support facilities and location. 

d. Identify the procedures used for chemical casualties. 

e. Determine the transportation requirements necessary to return 
troops to duty. 

f. Post hospital locations and information to service support matrix 
and overlay. 

g. Prepare the medical evacuation and hospitalization paragraph to 
the service support plan. 

Skill Level 3 101-92Y-0002 3-275 




Performance Steps 




7. Determine personnel services requirements. 

a. Identify personnel services support (PSS) requirements. 

(1) Identify the installation location and operating hours if 
applicable. 

(2) Identify the personnel service support operating units and area 
served. 

(3) Identify the personnel rotation criteria. 

(4) Identify the unit responsibility for movement or administration 
of personnel. 

b. Identify maintenance of unit strength requirements. 

(1) Identify instructions for submission of strength reports. 

(2) Identify instructions for replacement of personnel. 

c. Identify casualty operations requirements. 

(1) Identify instructions for recording casualty information. 

(2) Identify instructions for reporting casualty information. 

(3) Identify instructions for verifying casualty information. 

(4) Identify instructions for processing casualty information. 

d. Identify personnel management requirements. 

(1) Identify instructions for military personnel. 

(2) Identify instructions for civilian personnel. 

(3) Identify instructions for EPW's, civilian interns/detainees. 

e. Identify discipline, law and order requirements. 

f. Identify headquarters management requirements. 

g. Identify miscellaneous personnel administrative matters. 

h. Post locations and information to service support matrix and 
overlay. 

i. Prepare the personnel services paragraph to the service support 
plan. 

8. Identify foreign/host nation support concepts. 

a. Identify plans for forecasted support. 

b. Identify plans for unforecasted support. 

c. Post foreign/host nation support information to service support 
m atrix overlay. 

9. Identify coordinating instructions. 



3-276 101-92Y-0002 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



a. Identify boundaries needed for combat service support (CSS) 
purposes. 

b. Identify protection measures for CSS units or installations. 

(1) Identify which units will provide protection based on threat 
level. 

(2) Identify which CSS units or installations will receive protection. 

c. Identify special reports not included in previous paragraphs. 

d. Identify other CSS matters not included in previous paragraphs. 

e. Identify time and/or conditions under which the plan is to be 
executed. 

f. Post coordinating instructions to service support matrix and 
overlay. 

Evaluation Preparation: This task can be evaluated during routine unit 

operations. 

Brief Soldier: Inform soldier that the evaluation is measured on the ability to 

perform the listed performance measures. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO jj 



1 . Reviewed the higher headquarters 
OPLAN/OPORD. 



CO 



a. Reviewed task organization for troop units. 



b. Reviewed the situation requirements for the 
operation. 



c. Reviewed the mission paragraph for CSS 
implications and requirements. 



d. Reviewed the execution paragraph and concept 
of operation. 



e. Reviewed the coordinating instructions 
subparagraph. 



f. Reviewed the service support paragraph. 



g. Identified command and signal requirements for 
logistics planning applications. 



h. Reviewed the acknowledgement of the 
OPLAN/OPORD. 



2. Determined requirements for all classes of supply 
and transportation. 



Skill Level 3 101-92Y-0002 3-277 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

a. Prepared a logistics support forecast for all 
classes of supplies. 

b. Computed the Class I requirements based on 

assigned personnel strength and mission. 

c. Computed Class II requirements based on the 
basis of issue allowances in the common table of 

allowances. 

d. Computed Class III bulk fuel and packaged 

products requirements based on equipment on hand. 

e. Computed Class IV requirements based on the 
mission needs, local unit SOP, and allowances in the 
common table of allowances. 

f. Computed the Class V requirements based on 
the RSR for the type of mission, and the type and 
number of weapons on hand for one day. 

g. Computed the Class VI requirements based on 
personnel assigned or attached. 

h. Determined the Class VII major end item 
requirements and command controlled items. 

i. Determined the Class VII requirements. 

j. Computed the Class IX requirements based on 
demand history. 

k. Determined the requirement for miscellaneous 
items that are not one of the 1 supply classes 
(captured material and salvage material). 

I. Determined the methods of resupply for specific 
classes of supplies. 

m.ldentified organic transportation capabilities. 



n. Identified transportation shortfalls by nodes. 



o. Identified the type of transportation required. 



p. Requested additional transportation support. 



q. Identified the traffic controls that may be 
necessary to the operation. 



- 



r. Posted the MSR and ASR to the supply point 
locations on the service support plan overlay. 

s. Prepared the logistics annex (service support) to 
OPORD. 

3-278 101-92Y-0002 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

3. Determined requirement for water and field 
services. 

a. Computed water requirements based on 
assigned personnel, unit equipment, and services to be 
provided. 



b. Determined water requirements for maintenance 
and care of equipment. 



c. Determined water requirements for other 
support requirements. 



- 



- 



d. Determined the water requirements for mortuary 
affairs. 



e. Posted water and services graphics information 
to service support matrix and overlay. 



f. Prepared the service paragraph to the service 
support plan. 

4. Determined labor requirements. 



CO 



a. Determined civilian and EPW labor capabilities. <u 

b. Allocated and set priorities for available labor. jjj 



c. Determined transportation requirements to move 



.* 



the labor force. OT 

5. Determined maintenance requirements. 

a. Verified the priority of maintenance support for 
air, ground, and watercraft. 

b. Verified the support maintenance, facilities and 
salvage collection points for equipment. 

c. Identified the controlled exchange, and 
cannibalization point. 

d. Verified the maintenance evacuation 
procedures. 

e. Identified maintenance capability shortfalls. 

f. Posted maintenance, controlled exchange, and 
cannibalization points to service support matrix and 
overlay. 

g. Prepared the maintenance paragraph to the 
service support plan. 






Skill Level 3 101-92Y-0002 3-279 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

6. Determined requirement for medical evacuation 

and hospitalization. 

a. Identified the medical evacuation policy. 



b. Identified treatment and hospitalization 
procedures. 



d. Identified the procedures used for chemical 
casualties. 

e. Determined the transportation requirements 
necessary to return troops to duty. 

f. Posted hospital locations and information to 
service support matrix overlay. 

g. Prepared the medical evacuation and 
hospitalization paragraph to the service support plan. 

7. Determined personnel services requirements. 



a. Identified PSS requirements. 



b. Posted location and information to service 
support matrix and overlay. 



8. Identified foreign/host nation support concepts. 



a. Identified plans for forecasted support. 



b. Identified plans for unforecasted support. 



9. Identified coordinating instructions. 



c. Identified other services information for all other 
combat health support matters. 



c. Prepared the personnel services paragraph to 
the service support plan. 



c. Posted foreign/host nation support information tc 
service support matrix and overlay. 



a. Identified boundaries needed for CSS purposes. 

b. Identified protection measures for CSS units or 
installations. 

c. Identified special reports not included in 
previous paragraphs. 

d. Identified other CSS matters not included in 
previous paragraphs. 



3-280 101-92Y-0002 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

e. Identified time and/or conditions under which the 
plan was to be executed. 

f. Posted coordinating instructions to service 

support matrix and overlay. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any perform ance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was done wrong and 
how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

CTA 50-900 AR 710-2 

CTA 50-909 DA Pam 71 0-2-1 

CTA 50-970 FM 10-27-4 

FM 101-5 FM 100-10 

FM 101-5-1 



301-371-1150 

Identify Intelligence and Electronic Warfare (IEW) Assets 

Conditions:Given the OPLAN, operational overlay, current enemy situation 
and a map of the area. 

Standards: Identified the types of intelligence and electronic warfare (IEW) 
support available and how they were integrated into the combined arms 
team. 

Performance Steps 

1. Identify the four major tasks that make up the IEW mission. 

a. Situation development. 

b. Target development. 

c. Electronic warfare (EW). 

d. Counterintelligence (CI). 

2. Determine the role of situation development. 

a. Locate enemy forces. 

b. Determine enemy capabilities, vulnerabilities, and intentions. 

c. Identify the enemy main effort. 

Skill Level 3 301-371-1150 3-281 




Performance Steps 




d. Determine how weather and terrain will affect friendly and enemy 
operations. 

e. Detect opportunities to exploit enemy weaknesses and seize or 
retain the initiative. 

3. Determine the role of target development. 

a. Provide combat information. 

b. Provide targeting data. 

c. Correlate target information. 

4. Determine the role of EW. 

a. Define EW. 

(1) EW is the means through which commanders protect their own 
electronic systems while attacking those of the enemy. 

(2) EW exploits, disrupts, and deceives enemy command and 
control while protecting friendly use of communications and non- 
communications systems. 

(3) On the battlefield, EW is divided into two categories: offensive 
and defensive. 

b. Define electronic attack (EA). 

(1) Offensive EW is referred to as EA. 

(2) EA is the transmission of electronic jamming signals that 
disrupt the enemy's communications and other signal emitter systems. It 
also transmits false communications that deceive enemyforces through 
their own information collection systems. 

(3) EW assets are targeted in much the same way as artillery and 
other weapon systems. 

(4) EA includes jamming and deception. 

c. Define electronic warfare support (ES). 

(1) Enemy sources of radiated electromagnetic energy are 
searched for, located, and identified through a process called ES. 

(2) ES focuses on the immediate requirements of the tactical 
commander. 

(3) ES includes the efforts to search, identify, intercept, and locate 
electronic emitters. 

d. Define electronic protection (EP). 

(1) Defensive EW seeks to protect friendly use of the 
electromagnetic spectrum by employing EP. 



3-282 301-371-1150 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(2) EP is the actions taken to protect friendly command, control, 
and communication (C3) from enemy collection and disruption efforts. 

(3) EP is planned around the commander's mission and concept 
of operations, and is the responsibility of the operations officer (G3/S3). 
Based on the mission, those communications and electronic systems that 
must be protected are identified and their vulnerability to enemy EA is 
assessed. The operation of these systems is then planned and monitored 
to ensure that the times, frequencies, duration, and location of their 
emissions provide the greatest possible security from enemy collection 
and disruption efforts. 

Note. FM 34-10 and FM 34-25 have not been updated to reflect current IEW 
terminology. These manuals refer to electronic attack (EA) as electronic 
countermeasures (ECM), electronic warfare support (ES) as electronic warfare 
support measures (ESM) and electronic protection (EP) as electronic counter- 
countermeasures (ECCM). 

5. Determine the role of counterintelligence (CI). 

a. Counters the hostile intelligence threat. 

b. Safeguards the command from surprise. 

c. Deceives the enemy. 

d. Counters enemy sabotage, subversion, and terrorism. 

6. Identify the major intelligence disciplines. 

a. Human intelligence (HUMINT) includes all information derived 
through human sources not accessible to other collection assets. 
HUMINT employs overt, covert, and clandestine operations to achieve 
worldwide collection objectives. 

b. Imagery intelligence (IMINT). IMINT can be obtained from land, 
sea, air, and space platforms (radar, photographic, infrared, and electro- 
optic imagery). 

c. Signals intelligence (SIGINT) is the products resulting from the 
collection, evaluation, analysis, integration, and interpretation of 
information derived from intercepted electromagnetic emissions. 

d. Measurement and signature intelligence (MASINT) is scientific and 
technical intelligence obtained by quantitative and qualitative analysis of 
data derived from technical sensors for the purpose of identifying any 
distinctive features associated with the source, emitter, or sender and to 
facilitate subsequent identification or measurement. 

7. Recognize how IEW supports the battlefield commander. 

a. Collect information on enemy forces. 

b. Provide targeting data to fire and maneuver elements. 

Skill Level 3 301-371-1150 3-283 




Performance Steps 




c. Evaluate, analyze, integrate, and interpret collected information to 
produce intelligence. 

d. Disseminate the intelligence product to the appropriate users. 

e. Conduct EW operations. 

f. Support operations security (OPSEC) and deception. 

8. Identify the staff responsibilities for IEW. 

a. The G2 coordinates the intelligence effort. He identifies 
intelligence requirements based on the commander's guidance and 
concept of the operation. 

b. The G3 has staff responsibility for planning and directing the 
jamming and deception operations of the command. He directs EA 
actions needed to support planned and ongoing operations. He identifies, 
in coordination with the G2, ES requirements to support EW. 

c. The military intelligence (Ml) unit commander manages the Ml 
assets to accomplish the assigned EW missions. He exercises command 
and control (C2) over all organic and attached Ml elements and 
operational control (OPCON) over supporting Ml assets. 

9. Identify how IEW is integrated into the combined arms team. 

a. Division tactical operations center support element (DTOCSE) 
augments the G2 and G3. Part of this element, the electronic warfare 
section (EWS), is the principle mission manager for EA. The EWS is also 
involved with the fire support element in the targeting process. 

b. The analysis and control element (ACE), formerly referred to as 
the technical control and analysis element (TCAE), is part of the Ml 
battalion tactical operations center (TOC) and is the asset manager for all 
ES and EA missions tasked to the Ml battalion. 

c. Intelligence and electronic warfare support element (IEWSE) is 
attached to the maneuver brigade TOC from the Ml battalion. This 
element serves as an interface between Ml assets in the brigade area and 
the brigade S2 and S3. 

d. The G2, G3, fire support officer and communications -electronics 
(CE) officer coordinate and direct IEW operations. They obtain the 
information required to answer the commander's requirements concerning 
both enemy forces and friendly vulnerabilities. They integrate EA with 
maneuver and fire and plan and coordinate OPSEC measures and 
defensive EP measures to protect from enemy intelligence collections 
operations. 



3-284 301-371-1150 Skill Level 3 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide the soldier with the materials listed in the conditions 

statement. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to identify the types of EW support available 

and how they are incorporated into the combined arms team. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Identified the four major tasks that make up the IEW 

mission. 

2. Determined the role of situation development. 



3. Determined the role of target development. 



4. Determined the role of EW to include- 



a. Defined EW. 



b. Defined EA. 



c. Defined ES. 



d. Defined EP. 



5. Determined the role of CI. 



> 



6. Identified the major intelligence disciplines. 



commander. 



7. Recognized how IEW supports the battlefield <n 



8. Identified the staff responsibilities for IEW to 
include — 



a. Responsibilities of the G2. 



b. Responsibilities of the G3. 



c. Responsibilities of the Ml unit commander. 



9. Identified how IEW is integrated into the combined 
arms team to include — 



a. The Ml support elements that assist in IEW 
operations. 

b. The principal personnel that coordinate and 

direct IEW operations. 

Evaluation Guidance: Failure to achieve a GO for this task will result in 
retraining of the failed areas and retesting. A second NO GO will result in 
retraining of the entire task and retesting. 



Skill Level 3 301-371-1150 3-285 




References 
Required Related 

FM 34-3 
FM 34-1 
FM 34-10 
FM 34-25 



551-88M-0001 

Lead a Convoy Serial/March Unit 

Conditions:You are a platoon leader or platoon sergeant in a field or 
garrison environment and have received an order directing your unit to 
conduct a motor transport convoy. You have access to the unit SOP, maps , 
and all applicable movement directives. 

Standards: Planned and conducted a motor transport convoy over a 
designated route that enabled the convoy to reach the SP and RP at the 
times prescribed in the convoy clearance. The convoy arrived safely at its 
destination with minimum loss or damage to vehicles, equipment, physical 
surroundings, or personnel. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine mission requirements. 

2. Conduct route reconnaissance. 

3. Prepare strip map. 

4. Request convoy clearance (administrative). 

5. Request convoy clearance (tactical). 

6. Plan convoy organization and control. 

7. Prepare m ovement order. 

8. Prepare drivers. 

9. Schedule and prepare convoy briefing. 

10. Supervise before operations PMCS. 

11. Ensure pre-departure steps. 

12. Enforce correct driving procedures. 

13. Instruct drivers. 

14. Perform RP checks. 

Evaluation Preparation: Evaluate this task during a field training exercise 
or a unit training exercise. 



3-286 551 -88M -0001 Skill Level 3 



Brief Soldier: Inform the soldier that the evaluation is measured on the 
ability to perform all the functions listed. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Collected warning order and area maps. 



2. Gathered SOP and reference directives. 



3. Reviewed unit load plans. 



4. Evaluated environmental impact. 



5. Selected primary and alternate routes. 



6. Identified halts. 



7. Identified route restrictions. 



8. Prepared and distributed the strip map. 



9. Coordinated submission of DD Form 1265 
(administrative). 



1 0. Coordinated for oversize or overweight vehicles <u 

(administrative). 5 

11. Coordinated with battalion S3 (tactical). = 



CO 



12. Appointed and instructed trail party. 



13. Coordinated support requirements. 



14. Planned for special mission requirements. 



15. Planned for placement of troop carrying vehicles. 



16. Divided the convoy into march units/serials. 



1 7. Planned gap time between serials. 



18. Determined position of march unit and serial 
commanders. 



19. Obtained civilian police assistance (when possible). 



20. Assigned radios. 



21 . Prepared and issued the movement order. 



Skill Level 3 551 -88M -0001 3-287 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

22. Ensured drivers possess valid driving permits. 



23. Ensured adequate rest periods. 



24. Scheduled for combat inspections. 



25. Scheduled, prepared, and conducted convoy 
briefing covering — 



a. The situation. 



b. The mission. 



c. Execution. 



d. Administration and logistics. 



e. Command and signal. 



f. Safety. 



26. Checked air hose couplings. 



27. Checked oil and lubrication levels. 



= 28. Checked cooling systems. 



29. Checked brakes. 



30. Checked tires. 



31 . Checked line up of vehicles. 



32. Checked vehicle markings. 



33. Selected pacesetter. 



34. Conducted operations weapons check. 



35. Ensured sandbags were installed. 



36. Ensured cargo was secured. 



37. Briefed drivers on rules of the road. 



38. Signaled to start engines. 



39. Signaled to move out. 



40. Enforced proper driving procedures. 



=r 



3-288 551 -88M -0001 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

41 . Informed drivers of details at halts. 



42. Had drivers inspect their vehicles and loads. 



43. Ensured operational checks by drivers. 



44. Checked load security. 



45. Ensured policing of areas after stops. 



46. Dismissed drivers. 



=r 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 21-60 TM 9-2320-273-10 

FM55-15 TM 9-2320-279-10-1 

FM 55-30 TM 9-2320-279-10-2 

FM 101-5 TM 9-2320-280-10 

TM 9-2320-283-10 

TM 9-2320-289-10 

TM 9-2320-360-10 

TM 9-2320-361-10 

TM 9-2320-364-10 

TM 9-2320-365-10 

TM 9-2320-366-10-1 

TM 9-2320-366-10-2 

551-88N-0003 

Plan Unit Move 

Conditions:Given a command directive to plan for your unit to conduct a 
move to port of embarkation to deploy in support of an Army or joint OPLAN. 
You have access to the unit SOP and all unit movement directives. 



Skill Level 3 551-88N-0003 3-289 





Standards: Planned a unit movement using the necessary references 
(vehicle -1 Os) and equipment to deliver vehicles and equipment to arrive 
safely at the port of debarkation with no loss of vehicles, equipment, or 
personnel. 

Performance Steps 

1. Identify what needs to be moved. 

2. Identify what needs to accompany troops. 

3. Identify what needs to be moved by air. 

4. Identify hazardous, sensitive, and classified material/equipment. 

5. Identify bulk cargo. 

6. Develop vehicle load plans. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field training exercise or a unit training 
exercise. 

Brief Soldier: Inform the soldier that the evaluation is measured on the 
ability to perform all the functions listed. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



— 1. Identified what needed to be moved. 



a. Determined number of deploying personnel. 



b. Determined deploying vehicles and equipment. 



c. Determined basic load. 



2. Identified what needed to accompany troops. 



a. Identified Yellow TAT. 



b. Identified Red TAT. 



c. Identified equipment not to accompany troops. 



3. Identified what needed to be moved by air. 



a. Established liaison with UMO. 



b. Determined advance party personnel. 



c. Determined supercargo personnel. 



4. Identified hazardous, sensitive, and classified 
equipment and material. 



a. Identified TAT ammunition quantities. 



b. Determined upload of ammunition for armored 
vehicles. 



3-290 551-88N-0003 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

c. Determined securable hatches. 

d. Determined palletized load for armored vehicles. 

e. Determined tiedown cargo requirements. 

f. Determined fuel reduction requirements. 

5. Identified bulk cargo. 



a. Determined packing list distribution. 



b. Determined BBPCT requirements. 



6. Developed vehicle load plans. 



a. Planned for load capacity. 



b. Determined commercial transportation 
requirements. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier a GO for the task if all 
performance measures are passed. Score the soldier a NO GO for the task 
if any performance measure is failed. For all NO GO performances, 
demonstrate how the performance should be performed and allow the 
soldier remediation. 



References 
Required Related 

FM 4-01. 011 
FM 55-1 
FM 100-17 
FM 101-5 
TB 55-46-1 




SUBJECT AREA 23: SECURITY AND CONTROL 



191-379-4407 

Plan Convoy Security Operations 

Conditions:You are given an operation order (OPORD), a combat load, a 
map of the area, a compass, a protractor, communications equipment, signal 
operating instructions (SOI), security personnel, and special orders , if 
required. 



Skill Level 3 191-379-4407 3-291 




Standards: Developed a plan that included all required considerations for 
the specific mission, coordinated with appropriate units for required support, 
ensured that necessary equipment and supplies were available and 
operational, and prepared briefings for the security personnel on the mission 
and assigned specific duties. Ensured that 360-degree security was 
maintained from the point of origin to destination when escorting special 
weapons. 

Performance Steps 

1. Receive the OPORD. 

Note. Follow all steps in troop-leading procedures. When carrying special 
weapons or ammunition, ensure that you obtain the special orders concerning this 
cargo, that you understand them, and that they cover any situations not covered in 
the OPORD. 

2. Coordinate with the host nation security personnel. 

3. Consult all sources of information, especially the engineers and the 
highway traffic division (HTD), to obtain as much information as possible. 

4. Reconnoiter the convoy route to identify the following: 

a. Likely trouble spots and ambush sites. 

b. Possible locations for traffic control posts (TCPs) and/or 
checkpoints. 

c. Route conditions. 

d. Location of friendly units in the area. 

5. Coordinate with the convoy commander to determine — 

a. Actions to be taken if enemy contact is made by— 

(1) A sniper. 

(2) An ambush with the road blocked. 

(3) An ambush with the road not blocked. 

(4) An air attack. 

(5) An artillery attack. 

Note. Based on the mission and/or the type of cargo, the reaction to an enemy 
attack may vary. See STP 1 9B1 -SM, Task 1 91 -376-41 1 0. When carrying special 
weapons or ammunition, ensure that procedures are covered in the special orders 
on exactly how to react to enemy contact. 

b. Protective measures for mines and booby traps. 

c. Convoy organizations to include the location of— 

(1) Critical cargo vehicles. 

(2) Control vehicles. 

(3) Armored vehicles and automatic weapons. 

3-292 191-379-4407 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



Note. Armored vehicles and automatic weapons are positioned within the convoy 
so they are mutually supporting. 

(4) Maintenance and recovery vehicles. 

Note. The convoy commander and/or unit maintenance officer or 
noncommissioned officer (NCO) will decide whether to repair, recover, or destroy 
vehicles. 

d. Primary and backup frequencies. 

e. Emergency communications procedures. 

f. The timetable for movements (especially for serials and march 
units). 

g. Coordination points (assembly area for everyone). 

h. Start and release points. 

i. Security measures to be used at halts and rest stops. The location 
of the halts should be — 

(1) In a relatively secure area. 

(2) Off the roadway where there is some natural cover and 
concealment. 

(3) Under the surveillance of a security force. 

(4) Where there is an unobstructed view for 200 meters at each 
end of the convoy (no curves, hills, and so forth). 

(5) In an area that is large enough to maintain convoy interval. 

(6) Where local civilians can be kept away from the convoy. 

(7) In an area that is not heavily populated. 

(8) Where there are host nation police present (if applicable). 
Note. When carrying special weapons or ammunition, additional procedures 
covering the establishment of an exclusion area and the enforcement of the "two- 
man rule" must be covered and written in the special orders, ensuring 360-degree 
security is maintained on the special weapons. If security cannot be maintained, 
instructions on how and when to disable the weapons must be included. 

j. The time and place that military police (MP) support begins and 
ends. 

k. Expected changes in the routes. 

I. Road conditions. 

m.Supporting fires to include artillery support, engineer support (for 
minesweeping of the route), gunship support, and host nation police 
support, if applicable. 

n. Primary and alternate routes. 
Skill Level 3 191-379-4407 3-293 




Performance Steps 




o. The location where MP vehicles and personnel will be positioned 
in the convoy. 

p. The method of escort for the convoy. Escort methods are as 
follows: 

(1) Scout, lead, and trail (leading/following). 

(2) Empty truck (or modified). 

(3) Leap frog. 

(4) Perimeter. 

6. Brief personnel on the mission, enemy situation, and specific 
individual duties to be performed to include — 

a. Procedures to be followed in case of mechanical breakdown. 

b. Defensive measures to be used against mines and booby traps. 

c. Actions to be taken when there is contact with the enemy (see 
STP 1 9-95B1 -SM, Task 1 91 -376-41 10). 

d. The method of escort. 

e. Communications. 

f. Special orders if applicable. 

7. Coordinate with friendly units (in the area where the convoy will pass) 
to identify — 

a. The support the friendly units can provide. 

b. What restrictions apply for the use of indirect fire. 

8. Coordinate with artillery units. 

a. Identify predetermined targels found during route reconnaissance 
or through coordination with the convoy commander. 

b. Identify locations for rest stops, halts, and possible enemy ambush 
sites. 

9. Coordinate with helicopter and/or Air Force units for gunship support. 

10. Inspect equipment to include — 

a. Vehicles. 

b. Radios. 

c. Ammunition. 

d. Weapons. 

e. Nuclear, biological, and chemical (NBC) equipment. 

f. Combat load. 



3-294 191-379-4407 Skill Level 3 



Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Schedule a field training exercise that will require the squad leader to 
plan convoy security operations. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the squad leader being evaluated that he must develop an 
accurate and concise plan for convoy security operations. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 




1. Received the OPORD. 




Note: Followed all steps in troop-leading procedures. 




2. Coordinated with the host nation security personnel. 




3. Consulted all sources of information, especially the 
engineers and the HTD, to obtain as much information 
as possible. 




4. Reconnoitered the convoy route and identified the 
following: 






a. Likely trouble spots and ambush sites. 


b. Possible locations for TCPs and/or checkpoints. 




CO 


c. Route conditions. 




"3 

> 


d. Location of friendly units in the area. 




JS 


5. Coordinated with the convoy commander to 
determine — 




2 

CO 


Note. Ensured 360-degree security was maintained from the 
point of origin to destination when escorting special weapons. 




a. Actions to be taken if enemy contact was made. 


b. Protective measures for mines and booby traps. 






c. Convoy organizations. 




d. Primary and backup frequencies. 




e. Emergency communications procedures. 




f. The timetable for movements (especially for 
serials and march units). 




g. Coordination points (assembly area for 
everyone). 




h. Start and release points. 




i. Security measures to be used at halts and rest 
stops. 





Skill Level 3 191-379-4407 3-295 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

j. The time and place that MP support begins and 
ends. 

k. Expected changes in the routes. 



w 



I. Road conditions. 



m.Supporting fires to include artillery support, 
engineer support (for minesweeping of the route), 
gunship support, and host nation support, if applicable. 



n. Primary and alternate routes. 



o. The location where MP vehicles and personnel 
would be positioned in the convoy. 



p. The method of escort for the convoy. 



6. Briefed personnel on the mission, enemy situation, 
and specific individual duties to be performed. 



7. Coordinated with friendly units (in the area where the 
convoy would pass) to identify — 



a. The support the friendly units could provide. 



b. What restrictions applied for the use of indirect 
fire? 



o 8. Coordinated with artillery units. 
w 



9. Coordinated with helicopter and/or Air Force units for 
gunship support. 



10. Inspected equipment. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-19.1 FM 3-19.30 

FM 3-19.4 FM7-10 

FM 19-25 



3-296 191-379-4407 Skill Level 3 



301-371-1052 

Protect Classified Information and Material 

Conditions:This task can be performed in field and garrison locations 
under all conditions. Given classified documents and/or material, AR 380-5, 
local SOP, SF 700, Security Container Information, SF 702, Security 
Container Check Sheet, SF 703, Top Secret Cover Sheet, SF 704, Secret 
Cover Sheet, SF 705, Confidential Cover Sheet, DA Form 3964, Classified 
Documents Accountability Record, office equipment, and supplies. 

Standards: Safeguarded classified information and material to prevent 
unauthorized disclosure 1 00 percent of the time. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Identify classified material. 

Note. Information is any knowledge that can be communicated or documentary 
material, regardless of its physical form or characteristics, that is owned by, 
produced by or for, or is under the control of the U.S. Government. Unauthorized 
disclosure is a communication or physical transfer of classified information to an 
unauthorized recipient. 

a. List the security classification levels. 

(1) Confidential: Information that, if disclosed to unauthorized > 
persons, could reasonably be expected to cause damage to the national .3 
security. = 

(2) Secret: Information that, if disclosed to unauthorized persons, OT 
could reasonably be expected to cause serious damage to the national 
security. 

(3) Top Secret: Information that, if disclosed to unauthorized 
persons, could reasonably be expected to cause exceptionally grave 
damage to the national security. 

b. Define original and derivative classifications. 

(1) Original classification — an initial determination that information 
requires, in the interest of national security, protection against unauthorized 
disclosure. 

(2) Derivative classification — the incorporating, paraphrasing, 
restating, or generating in new form information that is already classified, 
and marking the newly developed material consistent with the classification 
markings that apply to the source information. 

2. Locate and read the declassification and downgrading instructions, 
which appear on a classified document. Define declassification and 
downgrading. 

a. Declassification — the authorized change in the status of information 
Skill Level 3 301-371-1052 3-297 



Performance Steps 




from classified information to unclassified information. 

(1) At the time of original classification, the original classification 
authority shall attempt to establish a specific date or event for 
declassification. 

Note. Information that already has been declassified and released to the public 
cannot be reclassified. 

(2) If a specific date or event for declassification cannot be 
determined, then information shall be marked for declassification 10 years 
from date of the original decision. 

(3) The original classification authority may extend the duration of 
classification for a successive period, not to exceed 1 years at a time. 

(4) At the time of original classification, the original classification 
authority may exempt for declassification within 1 years specific 
information that the unauthorized disclosure could reasonably be expected 
to cause damage to the national security. 

(5) Information shall be declassified as soon as it no longer meets 
the standards for classification. 

b. Downgrading — a determination by a declassification authority that 
information classified and safeguarded at a specific level shall be classified 
and safeguarded at a lower level. 

3. Review information for required identification and markings. 

Note. Classification markings w ill be in letters larger than those used in the rest of 
the text. 

a. Check the document for required markings: 

(1 ) Ensure the overall classification of the document is marked, 
stamped, or affixed permanently — 

(a) On the top and bottom of the outside front cover, 

(b) On the title page, 

(c) On the first page, 

(d) On the outside of the back cover. 

(2) Each interior page, except those left blank, will be marked on 
the top and bottom according to content, to include unclassified. 

(3) Each section, part, paragraph, or similar portion of a classified 
document will be marked to show the level of classification of the 
information contained by showing the appropriate classification symbol. 



3-298 301-371-1052 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(4) Charts, maps, and drawings will bear the appropriate 
classification markings for the legend, title, or scale block. The higher of 
these markings shall be inscribed at the top and bottom of each such 
document. 

(5) Photographs, films (including negatives), recordings, and their 
containers will be marked with the specific level of the information 
contained within. 

(6) Information used to simulate classified or unclassified material 
or documents will be marked clearly to indicate the actual unclassified 
status of the information (for example SECRET for Training Purposes 
Only). 

b. Examine all classified documents for completeness; ensure no 
parts or pages are missing. 

c. Ensure the following appears on the face of all classified 
information: 

(1) The overall classification of the document should be stamped 
top and bottom. 

(2) The identity, by name or personal identifier, and position of the 
original classification authority. 

(3) The agency and office of origin. 

(4) Declassification instructions. 

(5) Reason for classification. 
4. Protect classified information through restricted access. 

a. Define access — the ability or opportunity to gain knowledge of 
classified information. Access is based on — 

(1) Security clearance. Ensure that personal security clearance is 
equal to, or exceeds, the classification level of the material required to 
perform official duties. 

(2) Need-to-know. Ensure that a determination has been made by 
an authorized holder of classified information that the prospective recipient 
requires access to specific information to perform or assist in a lawful and 
authorized government function. 

Note. No one has a right to have access to classified information solely by virtue of 
rank or position. 

b. Prevent unauthorized persons from gaining access to classified 
material. 

(1) Keep all classified documents under constant observation when 
removed from storage. 

Skill Level 3 301-371-1052 3-299 




Performance Steps 




(2) Keep all documents face down or covered when not in use. 

(3) Place one of the following cover sheets on all classified 
material: 

(a) SF 705 for Confidential information. 

(b) SF 704 for Secret information. 

(c) SF 703 for Top Secret information. 

c. Define Special Access Program — a program established for a 
specific class of classified information that imposes safeguarding and 
access requirements that exceed those normally required for information at 
the same classification level. 

5. Safeguard classified information and material. 

a. Use proper precautions to protect classified information and 
material: 

(1) Safeguard classified information when temporarily departing the 
work area. 

(2) Prevent display of classified information in public places. 

(3) Use the following procedures when working papers containing 
classified information are created: 

(a) Date the document. 

(b) Mark the document with the words "working papers." 

(c) Mark each page, top and bottom, according to the content 
classification. 

(d) Bring working papers under control as a finished document 
when — 

(i) Retained more than 90 days from date of origin. 

(ii) Released outside the originator's agency. 

(iii) Transmitted electrically or electronically. 

(iv) Filed permanently. 

(v) Papers contain top secret information. 

6. Comply with security regulations when discussing classified 
information. 

a. Do not discuss classified and/or sensitive information on an 
unsecured telephone. 

b. Use the following procedures when presenting a classified briefing: 

(1) Ensure that the briefing area has been cleared to the highest 
level of material to be discussed. 

3-300 301-371-1052 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



(2) Check the attendance roster to ensure all personnel are cleared 
and have a need-to-know. 

(3) Establish a sign-in roster at the main entrance to the briefing 
area and control access at all other entrances. 

(4) Ensure that all training aids are marked with security 
classification according to their content. 

(5) Inform the audience of the security classification of the briefing 
and the policy concerning note taking at the beginning of the briefing. 

(6) Repeat the security classification at the end of the briefing. 

c. Ensure that automated information systems, including networks and 
telecommunications systems, that collect, create, communicate, compute, 
disseminate, process, or store classified information must have controls 
that— 

(1) Prevent access by unauthorized persons. 

(2) Ensure the integrity of the information. 
7. Protect classified information during transport. 

a. Do not remove classified information from official premises without 
proper authorizations. 

b. Protect classified information when transporting outside of a 
secured area. 

(1) Address classified information to an official government activity 
or DOD contractor with a facility clearance and not to an individual. 

(2) Pack classified information in such a manner that the text will 
not be in contact with the inner envelope or container. 

(3) Attach or enclose a receipt, DA Form 3964, in the inner 
envelope or container for all SECRET and TOP SECRET information. 
CONFIDENTIAL information requires a receipt only if the originator deems 
it necessary. 

(4) Double wrap classified information in opaque envelopes or 
similar wrappings. 

(a) Mark the inner envelope with the overall classification of 
the contents, and any special instructions. 

(b) Mark the inner and outer envelope with the complete 
sender's and receiver's address. 

(c) Do not mark the outer envelope with any indications of the 
contents or the classification. 

(d) Do not display classified material in public places while 
transporting. 

Skill Level 3 301-371-1052 3-301 




Performance Steps 




(e) Do not store classified material in any detachable storage 
compartment, such as automobile trailers or luggage racks while 
transporting. 

8. Protect classified information during transmission. 

a. Transmit classified information and material according to the 
security classification level, as specified in AR 380-5. Transmit classified 
material by — 

(1) Approved courier services. 

(2) U.S. military personnel. 

(3) Government employees. 

(4) DOD contractors. 

(5) U.S. Postal Service. 

(6) Electronic transmission over secure lines using encryption. 

b. Ensure the appropriate contracting officer has authorized 
transmission in writing. 

c. Ensure TOP SECRET and SECRET classified information remain 
in constant custody and protection of the courier at all times. 

9. Safeguard classified material when in storage. 

a. Store classified information under conditions adequate to prevent 
unauthorized access. 

b. Store typewriter ribbons, computer disks, notes, and similar 
materials that are classified or used to process classified information, in a 
locked GSA approved security container, when not under the personal 
control and observation of an authorized person. 

c. Follow correct procedures when locking material in a GSA 
approved security container: 

(1) Complete SF 702 correctly, with the proper date, time, and 
initials. 

(2) Turn the "OPEN/CLOSED" sign on the front of the security 
container to the "CLOSED" position. 

(3) Ensure that another person checks the container to make sure 
it is locked and initials the SF 702. 

10. Use the following procedures when discovering an open or unattended 
security container. 

a. Keep the container or area under guard or surveillance. 



3-302 301-371-1052 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



b. Notify one of the persons listed on Part 1 of SF 700 attached to the 
inside of the security container drawer. If one of these individuals cannot 
be contacted, the duty officer, security manager, or other appropriate 
official will be notified. 

1 1 . Report possible compromise of classified information. List individual 
responsibilities in cases of suspected compromise: 

a. Any person having knowledge of the loss or possible compromise 
of classified information will immediately report it to their security manager, 
S2, or commanding officer (CO). 

b. Any person who discovers classified information out of proper 
control will take custody of the information, safeguard it, and immediately 
report to their security manager, S2, or CO. 

c. The security manager, S2, or CO will initiate a preliminary inquiry to 
determine the circumstances surrounding the loss or possible compromise 
of classified information and establish one of the following: 

(1 ) The loss or compromise of classified information did not occur. 

(2) The loss or compromise did occur but the compromise 
reasonably could not be expected to cause damage to the national 
security. 

(3) The loss or compromise of classified information did occur and 
that the compromise reasonably could be expected to cause damage to 
the national security. 

d. The security manager or S2 will report the circumstances of the 
compromise to the appropriate authority: 

(1) HQDA (DAMI-CIS) when dealing with SECRET and TOP 
SECRET information. 

(2) Commander when dealing with CONFIDENTIAL information. 

e. A further investigation may be initiated if warranted. 

12. Use proper procedures when destroying classified information. 

a. Destroy classified information in a way sufficient to preclude 
recognition or reconstruction. 

(1) Destroy classified information by burning, melting, chemical 
decomposition, pulping, pulverizing, cross-cut shredding, or mutilation. 

(2) Burning is the preferred method of destroying classified 
information. 

b. Complete DA Form 3964, Record of Destruction, for TOP SECRET 
information. Records shall be dated and signed at the time of destruction. 



Skill Level 3 301-371-1052 3-303 





Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide the soldier with the materials listed in the CONDITIONS 

statement. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier to protect the classified material. 

Note to the trainer. If this task is to be evaluated during training, prepare 
and provide the soldier material that is classified "FOR TRAINING 
PURPOSES ONLY." Ensure that the material is marked to this effect. The 
soldier must receive a GO on all items to receive a GO on this task. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Identified classification of classified material. 



2. Located and read the declassification and 
downgrading instructions. 



3. Marked documents with all required identification 
and markings, or corrected incorrect markings. 



4. Restricted access to classified information: 



a. Determined the requirement for access before 
releasing classified material to other persons: 



(1) Determined the need-to-know. 



(2) Determined security clearance. 



b. Prevented unauthorized persons from gaining 
access to classified material. 

(1) Kept all classified documents under constant 
observation when removed from storage. 

(2) Kept documents face down or covered when 
not in use. 

(3) Took appropriate measures when uncleared 
personnel entered the work area. 

5. Placed appropriate cover sheets on classified 
material. 



6. Safeguarded classified information and material. 



a. Safeguarded classified information when 
temporarily departing the work area. 



b. Prevented display of classified information in 
public places. 



c. Used correct procedures when creating 
classified working papers. 



3-304 301-371-1052 Skill Level 3 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 




7. Complied with security regulations when discussing 
classified information. 


a. Refrained from classified and/or sensitive 
information on an unsecured telephone. 


b. Used correct security procedures when 
presenting a classified briefing. 


c. Used proper controls when using automated 
information systems. 


8. Protected classified information during transport. 


9. Identified reference delineating correct transmission 
procedures. 


10. Locked classified material in an appropriate security 
container, when not in use. 




a. Locked and/or checked security container. 


b. Initialed and dated SF 702. 




c. Turned sign to "CLOSED" position. 


CO 


1 1 .Took appropriate action upon discovery of possible 
compromise of classified information. 


<u 

> 

J5 


12. Completed DA Form 3964, and determined best 
destruction method for documents of various 
classifications. 


2 
CO 


a. Listed three methods of destruction. 


b. Identified the two standards of destruction. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 380-5 

805C-PAD-3594 

Store Classified Information and Materials 

Conditions:You are a squad/section leader. Given classified material, 
storage containers, and AR 380-5. 

Skill Level 3 805C-PAD-3594 3-305 




Standards: Classified information and materials were placed in appropriate 
storage containers. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine storage and safekeeping requirements. 

a. Determine security containers . 

b. Determine locks. 

c. Determine access authorizations . 

2. Maintain physical security. 

a. Establish responsibility for securing and controlling classified area. 

b. Establish records for recording security of classified materials. 

c. Train section personnel on security requirements for classified 
materials. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task give a scenario that would require soldier to 
perform the performance measures. This will requiresimulated containers, 
locks, DA Form 702, a list of section personnel with varying security 
clearances, documents marked with various levels of security classification 
(marked "classified for training purposes only"), format for security check 
assignment, and classified document covers. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to select the 
appropriate container for each document concerned and indicate who would 
have access to which container. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Determined storage and safekeeping requirements. 



a. Determined proper security containers. 



b. Determined proper locks . 



c. Determined who had access authorization. 



2. Maintained physical security. 



a. Established responsibility for securing and 
controlling classified area. 

b. Established records for recording security of 

classified materials. 

c. Trained section personnel on security 
requirements for classified materials. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 

3-306 805C-PAD-3594 Skill Level 3 



soldier must score a GO on all of the performance measures to receive a 
GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 380-5 



SUBJECT AREA 24: ENEMY PERSONNEL 



191-379-4450 

Supervise Handling of Enemy Personnel and Eq uipment at Squad 
Level 

Conditions:You are a squad leader in a field environment, given a squad of 
soldiers, DD Form 2745, and enemy prisoners of war (EPWs) with 
equipment and weapons. 

Standards: Ensured soldiers searched, segregated, silenced, speeded, 
safeguarded, and tagged (5 Ss and T) EPWs according to FM 3-19.40. " 

Performance Steps > 



1 . Search captives. 

a. Thoroughly search each captive and confiscate any weapons, 
ammunition, military equipment, and items with intelligence value and 
record on DD Form 2745. 

Note. Any weapons or ammunition that are impractical to retain should be destroyed 
in place after recording what the items were. 

b. Allow captives to keep personal property (except items that could 
be used as weapons or that could have intelligence value) of nominal or 
sentimental value, such as wedding rings. Personal property also includes 
chemical protective equipment (if in a chemical environment or a potential 
chemical environment), helmets, and identification cards. Allow the 
EPW/civilian internee (CI) to retain his own rations in the early stages of 
captivity. 

Note. Conduct same gender searches when possible; however, this may not always 
be possible due to speed and security considerations. Therefore, mixed gender 
searches must be performed in a respectful manner using all possible measures to 
prevent any action that could be interpreted as sexual molestation or assault. The 
squad leader must carefully control soldiers doing mixed gender searches to prevent 
allegations of sexual misconduct. This does not mean the search will not be 
thorough, as the safety of you and your soldiers comes first. 

2. Segregate captives. 

Skill Level 3 191-379-4450 3-307 



3 

en 



Performance Steps 




a. Segregate by rank (officers, noncommissioned officers [NCOs], or 
enlisted), sex (male and female), civilian and military and, when possible, 
nationalities and/or ideologies. 

b. Segregate captives who surrendered willingly or who deserted from 
those who resisted capture. 

c. Segregate captives who cannot be readily identified as belonging to 
one of the above listed groups. 

d. Segregate captives who do not provide the information needed to 
make a correct classification, until their status can be determined. 

3. Ensure that each captive has DD Form 2745. 

a. Ensure that the form contains the following: 

(1) Date and time of the capture. 

(2) Grid coordinates of the capture. 

(3) Capturing unit. 

(4) Circumstances of the capture. 

b. Use either DD Form 2745 or a locally produced three-part form. 
Figure 191 -379-4450-1 shows what the form looks like. Instructions for the 
use of this form are on the reverse side of the form. 

(1) Place part A of the form on the captive and instruct him not to 
remove or alter it. 

(2) Place part C of the form on the bag or bundle of property taken 
from the captive. 

(3) Maintain part B of the form, as you are the capturing unit. 



3-308 191-379-4450 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



ENEMY PRISONER OF WAR (EPW) 
CAPTURE TAG {PART A) 



Attach this part of tag to EPW. (Da not remove 
from EPW.) 

1 . Search - For weapons, military documents, or 
special equipment. 

2. SHance - Prohibit talking among EPWs for ease 
of control. 

3. Segregate - By rank, sex, and nationality. 

4. Safeguard - To prevent harm or escape. 

5. Speed - Evacuate from the combat zone. 

6. Tag - Prisoners and documents or special 
equipment. 



DO FORM 274* Rim MAY M 



UNIT RECORD CARD (PART B) 



Forward to Unit. 
(Capturing unit retains for records.) 



Use string, wire, or other durable material 
to attach the appropriate section of this 
form to the EPW's equipment or property. 



DO FOflM 2748 BACH, MAY M 



DOCUMENT/SPECIAL EQUIPMENT 
WEAPONS CARD (PART C) 

Attach this part of tag to property taken. (Do not 
remove from property.) 

As a minimum, the tag must include the following 

Information: 

Item 1 . Date and time of capture (YYYYMMDD). 
Item 8. Capturing unit. 
ItemS. Place of capture {grid coordinates). 
Item 1 0. Circumstances of capture (how the EPW 
was captured). 



DO FORM 274S (BACK), MAY H 



1. DAnANDTMlMCAttuU ' ' 


2. SENALNO. 

A 


3. NAME 


.. «..-™ 


6 RANK 




7. UNIT OF EPW 


*. CAPTURING UNIT 


». LOCATION OF CAPTURE /Grid eoorttnmti 


1 0. CIRCUMSTANCES OF 
CAPTURE 


11 PHYSICAL CON- 
DITION OF EPW 


1 Z WEAPONS. EQUIP- 
MENT. DOCUMENTS 



1. DATE AND TlMl Of CAPTURE 


2. sefsaLno. ~ 

B 


3. NAME 


4. DATE OF WITH 


6. RANK 


• SERVICE NO. 


7. UNIT OF EPW 


8. CAPTURING UNIT 


». LOCATION OF CAPTURE KM* «onittMM*> 


CAPTURE 


11. PHYSICAL CON- 


1 1. WEAPONS. EQUIP 
MENT. DOCUMENTS 



DO FORM 274B, MAY M 





Twocm. rr 

c 






4. DATEOFMRTH 




«. SERVICE HO. 




a. CAPTVRINa UWT 




LOCATION OF CAPTURE (GrU rar.lh.lW 


10, UfcSUMPI ION OF WEAPONS. SPECIAL EQUIPMENT. DOCUMENTS 



DD FORM 2746, MAV M 



Figure 191-379-4450-1. Sample of DD Form 2745 




4. Report the acquisition of captives through your chain of command. 

5. Safeguard each captive until they are released to the military police 
(MP). 

6. Evacuate captives to the rear and turn them over to the MP as soon as 
possible. Do not delay evacuation to obtain name, rank, service number, or 
date of birth. 

a. Ensure that you receive receipts from the MP for the captives 
transferred to them. 



Skill Level 3 



191-379-4450 



3-309 



Performance Steps 



b. Give items taken from the captives (for security and/or intelligence 
reasons) to the MP, ensuring that each item is tagged by the MP to identify 
the owner. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Position soldiers to perform the mission. Have one or more soldiers 
to act as EPWs. Provide weapons and equipment for the role players. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the squad leader to instruct the soldiers on what they are 
to do and have the soldiers actually perform the steps necessary to 
complete the task. Tell the captive that he needs to follow instructions. Tell 
the soldiers acting as the squad not to continue to the next step until they 
are told to do so by the squad leader. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 




1. Searched captives. 



2. Segregated captives. 



3. Ensured that each captive had DD Form 2745. 



4. Reported the acquisition of captives through the 
chain of command. 



5. Safeguarded each captive until they were released 
to the MP. 



6. Evacuated captives to the rear and turned them 
over to the MP as soon as possible. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

AR 190-8 
DD Form 2745 
FM 3-19.40 
STAN AG 2044 



3-310 191-379-4450 Skill Level 3 



SUBJECT AREA 27: RISK MANAGEMENT 



850-001-3001 

Control Mission Safety Hazard 

Conditions: As a company level senior leader, in a garrison or tactical 
environment, given a subordinate who has received a mission or task. 
Standards: Verified that a risk assessment had been conducted, controls 
had been developed and properly implemented, the overall risk level for the 
mission or task was acceptable, and that the controls were effectively 
monitored. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Verify a risk assessment has been conducted. 

a. Ensure that all hazards associated with the mission or task have 
been identified. 

b. Ensure the level of risk for each hazard was correctly estimated. 

2. Verify controls have been developed and properly implemented. 

a. Ensure appropriate controls have been developed. 

b. Ensure the residual risk for each hazard and the overall residual 
risk for the mission or task is acceptable. 

c. Ensure controls have been properly implemented. 

3. Verify how the controls will be monitored. 

a. Verify the technique for monitoring the controls. 

b. Verify how well the controls and the risk management process 
worked. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, you will need a completed risk assessment for 
a mission task. It will be necessary to develop a short OPORD or FRAGO 
with a scenario for a commonly used combat operation (such as a road 
march, move to contact) that contains a minimum of one hazard. Develop a 
complete written risk assessment to represent an assessment, which a 
subordinate has performed. The risk assessment must include the level of 
risk, the controls, the residual risk for each hazard, and the overall residual 
risk for the mission. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier you are going to evaluate him on his ability to 
supervise the implementation of the risk management process. 



Skill Level3 850-001-3001 3-311 





Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Verified that all the hazards associated with the 

mission or task (a minimum of one, depending on the 

mission or task) had been identified. 

2. Verified the level of risk for each hazard was 
correctly estimated. 



3. Verified the controls for each hazard. 



E- 



4. Verified the residual risk for each hazard and the 
overall residual risk for the mission or task was 
acceptable. 



5. Verified methods for implementing the controls. 



6. Verified controls were effective. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show what was done wrong 
and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 100-14 
FM 101-5 



SUBJECT AREA 28: ADMINISTRATION/MANAGEMENT 



805C-PAD-3147 

Prepare the Senior Rater's Portion of a Noncommissioned Officer 
Evaluation Report (NCOER) 

Conditions: You are a supervisor and must senior rate one of your 
subordinate NCOs. You are given a partially completed DA Form 2166-8, 
AR 623-205, paper, and pen/pencil. 

Standards: All elements of the senior rater portion of the NCOER were 
completed with comments entered in bullet style, and justification entered 
where required. 



Performance Steps 



1 . Determine if eligible to render report. 

2. Verify rater has completed all entries and comments. 

3-312 805C-PAD-3147 Skill Level 3 



Performance Steps 



Note. Refer to AR 623-205 for actions required if these were not completed. 

a. Return NCOER to rater if all entries and comments are not 
completed. 

b. Return NCOER to rater if entries are incorrectly completed. 

3. Enter Ratings: 

a. Enter bullet comments in Block Ve, if senior rater qualifications are 
met. 

(1) Enter bullet comments addressing marginal ratings in Part Va. 

(2) Enter bullet comments addressing fair or poor ratings in Part 
Vc. 

(3) Enter comments focusing on potential, performance, and/or 
rater evaluation. 

b. Enter "senior rater does not meet minimum qualifications" in Block 
Ve if applicable. 

c. Enter overall performance evaluation in Block Vc if senior rater 
qualifications met. 

d. Enter overall potential for promotion and retention in Block Vd if 
senior rater qualifications are met. 

4. Sign the NCOER in Part II, Block b. 

5. Obtain rated NCO's signature in Part II, Block c. 

6. Forward NCOER to reviewer. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task provide the soldier with a partially completed DA 
Form 21 66-8, AR 623-205, pencil, and paper. Give a scenario that would 
require a soldier to ensure that all of the rater's entries are correct and 
provide enough information about individuals to allow for ratings. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be evaluated on his ability to 
prepare the senior rater's portion of a Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation 
Report (NCOER) 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Determined if eligible to render report. 




2. Verified rater completed all entries and comments. 



Note. Referred to AR 623-205 for actions required if these 
were not completed. 

a. Returned NCOER to rater if all entries and 
comments were not completed. 

Skill Level 3 805C-PAD-3147 3-313 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

b. Returned NCOER to rater if entries were 
incorrectly completed. 

3. Entered ratings — 



a. Entered bullet comments in Block Ve if senior 
rater qualifications were met. 



(1) Entered bullet comments addressing 
marginal ratings in Part Va. 



(2) Entered bullet comments addressing fair or 
poor ratings in Part Vc. 

(3) Entered comments focusing on potential, 
performance, and/or rater evaluation. 

b. Entered "senior rater does not meet minimum 
qualifications " in Block Ve if applicable. 

c. Entered overall performance evaluation in Block 
Vc if senior rater qualifications were met. 

d. Entered overall potential for promotion and 
retention in Block Vd if senior rater qualifications were 
met. 

4. Signed Part II, Block b. 



5. Acquired rated soldier's signature in Part II, Block c. 



6. Forwarded NCOER to reviewer. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on performance measures 1 to 4 to receive a GO 
on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 623-205 Software-FormFlow 

DA Form 21 66-8 Software-Office 

Software-Windows 



3-314 805C-PAD-3147 Skill Level 3 



Skill Level 4 



SUBJECT AREA 2: FIRST AID 



081-831-1047 

Supervise the Implementation of Preventive Medicine Policies 

Conditions:You are a leader in a unit performing a mission in a field 
environment. You are responsible to ensure personnel employ preventive 
medicine measures (PMMs) to protect themselves from disease and 
nonbattle injuries. 

Standards: Ensured soldiers applied PMMs, as appropriate, to protect 
against cold, heat, biting insects, diarrhea and dysentery, hearing loss, skin 
infections, sexually transmitted diseases (STD), acquired immunodeficiency 
syndrome (AIDS), and foot problems. Ensured soldiers practiced good oral 
hygiene and properly dispos ed of waste. Ensured that the Army tobacco 
use policies were applied. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Ensure proper preventive medicine measures (PMM) are followed for 
protection against cold injuries. 
a. Wear layers of loose clothing. 

Note. Minimize sweating. When clothing becomes wet or dirty, it loses its ability to 
provide warmth. 

(1) Remove layers of clothing before doing strenuous work. 



WARNING 

Do not remove protective clothing in a chemical environment. 



(2) Replace layers of clothing when your strenuous work is 
completed. 

(3) Launder clothing regularly. 

b. Exercise to increase blood circulation. 

(1) Tighten and relax arm and leg muscles, fingers, and toes. 

(2) Use hands to massage and warm the face. 



WARNING 

Physical and mental weariness contribute to inactivity, reduced heat, 
and increased chance for cold injury. 



(3) Refrain from smoking. Smoking decreases blood flow to the skin 
Skill Level 4 081-831-1047 3-315 




Performance Steps 



c. Change socks. 

(1) Put on dry socks during rest breaks to reduce the risk of frostbite 




and trench foot. 



WARNING 

Severe frostbite and trench foot can result in the loss of hands or feet. 



(2) Put damp socks inside your shirt around your waist to dry. 

d. Prevent dehydration. 

(1) Drink sufficient fluids (potable water, juices, and warm 
nonalcoholic beverages). 

Note. Drinking a sufficient amount of potable water in cold weather is as important as 
it is in hot weather. In cold weather, you may not realize that your body is losing fluids 
and salt. Sweat evaporates rapidly or is absorbed so completely by the layers of 
clothing that it is seldom visible on the skin. 

(2) Rest when possible. 

e. Pair with a buddy. 

(1 ) Remind each other to do warming exercises often. 

(2) Watch for signs of cold injury such as frostbite, trench foot, and 
hypothermia. 

2. Ensure proper PMMs are followed for protection against heat injuries . 

a. Drink sufficient amounts of water. 
Note. Your body needs a minimum amount of water for cooling, waste elimination, 
and metabolism. Any attempt to train the body to use less water can be harmful and 
may lead to heat injuries. 



3-316 081-831-1047 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



(1) Use the fluid replacement policy for warm weather table as a 
guide (see tables 081-831-1047-1 and 081-831-1047-2). 



Table 081-831-1047- L *Fluid Replacement Policy for Warm Weather 
(Average Acclimated Soldier Wearing BDU, Hot Weather) 




Easy Work 


Moderate Work 


Hard Work 


Heat 
Category 


WBGT 
Index, *F 


Work/ 
Rest 


Water 
Intake, 
Qt/Hr 


Work/ 
Rest 


Water 
Intake, 
Qt/Hr 


Work/ 
Rest 


Water 
Intake, 
Qt/Hr 


1* 


78-81.9 


NL 


Vi 


NL 


% 


40/20 min 


% 


2 (green) 


82-84.9 


NL 


Vi 


50/10 min 


% 


30/30 min 




3 (yellow) 


85-87.9 


NL 


% 


40/20 min 


% 


30/30 




4 (red) 


88-89.9 


NL 


% 


30/30 min 


% 


20/40 min 




5** (black) 


>90 


50/10 min 


1 


20/40 min 


1 


10/50 




CAUTION 

Hourly Fluid Intake Should Not Exceed VA> Quarts. Daily Fluid Intake Should Not 
Exceed 12 Quarts. 


*The work/rest times and fluid replacement volumes will sustain performance and 

hydration for at least 4 hours of work in the specified heat category. Individual water 

needs will vary ± Vi quart per hour. 

*NL = no limit to work time per hour. Rest means minimal physical activity (sitting or 

standing) and should be accomplished in shade if possible. 

'Wearing body armor adds 5° F to WBGT Index. 

Wearing ALL MOPP overgarments adds 10° F to WBGT Index. 

"Suspend physical training and strenuous activity. If an operational (nontraining) 

mission requires strenuous activity, enforce water intake to minimize expected heat 

injuries. 




Skill Level 4 



081-831-1047 



3-317 



Performance Steps 



Table 081-831-1047-2, Examples of Categories of Work 


Easy Work 


Moderate Work 


Hard Work 


• Weapon maintenance. 

• Walking on hard 


• Walking on loose sand 
at 2.5 mph, no load. 


• Walking on loose sand 
at 2.5 mph with load. 


surface at 2.5 mph, 
< 30-pound load. 

• Manual of arms. 

• Marksmanship training. 

• Drill and ceremony. 


• Walking on hard 
surface at 3.5 mph, 
< 40-pound load. 

• Calisthenics. 

• Patrolling. 

• Individual movement 
techniques, i.e. low 
crawl, high crawl. 

• Defensive position 
construction. 

• Field assaults. 


• Walking on hard 
surface at 3.5 mph, 
> 40-pound load. 




(2) Drink extra water before combat operations. 

(3) Maintain excess water in your system for strength and alertness. 

(4) Protect yourself from dehydration and heat injuries associated 
with wearing full chemical protective gear. 

b. Rest whenever possible. 

(1) Take rest breaks in accordance with the heat condition table as 
the tactical situation permits. 

(2) Use rest breaks to drink water and to cool off. 

c. Eat meals. 

(1 ) Eat regular meals daily to replace salt lost through heavy 
sweating. 

(2) Eat something at each meal, even if you are not hungry. 

Note. Usually, eating field rations or liberal salting of the garrison diet will provide 
enough salt. Excess intake of salt should be avoided. 

d. Protect yourself from exposure. 

(1) Wear uniform properly. 

(2) Provide shade whenever possible. 

(3) Use barrier creams and lotions. 

3. Ensure proper PMMs are followed for protection against biting insects. 



3-318 



081-831-1047 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



a. Apply extended-duration repellent lotion — 

Note. Extended-duration repellent lotion is a preparation that can be used on the 
skin. 

(1) On exposed skin except the eyes, lips, and sensitive skin. 

(2) Two inches under edges of battle dress uniform (BDU). 

(3) Keep away from flame or excessive heat. 

(4) Wipe hands after application. 

Note. Repeat the above application every 6 hours during strenuous activity and soon 
after any activity that washes away the repellent (such as stream crossings). 

Note. Do not wear after-shave lotion or cologne in the field; they attract biting or 
stinging arthropods (insects). 

b. Apply permethrin aerosol clothing repellent. 

(1) Use only on fabric. 

(2) Do not apply to skin. 

(3) Do not treat BDUs while being worn. 

(4) Treat outside of BDU, insect head net, and mosquito bed net. 

(5) Do not treat underwear or inside the cap. 

(6) Avoid breathing vapors. 

(7) Dry clothing (BDUs) thoroughly prior to wearing. 

c. Wear uniform properly. 

(1) Tuck pant legs into boots, roll sleeves down, and close collar. 

(2) Wear uniform loosely. 

(3) Check clothing frequently. 

(4) Use buddy system to check areas of body not easily seen during 
self-examination. 

d. Take malaria pills to protect against malaria parasites. (Use in the 
manner prescribed for your unit.) 

e. Clean and inspect yourself. 

(1) Wash yourself daily or as often as the tactical situation permits. g 

(2) Use the buddy system to check each other for ticks and for j 
arthropod bites. (If ticks are found attached or if insect bites are found, seek j= 
medical attention.) « 

(3) Use insecticide powder, cream, or shampoo when prescribed by 
medical personnel. 

f. Clean and inspect your clothing. 



Skill Level 4 081-831-1047 3-319 



Performance Steps 




(1) Wash your uniform to remove arthropods and their eggs. 

(2) Use available military laundry service or scrub your clothing 
yourself with soap and water. 

g. Use your bed net when sleeping. 

(1) Suspend bed net above sleeping area. 

(2) Tuck edges of bed net under the sleeping pad or bag. 

(3) Treat the bed net with permethrin aerosol clothing repellent. 

(4) Spray interior space with resmethrin. 

(5) Avoid breathing vapors. 

(6) Do not use permethrin clothing repellent or resmethrin on skin. 

4. Ensure proper PMMs are followed for protection against diarrhea and 
dysentery. 

a. Identify the indications of diarrhea and dysentery. 

Note. Diarrhea is an intestinal disorder characterized by abnormally frequent and 
watery bowel movements. 

Note. Dysentery is an infectious disease characterized by stomach pain and diarrhea 
with passage of mucus and blood. 

b. Purify your drinking water if treated water is not available. 

Note. Before using iodine tablets, check them for physical change. If they are old, 
they can lose their disinfecting ability. Tablets that are not uniformly steel gray or that 
are stuck together or crumbled should not be used. 

(1) Fill your canteen with the cleanest, clearest water available. 

(2) Add iodine tablets. 

(a) Add two tablets to a one-quart canteen of water. 

(b) Double the amount of tablets if a two-quart canteen is used. 

(3) Replace the cap. 

(4) Wait five minutes for the tablets to dissolve. 

(5) Shake the canteen to mix the contents. 

(6) Disinfect the canteen cap threads. 

(a) Loosen the cap. 

(b) Tip the canteen over and squeeze to allow leakage around 
the canteen threads. 

(c) Turn the canteen right side up. 

(d) Tighten the cap. 

(7) Wait 30 additional minutes before drinking. 

3-320 081-831-1047 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



c. Obtain food and drink from an approved source. 

(1) Obtain food, drink, and ice only from medically approved 
sources. 

Note. Do not obtain food, drink, and ice from vendors unless they have been 
approved by medical personnel. 

(2) Obtain food from the dining facility when possible. 

d. Wash your hands for at least 30 seconds — 

(1) After using the latrine. 

(2) Before touching eating utensils or food. 

(3) After eating. 

(4) After smoking. 

e. Dispose of food waste properly. 

(1) Use covered container to keep out pests and to prevent breeding 
of flies. 

(2) Use plastic bags in the event you have dumpster-type 
receptacles and regular waste pick-up. 

(3) Bury in the event you are in the field and do not have waste pick- 
up or other disposal methods available. 

Note. Before burying any waste, obtain prior approval by contacting either the 
logistics or the preventive medicine section. 

5. Ensure proper PMMs are followed for protection against hearing loss. 

a. Wear protective devices such as earplugs, ear canal caps, or 
earmuffs. 

b. Wear vehicle headgear such as helicopter crew helmets and 
armored vehicle crew helmets. 

c. Keep hearing protection devices clean to avoid ear infections. 

d. Avoid noise and/or limit the time in noise hazardous areas. 

6. Ensure proper PMMs are followed to prevent skin infections. 

a. Bathe frequently. Take a full bath at least once every week. If 
showers or baths are not available, use a washcloth daily to wash — 

(1) Your genital area. 

(2) Your armpits. 

(3) Your feet. 

(4) Other areas where you sweat or that become wet (between 
thighs or [for females] under breasts). 

p. Keep skin dry. 

Skill Level 4 081-831-1047 3-321 




Performance Steps 




(1) Use foot powder on your feet (especially if you have had fungal 
infections in the past). 

(2) Use talcum powder in areas where wetness is a problem. 
(Cornstarch may be used as a substitute for talcum powder.) 

c. Change to clean clothing after a full bath. 

(1) Wear loose-fitting uniforms to allow for better ventilation and 
blood circulation. 

(2) Wear proper clothing. 

Note. Do not wear nylon or silk-type undergarments. Cotton undergarments allow 
more evaporation of moisture. 

d. Shave facial hair often enough to be clean shaven (males only) to 
allow a tight fit of the protective mask. 

7. Ensure proper PMMs are followed for care for the feet. 

a. Before movement. 

(1) Wear the proper type of footgear, correctly fitted and broken in. 

(2) Wear clean socks that are free of holes or knotty darns. 

(3) Use foot powder and clean socks. 

(4) Treat and protect blisters, pressure spots, and infections before 
movement. 

b. During movement. 

(1) Keep feet as dry as possible. 

(2) Change socks (if possible) for dry ones when they become damp 
or wet. 

(3) Dry socks by putting them inside your shirt around your waist. 

(4) Relieve tender pressure spots on the feet by adjusting gear. 

(5) Dust the feet with foot powder once or twice daily. 

c. Inspect feet at rest periods. 

(1) Wash feet during the noon break if possible. 

(2) Raise feet while resting to help reduce congestion and swelling. 

d. Take care of blisters. 

(1 ) Wash the blister and the surrounding area with soap and water. 

(2) Seek medical treatment for painful blisters or signs of infection 
such as redness, throbbing, and drainage. 

8. Ensure soldiers practice good oral hygiene. 

a. Brush your teeth after every meal if possible. 

3-322 081-831-1047 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



b. Use dental floss at least once a day. 

c. Rinse your mouth with potable water after brushing and flossing. 

9. Ensure soldiers are informed about protection against STD. 

a. Use a prophylactic (condom). 

Note. Individuals should use a condom during sexual intercourse when there is a 
possibility of acquiring an infection. 

b. Urinate immediately after intercourse. 

c. Wash well with soap and water. 

Note. Females should not douche unless directed to do so by medical personnel. 

10. Ensure soldiers are informed about protection against AIDS. 

Note. AIDS is contagious in the same way as STDs are contagious. Infection can 
result from a sexual relationship with an infected person. Sexual contact is not the 
only way to contract AIDS but is a major contributor. 

a. Prevent sexual transmission — know your partner. 

(1) Avoid having sex with multiple partners. 

(2) Avoid having sex with persons who might be carriers of the AIDS 
virus (high-risk groups include homosexual and bisexual persons and 
intravenous drug users). 

b. Prevent transmission through shared needles or syringes — do not 
inject illicit drugs. 

Note. There is presently no cure for AIDS and no vaccine to prevent AIDS. 

1 1 . Ensure proper PMMs are followed for disposal of waste. 

a. For human waste — 
(1) Use unit latrine. 



(2) Use cat-hole latrine. 






(a) Use only on the march. 






(b) Cover immediately after use. 






(3) Use a straddle trench for 1 to 3 day bivouac. 




^ , 


b. For other waste — 




<D 


(1) Bury — less than one week in the field. 




J5 


(2) Incinerate — longer than one week in the field. 




!2 


12. Apply Army tobacco use policies. 




CO 


a. Long term and immediate adverse effects of tobacco use. 




(1) Leading preventable cause underlying death in 


the United States 




is tobacco use. 







Skill Level 4 081-831-1047 3-323 



Performance Steps 




(2) Heart disease, cancer, emphysema, stroke. 

b. Tobacco use in the military. 

(1) Decreases readiness, night vision, hand-eye coordination, and 
stamina. 

(2) Increases cold weather injuries and number of injuries. 

(3) Leads to addiction. 

c. Army tobacco use policy. 

(1) AR 600-63. 

(2) Smoking is not permitted in DA-space except in designated 
areas. 

(3) Healthy People 2000 priorities — 

(a) Reduce military smokers to 20 percent. 

(b) Reduce smokeless tobacco use to 4 percent for age groups 
between 12 and 24. 

d. Sources to help soldiers become tobacco-free. 

(1) Medical professionals. 

(2) Local preventive medicine service. 

(3) American Cancer Society. 

(4) Nicotine gum, nicotine patches. 

(5) Family and unit support. 

13. Identify division PM section missions to support field forces. 

a. Identify breakdowns in PMM (individual and leader/unit). 

b. Inform commanders on specific measures to repair the breakdowns. 

c. Provide technical assistance for training the unit FSTs. 

d. Monitor training of individual and unit PMM. 

e. Perform limited sanitation and vector control work. 

14. Identify corps-level PM missions to support field forces. 

a. Corps PM detachments. 

(1) Provide PM support to deployed forces in the corps/COMMZ in a 
direct support role or a general support role. 

(2) Transport organic personnel and equipment with logistical 
support from a unit in the geographic area. 

(3) Perform area and aerial spraying missions, medical detachment, 
PM (ENTO) only. 



3-324 081-831-1047 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



b. Armored cavalry regiment (ACR). Provide the same type of support 
to the regiment as the division PM section provides to the division. 

c. Separate brigades (separate infantry brigade [SIB] and heavy 
separate brigade [HSB]). Provide the same type of support to the SIB/HSB 
that the division PM section provides to the division. 

d. Civil affairs (CA) units. Provide support for displaced persons, 
refugees, and evacuees. Re-establish essential public health services. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task during a field training exercise (FTX) or during a 
normal training session. If the evaluation is conducted during an FTX, the 
environmental and physical conditions at the FTX will be used as the 
scenario for which PMM policies are implemented. If the evaluation is done 
during a normal training session, create the scenario to include 
environmental and physical conditions. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to 
supervise/ensure appropriate preventive medicine policies are followed. The 
soldier will respond to appropriate performance measures. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Ensured soldiers protected against cold. 



2. Ensured soldiers protected against heat. 



3. Ensured soldiers protected against biting insects. 



4. Ensured soldiers protected against diarrhea and 
dysentery. 



5. Ensured soldiers protected against hearing loss. 



6. Ensured soldiers protected against skin infections. 



7. Ensured soldiers provided care for the feet. 



8. Ensured soldiers practiced good oral hygiene. Nt 

~o 

9. Ensured soldiers understood PMM to protect J 

against sexually transmitted diseases. 



10. Ensured soldiers understood PMM to protect 
against AIDS. 



CO 



1 1 . Ensured soldiers disposed of waste properly. 



Skill Level 4 081-831-1047 3-325 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

12. Applied the Army's policies on tobacco use. 




13. Identified division and corps level PMs and their 
mission. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 40-5 
AR 600-63 
FM 4-25.11 
FM 21-10 

081-831-1055 

Ensure Unit Combat Lifesaver Requirements Are Met 

Conditions:You are an NCO appointed as the combat lifesaver program 
coordinator. The combat lifesaver correspondence course is going to be 
used for the unit training. 

Note. The combat lifesaver program coordinator will be the medical NCO, if one is 
assigned. 

Standards: Conducted the combat lifesaver program in accordance with 
AR 350-1, paragraph 4-12 and subcourse IS0826. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Research information on the combat lifesaver program. 

a. Read AR 350-1 , paragraph 4-1 2. The address to access the AR 
is — 

http://www.usapa.army.mil/pdffiles/r350_1.pdf 

b. Read AMEDDC&S information about the combat lifesaver program 
and course options. The program is downloadable from the following 
address — http://www.cs.amedd.army.mil/clsp 

c. Read DA Pam 350-59, Combat Lifesaver Section, section VIII. The 
address to access the Pam is — 

http://www.usapa.army.mil/pdffiles/p350-59.pdf 



3-326 081-831-1055 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



2. Determine the number of personnel who need to be trained. Check 
local unit personnel training records to determine the number of qualified 
combat lifesavers and distribution of the CLs by squad. (See step 9, 
Ensure combat lifesavers maintain proficiency.) 

Note. There should be at least one combat lifesaver per squad, crew, or 
equivalent-size unit. 

Note. If there are too few soldiers to be trained, check other units in the area about 
combining students for the course. There is the possibility you may have too many 
students requiring more frequent classes until the required number are trained. 

Note. Recommend that all qualified combat lifesavers notify the combat lifesaver 
coordinator as soon as a new assignment notification is received. This will allow 
the coordinator to schedule training of replacement combat lifesavers. A list could 
be generated by S-1 PAC that shows personnel PCS/ETS and CL status. 

3. Contact the appropriate staff surgeon combat lifesaver program 
supervisor at corps/division/brigades and separate brigade-size units. 
The coordination should be accomplished prior to the start of training. 

Note. A phone call, e-mail, or memorandum giving notification of intent to conduct 
a course is normally sufficient. In real life the PAs at the Bn level are aware of the 
training for local units and the Bn senior medical NCO will probably run the course. 

4. Identify and appoint a qualified Instructor and assistants as applicable. 

a. Estimate the number of instructors/assistants required. 

Note. The surgeon combat lifesaver supervisor or an experienced CL instructor 
should be able to give you an idea of the student to teacher ratio. Also, if you can 
obtain a copy of the lesson plans in IS0826, you can determine the number of 
instructors and assistants required for each lesson. 

b. If a qualified instructor is not available from the unit being trained, 
request training instructor support from the next higher command surgeon 
or local medical treatment facility. 

Note. The primary instructor will be at least a senior medical NCO and either hold 
primary 91 W, 18D or be a licensed paramedic (state or national), registered nurse, 
physician assistant, or physician. The instructor for the intravenous infusion lesson 
must be an expert in administering IVs and qualified to handle emergencies that 
could arise when students practice initiating IVs. (This can be a senior 91 W, 1 8D, 
LPN, EMT-1 or P, RN, PA or MD.) For the IV portion, the student/instructor ratio 
needs to be two students per instructor. ju 

5. Enroll selected unit personnel in the combat lifesaver training course 
at least eight weeks before group instruction begins. w 

Note. Tell the soldiers they can receive eight promotion points for successful 
completion of the combat lifesaver course. 



Skill Level 4 081-831-1055 3-327 



Q) 

> 



Performance Steps 



a. Cover letter signed by battalion commander or a lieutenant colonel 
or higher (see example). 

EXAMPLE OF A COVER LETTER 



(LETTERHEAD) 



ABCD-EFG-H (XXX) 



Date 



MEMORANDUM FOR Commander, U.S. Army Training Support Center, 
ATTN: ATIC-DLS, Fort Eustis, Virginia 23628-001 . 

SUBJECT: Enrollment of Students and Instructor in Combat Lifesaver 
Course 

1 . Request enrollment of the instructor and students as indicated in the 
Combat Lifesaver Course. 

2. Please code student enrollment applications as indicated on the 
student roster. 

3. Send all printed materials in care of Group Leader SFC Robert B. 
James, 1 st Battalion, 509 th Infantry, APO NY 09168. 

For the commander 




2 End 

1. DA Form 145 

2. Student roster 



JOHN J. JONES 
Lieutenant Colonel, Infantry 
Commanding 



3-328 



081-831-1055 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



b. Complete one DA Form 145 enrolling the primary instructor in 
IS0826 (http://www.usapa.army.mil/forms/). 

(1) Include a list of assistant instructors, if any. 

(2) Provide the instructor and assistant instructors retirement year 
ending date (RYE) if applicable Army National Guard (ARNG) and U.S. 
Army Reserve (USAR). 

(3) The "student" address on DA Form 145 is the primary 
instructor's address. All subcourse materials will be sent to the primary 
instructor. 

(4) Attach a student roster (see table 081 -831 -1 055-1 ) with the DA 
Form 1 45. List the name, rank, social security number, and unit of each 
student. For ARNG or USAR, include the retirement year ending (RYE) 
date. 



Table 081-831-1055-L Example of a Student Roster 




The following students are to be enrolled in the Combat Lifesaver Course 




SSN 


Name 


Component 
Code 


Branch 


Rank 




111-11-1111 


Ames, Adam A 


10 




SGT 




222-22-2222 


Baker, Bruce B 


9 




CPL 




333-33-3333 


Clay, Charles C 


3 




CPL 




444-44-4444 


Dough, David D 


3 




SGT 




555-55-5555 


Edwards, Earnest E 


3 




CPL 




666-66-6666 


Frost, Frank F 


3 




PFC 




777-77-7777 


Gains, Gary G 


3 




CPL 




888-88-8888 


Haines, Harold H 


3 




CPL 




999-99-9999 


Kelly, Keith K 


3 




CPL 


"33 

> 

_l 

!2 

CO 


1 1 1 -22-3333 


Locke, Larry L 


3 




CPL 


444-55-6666 


Manne, Morris M 


3 




SGT 


777-88-9999 


Nay, Ned N 


3 




SGT 


111-00-1111 


Peach, Paul P 


3 




CPL 


222-23-4444 


Ray, Ralph R 


3 




SSG 


999-88-7777 


Smith, Stanley S 


2 


QM 


1LT 


(5) Have the DA Form 145 signed by a responsible official who 
has the authority to requisition or acquire the necessary medical 
equipment and supplies in support of the training. 

6. Obtain equipment and supplies. 



Skill Level 4 



081-831-1055 



3-329 



Performance Steps 



a. Course equipment and supplies (see table 081 -831 -1 055-2). 
Items such as intravenous infusion (IV) trainers may need to be 
purchased. (Check with local medical treatment facilities first.) You can 
also check with your local Training/Visual Information Support Center 
(T/VISC) concerning these items. 




3-330 081-831-1055 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



Table 081-831-1055-2. Combat Lifesaver Program 
Proposed List of Course Supplies forSix Students 




The following items and quantities are required to train six combat lifesaver 
students 




#2 Lead pencils 


1 box for written test and notes 




Dressing, field 


12 




Cravat 


12 




Gloves, latex surgical/exam 


12 pair, assorted sizes 7-8 1 /2 




Chucks, or equivalent 


12 (to absorb fluids and protect table surfaces) 




Catheter, Intravenous 


1 8 (21 ) 20 or 22 gauge; 1 8 gauge for practice 




Container, sharps 


1 (for needles) 




Plastic trash bags 


3 for non- medical waste 




Bag, plastic, red HAZMAT 


1 for bio waste 




IV Moulage, arm strap-on 


3 for IV practice 




IV administration set 


8 




Band, elastic 


6 (constricting band for IV administration) 




Fluid, IV 


8 normal saline, Ringer's, or D5W 
(500 or 1000 ml) 




Tape, V2 inch 


1 roll 




Tape, 1 inch 


1 roll 




Bandage, adhesive 


1 box (Band-Aids) 




Capsule, ammonia inhalant 


5 (1 box) 




Sponge, gauze, 2" x 2" 


1 box (24s) 




Sponge, gauze, 4" x 4" 


1 box (24s) 




Pad, povidone-iodine 


1 box (24s) 




Pad, alcohol 


1 box (24s) 




Oropharygeal Airway 


3 (different sizes) 




Splint, SAM 


3 


"33 

> 

_l 

!2 

CO 


Splint, basewood 


4 


Training MA RK I antidote kit 
and CANA 


1 (obtained through Training and Audiovisual 
Support Center (TASC); unit should request) 


Combat lifesaver aid bag 


1 complete for demonstration 


Blanket, OD, wool 


1 (for improvised litter task; a poncho may be 
used) 


Poles, tent 


2 (the poles are for the improvised litter) 


Litter, folding; 3 straps 


1 (a litter is desirable for a hands-on exercise) 







Skill Level 4 



081-831-1055 



3-331 



Performance Steps 




Note. Include equipment for the buddy -aid tasks, IS0824, even though it may not 
be taught in a group. The equipment will be used for the performance evaluation. 

Note. Plan on enough materials to allow for practice and retests. Your instructor, 
the staff surgeon combat lifesaver supervisor, or previous instructors of the CL 
course may be able to give you an idea of how much extra to have on hand. 

Note. The combat lifesaver program is a continuous ongoing program and 
requires continuous equipment and material support for the already qualified CLs. 
Be sure to maintain contact with your supply source to ensure your CL supplies are 
programmed into the system. 

b. Resupply of Class VIII supplies for combat lifesaver bags during 
garrison operations: 

(1) Request Class VIII resupply through assigned medical 
personnel. 

(2) Request Class VIII supplies through the appropriate division, 
brigade or regimental medical supply office (MSO) when medical 
personnel are not assigned. For the latest CL bag content list go to: 
http://www.armymedicine.army.mil/usamma 

(3) Request Class VIII support from the installation medical supply 
activity (IMSA), normally the MSO of the medical department activity 
(MEDDAC) or U.S. Army Medical Center (MEDCEN) if a nondivisional 
unit. 

c. Resupply, during field operations, is accomplished in the same 
manner as during garrison operations with two exceptions. 

(1) Nondivisional units obtain resupply support from the nearest 
medical unit available. 

(2) Emergency resupply is provided to all units by the nearest 
medical unit capable of doing so. 

Note. Field medical units maintain stocks of medical material with which to effect 
resupply of combat lifesaver aid bags during field operations. 

7. Reserve facilities. The facilities should allow the students to clearly 
see the demonstrations and provide plenty of room for student practice. 
Make sure there are enough tables and chairs available for the number of 
students participating. 

8. Inform instructor, assistant instructors, and students: 

a. Instructor and assistant instructors. 

Note. If you are not the medical instructor, the arrangements and documentation 
should be provided to the primary instructor. 

(1) Provide a copy of CL memorandum with all attachments. 



3-332 081-831-1055 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



(2) Remind instructor and assistant instructors of target start date 
for the class and location (such as building, room). 

(3) Inform the instructor that administrative information, suggested 
course schedule, and lesson plans are in IS0826, Combat Lifesaver 
Instructor Manual. 

(4) Inform the primary instructor that all student and instructor 
materials shipped from the Army Institute for Professional Development 
(AIPD) will be sent to the instructor's address. The instructor is 
responsible to verify the shipment is complete and to distribute the 
subcourses to the students. 

(a) Distribute IS0824 at least two weeks before written and 
performance examinations. 

(b) Distribute IS0825 at least two weeks before attending 
class. 

Note. If classes on IS0825 immediately follow testing on IS0824, then distribute 
both subcourses at the same time. If possible, provide soldiers a field dressing and 
two muslin bandages at the time of distribution for practice. Do not give the 
examination booklets or response sheets to the soldiers. 

(5) Inform the course coordinator that the day-to-day 
administration and conducting of the class is his responsibility once the 
course materials have been received. (The course coordinator may or 
may not be the primary instructor.) 

b. Inform the soldiers of their selection, start date and location. 

9. Ensure combat lifesavers maintain proficiency. 

a. Conduct annual (12 month) recertification. 

(1 ) Determine the number of CLs requiring recertification by 
reviewing local unit training records. 

(2) Designate instructor(s). Unit instructors accomplish CL 
recertification. If no instructors are in the unit, recommend coordinating 
recertification with the primary instructor for the Combat Lifesaver Course. 

(a) Obtain evaluations and lessons . Combat lifesaver 
recertification tasks are designated in the IS0826 under "Recertification 
Testing." Use designated CL performance tests and specified lessons 
available in IS0826; they may be reproduced as needed. Only the most 
critical, life-saving tasks are designated for recertification requirements. 

(b) Obtain equipment needed for recertification (see 
table 081 -831 -1055-3.) 



> 



CO 



Skill Level 4 081-831-1055 3-333 




Performance Steps 


Table 081-831-1055-3. Combat Lifesaver Rec edification Performance Examination 
Equipment and Supplies 


Equipment 


NSN 


Quantity 


IV fluid bag (500 ml) 


6505 01 372 3425 


2 bags 


IV Injection set 


6515 01 472 1863 


2 sets 


Catheter and needle IV unit (18 ga) 


6515 01 315 6227 


2 units 


Tube drain 1 x 18" can be used as constricting 
band 


6515 01 188 5316 




Povidine-iodine impregnated cotton pads 


6510 01 010 0307 




Pad isopropyl alcohol 


6510 00 786 3736 




Timepiece with second hand. (*lf the time can 
be seen by both CL and evaluator) 




*1 
2 


Manikin suitable for administering modified 
abdominal thrusts, finger sweeps, and mouth- 
to-mouth resuscitation 


6910 01 206 0312 




Field dressing 






Materials for pressure dressing wad, pressure 
dressing bandage, tourniquet band and 
securing materials (4 muslin bandages, for 
example). 






Rigid object (stic k) for tourniquet 






Padding for tourniquet 






Pack, log, or other object to elevate a leg. 







(c) Reserve a training facility (classroom) or area. 

(d) Schedule CLs for the recertification. 

(e) Make an entry on the combat lifesaver's local training 
record indicating the date he passed the recertification examination. 

b. Ensure combat lifesavers are allowed to practice their skills to 
maintain proficiency during home station training activities (to include 
FTXs) and during deployment for training. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.None. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be asked to state the steps of 
ensuring the unit combat lifesaver requirements are met. 



3-334 



081-831-1055 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Researched information on the Combat Lifesaver 
Program. 

2. Determined the number of personnel who need to 

be trained. 

3. Contacted the appropriate staff surgeon combat 

lifesaver program supervisor at corps/division/brigade 

and separate brigade-size units. 



4. Identified and appointed a qualified instructor and 
assistants as applicable. 



5. Enrolled selected unit personnel in the Combat 
Lifesaver Training Course at least eight weeks before 
group instruction began. 

6. Obtained equipment and supplies. 



7. Reserved facilities. 



8. Informed instructor, assistant instructors, and 
students. 



9. Ensured combat lifesavers maintained proficiency. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 350-1 

DA Pam 350-59 

IS0826 



SUBJECT AREA 4: SURVIVE (COMBAT TECHNIQU ES) 



071-326-5775 

Coordinate with an Adjacent Platoon 

Conditions:Given a platoon-size element with two adjacent platoon-size 
elements. 



Skill Level 4 071-326-5775 3-335 





Standards: Coordinated with the adjacent platoon-size elements for 
offensive and defensive operations to ensure mutually supporting positions, 
fires, and signals. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Coordinate with adjacent elements. After receiving an order for an 
offensive or defensive operation and during the planning phase, consider 
coordination with adjacent elements. If you receive the order while all 
other platoon-size element leaders are present, take that opportunity to 
coordinate as much as possible to avoid delays later in the operation. 
While many of the details that must be coordinated will vary with the 
situation, always coordinate essential items. 

2. Coordinate in the offense. In the offense, coordinate — 

a. Lateral distance between all attacking elements. 

b. Movement routes, to ensure that mutual support by fire or 
maneuver can be maintained between the lead elements. 

c. Visual signals, such as arm -and-hand signals and pyrotechnics. 

d. Radio call signs. 

3. Coordinate in the defense. In the defense, coordinate to ensure that 
there are no gaps, and that fires interlock and are mutually supporting. 
Information coordinated includes — 

a. Location of positions (primary, alternate, and supplementary). 

b. Dead space between units. 

c. Location of observation posts (OPs). 

d. Signals. 

e. Patrols and ambushes (size, type, time of departure and return, 
and routes). 

f. Location and types of obstacles. 

g. Boundaries. 

h. Control measures. 

4. Allocate final protective fire. If a mortar or artillery final protective fire is 
allocated to the platoon-size elements, coordinate it with the fire support 
team (FIST) forward observer (FO) and integrate it into the fire plan for 

the element. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.ln the defense, provide a field location with varying terrain, two 
adjacent element leaders, and the last fighting position for each of the 
flanking elements. In the offensive, provide a field location with varying 
terrain, and two element leaders from adjacent platoons. 



3-336 071-326-5775 Skill Level 4 



Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he is the center platoon leader and must 
coordinate with both adjacent element leaders. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Coordinated with adjacent element leaders for 

offensive operations. 

a. Lateral distance between attaching elements. 



b. Movement routes. 



c. Visual signals. 



d. Radio call signs. 



e. Boundaries. 



f. Control measures. 



2. Coordinated with adjacent leaders for defensive 
operations. 



a. Location of primary position. 



b. Location of alternate position. 



c. Location of supplementary position. 



d. Dead space between units. 



e. Location of OPs. 



f. Signals. 



g. Patrols and ambushes. 



h. Locations and types of constructed obstacles. 



i. Boundaries. 



j. Control measures. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-21 .71 
FM7-7 
FM7-8 
FM 3-90.1 



Skill Level 4 071-326-5775 3-337 





101-CLT-0198 

Supervise Tactical Feeding Operation 

Conditions:As a supervisor in a field environment, given AR 30-22, 

FM 10-23, FM 21-10, FM 4-25.12, STP 21 -24-SMCT, TB Med 530, the unit 

commander has directed you to supervise the field feeding mission. 

Standards: Supervised personnel in a tactical environment at a field kitchen 
site and set realistic and attainable goals. Clearly delegated tasks and 
evaluated performance. Completed all performance measures accurately to 
ensure that the feeding mission was completed on time. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Ensure soldiers receive three quality meals each day. 

a. Review the field menu for possible changes. 

b. Plan to modify the menu using the appropriate forms and procedures. 

c. Provide the essential nutrients by meeting the requirements of the 
basic food guide pyramid. 

(1) A variety of foods. 

(2) Reduced portion size. 

(3) Foods drained of excess fat and oil . 

(4) Baked items when fried foods are offered. 

(5) Meats trimmed of excess fat. 

(6) Fresh fruits. 

d. Plan calories and portion sizes using field-feeding procedures based 
on operational plans. 

2. Ensure feeding site is camouflaged. 

a. Determine the best available site for the field kitchen operations. 

b. Select an area that provides good natural cover. 

c. Erect camouflage net to supplement whatever natural concealment is 
available. 

d. Use natural concealment or camouflage net to cover vehicles and field 
kitchen equipment. 

e. Plan to place serving line and mess kit laundry line with maxim urn 
protection from the enemy by using natural concealment or camouflage net. 

3. Keep soldiers disbursed during feeding operations. 

a. Select an area for operation that provides good natural concealment. 

b. Select an area that has enough space to prevent crowding. 

c. Place mess kit laundry line 50 feet (1 5 meters) from the field kitchen. 

3-338 101-CLT-0198 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



d. Establish and monitor the setup of serving lines during feeding time 
based on location, enemy activity, unit mission, weather, and visibility. 

e. Apply one of the following serving-line concepts based on terrain, 
enemy activity, weather, visibility, and field kitchen equipment being used. 

(1) One-way staggered. 

(2) One-way straight. 

(3) U-shaped (MKT). 

(4) Two serving lines (MKT). 

4. Enforce preventive medicine standards. 

a. Consult with the veterinary officer on food products that are suspected 
of being contaminated. 

(1) Inspect for contaminated subsistence. 

(a) Check canned foods for swellers, leaks, or springers. 

(b) Check meat, poultry, and seafood for abnormal odor or color. 

(2) Isolate subsistence, which may be contaminated, so it is not 
prepared and served. 

(3) Request a veterinary officer inspect food products that may be 
contaminated. 

(4) Request information on how to dispose of food products that are 
unfit for human consumption. 

b. Consult with the veterinary officer on the shelf life of food products. 

(1) Request that officer inspect subsistence when expiration date has 
expired. 

(2) Request that officer inspect canned goods that have outward signs 
of deterioration. 

c. Obtain certificate of unfitness from the veterinary officer when 
subsistence is damaged or destroyed and when condemnation loss or report 
of survey is being completed. 

(1) Prepare DA Form 31 61 , Request for Issue or Turn-in, for the 
disposition of unfit items (prepare separate DA Forms 31 61 for perishable and ^ 
semi-perishable subsistence items). 

(2) Ensure that veterinary or medical personnel, the TISO, and a 
witness each sign the proper statement on DA Form 31 61 stating that the 
items listed have been inspected and are unfit for human consumption. 

(3) Ensure that items having no potential sale value are disposed of 
properly. 

(4) If using an automated system, enter and process items according 

Skill Level 4 101-CLT-0198 3-339 




Performance Steps 






to their disposition. 

d. Coordinate with the veterinary officer on problems associated with 
sanitation, pest control, and the environmental condition of the field site. 

(1) Coordinate in assessing the adequacy of food service sanitation 
practices. 

(2) Ask for technical guidance and assist i n presentation of food 
service sanitation training for non-supervisory personnel. 

5. Schedule meal times to fit operational plans. 

a. Coordinate with the unit commander for unit mission data. 

(1) Review previously prepared SOPs, if available. 

(2) Determine the regulatory guidelines. 

(3) Examine work schedule and equipment layout. 

(4) Evaluate current procedures to ensure they are effective. 

(5) Verify that procedures to be used are within regulatory guidelines. 

(6) Select the procedures to be used. 

(7) Provide further guidance based on the unit mission, as needed. 

b. Coordinate operation standards with the food advisor. 

c. Coordinate with the food service officer. 

d. Plan and develop the SOP. 

(1) Draft the SOP. 

(2) Finalize the SOP. 

e. Coordinate with the ration breakdown point and the TISA for requesting 
and issuing schedules and available menus. 

f. Coordinate with the S-4 for supply requirements. 

g. Organize the equipment based on the unit mission. 

h. Inform the operating team of coordination accomplished. 

i. Implement the action plan, using the advanced party to set up the field 
feeding operation. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



S 1 . Ensured soldiers received three quality meals each 
day. 

2. Ensured feeding site was camouflaged. 



3. Kept soldiers disbursed during feeding operations. 



3-340 101-CLT-0198 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

4. Enforced preventive medicine standards. 



5. Scheduled meal times to fit operational plans. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 30-22 
FM 4-25.1 2 
FM 10-23 
FM 21-10 
STP21-24-SMCT 
TB Med 530 



SUBJECT AREA 19: CROWD CONTROL 



191-379-5400 

Form the Platoon into a Riot Control Formation 

Conditions:Given a mission to conduct riot control formations and a 
platoon of soldiers fully equipped with riot control gear. 

Standards: Issued the correct commands and made on-the-spot corrections 
to ensure that the platoon correctly executed and formed into one of the 
following three formations: 

1 . Platoon line, platoon line with one squad in general support, platoon line 
with one squad in lateral support, and platoon line with one squad in close 
support. 

2. Platoon echelon, right (or left); platoon echelon, right (or left) with one 
squad in general support; platoon echelon, right (or left) with one squad in 
lateral support; and platoon echelon, right (or left) with one squad in close 
support. 

3. Platoon wedge, platoon wedge with one squad in general support, platoon 
wedge with one squad in lateral support, and platoon wedge with one squad 
in close support. 

Reassembled the platoon from a riot control formation. 



> 
a) 



CO 



Skill Level 4 191-379-5400 3-341 



Performance Steps 

Note. The platoon formation is selected depending on the crowd structure and 
temperament. Any size squad, platoon, or larger unit may be employed, and a crowd 
control formation can be adapted to fit the unit organization. For these formations, 
such as the four-squad platoon, see FM 19-15, chapter 8. 

1 . Form the platoon in a platoon line (figure 1 91 -379-5400-1 ). 




w 

®0C 

X 


1st I 


2d J, 


3d | 
squad ' j 

D©©0© 

X 


squad > | * squad ' j ~ 

5)®®©©©®©®©©©®®C 

\z\\z\ ^\z\ 

SM D 
+ 



Figure 191-379-5400-1. Platoon Line 

a. Give the preparatory command, "Platoon as skirmishers," while 
simultaneously using hand and arm signals. (Raise both arms straight out 
to the side, arms and hands extended, palms down.) 

b. Give the execution command, "Move," and at the same time, point 
to the place where you want the formation. Ensure that the following occur: 

(1) Squad leaders of first and second squads must give the 
command, "Follow me," while the leader of the third squad gives the 
command, "Stand fast." 

(2) Ensure that the number two member of the second squad is the 
base member for the formation. The rest of the second squad forms a line 
to the right of the base member. The first squad forms a line to the left. 

(3) Ensure that the squad leader of the third squad commands, 
"Follow me," after the first and second squads have assumed their 
positions. 

(4) Ensure that the third squad forms a line to the right of the 
second squad. 

Note. All squads dress on the second squad. 

2. Form the platoon in a platoon line with one squad in general support. 

a. Form the platoon line with one squad in general support in a column 
of twos (figure 191-379-5400-2). 



3-342 



191-379-5400 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



Odd 
numbers ( 5 




2d 
squad 





1st 


j 


3d 




■* 


squad 


*\* 


squad 


»- 


®©®®@@@@®®©®©® 


X 




*, 




X 




SM 


• 


D 





Even 
numbers 



Figure 191-379-5400-2 Platoon Line with One Squad in General Support in a 

Column of Twos 

(1) Give the command, "Platoon as skirmishers, second support in 
a column of twos." 

(2) Ensure that the leaders of the first and third squads command, 
"Follow me," and that the leader of the second squad commands, "Stand 
fast." 



0) 

> 



tn 



Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-343 



Performance Steps 

(3) Give the command; "Move," and point to the place where you 
want the formation. The first and third squads move forward to their 
appointed place (the number 2 member of the first squad is the base 
member for the formation). The second squad, at the command of its 
squad leader, executes a column of twos to the right. 

b. Form the platoon in a platoon line with one squad in support in a 
single column (figure 1 91 -379-5400-3). The support squad, usually the 
second squad, may also be formed in a single column. The command is, 
"Platoon as skirmishers, second in support, move." The first and third 
squads execute the formation, while the second squad remains in column 
formation. 




3-344 191-379-5400 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 

1sT~ 
squad 



3d 
squad 



®©®®®®©©®@®®©® 



SM 



^ 



* 



/ 



D 



& 



Kl 



2d 

5 ) squad 



Q) 
> 
0) 






Figure 191-379-5400-3. Platoon Line with One Squad in Support in a Single 

Column 

3. Form the platoon in a platoon line with one squad in lateral support 
(figure 191-379-5400-4). 



Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-345 



Performance Steps 




1st 
squad 



3d 
squad 



®®©©®®©@®®©©0® 

T~ (Is) r v ^i i ^i i ^i i s. s \ (2) ~ Y 



2d squad 

odd (5 
numbers 

_Jl_ 




/ 



SM 




4) 2d squad 
even 
numbers 



ISI 



Figure 191-379-5400-4. Platoon Line with One Squad in Lateral Support 



'Platoon as skirmishers, second squad in 
'Move," and point to the place where you want 



a. Give the command, 
lateral support." 

b. Give the command, 
the formation. 

c. Ensure that after the first squad forms a line to the left of the base 
member, the third squad forms a line to the right of the base member. After 
the line has been formed, the squad leader for the second squad 
commands, "Odd numbered soldiers, follow me," and the assistant squad 
leader commands, "Even numbered soldiers, follow me." The odd 
numbered soldiers move out to the left and form a column behind the last 
soldier in the third squad. The even numbered soldiers move out to the 
right and form a column behind the last soldier in the first squad. 

4. Form the platoon in a platoon line with one squad in close support 
(figure 191 -379-5400-5). 



3-346 



191-379-5400 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



1st 
squad 



3d 
squad 



®®©©®©@©®@©©©® 
©©©©©©© 

I 2d J 

\ squad H 



\Z\^\Z\^ 



. 



SM D 



Figure 191-379-5400-5. Platoon Line with One Squad in Close Support 

a. Give the command, "Platoon as skirmishers, second in close 
support." The first and third squads will execute a line as in step 1 . 

b. Ensure that the leaders of the second squad command, "Stand 
fast." 

c. Ensure that after the first and third squads move to the appointed 
place and execute the line, the second squad executes a similar line to the 
rear of the leading line. The second squad forms to the right of its base 
soldier. The second squad can be shifted to the right or left to support any 
segment of the formation. 

Note. Make sure the second squad closes and covers the intervals between the 
elements in the leading line. 

5. Form the platoon in a platoon echelon right (or left) (figure 191 -379- 
5400-6). 




Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-347 



Performance Steps 





Figure 191-379-5400-6. Platoon Echelon, Right 

a. Give the command, "Platoon echelon, right (or left)." 

b. Give the command, "Move," and point to where you want the 
formation. 

c. Give hand signals with the voice commands. Extend one arm 45 
degrees above and the other 45 degrees below the horizon, arms and 
hands extended. (When facing the platoon, the upper arm indicates the 
direction of the echelon.) 

d. Ensure that the first squad leader commands, "Follow me," and the 
squad executes an echelon right. 

e. Ensure that the second and third squad leaders command, "Stand 
fast." 

f. Ensure that as each squad clears the column, the next squad 
moves to extend the echelon formed by the preceding squad. 



3-348 



191-379-5400 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 

Note. For an echelon left, the third squad executes echelon left with the rest of the 

squads following. 

6. Form the platoon in a platoon echelon, right (or left) with one support 
squad in general support the same as with the line (figure 191 -379-5400- 
7). 



SM 



f ■ — ■ isr^rCik N 3d 

>< ^T4) squad 




© 



^ 



© 



Odd x-v 
numbers \$J 

© 



2d 
squad 



© 

>< Even 

Ci) numbers 

® SqU3d 



Figure 191-379-5400-7. Platoon Echelon, Right with One Squad in General 

Support 

a. Give the command, "Platoon echelon, right (or left), second squad 
in general support." 

b. Give the command, "Move," and point to the place where you want 
the formation. 

c. Give hand signals with the voice commands. Extend one arm 45 
degrees above and the other 45 degrees below the horizon, arms and 
hands extended. (When facing the platoon, the upper arm indicates the 
direction of the echelon.) 



> 
a) 



CO 



Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-349 



Performance Steps 

d. Ensure that the first squad leader commands, "Follow me," and that 
the squad executes an echelon right (or left). 

e. Ensure that the second and third squad leaders command, "Stand 
fast." 

f. Ensure that as the first squad clears the column, the third squad 
moves to extend the echelon formed by the first squad. The second squad, 
at the command of its squad leader, executes a column of twos to the right 
(or left). 

7. Form the platoon in a platoon echelon, right (or left) with one support 
squad in lateral support the same as with the line (figure 191 -379-5400-8). 




1st 




3d ,-£> 

squad (4) 

4D U 







squad (4} ^^ Even 
(^V^ (7) numbers 



2d 
squad 



/jna 



Odd 
numbers (5, 
2d squad ( -, 



^ 





is 


SM 


I * D 




* 



Figure 191-379-5400-& Platoon Echelon, Left with One 
Squad in Lateral Support 

a. Give the command, "Platoon echelon, right (or left), second squad 
in lateral support." 



3-350 



191-379-5400 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 

b. Give the command, "Move," and point to the place where you want 
the formation. 

c. Give hand signals with the voice commands. Extend one arm 45 
degrees above and the other 45 degrees below the horizon, arms and 
hands extended. (When facing the platoon, the upper arm indicates the 
direction of the echelon.) 

d. Ensure that the first squad leader commands, "Follow me," and that 
the squad executes an echelon right (or left). 

e. Ensure that the second and third squad leaders command, "Stand 
fast." 

f. Ensure that as the first squad clears the column, the third squad 
moves to extend the echelon formed by the first squad. After the echelon 
has formed, the squad leader for the second squad commands, "Odd 
numbered soldiers, follow me," and the assistant squad leader commands, 
"Even numbered soldiers, follow me." The odd numbered soldiers move 
out to the right (or left) and form a column behind the last soldier in the 
third squad. The even numbered soldiers move out to the left (or right) and 
form a column behind the first soldier in the first squad. 

8. Form the platoon in a platoon echelon, right (or left) with one support 
squad in close support the same as with the line (figure 1 91 -379-5400-9). 




Skill Level 4 191-379-5400 3-351 



Performance Steps 





Figure 191-379-5400-9. Platoon Echelon, Left with One 
Squad in Close Support 

a. Give the command, "Platoon echelon, right (or left), second squad 
in close support." 

b. Give the command, "Move," and point to the place where you want 
the formation. 

c. Give hand signals with the voice commands. Extend one arm 45 
degrees above and the other 45 degrees below the horizon, arms and 
hands extended. (When facing the platoon, the upper arm indicates the 
direction of the echelon.) 

d. Ensure that the first squad leader commands, "Follow me," and that 
the squad executes an echelon right (or left). 

e. Ensure that the second and third squad leaders command, "Stand 
fast." 

f. Ensure that as the first squad clears the column, the third squad 
moves to extend the echelon formed by the first squad. After the echelon 
has formed, the second squad executes a similar echelon to the rear of the 
leading echelon. The second squad will form to the right (or left) of its base 
soldier. The second squad can be shifted to the right or left to support any 
segment of the formation. 



3-352 



191-379-5400 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 

9. Form the platoon in a platoon wedge (figure 1 91 -379-5400-1 0). 



/ ®%k 3d 

1st x (iV Q k squad 

squad© r^ © v 

/ rg> L2SJ CskX 



SM 



y 



D 



^ 



Figure 191-379-5400-10. Platoon Wedge 



a. Give the command, "Platoon wedge," followed by the command, 
"Move." Give hand signals with the commands. Extend both arms down to 
the sides at an angle of 45 degrees below the horizon, palms down and 
towards the body. Then point to where you want the formation as you give 
the command of execution. 

b. Ensure that the first and third squad leaders command, "Follow 
me," while the second squad leader commands, "Stand fast." 

c. Ensure that the first and third squads move to the front and, when 
the last element of the squads have cleared the front of the second squad, 
the second squad leader commands, "Follow me." The squad moves to the 
left and right res pectively. 

d. Ensure that the third squad executes an echelon right off the 
number 2 member (the base member) and the first squad executes an 
echelon left. 




Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-353 



Performance Steps 

e. Ensure that the odd-numbered soldiers of the second squad form 
an echelon left on the rear elem ent of the first squad and the even- 
numbered soldiers form an echelon right on the rear element of the third 
squad. 

10. Form the platoon in a platoon wedge with one squad in general support 
in a column of twos (figure 191-379-5400-11). 




3-354 191-379-5400 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 




(£)%)' 3d 
1st ' ® W ^Qsquad 

squad ® ^ % 



7)©^ 




• 



SM * D 



Odd 



© 



numbers \$) 

© 



© 



(4) Even 

©numbers 

© 



2d 
squad 



Figure 191-379-5400-11. Platoon Wedge with One Squad in General 
Support in a Column of Twos 

a. Give the command, "Platoon wedge, second squad in support in a 
column of twos, move." 




Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-355 



Performance Steps 



b. Ensure that the first and third squads execute the wedge and the 
second squad, at the command of its squad leader, executes a column of 
twos to the right. 

Note. The support squad, usually the second squad, may also be forrred in a single 
column. The command for this would be, "Platoon wedge, second in support, move." 
The first and third squads execute the formation, while the second squad remains in 
column formation. 

1 1 . Form the platoon in a platoon wedge with one squad in lateral support 
(figure 191 -379-5400-12). 




3d 




© 
© © 
® rS^TI® squad 
squad ^ >< ^^ _ 

\Z\® 



2d squad 

odd 
numbers 



SM 



EX] 



/ 



© 



© 

© 

C\ 2d 

\zJ squad 



even 
umbers 



Figure 191-379-5400-12. Platoon Wedge with One Squad in Lateral Support 

a. Give the command, "Platoon wedge, second squad in lateral 
support, move." The first and third squads execute the wedge, while the 
second squad stands fast. 

b. Ensure that after the wedge has been formed, the squad leader for 
the second squad commands, "Odd-numbered soldiers, follow me," and 
the assistant squad leader commands, "Even-numbered soldiers, follow 
me." The odd-numbered soldiers move out to the left and form a column 
behind the last soldier in the third squad. The even-numbered soldiers 
move out to the right and form a column behind the last soldier in the first 
squad. 



3-356 



191-379-5400 



Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 

c. Give the command, "Second squad, lateral support, move," to move 
the second squad from general support to lateral support. 

d. Give the command, "Second squad, extend the wedge, move," to 
have the second squad join the wedge from either general support or 
lateral support. The second squad leader and the assistant squad leader 
command, "Follow me," and move out to the left and right, respectively, to 
extend the wedge on the first and third squads. 

12. Form the platoon in a platoon wedge with one squad in close support 
(figure 191-379-5400-13). 



2d 

squad 

odd 

numbers 



1st 












#<% 



rw Ex]E><I 



2d 

squad 

even 

numbers 



SM 




D 



EX] 



Figure 191-379-5400-13. Platoon Wedge with One Squad in Close Support 

a. Give the command, "Platoon wedge, second squad in close 
support, move." 

b. Ensure that the first and third squads execute a wedge. The second 
squad executes a squad wedge behind, and centered on, the leading 
wedge. 



0) 

> 



tn 



Skill Level 4 



191-379-5400 



3-357 



Performance Steps 



c. Ensure that the members in the supporting wedge cover the 
intervals between members in the leading wedge. 

13. Reassemble the platoon from a formation. 

a. Move to the rear of the platoon where you want the platoon 
members to assemble and give the command, "Platoon assemble, move," 
while making a circular motion above your head with your right hand. 

b. Ensure that the number two members (base member) of each 
squad do an about face and all other squad members do a facing 
movement toward their number two member. 

c. Ensure that the platoon comes to port arms upon hearing the 
command, "Platoon assemble." 

d. Ensure that upon the command, "Move," the second squad leader 
commands, "Follow me." The first and third squad leaders command, 
"Stand fast." 

e. Ensure that as the second squad clears the formation, the first and 
third squad leaders command, "Follow me." The first and third squads 
follow, moving at double time, and dress to the right of the third squad until 
the platoon is fully formed. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 




*> 



1 . Formed the platoon in a platoon line. 



2. Formed the platoon in a platoon line with one squad 
in general support. 



3. Formed the platoon in a platoon line with one squad 
in lateral support. 



4. Formed the platoon in a platoon line with one squad 
in close support. 



5. Formed the platoon in a platoon echelon right (or 
left). 



w 6. Formed the platoon in a platoon echelon right (or 
|j left) with one support squad in general support the 
same as with the line. 



- 



7. Formed the platoon in a platoon echelon right (or 
left) with one support squad in lateral support the same 
as with the line. 



8. Formed the platoon in a platoon echelon right (or 
left) with one support squad in close support the same 
as with the line. 



3-358 191-379-5400 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

9. Formed the platoon in a platoon wedge. 



10. Formed the platoon in a platoon wedge with one 
squad in general support in a column of twos. 



1 1 . Formed the platoon in a platoon wedge with one 
squad in lateral support. 



12. Formed the platoon in a platoon wedge with one 
squad in close support. 



13. Reassembled the platoon from a formation. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed . Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed . 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

FM 19-15 



SUBJECT AREA 21 : DEFENSE MEASURES 



071-430-0006 

Conduct a Defense by a Platoon 

Conditions:Given a specified area to defend, a platoon with table of 

organization and equipment (TOE) equipment, and a requirement to defend 

that area. 

Standards: The threat was engaged in accordance with the defensive plan, 

fires were controlled, terrain was retained, and the threat was destroyed or 

repelled. 

Performance Steps 

1. Analyze the mission. 

a. You are given a mission to defend by the company commander. It 
is either an operations order (OPORD) or a warning order. 

b. Identify both specified tasks and implied tasks. 

c. Make an estimate of the situation using the factors of mission, ^ 
enemy, terrain, troops, and time available (METT-TC). 

2. Issue a warning order to the squad leaders. The warning order should 
include the mission, time, place for issuing the OPORD, and any special 
instructions needed to start preparation for the mission. 

Skill Level 4 071-430-0006 3-359 



Performance Steps 




3. Make a tentative plan. 

4. Conduct a reconnaissance. 

a. As a minimum, make a map reconnaissance. 

b. If at all possible, conduct a ground reconnaissance. 

c. Evaluate the terrain based on how the available observation, fields 
of fire, cover and concealment, obstacles, key terrain, and avenues of 
approach best support your mission and the commander's intent. 

d. Request that the squad leaders, radiotelephone operator, and 
forward observers accompany the platoon leader on the reconnaissance. 
You may need to take along some additional security depending on the 
tactical situation. 

5. Start necessary movement or preparations. The platoon sergeant 
should: 

a. Initiate orders to prepare for any necessary movement and 
prepare for the defense as soon as the warning order is issued. 

b. Request and draw ammunition rations, water, and any special 
equipment required. 

c. Accomplish any needed maintenance. 

d. Perform any movement required. 

e. Accomplish this during the time you and your reconnaissance 
party are conducting the reconnaissance. 

6. Complete the plan. 

a. The plan is completed or revised based on continuing analysis and 
completion of the reconnaissance. 

b. As a minimum, the plan should provide for — 

(1) The deployment of squads. 

(2) The deployment of key weapons. 

(3) The use of indirect fire. 

(4) The use of mines and obstacles. 

(5) The establishment of security measures. 

(6) The selection and operation of command and observation 
posts. 

7. Occupy the position. 

a. Establish local security. Locate observation posts to make 
maximum use of long-range observations. 



3-360 071-430-0006 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



b. Position key weapons. Ensure machine guns cover infantry 
avenues of approach, have primary and secondary sectors of fire, and 
provide as much g razing fire as possible, and are assigned either a final 
protective line (FPL) or a principal direction of fire. Ensure Javelins or 
Dragons cover armor avenues of approach, have primary and secondary 
sectors of fire, are positioned to engage targets from the flank, and are 
mutually supporting. 

c. Clear fields of fire. Ensure each fighting position clears its field of 
fire to engage the advancing enemy without exposing friendly positions. 
Range cards are prepared for each machine gun and Dragon. 

d. Ensure positions have overlapping sectors of fire. 

e. Improve fighting positions , as time is available. Improving 
overhead cover, aiming and limiting stakes, and camouflage are on-going 
activities. 

f. Select and improve alternate and supplementary positions . 
Improve them, as tim e is available. 

8. Emplace early warning devices. Platoon early warning system is used, 
if available. Trip flares are set out. Improvised early warning devices can 
be used, such as noisemakers , trip wire grenades, or other explosives. 

9. Emplace hasty minefields and other obstacles. These should be 
covered by observation and fire. 

10. Establish communication systems. Depend on radio as little as 
possible. Wire networks should be established down to each squad and 
up to the company command post (CP). 

1 1 . Stockpile ammunition, water, food, and other supplies. Ensure that 
any materiel is protected from direct fire and is provided overhead 
protection. 

12. Engage the enemy at maximum range. When the enemy appears in 
the platoon sector, he is engaged with supporting direct and indirect fires. 
As he comes within the range of your organic weapons, you direct your 
gunners to start engaging the enemy. 

a. When the enemy encounters your minefields and obstacles, use 
all friendly fires to break up the enemy formations. 

b. If the enemy is able to start an assault, repel or destroy him by 
calling for final protective fires (FPF) of small arms and machine guns, 
and FPF from mortars and artillery. 




Skill Level 4 071-430-0006 3-361 




Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Select an area in the field large enough for a platoon defensive 
position, including primary, alternate, and supplementary positions. 

Brief Soldier:Te\\ the soldier his platoon's sector of responsibility and that he 
is the acting platoon leader. Issue an OPORD (from the company 
commander) for a defense of the position. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Analyzed the mission. 



2. Issued a warning order. 



3. Made a tentative plan. 



4. Conducted a reconnaissance. 



5. Caused necessary movement and preparation to be 
initiated. 



6. Completed the plan and issued the order. 



7. Occupied the position. 



a. Established local security. 



b. Positioned key weapons. 



c. Ensured fields of fire were cleared. 



d. Ensured overlapping sectors of fire. 



e. Selected alternate and supplementary positions. 



8. Ensured early warning devices were installed. 



9. Ensured hasty protective minefields and other 
obstacles were constructed. 



10. Established communication systems, wire and 
radio. 



1 1 . Requested ammunition, food, water, and other 
supplies for stockpiling. 



12. Engaged the enemy at maximum ranges. 



a. Covered obstacles with fire. 



b. Called for FPL and FPF. 



3-362 071-430-0006 Skill Level 4 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 3-21 .71 
FM7-7 
FM7-8 
FM 3-90.1 



SUBJECT AREA 22: UNIT OPERATIONS 



091-CLT-3009 

Supervise Maintenance Operations 

Conditions: In a field or garrison environment, given maintenance 
personnel, equipment, maintenance facility/site, SOPs, and applicable 
references. 

Standards: Established and maintained an effective maintenance shop 
operation in accordance with SOPs and applicable references. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Ensure unit maintenance procedures are in accordance with AR 750-1 , 
DA Pam 750-35 and local major Army command (MACOM) policies. 

a. Review unit standing operating procedures (SOP) for maintenance. 

b. Inform unit personnel of changes in policy and new policy that impacts 



unit SOP. 




2. Provide technical assistance to unit maintenance activities. 




a. Inspect unit maintenance operations . 




b. Identify shortcomings . 


^ , 


c. Make recommendations for corrective action. 


<D 


d. Provide training in maintenance procedures. 


J5 


3. Provide maintenance management to units. 


!2 


a. Review reports (MCRS and ULLS-G). 


CO 


b. Coordinate with higher level maintenance activities. 




c. Direct cross-leveling of maintenance assets/workload. 









Skill Level 4 091-CLT-3009 3-363 




Performance Steps 



d. Prioritize maintenance efforts of units. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1. Reviewed unit SOP as scheduled. 



8. Recorded training needs. 



2. Compared unit SOP against standards set in DA 
Pam 750-35. 



3. Completed regular inspection of unit operations. 



4. Compared unit operations against standards in AR 
750-1 , DA Pam 738-750, and DA Pam 750-35. 



5. Inspected environmental protection practices for 
compliance. 



6. Reviewed safety program practices for compliance 
with AR 385-55. 



7. Recorded and submitted deficiencies to proper 
personnel for correction. 



9. Coordinated with appropriate personnel to provide 
needed training. 



10. Reviewed MCSR for accuracy and compliance with 
standards in AR 700-1 38 and applicable user's manual. 



11. Coordinated with appropriate maintenance level to 
correct maintenance discrepancies. 



12. Coordinated with TRADOC and AMC to ensure that 
emerging issues were addressed appropriately at the 
unit. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him what was done 
wrong and how to do it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 190-51 
AR 385-10 
AR 385-40 

3-364 091-CLT-3009 Skill Level 4 



References 
Required Related 

AR 385-55 

AR 600-55 

AR 700-4 

AR 700-1 38 

AR 710-2 

AR 725-50 

AR 735-5 

AR 735-1 1-1 

AR 750-43 

DA Pam 25-30 

DAPam 710-2-2 

DA Pam 738-750 

DA Pam 750-1 

DA Pam 750-35 

FM 4-30.3 (FM 9-43-1) 



101-92Y-0001 

Supervise Supply Activities 

Conditions: You are assigned to an organization with the duty to supervise 
a supply activity in a field or garrison environment. Given the various types 
of supply functions, you have full access to all supply reports, references, 
equipment and logistical automated systems. A logistician specializing in the 
supply field will be present to assist you. 

Standards: Attained and maintained 100 percent accountability of all 
supplies, equipment, and supply records assigned to your activity. Ensured 
all organizational supply needs were met in the correct quantities, at the 
appropriate place and time. 

^ 

Performance Steps ^ 

0) 

1 . Verify supply activity operations are in accordance with the governing 

regulations. 

a. Review the appropriate regulations governing the specific supply 

functions being performed. 

(1) Determine which regulations and forms are essential to perform 
specific supply functions. 

Skill Level 4 101-92Y-0001 3-365 



03 



Performance Steps 



(2) Review all policy letters, commander guidance, and standing 
operating procedures (SOP) pertaining to the activity operations. 

(3) Make a list of critical supply functions and areas of concentration 
that can jeopardize the mission. 

b. Evaluate the performance of the supply activity operations. 

(1) Review the historic reports and documents generated from the 
activity. 

(2) Identify areas where the supply functions are substandard 
operations . 

(3) Meet with key personnel and set up internal controls to correct 
substandard procedures. 

(4) Design internal SOPs based on the governing regulations, and 
indoctrinate the commander's guidance. 

2. Identify the areas of responsibility and accountability. 

a. Establish the chain of command. 

(1) Identify the key personnel in your supply activity. 

(2) Identify the responsibilities of your position. 

(3) Identify the responsibilities of your subordinates. 

(4) Identify property and equipment for which you are responsible. 

b. Establish property and equipment accountability. 

(1) Conduct a 100-percent physical inventory of all supplies and 
equipment for which you are responsible. 

(2) Report all identified shortages and overages through command 
supply channels. 

(3) Ensure appropriate methods of relief are applied. 





(4) Ensure that all property and equipment is properly distributed (sub- 




hand receipt) down to the user level. 




(5) Update and maintain your hand receipt/sub-hand receipt as 


(/) 


necessary. 


2; 


c. Establish an active physical security program for the areas for which 


<7 

< 

CD 


you are responsible. 


(1) Arms room and sensitive item. 


■b 


(2) Supply room and OCIE. 




(3) Storage area. 




(4) NBC. 




d. Steward resources. 





3-366 101-92Y-0001 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



(1) Review expendable requisitions. 

(2) Review the GSA/SSSC requisitions. 

3. Develop the supply activity portion of the unit SOP. 

a. Collect pertinent data concerning the administrative and technical 
procedures of your activity. 

b. Incorporate the following areas into your SOP: 

(1) Commander's training guidance. 

(2) Reporting procedures/situation reporting procedures (SITREP). 

(3) Chain of Command. 

(4) Environmental hazards. 

(5) Safety program . 

(6) Physical security program . 

c. Develop a detailed plan on how you will implement the following: 

(1) Command supply discipline program (CSDP). 

(2) Internal control system. 

(3) Cyclic inventories. 

d. Enforce safety standards and regulations. 

(1) Appoint safety officer to coordinate with the unit safety officer, write 
the safety portion of the activity SOP, and ensure the administration of the unit 
safety program. 

(2) Verify that the safety SOP is publicized and posted in your activity 
area. 

(3) Verify soldiers are trained on and practice the safety standards. 

e. Conduct risk management. 



(1) Ensure supply activity members adhere to all safety and 




occupational health standards applicable to routine 


operations. 




(2) Incorporate risk management techniques into all 


activity operation 


s. 


(a) Identify hazard. 






^ , 


(b) Assess risk. 






<D 


(c) Determine controls. 






J5 


(d) Make decisions. 






!2 


(e) Supervise and evaluate. 






CO 


4. Supervise supply activity operations. 








a. Determine required reports. 








(1) Determine what reoccurring reports your 


activity 


must generate. 





Skill Level 4 101-92Y-0001 3-367 



Performance Steps 




(2) Determine what automated/status reports are required of you and 
at what frequency. 

(3) Determine what input to the unit status reporting is required from 
your activity. 

(4) Determine the interval required to conduct inventories . 

b. Randomly review supply documents leaving your activity for 
correctness and completeness. 

(1) UND codes on requisitions. 

(2) Document register for discrepancies. 

(3) Turn-in documents. 

(4) Training ammunition requests. 

(5) Reconciliation validation reports. 

(6) Cancellation requests. 

(7) Receipt documents. 

c. Consult with the supply subject matter experts at regular intervals. 

(1 ) Obtain information on how the functional areas supply operations 
are conducted. 

(2) Disseminate information and identify areas of concern that need to 
be elevated to the next higher level. 

(3) Follow up as necessary to assure improved productivity. 

(4) Keep your commander informed about the productivity of the 
activity. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:TU\s task can be evaluated during routine unit operations. 

Brief Soldier: Inform soldier that the evaluation is measured on the ability to 
perform the listed performance measures. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Used the proper procedures to access the 

DA Pam 25-30 CD ROM to identify blank forms and 
needed publications, and gather most recent 
information on available publications. 

2. Checked property book accounting (manual and 
automated) in accordance with DA Pam 710-2-1 
chapter 4, section I. 



3-368 101-92Y-0001 Skill Level 4 



- 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

3. Checked for accuracy and completion of hand 

receipts, sub-hand receipts, hand-receipt annexes and 

component listings in accordance with AR 71 0-2 and 

DAPam 710-2-1, chapters 5, 6, and 9. 

4. Coordinated issuing, storing and turn in of supplies 

and equipment in accordance with DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , 
chapters 3 and 5. 

5. Coordinated requisitioning and receipt of supplies 

and logistical services in accordance with 

DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , chapter 2. 

6. Verified that all 10-percent, quarterly, semi-annual, 

and annual inventories were performed in accordance 
with DA Pam 71 0-2-1 , chapter 9. 

7. Verified that corrective actions were taken to rectify 

discrepancies in accordance with AR 735-5, chapters 
1 2 and 1 3, and DA Pam 710-2-1 , chapter 9, section II, 
and chapter 4. 

8. Determined if equipment was reportable in 

accordance with DA Pam 738-750. 

9. Coordinated the processing of required supply 

operations reports in accordance with DA Pam 710-2, 
chapters 2 and 3. 



- 



10. Conducted random checks of supply documents 
leaving your activity in accordance with AR 71 0-2, 
appendix B, and AR 735-5, chapter 1 1 . 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO on any performance measure, show him what 
was done wrong and how to do it correctly. 

References 

Required Related 

AR 700-84 AR 190-11 

AR710-2 AR 190-13 

AR 735-5 AR 220-1 

DA Pam 25-30 AR 30-22 

DA Pam 71 0-2-1 AR 385-10 

DA Pam 710-2-2 AR 725-50 

Skill Level 4 101-92Y-0001 3-369 




References 
Required Related 

DA Pam 738-750 DA Pam 385-1 

FM 100-15 
FM 10-1 
FM 10-27-3 
FM 10-15 
FM 10-23 
FM 10-23-1 
FM 10-27-4 




151-357-0001 

Supervise CSS Functions During Platoon Operations 

Conditions:You are a platoon leader/sergeant of a platoon operating in a 
field environment with the responsibility of supervising CSS operations 
relating to your platoon. 

Standards: Ensured the proper accountability of personnel, the control of 
the platoon health procedures, the verification of financial readiness, the 
control of supply accountability and LOGPAC procedures , and the control of 
the platoon's movement. Task was performed in accordance with current 
doctrine and unit SOP. 

Performance Steps 

1. Account for personnel. 

a. Verify status report. 

b. Review DA Form 1 1 55 and DA Form 1 1 56, Casualty Feeder Report. 
Control the platoon's health procedures . 

a. Verify evacuation procedures . 

b. Identify major components of the medical threat. 

c. Identify preventive medicine measures to prevent the threat. 

d. Identify requirement and responsibility for the FST. 

e. Identify combat lifesaver. 
Verify platoon's financial readiness. 
Control platoon's classes of supplies . 

a. Identify resource requirement. 

b. Control accountability. 

3-370 151-357-0001 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



5. Direct platoon's LOGPAC operation. 

a. Ensure that the proper log report was submitted to the company. 

b. Verify the commander's intent for resupply operations . 
5. Control the platoon movement plan. 

a. Prepare platoon movement plan. 

b. Verify route surveillance. 

c. Ensure that vehicles are fully fueled. 

d. Check for operational readiness of vehicles . 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Obtained squad personnel status report and 

completed DA Form 1 1 55 and DA Form 1 1 56 from the 

squad leaders. 

2. Processed and consolidated the information 

provided by squad leaders to prepare a platoon 

strength report. 



3. Recorded situation reports (SITREPS) and other 
personnel information. 

4. Updated the battle roster. 



5. Forwarded the platoon strength and completed DA 
Form 1 1 55 and DA Form 1 1 56 to the company 
command post. 



6. Verified that personnel were aware how to- 



d. State the purpose of the message in clear text. 



a. Collect all information needed for the MEDEVAC 
request. 

b. Record MEDEVAC information using authorized 
brevity codes. 

c. Contact the medical unit that controls «* 

evacuation. ~o 

> 



e. Transmit the MEDEVAC request information. 



CO 



7. Supervised the movement of the casualty. 



8. Verified that there was a combat lifesaver in your 
platoon. 



Skill Level 4 151-357-0001 3-371 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

9. Coordinated with medical personnel to ensure 

platoon had properly trained personnel. 

1 0. Supervised the actions of the combat lifesaver. 



1 1 . Verified platoon basic pay and entitlements. 



12. Verified accuracy of platoon LES. 



13. Conducted predeloyment review of platoon financial 
readiness. 



14. Inspected availability and accuracy of unit SOP. 
Included storage requirements, methods, facilities, and 
responsibility. 



15. Inspected location, storage method, material 
conditions, and general appearance of storage areas. 



a. For weapons and sensitive items, included 
accountability, environmental control, physical security 
and access considerations. 

b. For ammunition and explosives, included 
accountability, environmental control, physical security 
and access considerations. 

c. For petroleum, oils , and lubricants and 
flammable liquids, same as above. 



16. Verified accuracy of logistics report submitted to the 
company. 



- 



1 7. Ensured the platoon rotated for supplies, mail, 
rations, and refilled or exchanged water cans. 



1 8. Verified the rearming and refueling of the platoon. 



< 



?? rear 



19. Ensured all platoon wounded in action (WIA), killed 
in action (KIA), and enemy prisoners of war (EPW) 
were present at the resupply point for transport to the 



" 



20. Verified KIA were separated from WIA and EPWs. 



2. 21 . Verified vehicles needing unit level or higher 
maintenance stopped in maintenance holding area. 



22. Ensured a precombat inspection was done after 
resupply operation was complete. 



3-372 151-357-0001 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures 


GO 


NO GO 


23. Coordinated with company on movement orders. 


24. Verified route. 


25. Conducted pre-combat inspection on assigned 
vehicles and equipment. 







Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 8-1 0-6 
FM 10-27-4 
FM 21-10 
FM 55-30 
FM 100-10 
TC21-7 

151-357-0002 

Coordinate Combat Service Support (CSS) Operations 

Conditions:You are assigned the position of support operations NCO and 
are responsible for supervising CSS operations in a Force XXI and AOE 
organization. 

Standards: Prioritized support requirements, identified logistical capabilities 
(including medical), determined logistical planning considerations, and listed 
the roles and responsibilities of assigned personnel. These duties were 
performed in accordance with established directives, current doctrine, and 
local SOP and applied to Force XXI and AOE. 

Performance Steps 

1. Become familiar with CSS missions and organization in AOE and Force 5 
XXI units. J 

a. Identify functional responsibilities of CSS staff. 

b. List basic elements for CSS support planning. 

c. Recognize the primary support capabilities of a DISCOM corps support 
group. 

Skill Level 4 151-357-0002 3-373 




Performance Steps 



2. Describe the responsibilities of the support operations NCO in managing 
all classes of supplies. 

a. Identify external support requirements. 

b. Assess internal support assets required to accomplish customer 
support. 

c. Prioritize support based on commander's guidance (SOP, policies, 
customer needs, and supporting units capabilities). 

d. Provide input for external support SOP. 

e. Plan future support operations. 

f. Manage internal support mission. 

g. Conduct logistics planning. 

h. Plan all supply, maintenance, and supply service operations. 

3. Discern CSS structure for Force XXI and AOE division, corps, and theater 
levels. 

a. Sequence the supply flow from depot to foxhole. 

b. List responsibilities of personnel. 

c. Apply support operations. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 




1 . Listed staff session capabilities, mission, and 
responsibilities. 



a. Verified support capabilities of internal staff. 



b. Verified support capabilities on next higher 
echelon. 



c. Coordinated efforts based on known functions 
and capabilities. 

d. Evaluated sustainment capabilities of support 
operations procedures. 

e. Reviewed the accuracy of unit SOP. 

2. Ensured that staff employed the sustainment 
imperatives of anticipation, integration, continuity, 
responsiveness, and improvisation. 



a. Anticipated placement of Classes I, II, III, IMP, 
IV, V, VI, VIII, IX, water, and other support. 

b. Ensured METT-TC were always considered. 



3-374 151-357-0002 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

c. Verified that operations were supported at every 
stage of planning and execution. 

d. Tailored configured load based on priority, 
customer, and mission responsiveness to changing 
tactical situations. 

e. Participated in internal and external exercises 
designed to measure responsiveness to changing 
tactical situations. 

f. Identified staff counterpart at DISCOM or corps 
support group support operations section. 

g. Prepared required reports for submission to 
support operations officer and higher headquarters. 

h. Identified internal support requirements to all 
battalion staff sections . 



c. Verified the accuracy of logistics reports. 



- 



i. Tracked command -directed critical supplies and 
equipment. 

3. Reviewed logistics reports from subordinate units. 

a. Prepared consolidated report for support 
operations staff. 

b. Updated critical equipment list. 



d. Maintained customer density lists. 



e. Maintained asset visibility. 



4. Verified support requirements for Classes I, II, III, 

NIP, IV, V, VI, VII, VIII, and IX. 

a. Identified current location of storage and support 
facilities. 

b. Obtained projected location of storage and 
support facilities. I „ 

c. Maintained visibility of all stockage levels. g 

d. Assisted in conducting authorized stockage list _i 
(ASL) review board. = 

e. Served as subject matter expert (SME) and w 
evaluator of subordinate unit inspections or assistance 
visits. 

f. Coordinated field service support. 
Skill Level 4 151-357-0002 3-375 




Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 


5. Coordinated movement requirements . 


a. Selected most appropriate model based on 
commander's priorities . 




b. Provided (based on METT-TC) input in creating 
multifunctional modular support packages for 
deployment operations . 




c. Assessed internal lift capabilities. 


d. Requested external support assets. 


e. Conducted terrain analysis. 


6. Coordinated with appropriate medical support units. 


a. Identified appropriate POCs. 


b. Assisted in coordinating medical support for 
battalion. 





Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

DAPam 710-2-2 
FM 63-2 
FM 63-2-1 
FM 63-20 
FM 63-20-1 
FM 63-21 
FM 63-21-1 
FM 63-23-2 
FM 100-10 

159-200-2020 

Integrate Threat Capabilities into Mission Planning. 

Conditions: You are assigned to a battalion staff in the operations (S3) or 
intelligence (S2) section. Your battalion is tasked to plan and conduct a field 
operation based on a brigade operations order. You have access to the 

3-376 159-200-2020 Skill Level 4 



brigade operations order, the brigade intelligence estimate, and the battalion 
commander's initial guidance. You have access to tactical C4I systems. 

Standards: Correctly identified global threats to the United States and its 
forces. Correctly identified threat capabilities for the specific tactical and 
operational situation. Integrated threat capabilities into all courses of action 
(COA) analysis and mission planning. 

Performance Steps 

1. Identify global threats. 

a. Identify global trends. 

b. Characterize the global threat environment. 

c. Recognize competitors to U.S. interests. 

d. Recognize asymmetrical threat methods and actions. 

2. Determine threat capabilities. 

a. Evaluate Intelligence estimate from higher headquarters . 

b. Recognize available database sources of threat information. 

c. Access Interlink or Interlink-S sources of regional information. 

d. Access MIDB. 

e. Access unclassified Internet (www) sources of regional information. 

3. Apply threat capabilities to COA analysis and mission planning. 

a. Wargame most likely threat COA against friendly plans and incorporate 
into mission plans. 

b. Wargame most dangerous threat COA against friendly plans and 
incorporate into mission plans. 

c. Identify potential vulnerabilities to friendly plans and incorporate into 
mission plans. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide the soldier with the materials listed in the conditions 
statement and a copy of the performance measures. The performance of 
this task could be evaluated during a training exercise. 

Brief Soldier: Tell soldier that he will be evaluated on correctly passing all the ^ 

performance measures. "3 

> 

Performance Measures GO NO GO j 

1. Identified four major global trends and their effect on 2 

the operational environment. OT 

2. Described the global threat environment. Described 
how it is different from that of the Cold War era. 



Skill Level 4 159-200-2020 3-377 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

3. Described asymmetrical methods. Explained the 

difference between asymmetrical and conventional 

military methods. 

4. Located the intelligence estimate within an 
operations order. 



B- 



< 



5. Derived applicable information from higher 
headquarters intelligence estimate. 



6. Identified four available databases containing threat 
information. 



7. Retrieved regional and threat-specific information 
from Interlink or Interlink-S. 



8. Retrieved regional and threat-specific information 
from unclassified Internet sources. 



9. Identified the most likely threat COA and the most 
dangerous threat COA. 



10. Identified at least one potential vulnerability in the 
friendly plan. 



1 1 . Incorporated threat findings in all mission planning. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show the soldier what was done wrong and 
how to do it correctly. 



References 
Required Related 

FM 34-1 30 



181-101-4001 

Conduct a Search/Seizure 

(/) 

5; Conditions: You are a soldier in the U.S. Army. As a soldier, you are 

responsible for identifying and understanding protections of the 4th 
Amendment of the U.S. Constitution against unreasonable searches and 
2. seizures and its application in the U.S. Army. You must also identify and 
understand who is permitted to authorize a search; the search's legal basis, 
purpose, and scope; and permissible exceptions to the 4th Amendment. 
Additionally, you must identify and understand the differences between an 
inspection and a search. 



3-378 181-101-4001 Skill Level 4 



Standards: Identified and understood the protections of the 4th Amendment 
of the U.S. Constitution against unreasonable searches and seizures and its 
application in the U.S. Army. Identified and understood who was permitted 
to authorize a search; the search's legal basis, purpose, and scope; and 
permissible exceptions to the 4th Amendment. Identified and understood 
the differences between an inspection and a search. 

Performance Steps 

1 . List the authority for search and seizure. 

a. Describe the 4th Amendment to the U.S. Constitution's protection 
against unreasonable searches and seizures. 

b. Describe the 4th Amendment to the U.S. Constitution's applicability to 
U.S. Army soldiers. 

c. Describe the necessity for the 4th Amendment to the U.S. Constitution 
to apply differently to soldiers and civilians. 

d. Describe the 4th Amendment to the U.S. Constitution's requirement 
that a search or seizure be based on probable cause and a "warrant" or 
"authorization" in the armed forces. 

2. Identify the requirements for conducting a search or seizure. 

a. Describe the requirement for the commander to first determine 
whether probable cause exists and define what constitutes probable cause to 
search. 

b. Describe the totality of the circumstances test used to evaluate 
whether probable cause exists. 

3. Describe which person(s) have the authority to authorize a search. 

a. Describe where this authority is derived. 

b. Describe whether this authority can be further delegated. 

c. Describe why it might be preferable to have a military magistrate or 
military judge authorize a search instead of the commander. 

d. Describe the requirement for a commander to have authority over the 
place to be searched in order to authorize a search of that place. 

e. Describe whether a commander has authority to authorize a search of 
a soldier's off-post quarters or personal property in the continental United 
States (CONUS). 

4. Describe the procedures required to obtain an authorization to search. 

5. Describe the scope of an authorized search. 

6. Describe the requirement for the commander to be neutral and detached 

7. Describe exceptions to the 4th Amendment. 

a. Describe various types of searches that are exceptions to the 4th 

Skill Level 4 181-101-4001 3-379 




Performance Steps 




Amendment. 

(1) Describe the necessity for the suspect to have a reasonable 
expectation of privacy in the area searched. 

(2) Describe the 4th Amendment's application to the search of 
Government property. 

(3) Describe the 4th Amendment's application to items in "open view." 

b. Describe a consent search. 

(1) Describe whether command authorization is required with a 
consent search. 

(2) Describe whether probable cause is required with a consent 
search. 

(3) Describe the requirement for the consent to be voluntary or freely 
given. 

(4) Describe the applicability of the totality of the circumstances test 
to a consent search. 

(5) Describe how the consent may be partial or limited and the 
restrictions this places on the search. 

(6) Describe withdrawal of consent and its effect on continuation of 
the search. 

c. Describe search incident to apprehension. 

(1) Describe the legitimate reasons for such a search. 

(2) Describe the scope or parameters of such a search. 

d. Describe search under exigent circumstances. 

(1) Define what constitutes exigent circumstances. 

(2) Describe the legitimate reasons for conducting a search under 
exigent circumstances. 

(3) Describe whether a search authorization is required for search 
under exigent circumstances. 

e. Describe the requirement and importance of maintaining a proper 
chain of custody. 

8. Describe inspection procedures. 

a. Define inspection. 

b. Describe the primary purpose test of inspection. 

c. Describe the scope of inspection. 

d. Describe whether the 4th Amendment restricts a commander's 
authority to order an administrative inspection. 

3-380 181-101-4001 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



e. Describe the relationship between a "search" and an "inspection." 

f. Describe the subterfuge rule regarding an "inspection." 

g. Describe health and welfare Inspection. 

(1) Describe the primary purpose and scope of health and welfare 
inspection. 

(2) Describe whether the use of drug detection dogs during health 
and welfare inspection is permissible. 

h. Describe the permissibility of a commander conducting an inspection 
or "lock-down" for lost weapons or ammunition. 

i. Describe the permissibility of a gate i nspection. 

j. Describe the admissibility of evidence at trial obtained through an 
illegal search or inspection. 

k. Describe the authority of a commander to conduct an inventory of a 
soldier's property. 

(1) List the circumstances under which an inventory is required. 

(2) Describe whether contraband discovered during inventory may be 
seized and used as evidence in a criminal prosecution. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Evaluate this task at the end of military justice training on conducting 
searches and seizures. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier that he will be evaluated on his ability to 
identify and understand protections of the 4th Amendment of the U.S. 
Constitution against unreasonable searches and seizures and its application 
in the U.S. Army. Tell the soldier that he will also be evaluated on his ability 
to identify and understand who is permitted to authorize a search; the 
search's legal basis, purpose, and scope; and permissible exceptions to the 
4th Amendment. Tell the soldier that he will also be evaluated on his ability 
to identify and understand the differences between an inspection and a 
search. 



*r 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Listed the authority for search and seizure. "3 



a. Described the 4th Amendment's protection 
against unreasonable searches and seizures . 

b. Described the 4th Amendment's applicability to 
U.S. Army soldiers. 



CO 



c. Described the necessity for the 4th Amendment 
to apply differently to soldiers and civilians. 

Skill Level 4 181-101-4001 3-381 




b. Described whether this authority can be further 
delegated. 



5. Described the scope of an authorized search. 



— 7. Described exceptions to the 4th Amendment. 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

d. Described the 4th Amendment requirement that 
a search or seizure be based on probable cause and a 
"warrant" or "authorization" in the armed forces. 

2. Identified the requirements for conducting a search 

or seizure. 

a. Described the requirement for the commander tc 
first determine whether probable cause existed and 
defined what constitutes probable cause to search. 

b. Described the totality of the circumstances test 
used to evaluate whether probable cause existed. 

3. Described which person(s) have the authority to 
authorize a search. 

a. Described where this authority is derived. 



- 



c. Described why it might be preferable to have a 
military magistrate or military judge authorize a search 
instead of the commander. 

d. Described the requirement for a commander to 
have authority over the place to be searched in order to 
authorize a search of that place. 

e. Described whether a commander has authority 
to authorize a search of a soldier's off-post quarters or 
personal property in the continental United States 
(CONUS). 

4. Described the procedures required to obtain an 
authorization to search. 




6. Described the requirement for the commander to be 
neutral and detached. 



a. Described various types of searches that are 
exceptions to the 4th Amendment. 



(1 ) Described the necessity for the suspect to 
have a reasonable expectation of privacy in the area 
searched. 



3-382 181-101-4001 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

(2) Described the 4th Amendment application to 
the search of Government property. 

(3) Described the 4th Amendment application to 

items in "open view." 

b. Described a consent search. 

(1) Described whether command authorization 
is required with a consent search. 

(2) Described whether probable cause is 

required with a consent search. 

(3) Described the requirement for the consent to 
be voluntary or freely given. 



c. Described search incident to apprehension. 



e. Described the requirement and importance of 
maintaining a proper chain of custody. 

8. Described inspection procedures. 



- 



(4) Described the applicability of the totality of 
the circumstances test to a consent search. 

(5) Described how the consent may be partial or 
limited and the restrictions this places on the search. 

(6) Described withdrawal of consent and its 
effect on continuation of the search. 



(1) Described the legitimate reasons for such a 
search. 



(2) Described the scope or parameters of such 
a search. 

d. Described search under exigent circumstances. 

(1) Defined what constitutes exigent 
circumstances. 

(2) Described the legitimate reasons for 
conducting search under exigent circumstances. 

(3) Described whether a search authorization is 
required for a search under exigent circumstances. 



Q) 

> 

0) 



j£ 



a. Defined inspection. OT 

b. Described the primary purpose test of 
inspection. 

c. Described the scope of inspection. 

Skill Level 4 181-101-4001 3-383 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

d. Described whether the 4th Amendment restricts 
a commander's authority to order an administrative 
inspection. 

e. Described the relationship between a "search" 
and an "inspection." 



f. Described the subterfuge rule regarding 
inspection. 



g. Described health and welfare inspection. 



- 



(1) Described the primary purpose and scope of 
a health and welfare inspection. 

(2) Described whether the use of drug detection 
dogs during a health and welfare inspection is 

permissible. 

h. Described the permissibility of a commander 
conducting an inspection or "lock-down" for lost 
weapons or ammunition. 

i. Described the permissibility of agate inspection. 

j. Described the admissibility of evidence at trial 
obtained through an illegal search or inspection. 

k. Described the authority of a commander to 
conduct an inventory of a soldier's property. 

(1) Listed the circumstances under which an 

inventory is required. 

(2) Described whether contraband discovered 
during an Inventory may be seized and used as 
evidence in a criminal prosecution. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 



551-721-4326 

Perform Duties as Convoy Commander 

Conditions:You are required to perform duties as a convoy commander. 
Given an alert notification of a convoy move, AR 55-162, a specified number 
of vehicles, personnel, convoy commander's briefing, and the task to 
command a convoy. 

3-384 551-721-4326 Skill Level 4 



Standards: Ensured that personnel were briefed on convoy operations; 
there were ample vehicles and personnel to transport cargo; all support 
elements were informed of the date and time of the convoy; all orders were 
brief and to the point; proper reconnaissance was carried out; and vehicles 
were correctly lined up according to cargo, size, and use. 

Performance Steps 

1. Start initial planning steps. 

a. Alert unit operation. 

b. Review operation order. 

(1) Determine the number of vehicles needed. 

(2) Break columns down into manageable groups of 20 vehicles or 
less. 

(3) Determine requirements needed for given situation. 

(4) Divide march column in three parts: head, main body, and trail. 

(a) Head — the first task vehicle or pacesetter. 

(b) Main Body — troop carrying, equipment and/or supply 
vehicles. 

(c) Trail — wrecker, maintenance and medical support 
vehicles/teams. Trail officer/noncommissioned officer is responsible for 
maintenance and medical support. 

2. Schedule convoy commander's briefing with the battalion operations 
officer (S3). 

a. Determine which unit will provide security. 

b. Find out who will be the security elements commander. 

c. Discuss any topic not covered or not clear. 

d. Discuss the threat to include target acquisition and intelligence that 
may impact on convoy success. 

3. Commander's briefing. 

a. Take notes. 

b. Update maps, if appropriate. 

4. Prepare convoy commander's checklist. Items supervisors and 
drivers need to be briefed — 

(a) Rules of the road. 

(b) Traffic laws or regulations. 

(c) Speed limits. 

(d) Time and distance gaps. 

(e) Routing plans. 

Skill Level 4 551-721-4326 3-385 




Performance Steps 




(f) Schedules. 

(g) March discipline. 

5. Map reconnaissance. 

a. Select tentative check points or confirm already established 
checkpoints . 

b. Contact those units whose combat areas they will be passing 
through, and find out about trouble areas and ambush sites. 

6. Ground reconnaissance. 

a. Select sites for scheduled halts, mess, and refueling that will safely 
accommodate convoy personnel and equipment. 

b. Select release point. 

c. Identify problem areas along the route. 

d. Select a bypass or alternate route. 

7. Review the reconnaissance map and make a final s election. 

8. Give a copy of the map marked with all convoy information to the 
battalion S3. 

a. Request convoy clearance from the battalion S3. 

b. Request copy of movement graphs from the battalion S3. 

9. Coordinate to obtain artillery support with the artillery unit. 

a. Use information from the security officer or obtained by route 
reconnaissance to plan fire support. 

b. Determine the type of ammunition to be fired under various 
conditions. 

c. Determine the number of rounds to be fired at given targets. 

d. Determine the types of targets that warrant fire missions. 

10. Mark on the map the range limitations of each artillery unit. 

1 1 . Plan/coordinate with the escort and security elements (military police 
units) for convoy security. 

a. Maintain noise and light discipline. 

b. Maintain front, flank, and rear security. 

c. Conduct security measures during halts. 

d. Request air cover (as required). 

e. Request fire support (as required). 

f. Maintain convoy communication. 

12. Direct the placement of guides and signs along the convoy route. 

3-386 551-721-4326 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



a. The authority in charge of movement has responsibility for placing 
guides and signs. 

b. Guides and signs can be used to direct the convoy. 

13. Brief/issue work assignments to subordinate elements. 

1 4. Direct the operation section to prepare strip maps and/or overlays (as 
required). 

15. Prepare for vehicle movement. 

a. Perform vehicle preventive maintenance checks and services 
(PMCS). 

(1) Perform before operation PMCS using the appropriate -10 
level manual. 

(2) Check for and have items repaired, filled, or adjusted as 
needed. 

b. Mark vehicles for the convoy move. 

(1) Place a "Convoy Follows" sign on the first task vehicle, below 
the windshield in a conspicuous location. 

(2) Place a "Convoy Ahead" sign on the rear of the last task 
vehicle. 

(3) Identify the lead vehicle with a 1 2- by 1 8-inch blue flag on the 
left (driver's) side. 

(4) Identify the convoy commander and the serial commander with 
a 1 2- by 1 8-inch black and white (divided diagonally) flag on the left 
(driver's) side. 

(5) Identify the last vehicle with a 12- by 18-inch green flag on the 
left (driver's) side. 

(6) Identify vehicles with a convoy identification number. 

(7) Ensure that all vehicles are marked in accordance with 
AR 55-1 62. 

c. Establish convoy communications. 

(1) Radio is the best means of communication during convoy. 

(2) Remember radio signals can be intercepted. 

d. Load cargo and equipment onto vehicles/trailers or semitrailers (as 
required). 

e. Assemble inspection area. 

(1) Ensure the area is large enough to accommodate vehicles. 

(2) Ensure that the maintenance team in the assembly area 
inspects vehicles. 

Skill Level 4 551-721-4326 3-387 




Performance Steps 




(3) Ensure that all personnel and equipment are inspected in the 
assembly area. 

16. Prepare the convoy briefing on the following — 

a. Rules of the road. 

b. Traffic laws or regulations. 

c. Speed limits. 

d. Time and distance gaps. 

e. Routing plans. 

f. Schedules. 

g. March discipline. 

1 7. Hand out strip maps and brief convoy personnel. 

1 8. Give signal/order to start engines. 

1 9. Give signal/order to move out. 

20. Maintain organizational control by — 

a. Monitoring communication. 

b. Maintaining communication with subordinate element 
commanders. 

c. Making on-the-spot corrections. 

d. Informing subordinate element commanders of control infractions 
and ordering them to take corrective actions. 

21 . Direct at-halt activities, monitor activities in progress, and make on- 
the-spot corrections. 

22. Give signal/order to reform and start engines. 

23. Give signal/order to move out. 

24. Direct the off-loading of cargo/equipment at the release point, as 
required. 

25. Inform higher headquarters of the convoy status. 

26. Inform fire support unit(s) of the convoy status. 

27. Evaluate task performance, noting personnel — 

a. To be acknowledged for outstanding work performance. 

b. To be acknowledged for substandard work performance and/or 
scheduled for training. 

28. Prepare convoy command's report and give a copy to higher 
headquarters. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

3-388 551-721-4326 Skill Level 4 



Setup: Evaluate this task during a field training exercise or normal training 
session. Provide the soldier with the items listed in the conditions statement. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier he will be evaluated on his ability to properly 
perform duties as a convoy commander. 



6. Conducted a ground reconnaissance if time 
permitted and noted on the map clearances of 
overhead structures/obstacles; load classifications; 
speed limits; and rest, mess, and refueling sites that 
would safely accommodate convoy personnel and 
equipment. 

7. Reviewed reconnaissance map and made final 
selection of primary and alternate routes, and rest, 
mess, and refueling areas. 

8. Gave a copy of the map with all convoy information 
marked on it to the battalion S3 and requested a 
clearance if not already initiated. Also requested that 
the move be plotted and a copy of the movement graph 
be issued. 



12. Directed the placement of guides and signs along 
the convoy route. 



Performance Measures 


GO NO GO 


1. Started initial planning steps. 


a. Alerted unit operation. 


b. Reviewed operation order. 


2. Scheduled convoy commander's briefing with the 
battalion S3 officer. 


3. Attended convoy commander's briefing, took notes, 
and updated maps. 


4. Prepared convoy commander's checklist. 


5. Conducted a map reconnaissance to select and 
mark routes/sites not dictated by higher headquarters. 






9. Coordinated to obtain artillery support with artillery 

unit. * 

10. Marked on the map the range limitations of each > 

artillery unit. j 

11. Planned/coordinated with the escort and security 2 

elements (military police units), security fire support, air OT 
support, and convoy communications needs. 



Skill Level 4 551-721-4326 3-389 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

13. Issued work assignments to subordinate element 

commanders and briefed them on performance 

standards required. 

14. Directed the operation section to prepare strip maps 

and/or overlays (as required). ~~ 



15. Prepared for vehicle movement. 



a. Performed vehicle PMCS. 



b. Marked vehicles for convoy move. 



c. Established convoy communications. 



e. Assembled inspection area. 



(2) Ensured that all personnel and equipment 
were inspected in the assembly area. 

16. Prepared the convoy briefing. 



1 7. Handed out strip maps and briefed convoy 
personnel on the situation, mission, execution, 
administration and logistics, and safety. 



(1) Placed "Convoy Follows" sign on the first 
task vehicle, below the windshield in a conspicuous 
location. 

(2) Placed "Convoy Ahead" on the rear of the 
last task vehicle. 

(3) Identified the lead vehicle with a 12- by 18- 
inch blue flag on the left (driver's) side. 

(4) Identified convoy commander and serial 
commander with a 12- by 18-inch black and white 
(divided diagonally) flag on the left (driver's) side. 

(5) Identified the last vehicle with a 1 2- by 1 8- 
inch green flag on the left (driver's) side. 

(6) Identified vehicles with convoy identification 
number. 

(7) Ensured that all vehicles were marked in 
accordance with AR 65-1 62. 






d. Loaded cargo and equipment onto vehicles/ 
trailers or semitrailers (as required). 



(1) Ensured that the maintenance team in the 
assembly area inspected vehicles . 



" 



3-390 551-721-4326 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 8. Gave signal/order to start engines. 



1 9. Gave signal/order to move out. 



20. Maintained organizational control by — 



a. Monitoring communication. 



b. Maintaining communication with subordinate 
element commanders. 



c. Making on-the-spot corrections. 



d. Informing subordinate commanders of control 
infractions and ordering them to take corrective actions. 



21 . Directed at-halt activities, monitored activities in 
progress, and made on-the-spot corrections. 

22. Gave signal/order to reform and start engines. 



23. Gave signal/order to move out. 



24. Directed the off-loading of cargo/equipment at 
release point, as required. 



25. Informed higher headquarters of the convoy status. 



26. Informed fire support unit(s) of the convoy status. 



27. Evaluated task performance, noting personnel — 



a. To be acknowledged for outstanding work 
performance. 



b. To be acknowledged for substandard work 
performance and/or scheduled for training. 

28. Prepared convoy commander's report and gave a 

copy to higher headquarters. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures ^ 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. "3 
If the soldier fails , show him what was done wrong and how to do it correctly. §J 



CO 



Skill Level 4 551-721-4326 3-391 



SUBJECT AREA 23: SECURITY AND CONTROL 



191-379-4408 

Plan Security for a Command Post (CP) 

Conditions:You are a military police (MP) platoon sergeant and your 
platoon has been given a mission to provide security for a CP. You will have 
orders; information on the size and layout of the CP (massed or dispersed); 
inform ation on mission, enemy, terrain, troops, time available, and civilian 
considerations (METT-TC); and access to the provost marshal (PM) and 
headquarters personnel. 

Standards: Developed a security plan that included all required elements to 
detect the enemy and to defend the CP before the enemy could move within 
direct-fire range. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Determine the number of personnel available to conduct CP security 
to include augmented personnel (for example, corps assets and the 
division band). Consider METT-TC and the CP size and layout. 
Note. For dispersed CPs, MP security is concentrated toward providing early 
warning through screening operations. For massed CPs, the type of MP security 
provided depends on the presence or absence of augmentation. Only when a CP is 
massed can the MP provide close-in security through augmentation from corps 
assets. 

2. Identify personnel to secure critical facilities within the CP. 
Note. Critical facilities within the CP requiring security and controlled access 
include the tactical operations center, the war room, the communications center, 
the facilities for special intelligence, and the commander's quarters. 

3. Conduct reconnaissance of the routes to the CP and areas around it. 

4. Plan the best method and/or mix of forces for security, varying 
between massed and dispersed CPs, to include static posts, traffic control 
posts (TCPs), listening posts (LPs), observation posts (OPs), access 

w control, mobile patrols, and quick-response forces (both organic and 
SI augmenting). 

JT 5. Determine the number of personnel required to provide close-in 
< security for the commander within the area of operations. 

* 6. Determine the amount of Class IX barrier materials needed. 

7. Request the barrier materials through the appropriate channels. 

8. Obtain an access list (of personnel authorized in the CP) from the PM 
or headquarters personnel. 

3-392 191-379-4408 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



9. Prepare plans for the internal security of the CP. Coordinate directly 
with the existing security forces, access control personnel, Headquarters 
personnel, and the PM, as appropriate. 

10. Plan for security of tactical CPs when established and when in transit. 

1 1 . Prepare a standing operating procedure (SOP) and/or special orders 
detailing duties, responsibilities, and procedures to be used to provide 
security to the CP. 

12. Brief all soldiers included in the CP security on the tactical situation 
and the defensive plans. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.This task may be evaluated in the field or in a classroom 
environment. Provide the soldier with information on the size and layout of 
the CP (massed or dispersed), a map of the area, and METT-TC. The 
evaluator will act as PM and headquarters personnel and answer any 
questions the soldier may have for which information has not been provided. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Determined the number of personnel available to 

conduct CP security to include augmented personnel. 

2. Identified personnel to secure critical facilities within 

theCP. 

3. Conducted reconnaissance of the routes to the CP 

and areas around it. 

4. Planned the best method and/or mix of forces for 
security varying between massed and dispersed CPs to 
include static posts, TCPs, LPs, OPs, access control, 
mobile patrols, and quick-response forces (both organic 
and augmenting). 

5. Determined the number of personnel required to 
provide close-in security for the commander within the 
area of operations. 

6. Determined the amount of Class IX barrier materials 

needed. 

7. Requested the barrier materials through the 
appropriate channels. 






8. Obtained an access list (of personnel authorized in 
the CP) from the PM or headquarters personnel. 



0) 

> 



CO 



Skill Level 4 191-379-4408 3-393 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

9. Prepared plans for the internal security of the CP. 

Coordinated directly with the existing security forces, 

access control personnel, headquarters personnel, and 

the PM, as appropriate. 

10. Planned for security of tactical CPs when established 

and when in transit. 



" 



1 1 . Prepared an SOP and/or special orders detailing 
duties, responsibilities, and procedures to be used to 
provide security to the CP. 

12. Briefed all soldiers included in the CP security on the 
tactical situation and the defensive plans. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier fails any performance measure, show him how to do it correctly. 



References 
Required Related 

FM 3-19.4 



SUBJECT AREA 26: CRIME PREVENTION 



191-379-4425 

Implement the Unit's Crime Prevention Program 

Conditions:You are given the unit crime prevention standing operating 
procedures (SOP), the results of the last organizational inspection program 
(OIP), a copy of the installation's crime prevention program, and FM 3-1 9.30. 

Standards: Implemented the unit crime prevention program in accordance 
with the unit SOP and the installation crime prevention program. 

Performance Steps 

O) 1. Review the unit crime prevention SOP and the installation's crime 
* prevention program to identify unique unit/installation needs and 
requirements. 

§ 2. Review the results of the unit's last OIP for deficiencies identified during 
the last inspection. 

3. Conduct crime prevention surveys in accordance with the unit crime 
prevention SOP. 



3-394 191-379-4425 Skill Level 4 



Performance Steps 



4. Ensure that unit equipment is marked in accordance with Army 
regulations and command guidance. 

Note. Equipment markings vary greatly depending on the type of equipment 
assigned to the unit. Check unit SOPs, technical manuals, and/or Army regulations 
to determine the correct procedures for marking unit equipment. 

5. Brief unit soldiers on "Operation ID" to include the following: 

a. Methods of identifying personal property. 

b. Recording personal property 

c. Identification numbering. 

d. Standard Army numbering system. 

6. Attend the battalion or brigade crime prevention working groups as 
required by the SOP and/or the installation crime prevention program. 

7. Conduct crime prevention briefings to unit personnel as required by the 
unit SOP and/or the installation crime prevention program. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Reviewed the unit crime prevention SOP and the 

installation crime prevention program to identify unique 

unit/installation needs and requirements. 



2. Reviewed the results of the unit's last OIP for 
deficiencies identified during the last inspection. 



3. Conducted crime prevention surveys in accordance 
with the unit crime prevention SOP. 



E- 



4. Ensured that unit equipment was marked in 

accordanc 

guidance. 



accordance with Army regulations and command 



5. Briefed unit soldiers on "Operation ID. 



6. Attended the battalion or brigade crime prevention 
working groups as required by the SOP and/or the 
installation crime prevention program. 



7. Conducted crime prevention briefings to unit J 

personnel as required by the unit SOP and/or the ^ 

installation crime prevention program. 



CO 



Skill Level 4 191-379-4425 3-395 




References 

Required Related 

FM 3-19.30 



SUBJECT AREA 27: RISK MANAGEMENT 



850-001-4001 

Integrate Risk Management into Mission Plans 

Conditions: You are a small unit leader. Given a mission or task, in a 
garrison or tactical environment, access to FM 1 00-1 4, and a risk 
management worksheet. 

Standards: Completed all sections of the risk management worksheet. 



Performance Steps 



1. Conduct a risk assessment. 

a. Identify the hazards associated with the mission or task. 

b. Assess the hazards to determine their impact on the mission or task. 

2. Develop controls. 

a. Develop one or more controls that will eliminate the hazard or reduce 
the risk. 

b. Determine the residual risk for each hazard and the overall residual risk 
for the mission or task. 

c. Decide who is authorized to accept the risk. 

3. Identify ways to implement the controls 

a. Decide how controls will be put into effect. 

b. Coordinate and communicate control measures up and down the 
chain-of-command. 

4. Identify how to supervise and evaluate the controls. 

a. Determine how each control will be monitored. 

b. Evaluate the effectiveness of each control. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task you need an assigned mission ortaskthatmay 
be in the form of an operations order (OPORD), fragmentary order 
(FRAGO), warning order, patrol order, training task, and so forth . The 
soldier will apply the risk management process to the assigned missio n task. 

Brief Soldier: Tell the soldier you are going to evaluate him on his ability to 
apply the risk management process. 

3-396 850-001-4001 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Identified all the hazards associated with the 

mission or task (a minimum of one, depending on the 
mission or task). 



2. Determined the level of risk (E, H, M, L) for each 
hazard. 



3. Developed at least one control for each hazard. 



4. Determined the residual risk for each hazard. 



5. Determined how controls will be implemented. 



6. Determined the overall residual risk for the mission 
or task. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was done wrong and how to do 
it correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

FM 100-14 FM 101-5 



SUBJECT AREA 28: ADMINISTRATION/MANAGEMENT 



805C-PAD-4359 

Manage Soldier's Deployment Requirements 

Conditions:Given a requirement to prepare a section for deployment, 
access to FM 3-0, FM 55-65, FM 1 00-1 7, and AR 600-8-1 04, standard office 
supplies, equipment, assigned personnel, and transportation and local 
directives. 

Standards: Performed initial deployment activities to include verification of 
section/platoon roster, recall/alert roster, individual SRP packets and load 



^ , 



plan. > 



Performance Steps 



1 . Perform initial deployment activities. 

a. Review soldier readiness processing (SRP) packets to identify 
deployable and non-deployable soldiers. 

b. Review sections recall procedures. 



03 



Skill Level 4 805C-PAD-4359 3-397 



Performance Steps 



c. Identify any special items of clothing or equipment the section needs, 
based on climate, location, or local SOP. 

d. Keep soldiers informed: 

(1) Determine mission. 

(2) Determine unit movement plans. 

(3) Determine requirements for advance party personnel. 

(4) Determine individual/unit equipment layout. 

(5) Determine security guidance to include OPSEC and subversion 
and espionage directed against the Army (SAEDA). 

e. Determine equipment status. 

(1) Ensure equipment and vehicle requirements based on the AOC, 
such as camouflaging. 

(2) Ensure requirements to retrieve equipment and maintenance. 

(3) Ensure requirement to retrieve loaned equipment. 

f. Determine records requirements. 

(1) Ensure records needed to operate effectively and efficiently at the 
new location accompany the unit. 

(2) Determine local requirement. 

g. Determine procedures for station property. 

(1 ) Ensure all TOE equipment is accounted for properly with the 
appropriate property book officers. 

(2) Prepare a hand receipt or annex for station property. 

(3) Turn in excess POL and PLL. 

(4) Turn in or transfer fixed facilities to a non-deploying unit. 

(5) Cancel outstanding requisitions or give a ship-to address to the 
servicing supply support activity (SSA). 

2. Prepare equipment for deployment: 

a. Maintain current equipment inventory. 
w 
2; b. Maintain current load plans. Ensure that these plans are based on 

real-world contingencies and include both programmed and immediate 

considerations. 

(1) Ensure load plans include current MTOE equipment. 

(2) Adjust load plans as MTOE equipment changes. 

(3) Adjust load plans for the type of transportation to be utilized. 
(4) Adjust load plans for mission requirements and location 

3-398 805C-PAD-4359 Skill Level 4 



< 

CD 



Performance Steps 



considerations. 

(5) Maintain current visual equipment loading layout. 

c. Perform regular and preventive maintenance checks and services 
(PMCS). 

d. Obtain packing/loading materials. 

e. Load equipment, supplies , and personnel for movement. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Sefup.This task can be performed in an administrative environment. 
Soldiers should be informed to bring the section/platoon personnel roster, 
recall/alert roster, SRP packets, and load plan. At the test site verify that 
these files and documents have been properly prepared and are accurate 
and current. 

Brief Soldier: Inform the soldier that he is being evaluated on his ability to 
manage soldier deployment requirements. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 



1 . Performed initial deployment activities: 



~ 



a. Reviewed soldier readiness processing (SRP) 
packets to identify deployable and non-deployable 
soldiers. 



b. Reviewed and tested section recall procedures. 

c. Identified special items of clothing or equipment 
the section needs, based on climate, location, or local 
SOP. 

d. Kept soldiers informed: 



(1) Determined mission. 



(2) Determined unit movement plans. 



(3) Determined requirements for advance party, 
personnel. 



(4) Determined individual/unit equipment layout. 



(5) Determined security guidance to include > 



OPSEC and subversion and espionage directed against 

the Army (SAEDA). 

e. Determined equipment status. 

(1) Ensured equipment and vehicle 
requirements based on the AOC, such as 
camouflaging. 

Skill Level 4 805C-PAD-4359 3-399 



0) 



CO 




Performance Measures GO NO GO 

(2) Ensured requirements to retrieve equipment 
and maintenance. 

(3) Ensured requirement to retrieve loaned 

equipment. 

f. Determined record requirements. 



(1) Ensured records needed to operate 
effectively and efficiently at the new location 
accompanied the unit. 



(2) Determined local requirement. 



g. Determined procedures for station property. 



(1 ) Ensured all TOE equipment was accounted 
for properly with the appropriate property book officers. 



(2) Prepared a hand receipt or annex for station 
property. 



(3) Turned in excess POL and PLL. 



(5) Counseled outstanding requisitions or gave 
a ship-to address to the servicing supply support 
activity (SSA). 

2. Prepared equipment for deployment: 



a. Maintained current equipment inventory. 



- 



(4) Turned in or transferred fixed facilities to a 
non-deploying unit. 



b. Maintained current load plans . Ensured these 
plans were based on real word contingencies and 
included both programmed and immediate 
considerations. 

(1) Ensured load plans included current MTOE 
equipment. 

(2) Adjusted load plans as MTOE equipment 
changed. 

(3) Adjusted load plans for the type of 
transportation to be utilized. 

(4) Adjusted load plans for mission 
requirements and location considerations. 

(5) Maintained current visual equipment loading 
layout. 



3-400 805C-PAD-4359 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

c. Performed regular and preventive maintenance 
checks and services (PMCS) 

d. Obtained packing/loading material. 

e. Loaded equipment, supplies, and personnel for 
movement. 

Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measure failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on all performance measures specified in the 
evaluation preparation to receive a GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO 
GO, show the soldier what was wrong. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 600-8-1 04 FM3-0 

FM 4-01 .011 
FM 100-17 

805C-PAD-4550 

Prepare a Standing Operating Procedure (SOP) 

Conditions: Given a requirement to prepare an SOP to standardize routine 
or recurring actions or functions, appropriate operational references or local 
policy guidance, access to AR 25-50 and AR 380-5, computer with 
authorized software, and office supplies. 

Standards: SOP identified purpose, distribution, and references, and was in 
proper format. SOP had proper security classification marks applied (if 
applicable) and was properly authenticated. 







Performance Steps 




1. Determine purpose. 




a. Determine requirement for action/function. 




b. Analyze intended outcome. 


^ 

« 


2. Determine audience/distribution. 


> 

.3 


a. Identify level of application. 




b. Identify units, section, and personnel involved. 


CO 


3. Determine references for content. 




4. Select content for SOP. 




5. Prepare SOP. 









Skill Level 4 805C-PAD-4550 3-401 



Performance Steps 



6. Determine security classification requirements. 

7. Apply the proper security classification marking. 

8. Determine coordination requirement for approval. 

9. Coordinate SOP. 

10. Use proper format for the SOP. 

1 1 . Distribute SOP for coordination. 

12. Review coordination comments. 

13. Prepare final. 

a. Incorporate the coordination comments. 

b. Coordinate final review. 
14. Obtain authentication. 

15. Determine reproduction requirements. 

16. Distribute SOP as required by local procedures. 
Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup:To evaluate this task, gather the items listed in the conditions 
statement. Give the soldier a scenario that would provide all information 
necessary to perform the performance measures to include topic references. 
Have computer and printer or pencil and paper for soldiers to prepare SOP. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1. Determined purpose. 




a. Determined requirement for action/function. 



b. Analyzed intended outcome. 



2. Determined the audience/distribution. 



a. Identified level of application. 



b. Identified units, section, and personnel involved. 



3. Determined references for content. 



= 4. Selected content for SOP. 



ZT 



5. Prepared the SOP. 



6. Determined security classification marking. 



7. Applied the proper security classification marking. 



3-402 805C-PAD-4550 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

8. Determined coordination requirement for approval. 



9. Coordinated SOP. 



10. Used the proper format for the SOP. 



1 1 . Distributed SOP for coordination. 



12. Reviewed coordination comments. 



13. Prepared final. 



= 



a. Incorporated the coordination comments. 



b. Coordinated final review. 



14. Obtained authentication. 



15. Determined reproduction requirement. 



16. Distributed SOP as required by local procedures. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO on performance measures 
passed. Score the soldier NO GO on any performance measures failed. The 
soldier must score a GO on 80 percent of the performance measures to 
receive a GO on the task. If the soldier scores NO GO, show him what was 
done wrong and how to do it correctly. 



References 
Required Related 

AR 25-50 

AR 380-5 

FM 101-5 

Software-Office 

Software-Windows 



805C-PAD-4597 

Integrate Newly Assigned Soldiers 

Conditions:Given a section/platoon, newly assigned soldiers, and local 
policy. 

Standards: Established personnel accountability. Provided soldiers with 
health and welfare items, initial area orientations, and special orders (if 

Skill Level 4 805C-PAD-4597 3-403 





required.) Verified soldier qualification, assigned soldiers to duty positions, 
informed commander, and conducted initial counseling. 

Performance Steps 

1 . Receive new soldiers . 

a. Establish accountability. 

b. Provide health and welfare items. 

c. Provide initial required area orientations and special orders . 

2. Verify soldiers' qualifications and equipment. 

3. Determine duty assignments . 

a. Notify commander. 

b. Notify soldiers . 

4. Provide initial counseling. 

5. Update personnel accountability. 

Evaluation Preparation: 

Setup: Provide soldier with a scenario with sufficient information to 
accomplish performance steps. Provide soldier with a section/platoon battle 
roster that indicates MOS, grades and filled/vacant positions, paper and 
pencils. Scenario should provide local requirements for personnel 
accounting, health and welfare items, and area orientations. Have the 
soldier list the actions/items he would do or provide to integrate newly 
assigned soldiers. 

Brief Soldier: Inform the soldier that he will be tested on his ability to receive 
and integrate new soldiers into the section/platoon. Tell the soldier he will 
list the actions/items necessary to properly integrate newly assigned 
soldiers. 

Performance Measures GO NO GO 

1 . Received new soldiers . 



a. Established accountability. 



b. Provided health and welfare items. 



c. Provided initial area orientations and special 
orders . 



2. Verified soldiers' qualifications and equipment. 



3. Determined duty assignments. 



a. Notified commander. 



b. Notified soldiers. 



3-404 805C-PAD-4597 Skill Level 4 



Performance Measures GO NO GO 

c. Provided initial counseling. 

4. Updated personnel accountability. 



Evaluation Guidance: Score the soldier GO if all performance measures 
are passed. Score the soldier NO GO if any performance measure is failed. 
Soldier must score GO on all performance measures to receive a GO. If the 
soldier scores NO GO, show what was done wrong and how to do it 
correctly. 

References 
Required Related 

AR 600-8-1 01 




Skill Level 4 805C-PAD-4597 3-405 



Appendix A 

Proponent School or Agency Codes 

The first three digits of the task number identify the proponent school or 
agency responsible for the task. Record any comments or questions 
regarding the task summaries contained in this manual on a DA Form 2028 
(Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms) and send it to 
the proponent school with an information copy to: Commander, U.S. Army 
Training Support Center, ATTN: ATIC-ITSC-CM, Fort Eustis, VA 23604- 
5166. 



Table A-1 . Proponent School or Agency Codes 


School Code 


Command 


MANSCEN 
CM 031 
EN 052 

MP 191 


MANSCEN, Directorate of Training Development 
U.S. Army Engineer Center and Fort Leonard Wood 
320 Engineer Loop, Suite 220 
Fort Leonard Wood, MO 65473-8929 


FA 061 


Commandant, USA Field Artillery School 
ATTN: ATSF-DOTD 
Fort Sill, OK 73503-5600 


IN 
071 


Commandant, U.S. Army Infantry School 

ATTN: ATSH-OTDD 

Fort Benning, GA 31905-5700 


AHS 
081 


USAAHS, Dean, AHS 

ATTN: MCCS-HTI 

Fort Sam Houston, TX 78234-6122 


TRADOC 

DCSINT 

159 


Commander, HQ TRADOC 

ATTN: ATIN-ZA 

33 Ingalls Rd. 

Fort Monroe, VA 23651-1067 


JAG 
181 


Commandant, Judge Advocate General School 
ATTN: JAGS-TDD 
600 Massie Road 
Charlottesville, VA 22903-1781 



A-1 



Table A-1 . Proponent School or Agency Codes 


School Code 


Command 


APAC 
224 


Director, Army Public Affairs Center 

6 ACR Road, Bldg 8607 

ATTN: SAPA-PA 

Fort Meade, MD 20755-5650 


Ml 
301 


Commander, USA Intelligence Center & Fort Huachuca 

ATTN: ATZS-FDR-TA 

Fort Huachuca, AZ 85613-6000 


JFK 
331 


Commander 

USA John F. Kennedy Special Warfare Center and 

School 

ATTN: AOJK-DT-DMO 

Fort Bragg, NC 28310-5000 


AD 
441 


Commandant, U.S. Army Air Defense Artillery School 

ATTN: ATSA-DT 

2 Sheridan Road 

Fort Bliss, TX 79916-3802 


CASCOM 
091 
101 
151 
551 


U.S. Army Combined Arms Support Command 
(CASCOM) Training Directorate 
USACASCOM, ATTN: ATCL-A 
401 First St., Suite 227 
Fort Lee, VA 23801-1511 


SSI 
805C 


Commander, USA Soldier Support Institute 

ATTN: ATSG-TD-HRD 

Fort Jackson, SC 29207-7065 


TRADOC 

Safety Office 

850 


Commander, HQ USA Training and Doctrine Command, 

Safety Office, Bldg 5 

ATTN: ATCS-S 

Fort Monroe, VA 23651-5000 



A-2 



Appendix B 
GUIDE TO FORMS 

This appendix contains a list of forms pertinent to SMCT and CTT 
evaluations and administration. In the electronic, online version of this 
manual, hot links will, where indicated, provide downloadable and 
reproducible copies of the forms. The user can also visit the CTT site in the 
Reimer Digital Library where access to the CTT Manual and CTT Notice 
(Bulletin) provide additional helpful information and links. Some of these 
forms may be available in your unit. 

DA Form 5164-R (Hands On Evaluation), used by CTT scorer to record 
GO/NO GO for each performance measure in a given task. Refer to the 
CTT Manual for the current FY (in the Reimer Digital Library) for links to DA 
Forms 51 64-R that are overprinted with the performance measures for each 
task on the current CTT. 

CTT Performance Sheet used by the CTT scorer to compile all GO/NO GO 
scores to produce an overall GO or NO GO for the soldier's common task 
test. As with the Hands On Evaluation form above, the CTT Performance 
Sheet is different for each FY; it is overprinted with the tasks from the current 
CTT and linked from the CTT Manual (in the Reimer Digital Library) for the 
current FY. 

DA Form 5165-R (Field Expedient Squad Book), used to record task 
proficiency for groups of soldiers in a squad. This squad book should be 
especially beneficial for recording training results gathered during MTP, field 
exercises, or individual training sessions. Once training is completed, 
trainers may transfer information from DA Form 51 65-R to the leader book 
(FM 25-101). 

CTT Roll Up for SL 1-2 and SL3-4 , used by trainers and administrators to 
record performances for larger, unit-size groups of soldiers. This form is a 
good means of seeing and reporting an overall ratio of soldiers passing the 
CTT to the total of those tested. 

DA Form 2028 (Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms), 
used by soldiers and trainers to record any comments or questions 
regarding the task summaries contained in this manual. Use the task 
proponent address for the appropriate proponent code given in appendix A 
(first three digits of the task number). 



B-1 



Glossary 



AA 


assembly area 


ACE 


analysis and control element; armored combat 




earth mover 


AD 


air defense 


ADW 


air defense warning 


AIDS 


acquired immunodeficiency syndrome 


AIPD 


Army Institute for Professional Development 


AIT 


advanced individual training 


alt 


altitude, alternate 


AMC 


air mission commander 


AMDO 


air and missile defense officer 


ANCOC 


Advanced NCO Course 


AO 


area of operations 


AOC 


air operations center 


ARC 


armored cavalry regiment 


ARNG 


Army National Guard 


ASL 


authorized stockage list 


ASR 


alternate supply route 


BCT 


basi c combat trai ni ng 


BDU 


battle dress uniform 


BFV 


Bradley fighting vehicle 


bn 


battalion 


BNCOC 


Basic NCO Course 


C2 


command and control 


C3 


command, control, and communications 


C4I 


command, control, communications, computers, and 




intelligence 


CA 


civil affairs 


CAM 


chemical agent monitor 



Glossary-1 



CB 


center of balance; chemical and biological 


C-E 


commu n i caton -en crypti on 


CED 


captured enemy document 


CEE 


captured enemy equipment 


CEM 


captured enemy material 


cGy 


centigray 


cGy/hr 


centigray per hour 


CH 


chaplain 


chem 


chemical 


CI 


counterintelligence; civilian internee 


CID 


Criminal Investigation Division 


CINC 


commander in chief 


CL 


combat lifesaver 


CM 


centimeter(s) 


CO 


commanding officer 


COA 


course of action 


COMMZ 


communications zone 


COMSEC 


communications security 


CONUS 


continental United States 


COOP 


continuity operations procedures 


CP 


command post 


CSDP 


Command Supply Discipline Program 


CSS 


combat service support 


CTT 


common task test 


DAP 


decontamination apparatus, portable 


DISCOM 


division support command 


div 


division 


DL 


delay lines 


DNBI 


diseases and nonbattle injury 


DOD 


Department of Defense 


DTG 


date-time group 


DTOCSE 


division tactical operations center support element 


DU 


depleted uranium 


Glossary-2 





DZ 


drop zone 


EA 


electronic attack 


ECM 


electronic countermeasures 


EIC 


end item codes 


EMP 


electromagnetic pulse 


EMT 


emergency medical treatment/emergency medical 




technician 


EO 


Equal Opportunity 


EOD 


emergency ordnance detachment 


EOM 


end of mission 


EP 


electronic protection 


EPW 


enemy prisoner of war 


ES 


electronic warfare support 


ESM 


electronic warfare support measures 


EW 


electronic warfare 


EWS 


electronic warfare section 


F 


Fahrenheit 


FDC 


fire direction center 


FEBA 


forward edge of the battle area 


FIST 


fire support team 


FM 


field manual 


FO 


forward observer 


FORSCOM 


Forces Command 


FPF 


final protective fire 


FPL 


final protective line 


FRAGO 


fragmentary order 


FST 


field sanitation team 


FTX 


field training exercise 


G2 


Assistant Chief of Staff, 1 ntelligence 


G3 


Assistant Chief of Staff, Operations 


Gl 


government issue 


GTA 


graphictrainingaid 


HEPA 


high-efficiency particulate air 


HQ 


headquarters 



Glossary-3 



HSB 


heavy support battalion/heavy separate brigade 




(depends on use) 


HTD 


highway traffic division 


HUMINT 


human intelligence 


IAW 


in accordance with 


ICM 


improved conventional munitions 


IDP 


initial delay position 


IEW 


intelligence and electronic warfare 


IEWSE 


intelligence and electronic warfare support element 


IG 


inspector general 


IMINT 


imagery intelligence 


inf 


infantry 


IPB 


intelligence preparation of the battlefield 


ITO 


installation transportation office 


IV 


intravenous 


JAG 


J udge Advocate General 


JP 


joint publication 


JTA 


joint table of allowances 


KIA 


killed in action 


lb 


pound 


LADW 


local air defense warning 


LBE 


load-bearing equipment 


LC 


line of contact 


LD 


line of departure 


LES 


leave and earnings statement 


LET 


light equipment transporter 


LOC 


lines of communications 


LOGPAC 


logistics package 


LPN 


licensed practical nurse 


LZ 


landing zone 


MACOM 


major Army command 


MASINT 


measurement and signature intelligence 


MBA 


main battle area 


MD 


medical doctor 


Glossary-4 





MEDCEN medical center 

MEDDAC medical department activity 

MEDEVAC medical evacuation 

METT-T mission, enemy, terrain, troops, and time available 

(Army); mission, enemy , terrain and weather, 
troops and support available, and time available 
(USMC) 

METT-TC mission, enemy, terrain, troops, time available, and 

civilian considerations 

MHE materials handling equipment 

Ml military intelligence 

mm millimeter 

MOPP mission-oriented protective posture 

MOSC military occupational specialty code 

MOUT military operations on urbanized terrain 

MP military police 

MPA mission planning agent; manpower authorization; 

maritime patrol aircraft 

MPH miles per hour 

MRE meal , ready to eat 

MSO medical supply officer 

MSR main supply route 

MTOE modified table of allowances 

NBC nuclear, biological, and chemical 

NBC 1 report nuclear, biological, and chemical initial report 

NBC 4 report nuclear, biological, and chemical 

monitoring/surveying results 

NBCC nuclear, biological, and chemical center 

NCO noncommissioned officer 

NCOER noncommissioned officer evaluation report 

obj objective 

OBSTINTEL obstacle intelligence 

OCIE organizational clothing and individual equipment 

OEG operational exposure guidance 

OP observation post 



Glossary-5 



OPCON 

OPLAN 

OPORD 

OPSEC 

ORP 

OSHA 

OSUT 

OVE 

PA 

PAC 

PAO 

PATI 

PATS 

PBO 

PCS 

PD 

PDF 

PDY 

PL 

PLDC 

PLL 

PM 

PMCS 

PMM 

PMOSC 

POL 

POSH 

PP 

PS 

PSS 

pub 

PW 

RADIAC 



operational control 

operation plan 

operation order 

operations security 

objective rallying point 

Occupational Safety and Health Administration 

one Station unit training 

on vehicle equipment 

public affairs; physician assistant 

personnel and administration center 

Public Affairs Office, public affairs operations 

protection assessment test instrument 

protection assessment test system 

property book officer 

permanent change of station 

point of departure 

principal direction of fire 

present for duty 

phase line 

Primary Leadership Development Course 

prescribed load list 

provost marshal; preventive maintenance 

preventive maintenance checks and services 

preventive medicine measures 

Primary Military Occupational Specialty Code 

petroleum, oils, and lubricants 

prevention of sexual harassment 

passage point 

personnel services 

personnel service support 

publication 

prisoner of war 

radiation, detection, indication, and computation. 



Glossary-6 



RN 

ROE 

RP 

R&S 

RSR 

RYE 

S2 

SAEDA 

SALUTE 

SIB 

SD 

sig 

SIGINT 

SITREP 

SKO 

SL 

SM 

SMCT 

SME 

SO 

SOI 

SOP 

SP 

SPBS-R 

SPOTREP 

SSA 

STB 

STD 

STP 

SUN 

T/VISC 

TASC 

TB 



registered nurse 

rules of engagement 

release point 

reconnaissance and security 

required supply rate 

retirement year ending 

battalion intelligence officer 

subversion and espionage directed against the Army 

size, activity, location, unit, time, and equipment 

separate infantry brigade 

self-development training 

signal 

signals intelligence 

situation report 

sets, kits, and outfits 

skill level; squad leader 

soldier's manuals; selected marksman 

soldier's manual of common tasks 

subject matter expert 

special operations 

signal operating instructions 

standing operating procedures 

start point 

Standard Property Book System-Redesigned 

spot report 

supply support activity 

super tropical bleach 

sexually transmitted disease 

soldier's training publication 

shipment unit number 

Training/Visual Information Support Center 

Training and Audiovisual Support Center 

Technical Bulletin 



Glossary-7 



TC 


training circular 


TCAE 


technical control and analysis element 


TCP 


traffic control post 


TDA 


table of distribution and allowances 


TECHINT 


technical intelligence 


TF 


task force 


tm 


team 


TOC 


tactical operations center 


TOE 


table of organization and equipment 


TRADOC 


United States Army Training and Doctrine 




Command 


trans 


transportation 


TRP 


target reference point 


TS 


top secret 


TTB 


transportation terminal battalion 


UAV 


unmanned aerial vehicle 


UCMJ 


Uniform Code of MilitaryJ ustice 


UIC 


unit identification code 


ULLS-G 


unit level logistics system-ground 


ULLS-S4 


unit level logistics system-S4 


UMO 


unit movement officer 


U.S. 


United States 


USAR 


U.S. Army Reserve 


WARNO 


warning order 


WCS 


weapons control status 


WESS 


weapons systems status 


WIA 


wounded in action 


WO 


warning order 


z 


Zulu Time 



Glossary-8 



evacuation (JP 1- l. The process of moving any person who is 
02) wounded, injured, or ill to and/or between medical 

treatment facilities. 2. The clearance of personnel, 
animals, or materiel from a given locality. 3. The 
controlled process of collecting, classifying, and 
shipping unserviceable or abandoned material, 
United States and foreign, to appropriate 
reclamation, maintenance, technical intelligence, or 
disposal facilities. (Army) - 1. Theorderedor 
authorized departure of noncombatants from a 
specific area by the Department of State, 
Department of Defense, or appropriate military 
commander. This refers to the movement from one 
area to another in the same or different countries. 
The evacuation is caused by unusual or emergency 
circumstances and applies equally to command or 
noncommand-sponsored family members. 2. A 
combat service support function that involves the 
movement of recovered material, personnel, 
casualties, bodies, prisoners of war, and so forth, 
from a forward collection point along a main supply 
route toa rearward, usually higher unit, exchange 
point, or facility. (See also collection point and 
medical evacuation (MEDEVAQ.) See F Ms 1-111, 
1-112, 7-10, 7-20, 7-30, 8-10-6, 17-95, 17-100, 71-123, 
100-5, and 100-15. 

pace A full 30-inch step as used when marching (1.3 

paces = 1 meter). 

vulnerability The second phase in the hazards analysis process. 

analysis This phase assesses the areas potentially affected by 

the release of a hazardous material, including on 
and off the installation; includes gathering 
information on the extent of the vulnerable zone, 
conditions that influence the zone, size and type of 
population within the zone, missions and critical 
systems that may be impacted, property that might 
be damaged, and the environment that might be 
affected. 



Glossary-9 



References 



REQUIRED PUBLICATIONS 



Required publications are sources that users must read to understand or 
comply with this publication. 

ARMY REGULATIONS 

AR 25-50, Preparing and Managing Correspondence, 3 J une2002. 

AR 25-400-2, The Modern Army Recordkeeping System (MARKS), 1 

October 2000. 
AR 27-10, Military J ustice, 6 September 2002. 
AR 30-22, The Army Food Program, 30 August 2002. 
AR 190-8, Enemy Prisoners of War, Retained Personnel, Civilian 

Internees and Other Detainees (OPNAVINST 3461.6; AFJ I 31-304; 

MCO 3461.1), 1 October 1997. 
AR 190-11, Physical Security of Arms, Ammunition and Explosives, 30 

September 1993. 
AR 190-13, The Army Physical Security Program, 30 September 1993. 
AR 19045, Law Enforcement Reporting, 20 October 2000. 
AR 190-51, Security of U nclassified Army Property (Sensitive and 

Nonsensitive), 30 September 1993. 

AR 22045, Duty Rosters, 15 November 1975. 

AR 350-30, Code of Conduct Survival, Evasion, Resistance and Escape 

(SERE) Training, 10 December 1985. 
AR 360-1, TheArmy Public Affairs Program, 15 September 2000. 
AR 380-5, Department of the Army I nformation Security Program, 29 

September 2000. 

AR 385-10, The Army Safety Program, 23 May 1988. 
AR 385-40, Accident Reporting and Records, 1 November 1994. 
AR 385-55, Prevention of Motor Vehicle Accidents, 12 March 1987. 
AR 525-13, Antiterrorism, 4 J anuary 2002. 

AR 600-8-2, Suspension of Favorable Personnel Actions (FLAGS), 30 
October 1987. 

AR 600-8-22, Military Awards, 25 February 1995. 

References- 1 



AR 600-8-101, Personnel Processing (In-and-Out and Mobilization 
Processing), 12 December 1989. 

AR 600-8-104, Military Personnel Information M anagement/Records, 27 

April 1992. 
AR 600-13, Army Policy for the Assignment of Female Soldiers, 27 March 

1992. 

AR 600-20, Army Command Policy, 13 May 2002. 
AR 600-55, The Army Driver and Operator Standardization Program 
(Selection, Training, Testing, and Licensing), 31 December 1993. 
AR 601-280, Army Retention Program, 31 March 1999. 

AR 623-205, Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation Reporting System, 15 

May 2002. 
AR 630-10, Absence Without Leave, Desertion, and Administration of 

Personnel Involved in Civilian Court Proceedings, 31 August 2001. 

AR 635-200, Enlisted Personnel, 1 November 2000. 

AR 7004, Logistics Assistance, 20 August 2002. 

AR 700-84, 1 ssue and Sale of Personal Clothing, 15 May 1983. 

AR 700-138, Army Logistics Readiness and Sustainability, 16 September 

1997. 
AR 710-2, 1 nventory M anagement Supply Policy Below the Wholesale 

Level, 31 October 1997. 
AR 725-50, Requisition, Receipt, and I ssue System, 15 November 1995. 
AR 735-5, Policies and Procedures for Property Accountability, 10 J une 

2002. 

AR 750-1, Army Materi el Maintenance Policy and Retail Maintenance 

Operations, 1 August 1994. 
AR 750-43, Army Test, Measurement and Diagnostic Equipment 

Program, 28 November 1997. 

DEPARTMENT OF ARMY FORMS 

DA Form 6, Duty Roster 

DA Form 638, Recommendation for Award 

DA Form 1155, Witness Statement on Individual 

DA Form 1156, Casualty Feeder Report 

DA Form 1971-R, Radiological Data Sheet- Monitoring or Point 

Technique 
DA Form 1971-6-R, Chemical/Biological Specimen Documentation 

DA Form 1971-10-R, NBC 4 Radiation Dose Rate 

Measurements/Chemical/Biological Areas of Contamination 

References-2 



DA Form 2166-8, Noncommissioned Officer Evaluation Report 
DA Form 2166-8-1, Noncommissioned Officer Counseling 

Checklist/R ecord 
DA Form 2404, Equipment Inspection and Maintenance Worksheet 
DA Form 2823, Sworn Statement 

DA Form 3881, Rights Warning Procedure/Waiver Certificate 
DA Form 3946, Military Police Traffic Accident Report 
DA Form 3975, Military Police Report 
DA Form 4002, Evidence/Property Tag 
DA Form 4137, Evidence/Property Custody Document 
DA Form 5367-R, Personnel Status Report 

DEPARTMENT OF ARMY PAMPHLETS 

DA Pam 25-30, Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank 

Forms, 1J anuary 2003. 
DA Pam 350-20, Unit Equal Opportunity Training Guide, 30 August 

1993. 

DA Pam 385-1, Small Unit Safety/Officer/NCO Guide, 29 November 

2001. 
DA Pam 600-26, TheDepartment of the Army Affirmative Action Plan, 

30 August 1993. 

DA Pam 710-2-1, Using Unit Supply System (Manual Procedures) 
(Standalone Pub), 31 December 1997. 

DA Pam 710-2-2, Supply Support Activity Supply System: Manual 
Procedures, 30 September 1998. 

DA Pam 738-750, Functional Users Manual for the Army Maintenance 

Management System (TAMMS), 1 August 1994. 
DA Pam 750-1, Leader's Unit Level M aintenance H andbook, 15 February 

1994. 

DA Pam 750-35, Guide for Motor Pool Operations, 1 August 1994. 
DEPARTMENT OF DEFENSE FORMS 

DD Form 1408, Armed Forces TrafficTicket 

DD Form 1805, United States District Court Violation Notice 

DD Form 1920, Alcoholic I nfluence Report 

DEPARTMENT OF DEFENS E PUBLICATIONS 

DODD 7050.6, Military W hi stleblower Protection, 23 J une2000 



References-3 



FIELD MANUALS 

FM 3-05.71(FM 21-78), (C) Resistance and Escape (U), 1 September 

2001. 
FM 3-09.21 (FM 6-20-1), Tactics, Techniques and Procedures for the 

Field Artillery Battalion 22 March 2001 

FM 3-3, Chemical and Biological Contamination Avoidance, 16 
November 1992. 

FM 3-4, NBC Protection, 29 May 1992. 
FM 3-5, NBC Decontamination, 28 J uly 2000. 
FM 3-19.1 (FM 19-1), Military Police Operations, 22 March 2001. 
FM 3-19.4 (FM 19-4), Military Police Leaders' Handbook, 4 March 2002. 
FM 3-19.30 (FM 19-30), Physical Security, 8 J anuary 2001. 
FM 3-19.40 (FM 1940), Military Police Internment/Resettlement 
Operations, 1 August 2001. 

FM 3-21.71 (FM 7-7J ), Mechanized I nfantry Platoon and Squad 
(Bradley), 20 August 2002. 

FM 3-25.26 (FM 21-26), Map Reading and Land Navigation, 20 J uly 
2001. 

FM 3-34.2 (FM 5-101 and FM 90-13-1), Combined-Arms Breaching 

Operations, 31 August 2000. 
FM 3-90.1 (F M 71-1), Tank and Mechanized Infantry Company Team, 9 

December 2002. 

FM 3-90.2 (FM 71-2), TheTank and Mechanized I nfantry BattalionTask 

Force, 11 J une2003. 
FM 4-01.011 (FM 55-65 and FM 55-9), Unit Movement Operations, 31 

October 2002. 

FM 4-25.11 (FM 21-11), First Aid, 23 December 2002. 

FM 4-25.12 (FM 21-10-1), Unit Field Sanitation Team, 25 J anuary 2002. 

FM 4-30.3 (FM 9-43-1), Maintenance Operations and Procedures, 1 

September 2000. 
FM 5-34, Engineer Field Data, 30 August 1999. (Will be revised as FM 

3-34.310). 

FM 5-103, Survivability, 10J unel985. (Will berevised as FM 3-34.112). 
FM 5-170 (FM 5-36), Engineer Reconnaissance, 5Mayl998. (Will be 

revised as FM 3-34.212). 
FM 6-30, Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for Observed Fire, 16 J uly 

1991. (Will berevised as FM 3-09.3). 



References-4 



FM 7-7, The M echanized I nfantry Platoon and Squad (APC), 15 March 
1985. (Will be revised as FM 3-21.7). 

FM 7-8, / nfantry Rifle Platoon and Squad, 22 April 1992. (Will be 

revised as FM 3-21.8). 
FM 7 -20, The I nfantry Battalion, 6 April 1992. (Will berevised as FM 3- 

21.20). 

FM 7-22.7, The Army Noncommissioned Officer Guide, 23 December 

2002. 
FM 8-10-6, Medical Evacuation in a Theater of Operations, Tactics, 

Techniques and Procedures, 14 April 2000. (Will berevised as FM 4- 

02.2). 
F M 10-23, Basic Doctrine for Army Field Feeding and Class I Operations 

Management, 18 April 1996. (Will berevised as FM 4-20.2). 

F M 10-27-4, Organizational Supply and Services for Unit L eaders, 14 

April 2000. (Will berevised as FM 4-20.05). 
FM 17-95, Cavalry Operations, 24 December 1996. (Will berevised as 

FM 3-20.95). 

FM 19-15, Civil Disturbances, 25 November 1985. (Will berevised as 

FM 3-19.15). 
FM 19-20, Law Enforcement Investigations, 25 November 1985. (Will be 

revised as FM 3-19.20). 
FM 19-25, Military PoliceTraffic Operations, 30 September 1977. (Will 

be revised as F M 3-19.25). 
FM 21-10, Field Hygiene and Sanitation, 21 J une 2000. (Will berevised 

asFM 4-25.10). 
FM 21-60, Visual Signals, 30 September 1987. (Will berevised as FM 3- 

12.60). 
FM 21-75, Combat Skills of the Soldier, 3 August 1984. (Will berevised 

asFM 3-21.75). 
FM 22-100, Army Leadership, 31 August 1999. (Will berevised as FM 6- 

22). 

FM 25-101, Battle Focused Training, 30 September 1990. (Will be 

revised as FM 7-1). 
FM 55-1, Transportation Operations, 3 October 1995. (Will berevised as 

FM 4-01). 

FM 55-15, Transportation Reference Data, 27 October 1997. (Will be 

revised as FM 4-01.15). 
FM 55-30, Army Motor Transport Units and Operations, 27 J une 1997. 

(Will berevised as FM 4-01.40). 

References-5 



F M 63-2, Division Support Command, Armored, Infantry, and 

Mechanized I nfantry Divisions, 20 May 1991. (Will be revised as FM 

4-93.2). 
FM 63-2-1, Division Support Command Light Infantry, Airborne, and Air 

Assault Divisions, 16 November 1992. (Will be revised as FM 4- 

93.25). 
FM 63-20, Forward Support Battalion, 26 February 1990. (Will be 

revised as FM 4-93.20). 

FM 63-21, Main Support Battalion, 1 August 1990. (Will be revised as 

FM 4-93.21). 
FM 63-21-1, Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for the Division 

Support Battalion (Digitized). (Will be revised as FM 4-93.51). 

F M 63-23-2, Tactics, Techniques, and Procedures for the Division 

Aviation Support Battalion (Digitized) 
FM 100-10, Combat Service Support, 3 October 1995. (Will be revised as 

FM 4-0). 

FM 100-14, Risk Management, 23 April 1998. (Will be revised asFM 5- 

19). 
FM 100-17, Mobilization, Deployment, Redeployment, Demobilization, 28 

October 1992. (Will be revised as FM 3-35). 

FM 101-5, Staff Organization and Operations, 31 May 1997. (Will be 

revised as FM 5-0). 
FM 101-5-1, Operational Terms and Graphics, 30 September 1997. (Will 

be revised as FM 1-02). 

GRAPHIC TRAINING AIDS 

GTA 03-06-008, NBC Warning and Reporting System, 1 August 1996. 
OTHER PRODUCT TYPES 

CTA 50-900, Clothing and Individual Equipment, 1 September 1994. 
CTA 50-909, Field and Garrison Furnishings and Equipment, 1 August 
1993. 

CTA 50-970, Expendable/Durable Items (Except: Medical, Class V, 
Repair Parts and Heraldic Items), 21 September 1990. 

DD Form 2745, Enemy Prisoner of War (EPW) CaptureTag 
MCM 2002, Manual for Courts-Martial, United States, 2002 Edition, 21 
J une2002. 

STAN AG 2044, Procedures for Dealing with Prisoners of War (PW). 



References-6 



SOLDIER TRAINING PUBLICATIONS 

STP 19-95B1-SM, Soldier's Manual forMOS 95B, Military Police Skill 

Level 1, (E M O) 6 August 2002. 
STP 21-1-SMCT, Soldier's Manual of Common Tasks Skill Level 1, 31 

August 2003. 

TECHNICAL BULLETINS 

TB Med 530, Occupational and Environmental Health Food Service 
Sanitation, 28 November 1991. 

TB Sig 226-8, Chargers, RADIAC Detector PP-1578/PD AND PP- 
1578A/PD, 6 October 1982. 

TB 55-46-1, Standard Characteristics (Dimensions, Weight, and Cube) 
for Transportability of Military Vehicles and Other 
Outsize/Overweight Equipment (In Toe L ine I tern Number Sequence), 
1J anuary 2002. 

TECHNICAL MANUALS 

TM 3-4240-279-10, Operator's Manual for Mask, Chemical -Biological: 

Field, ABC- M 17, M 17A1, M 17A, 5 October 1987. 
TM 3-6665-307-10, Operator's Manual for Chemical Agent Detector Kit, 

M256 and M256A1, 1 September 1985. 

TM 3-9905-001-10, Operator's Manual for M arki ng Set, Contamination: 
Nuclear, Biological, Chemical (NBC), 23 August 1982. 

TM 9-243, Use and Care of Hand Tools and Measuring Tools, 12 
December 1983. 

TM 10-8415-209-10, Operator's Manual for Individual Chemical 
Protective Clothing, 31 M arch 1993. 

TM 11-6665-214-10, Operator's Manual for RADIACMETERS, IM - 

9E/PD, IM-93AJDAND IM -147/PD, 1 August 1986. 
TM 11-6665-232-12, Operator's and Organizational Maintenance Manual 

for RADIACMETERS, IM -174A/PD andIM -174B/PD, 1 October 

1987. 

TM 11-6665-251-10, Operator's M anual for RADIAC Set AN NDR, 1 

March 1988. 
TM 11-6665-365-12&P, Operator's and Unit Maintenance Manual 

(Including Repair Parts and Special Tools List) for RADIAC Set 

AN/PDR-71, 28 February 1995. 

TRAINING CIRCULARS 

TC 3-41, Protection Assessment Test System (PATS), 14 J anuary 1995. 



References-7 



TC 21-7, Personal Financial Readiness and Deployability Handbook, 17 
November 1997. 

TC 26-6, Commander's Equal Opportunity Handbook, 14 October 1994. 

RELATED PUBLICATIONS 

Related publications are sources of additional information. They are not 
required in order to understand this publication. 

ARMY CORRESPONDENCE COURSE PROGRAM SUBCOURSES 

I S0826, Combat Li fesaver Instructor Manual. 

ARMY REGULATIONS 

AR 40-5, Preventive Medicine, 15 October 1990. 
AR 190-22, Searches, Seizures and Disposition of Property, 1 J anuary 
1983. 

AR 220-1, Unit Status Reporting, 30 November 2001. 
AR 350-1, Army Training and Education, 9 April 2003. 
AR 385-63, Policies and Procedures for Firing Ammunition for Training, 
Target Practice and Combat, 15 October 1983. 

AR 600-8-1, Army Casualty Operations/Assistance/I nsurance, 20 October 
1994. 

AR 600-63, Army Health Promotion, 17 November 1987. 

DEPARTMENT OF ARMY FORMS 

DA Form 1971-2-R, Chemical Data Sheet - M onitoring or Survey 

DEPARTMENT OF ARMY PAMPHLETS 

DA Pam 350-59, Army Correspondence Course Program Catalog, 1 

October 2002. 
DA Pam 385-1, Small Unit Safety Officer/N CO Guide, 29 November 

2001. 

DEPARTMENT OF DEFENS E PUBLICATIONS 

DODD 1300.7, Training and Education toSupport the Code of Conduct, 8 
December 2000. 

FIELD MANUALS 

FM 3-0, Operations, 14J une2001. 

FM 3-3-1, Nuclear Contamination Avoidance, 9 September 1994. 
FM 3-22.68 (FM 23-14), M249 Light MachineCun in the Automatic Rifle 
Role, 31 J anuary 2003. 

FM 5-10, Combat Engineer Platoon, 3 October 1995. (Will be revised as 
FM 3-34.220). 

References-8 



FM 5-100, Engineer Operations, 27 February 1996. (Will be revised as 
FM 3-34). 

FM 5-102, Countermobi I ity, 14 March 1985. (Will be revised as FM 3- 

34.1). 
FM 7-10, The I nfantry Rifle Company, 14 December 1990. (Will be 

revised as FM 3-21.10). 

FM 10-1, Quartermaster Principles, 11 August 1994. (Will be revised as 

FM 4-20). 
FM 10-15, Basic Doctrine M anual For Supply And Storage, 12 December 

1990. (Will berevised as FM 4-20.06). 

F M 10-23-1, Commander's Guide to Food Service Operations, 17 M arch 
1992. (Will be revised as FM 4-20.51). 

F M 10-27-3, Tactics, Techniques and Procedures for Quartermaster 
Headquarters, 30 October 1990. (Will berevised as FM 4-20.04). 

FM 19-25, Military Pol ice Traffic Operations, 30 September 1977. (Will 

be revi sed as F M 3-19.25). 
FM 20-3, Camouflage, Concealment, and Decoys, 30 August 1999. (Will 

berevised as FM 3-58.1). 
FM 20-32, Mine/Countermine Operations, 29 May 1998. (Will berevised 

asFM 3-34.32). 

FM 23-1, Bradley Gunnery, 18 March 1996. (Will berevised as FM 3- 

22.1). 
FM 23-90, Mortars, 1 March 2000. (Will berevised asFM 3-22.90). 
F M 34-1, Intelligence and Electronic Warfare Operations, 27 September 

1994. (Will berevised as FM 2-0). 

FM 34-3, Intelligence Analysis, 15 March 1990. (Will berevised as FM 2- 

33.4). 
F M 34-10, Division Intelligence and Electronics Warfare Operations, 25 

November 1986. (Will berevised as FM 2-19.3). 

FM 34-25, Corps Intelligence and Electronic Warfare Operations, 30 

September 1987. (Will berevised as FM 2-19.2). 
FM 34-52, Intelligence Interrogation, 28 September 1992. (Will be 

revised as FM 2-22.3). 

FM 34-54, Technical Intelligence, 30 J anuary 1998. (Will be revised as 

FM 2-22.4). 
FM 34-130, Intelligence Preparation of the Battlefield, 8J uly 1994. (Will 

be revised as F M 2-01.3). 

FM 44-8, Combined Arms for the Air Defense, 1J unel999. (Will be 
revised as FM 3-01.8). 

References-9 



FM 44-80, Visual Aircraft Recognition, 30 September 1996. (Will be 
revised as FM 3-01.80). 

FM 44-100, U.S. Army Air and Missile Defense Operations, 15 J une 
2000. (Will be revised as FM 3-01). 

FM 46-1, Public Affairs Operations, 30 May 1997. 
FM 100-15, Corps Operations, 29 October 1996. (Will be revised as FM 
3-92). 

TECHNICAL MANUALS 

TM 3-4240-279- 20&P, Unit Maintenance Manual (Including Repair 
Parts and Special Tools List) for Mask, Chemical -Biological; Field, 
ABC-M17, M17A1, M17A2, 5 October 1987. 

TM 9-2320-273-10, Truck Tractor, Line Haul, 50,000 GVWR, 6X4, M915; 
Light Equipment Transporter (LET), 56,000 GVWR, 6X6, W/Winch, 
M916; Medium Equipment Transporter (MET) 75,000 GVWR, 8x6 
W/Winch, M920; Truck Chassis, 75,000 GVWR, 8x6 for 20-ton Dump 
Truck, M917; 56,000 GVWR, 6x6 for Bituminous Distributor Truck, 
M918, 75,000 GVWR, 8x6 for Concrete Mobile Mixer Truck, M919, 15 
May 1980. 

TM 9-2320-279-10-1, Operator's Manual for M 977 Series 8X8 Heavy 
Expanded, MOBILITY Tactical Trucks (HEMTT), Truck, Cargo, with 
Winch, M 977 Truck, Cargo, etc, 21 November 1986. 

TM 9-2320-279-10-2, Operator's Manual for M977 Series, 8X8 Heavy 
Expanded Mobility Tactical Trucks (HEMTT) Truck, Cargo, with 
Winch, M 977 (2320-01-097-0260) Truck, Cargo, without Winch, etc., 
15 J une 1987. 

TM 9-2320-280-10, Operator's Manual for Truck, Utility: Cargo/Troop 

Carrier, 1-1/4 TON, 4X4, M998 (NSN 2320-01-107-7155) (EIC: BBD); 

M998A1 (2320-01-371-9577) (EIC.BBN); Truck, Utility: Cargo etc., 31 

J anuary 1996. 
TM 9-2320-283-10, Operator's Manual for Truck Tractor, Line Haul; 

50,000 GVWR, 6X4, M915A1 (NSN 2320-01-125-2640), 27 J une 1983. 

TM 9-2320-289-10, Operator's Manual for Truck, Cargo, Tactical, 1-1/4 
Ton, 4X4, M1008 (NSN 2320-01-123-6827) Truck, Cargo, Tactical, 1- 
1/4 Ton, 4X4, M1008A1 (2320-01-123-2671) Truck, Utility, Tactical 3 A 
Ton etc, 4J ulyl986. 

TM 9-2320-360-10, Operator's Manual for Truck, Tractor, M1070, 8X8, 
Heavy Equipment Transporter (HET) (NSN 2320-01-318-9902), 31 
M arch 1994. 



References- 10 



TM 9-2320-361-10, Operator's Manual for 2-1/2-TON, 6X6, M44A2 Series 
Truck (Multifuel); Truck, Cargo: 2-1/2-Ton, 6X6, M35A2, M35A2C, 
M36A2, Truck, Tank, Fuel: 2-1/2-TON, 6X6, M49A2C; Truck, Tank, 
etc., 15 December 1988. 

TM 9-2320-364-10, Operator's Manual for Truck, Tractor, M1074 and 
M 1075 Palletized Load System (PLS) (NSN 2320-01-304-2277) (2320- 
01-304-2278), 1 August 1999. 

TM 9-2320-365-10, Operator's Instructions for M1078 Series, 2-1/2 Ton, 
4X4 Light Medium Tactical Vehicles (LMTV) Truck, Cargo, LMTV, 
M1078 W/WN (NSN 2320-01-360-1898), etc., 17 J une 1998. 

TM 9-2320-366-10-1, Operator's Instructions Manual for M1083 Series, 
5-Ton, 6X6, Medium Tactical Vehicles (MTV) Volume 1 of 2 Truck, 
Cargo, MTV, M1083 w/Wn (NSN 2320-01-360-1895) (E I C:BT 3) w/o 
Wn (2320-01-354-3386)(EIC:BR2) Truck, Cargo, MTV w/MATL 
HDLGEQPT (MHE), etc., 15 September 1998. 

TM 9-2320-366-10-2, Operator's Instructions Manual for M1083 Series, 
5-Ton, 6X6, Medium Tactical Vehicles (MTV) Volume 2 of 2 Truck, 
Cargo, MTV, M1083 w/Wn (NSN 2320-01-360-1895)(EIC:BT3) w/o 
Wn (2320-01-354-3386)(EIC:BR2) Truck, Cargo, MTV w/MATL 
HDLGEQPT (MHE) etc., 15 September 1998. 

TM 11-6665-236-12, Operator's and Unit Maintenance Manual for 
RADIAC Set, AN/PDR -75, 1 J une 1995. 

TM 38-250, Preparing Hazardous Materials for Military Air Shipments 
(AFMAN 24-204; NAVSUP PUB 505; MCO P4030.19H; DLAl 
4145.3), 12 December 2001. 



References-11 



STP21-24-SMCT 
31 AUGUST 2003 



By Order of the Secretary of the Army: 



PETER J. SCHOOMAKER 

General, United States Army 
Chief of Staff 



Official: 



JOEL B. HUDSON 

Administrative Assistant to the 
Secretary of the Army 
0320901 



DISTRIBUTION: 

Active Army, Army National Guard, and US Army Reserve: Distribute in accordance 
with the initial distribution number IDN 1 1 4379, requirements for STP 21-24-SMCT. 



PIN: 065276-000